]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - etc/NEWS
Advertize Makefile mode changes.
[gnu-emacs] / etc / NEWS
1 GNU Emacs NEWS -- history of user-visible changes. 2003-05-21
2 Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005
3 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 See the end for copying conditions.
5
6 Please send Emacs bug reports to bug-gnu-emacs@gnu.org.
7 For older news, see the file ONEWS
8 You can narrow news to the specific version by calling
9 `view-emacs-news' with a prefix argument or by typing C-u C-h C-n.
10
11 Temporary note:
12 +++ indicates that the appropriate manual has already been updated.
13 --- means no change in the manuals is called for.
14 When you add a new item, please add it without either +++ or ---
15 so we will look at it and add it to the manual.
16
17 \f
18 * Installation Changes in Emacs 22.1
19
20 ---
21 ** Emacs now supports new configure options `--program-prefix',
22 `--program-suffix' and `--program-transform-name' that affect the names of
23 installed programs.
24
25 ---
26 ** Emacs can now be built without sound support.
27
28 ---
29 ** You can build Emacs with Gtk+ widgets by specifying `--with-x-toolkit=gtk'
30 when you run configure. This requires Gtk+ 2.0 or newer. This port
31 provides a way to display multilingual text in menus (with some caveats).
32
33 ---
34 ** The `emacsserver' program has been removed, replaced with elisp code.
35
36 ---
37 ** By default, Emacs now uses a setgid helper program to update game
38 scores. The directory ${localstatedir}/games/emacs is the normal
39 place for game scores to be stored. You can control this with the
40 configure option `--with-game-dir'. The specific user that Emacs uses
41 to own the game scores is controlled by `--with-game-user'. If access
42 to a game user is not available, then scores will be stored separately
43 in each user's home directory.
44
45 ---
46 ** Leim is now part of the Emacs distribution.
47 You no longer need to download a separate tarball in order to build
48 Emacs with Leim.
49
50 +++
51 ** The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual is now part of the distribution.
52
53 The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual in Info format is built as part of the
54 Emacs build procedure and installed together with the Emacs User
55 Manual. A menu item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy
56 accessible (Help->More Manuals->Emacs Lisp Reference).
57
58 ---
59 ** The Introduction to Programming in Emacs Lisp manual is now part of
60 the distribution.
61
62 This manual is now part of the standard distribution and is installed,
63 together with the Emacs User Manual, into the Info directory. A menu
64 item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy accessible
65 (Help->More Manuals->Introduction to Emacs Lisp).
66
67 ---
68 ** New translations of the Emacs Tutorial are available in the
69 following languages: Brasilian Portuguese, Bulgarian, Chinese (both
70 with simplified and traditional characters), French, and Italian.
71 Type `C-u C-h t' to choose one of them in case your language setup
72 doesn't automatically select the right one.
73
74 ---
75 ** A French translation of the `Emacs Survival Guide' is available.
76
77 ---
78 ** Emacs now includes support for loading image libraries on demand.
79 (Currently this feature is only used on MS Windows.) You can configure
80 the supported image types and their associated dynamic libraries by
81 setting the variable `image-library-alist'.
82
83 ---
84 ** Support for Cygwin was added.
85
86 ---
87 ** Support for FreeBSD/Alpha has been added.
88
89 ---
90 ** Support for GNU/Linux systems on S390 machines was added.
91
92 ---
93 ** Support for MacOS X was added.
94 See the files mac/README and mac/INSTALL for build instructions.
95
96 ---
97 ** Support for GNU/Linux systems on X86-64 machines was added.
98
99 ---
100 ** Mac OS 9 port now uses the Carbon API by default. You can also
101 create non-Carbon build by specifying `NonCarbon' as a target. See
102 the files mac/README and mac/INSTALL for build instructions.
103
104 ---
105 ** Building with -DENABLE_CHECKING does not automatically build with union
106 types any more. Add -DUSE_LISP_UNION_TYPE if you want union types.
107
108 ---
109 ** When pure storage overflows while dumping, Emacs now prints how
110 much pure storage it will approximately need.
111 \f
112 * Startup Changes in Emacs 22.1
113
114 ** New command line option -Q or --quick.
115 This is like using -q --no-site-file, but in addition it also disables
116 the fancy startup screen.
117
118 +++
119 ** New command line option -D or --basic-display.
120 Disables the menu-bar, the tool-bar, the scroll-bars, tool tips, and
121 the blinking cursor.
122
123 +++
124 ** New command line option -nbc or --no-blinking-cursor disables
125 the blinking cursor on graphical terminals.
126
127 +++
128 ** The option --script FILE runs Emacs in batch mode and loads FILE.
129 It is useful for writing Emacs Lisp shell script files, because they
130 can start with this line:
131
132 #!/usr/bin/emacs --script
133
134 +++
135 ** The option --directory DIR now modifies `load-path' immediately.
136 Directories are added to the front of `load-path' in the order they
137 appear on the command line. For example, with this command line:
138
139 emacs -batch -L .. -L /tmp --eval "(require 'foo)"
140
141 Emacs looks for library `foo' in the parent directory, then in /tmp, then
142 in the other directories in `load-path'. (-L is short for --directory.)
143
144 +++
145 ** The command line option --no-windows has been changed to
146 --no-window-system. The old one still works, but is deprecated.
147
148 +++
149 ** The -f option, used from the command line to call a function,
150 now reads arguments for the function interactively if it is
151 an interactively callable function.
152
153 +++
154 ** When you specify a frame size with --geometry, the size applies to
155 all frames you create. A position specified with --geometry only
156 affects the initial frame.
157
158 +++
159 ** Emacs can now be invoked in full-screen mode on a windowed display.
160 When Emacs is invoked on a window system, the new command-line options
161 `--fullwidth', `--fullheight', and `--fullscreen' produce a frame
162 whose width, height, or both width and height take up the entire
163 screen size. (For now, this does not work with some window managers.)
164
165 +++
166 ** Emacs now displays a splash screen by default even if command-line
167 arguments were given. The new command-line option --no-splash
168 disables the splash screen; see also the variable
169 `inhibit-startup-message' (which is also aliased as
170 `inhibit-splash-screen').
171
172 +++
173 ** New user option `inhibit-startup-buffer-menu'.
174 When loading many files, for instance with `emacs *', Emacs normally
175 displays a buffer menu. This option turns the buffer menu off.
176
177 +++
178 ** Init file changes
179 You can now put the init files .emacs and .emacs_SHELL under
180 ~/.emacs.d or directly under ~. Emacs will find them in either place.
181
182 +++
183 ** Emacs now reads the standard abbrevs file ~/.abbrev_defs
184 automatically at startup, if it exists. When Emacs offers to save
185 modified buffers, it saves the abbrevs too if they have changed. It
186 can do this either silently or asking for confirmation first,
187 according to the value of `save-abbrevs'.
188 \f
189 * Incompatible Editing Changes in Emacs 22.1
190
191 +++
192 ** M-g is now a prefix key.
193 M-g g and M-g M-g run goto-line.
194 M-g n and M-g M-n run next-error (like C-x `).
195 M-g p and M-g M-p run previous-error.
196
197 +++
198 ** C-u M-g M-g switches to the most recent previous buffer,
199 and goes to the specified line in that buffer.
200
201 When goto-line starts to execute, if there's a number in the buffer at
202 point then it acts as the default argument for the minibuffer.
203
204 +++
205 ** The old bindings C-M-delete and C-M-backspace have been deleted,
206 since there are situations where one or the other will shut down
207 the operating system or your X server.
208
209 +++
210 ** line-move-ignore-invisible now defaults to t.
211
212 +++
213 ** When the undo information of the current command gets really large
214 (beyond the value of `undo-outer-limit'), Emacs discards it and warns
215 you about it.
216
217 +++
218 ** `apply-macro-to-region-lines' now operates on all lines that begin
219 in the region, rather than on all complete lines in the region.
220
221 +++
222 ** A prefix argument is no longer required to repeat a jump to a
223 previous mark, i.e. C-u C-SPC C-SPC C-SPC ... cycles through the
224 mark ring. Use C-u C-u C-SPC to set the mark immediately after a jump.
225
226 +++
227 ** The info-search bindings on C-h C-f, C-h C-k and C-h C-i
228 have been moved to C-h F, C-h K and C-h S.
229
230 +++
231 ** In incremental search, C-w is changed. M-%, C-M-w and C-M-y are special.
232
233 See below under "incremental search changes".
234
235 ---
236 ** C-x C-f RET, typing nothing in the minibuffer, is no longer a special case.
237
238 Since the default input is the current directory, this has the effect
239 of specifying the current directory. Normally that means to visit the
240 directory with Dired.
241
242 +++
243 ** The completion commands TAB, SPC and ? in the minibuffer apply only
244 to the text before point. If there is text in the buffer after point,
245 it remains unchanged.
246
247 +++
248 ** M-o now is the prefix key for setting text properties;
249 M-o M-o requests refontification.
250
251 +++
252 ** You can now follow links by clicking Mouse-1 on the link.
253
254 See below for more details.
255
256 +++
257 ** In Dired's ! command (dired-do-shell-command), `*' and `?' now
258 control substitution of the file names only when they are surrounded
259 by whitespace. This means you can now use them as shell wildcards
260 too. If you want to use just plain `*' as a wildcard, type `*""'; the
261 doublequotes make no difference in the shell, but they prevent
262 special treatment in `dired-do-shell-command'.
263 \f
264 * Editing Changes in Emacs 22.1
265
266 +++
267 ** The max size of buffers and integers has been doubled.
268 On 32bit machines, it is now 256M (i.e. 268435455).
269
270 +++
271 ** M-g is now a prefix key.
272 M-g g and M-g M-g run goto-line.
273 M-g n and M-g M-n run next-error (like C-x `).
274 M-g p and M-g M-p run previous-error.
275
276 +++
277 ** C-u M-g M-g switches to the most recent previous buffer,
278 and goes to the specified line in that buffer.
279
280 When goto-line starts to execute, if there's a number in the buffer at
281 point then it acts as the default argument for the minibuffer.
282
283 +++
284 ** The old bindings C-M-delete and C-M-backspace have been deleted,
285 since there are situations where one or the other will shut down
286 the operating system or your X server.
287
288 +++
289 ** line-move-ignore-invisible now defaults to t.
290
291 +++
292 ** When the undo information of the current command gets really large
293 (beyond the value of `undo-outer-limit'), Emacs discards it and warns
294 you about it.
295
296 +++
297 ** `apply-macro-to-region-lines' now operates on all lines that begin
298 in the region, rather than on all complete lines in the region.
299
300 +++
301 ** You can now switch buffers in a cyclic order with C-x C-left and
302 (prev-buffer) and C-x C-right (next-buffer). C-x left and C-x right
303 can be used as well.
304
305 +++
306 ** `undo-only' does an undo which does not redo any previous undo.
307
308 +++
309 ** M-SPC (just-one-space) when given a numeric argument N
310 converts whitespace around point to N spaces.
311
312 ---
313 ** New commands to operate on pairs of open and close characters:
314 `insert-pair', `delete-pair', `raise-sexp'.
315
316 ---
317 ** New command `kill-whole-line' kills an entire line at once.
318 By default, it is bound to C-S-<backspace>.
319
320 +++
321 ** Yanking text now discards certain text properties that can
322 be inconvenient when you did not expect them. The variable
323 `yank-excluded-properties' specifies which ones. Insertion
324 of register contents and rectangles also discards these properties.
325
326 +++
327 ** The default values of paragraph-start and indent-line-function have
328 been changed to reflect those used in Text mode rather than those used
329 in Indented-Text mode.
330
331 +++
332 ** M-x setenv now expands environment variable references.
333
334 Substrings of the form `$foo' and `${foo}' in the specified new value
335 now refer to the value of environment variable foo. To include a `$'
336 in the value, use `$$'.
337
338 +++
339 ** `special-display-buffer-names' and `special-display-regexps' now
340 understand two new boolean pseudo-frame-parameters `same-frame' and
341 `same-window'.
342
343 +++
344 ** The default for the paper size (variable ps-paper-type) is taken
345 from the locale.
346
347 ** Mark command changes:
348
349 +++
350 *** A prefix argument is no longer required to repeat a jump to a
351 previous mark, i.e. C-u C-SPC C-SPC C-SPC ... cycles through the
352 mark ring. Use C-u C-u C-SPC to set the mark immediately after a jump.
353
354 +++
355 *** Marking commands extend the region when invoked multiple times.
356
357 If you type C-M-SPC (mark-sexp), M-@ (mark-word), M-h
358 (mark-paragraph), or C-M-h (mark-defun) repeatedly, the marked region
359 extends each time, so you can mark the next two sexps with M-C-SPC
360 M-C-SPC, for example. This feature also works for
361 mark-end-of-sentence, if you bind that to a key. It also extends the
362 region when the mark is active in Transient Mark mode, regardless of
363 the last command. To start a new region with one of marking commands
364 in Transient Mark mode, you can deactivate the active region with C-g,
365 or set the new mark with C-SPC.
366
367 +++
368 *** M-h (mark-paragraph) now accepts a prefix arg.
369
370 With positive arg, M-h marks the current and the following paragraphs;
371 if the arg is negative, it marks the current and the preceding
372 paragraphs.
373
374 +++
375 *** Some commands do something special in Transient Mark mode when the
376 mark is active--for instance, they limit their operation to the
377 region. Even if you don't normally use Transient Mark mode, you might
378 want to get this behavior from a particular command. There are two
379 ways you can enable Transient Mark mode and activate the mark, for one
380 command only.
381
382 One method is to type C-SPC C-SPC; this enables Transient Mark mode
383 and sets the mark at point. The other method is to type C-u C-x C-x.
384 This enables Transient Mark mode temporarily but does not alter the
385 mark or the region.
386
387 After these commands, Transient Mark mode remains enabled until you
388 deactivate the mark. That typically happens when you type a command
389 that alters the buffer, but you can also deactivate the mark by typing
390 C-g.
391
392 +++
393 *** Movement commands `beginning-of-buffer', `end-of-buffer',
394 `beginning-of-defun', `end-of-defun' do not set the mark if the mark
395 is already active in Transient Mark mode.
396
397 ** Help command changes:
398
399 +++
400 *** Changes in C-h bindings:
401
402 C-h e displays the *Messages* buffer.
403
404 C-h followed by a control character is used for displaying files
405 that do not change:
406
407 C-h C-f displays the FAQ.
408 C-h C-e displays the PROBLEMS file.
409
410 The info-search bindings on C-h C-f, C-h C-k and C-h C-i
411 have been moved to C-h F, C-h K and C-h S.
412
413 C-h c, C-h k, C-h w, and C-h f now handle remapped interactive commands.
414
415 - C-h c and C-h k report the actual command (after possible remapping)
416 run by the key sequence.
417
418 - C-h w and C-h f on a command which has been remapped now report the
419 command it is remapped to, and the keys which can be used to run
420 that command.
421
422 For example, if C-k is bound to kill-line, and kill-line is remapped
423 to new-kill-line, these commands now report:
424
425 - C-h c and C-h k C-k reports:
426 C-k runs the command new-kill-line
427
428 - C-h w and C-h f kill-line reports:
429 kill-line is remapped to new-kill-line which is on C-k, <deleteline>
430
431 - C-h w and C-h f new-kill-line reports:
432 new-kill-line is on C-k
433
434 ---
435 *** Help commands `describe-function' and `describe-key' now show function
436 arguments in lowercase italics on displays that support it. To change the
437 default, customize face `help-argument-name' or redefine the function
438 `help-default-arg-highlight'.
439
440 +++
441 *** C-h v and C-h f commands now include a hyperlink to the C source for
442 variables and functions defined in C (if the C source is available).
443
444 +++
445 *** Help mode now only makes hyperlinks for faces when the face name is
446 preceded or followed by the word `face'. It no longer makes
447 hyperlinks for variables without variable documentation, unless
448 preceded by one of the words `variable' or `option'. It now makes
449 hyperlinks to Info anchors (or nodes) if the anchor (or node) name is
450 enclosed in single quotes and preceded by `info anchor' or `Info
451 anchor' (in addition to earlier `info node' and `Info node').
452
453 +++
454 *** The new command `describe-char' (C-u C-x =) pops up a buffer with
455 description various information about a character, including its
456 encodings and syntax, its text properties, how to input, overlays, and
457 widgets at point. You can get more information about some of them, by
458 clicking on mouse-sensitive areas or moving there and pressing RET.
459
460 +++
461 *** The command `list-text-properties-at' has been deleted because
462 C-u C-x = gives the same information and more.
463
464 +++
465 *** New command `display-local-help' displays any local help at point
466 in the echo area. It is bound to `C-h .'. It normally displays the
467 same string that would be displayed on mouse-over using the
468 `help-echo' property, but, in certain cases, it can display a more
469 keyboard oriented alternative.
470
471 +++
472 *** New user option `help-at-pt-display-when-idle' allows to
473 automatically show the help provided by `display-local-help' on
474 point-over, after suitable idle time. The amount of idle time is
475 determined by the user option `help-at-pt-timer-delay' and defaults
476 to one second. This feature is turned off by default.
477
478 +++
479 *** The apropos commands now accept a list of words to match.
480 When more than one word is specified, at least two of those words must
481 be present for an item to match. Regular expression matching is still
482 available.
483
484 +++
485 *** The new option `apropos-sort-by-scores' causes the matching items
486 to be sorted according to their score. The score for an item is a
487 number calculated to indicate how well the item matches the words or
488 regular expression that you entered to the apropos command. The best
489 match is listed first, and the calculated score is shown for each
490 matching item.
491
492 ** Incremental Search changes:
493
494 +++
495 *** Vertical scrolling is now possible within incremental search.
496 To enable this feature, customize the new user option
497 `isearch-allow-scroll'. User written commands which satisfy stringent
498 constraints can be marked as "scrolling commands". See the Emacs manual
499 for details.
500
501 +++
502 *** C-w in incremental search now grabs either a character or a word,
503 making the decision in a heuristic way. This new job is done by the
504 command `isearch-yank-word-or-char'. To restore the old behavior,
505 bind C-w to `isearch-yank-word' in `isearch-mode-map'.
506
507 +++
508 *** C-y in incremental search now grabs the next line if point is already
509 at the end of a line.
510
511 +++
512 *** C-M-w deletes and C-M-y grabs a character in isearch mode.
513 Another method to grab a character is to enter the minibuffer by `M-e'
514 and to type `C-f' at the end of the search string in the minibuffer.
515
516 +++
517 *** M-% typed in isearch mode invokes `query-replace' or
518 `query-replace-regexp' (depending on search mode) with the current
519 search string used as the string to replace.
520
521 +++
522 *** Isearch no longer adds `isearch-resume' commands to the command
523 history by default. To enable this feature, customize the new
524 user option `isearch-resume-in-command-history'.
525
526 ** Replace command changes:
527
528 ---
529 *** New user option `query-replace-skip-read-only': when non-nil,
530 `query-replace' and related functions simply ignore
531 a match if part of it has a read-only property.
532
533 +++
534 *** When used interactively, the commands `query-replace-regexp' and
535 `replace-regexp' allow \,expr to be used in a replacement string,
536 where expr is an arbitrary Lisp expression evaluated at replacement
537 time. In many cases, this will be more convenient than using
538 `query-replace-regexp-eval'. `\#' in a replacement string now refers
539 to the count of replacements already made by the replacement command.
540 All regular expression replacement commands now allow `\?' in the
541 replacement string to specify a position where the replacement string
542 can be edited for each replacement.
543
544 +++
545 *** query-replace uses isearch lazy highlighting when the new user option
546 `query-replace-lazy-highlight' is non-nil.
547
548 ---
549 *** The current match in query-replace is highlighted in new face
550 `query-replace' which by default inherits from isearch face.
551
552 ** File operation changes:
553
554 +++
555 *** Unquoted `$' in file names do not signal an error any more when
556 the corresponding environment variable does not exist.
557 Instead, the `$ENVVAR' text is left as is, so that `$$' quoting
558 is only rarely needed.
559
560 +++
561 *** In processing a local variables list, Emacs strips the prefix and
562 suffix are from every line before processing all the lines.
563
564 +++
565 *** find-file-read-only visits multiple files in read-only mode,
566 when the file name contains wildcard characters.
567
568 +++
569 *** find-alternate-file replaces the current file with multiple files,
570 when the file name contains wildcard characters.
571
572 +++
573 *** Auto Compression mode is now enabled by default.
574
575 ---
576 *** C-x C-f RET, typing nothing in the minibuffer, is no longer a special case.
577
578 Since the default input is the current directory, this has the effect
579 of specifying the current directory. Normally that means to visit the
580 directory with Dired.
581
582 +++
583 *** When you are root, and you visit a file whose modes specify
584 read-only, the Emacs buffer is now read-only too. Type C-x C-q if you
585 want to make the buffer writable. (As root, you can in fact alter the
586 file.)
587
588 +++
589 *** C-x s (save-some-buffers) now offers an option `d' to diff a buffer
590 against its file, so you can see what changes you would be saving.
591
592 +++
593 *** The commands copy-file, rename-file, make-symbolic-link and
594 add-name-to-file, when given a directory as the "new name" argument,
595 convert it to a file name by merging in the within-directory part of
596 the existing file's name. (This is the same convention that shell
597 commands cp, mv, and ln follow.) Thus, M-x copy-file RET ~/foo RET
598 /tmp RET copies ~/foo to /tmp/foo.
599
600 ---
601 *** When used interactively, `format-write-file' now asks for confirmation
602 before overwriting an existing file, unless a prefix argument is
603 supplied. This behavior is analogous to `write-file'.
604
605 ---
606 *** The variable `auto-save-file-name-transforms' now has a third element that
607 controls whether or not the function `make-auto-save-file-name' will
608 attempt to construct a unique auto-save name (e.g. for remote files).
609
610 +++
611 *** If the user visits a file larger than `large-file-warning-threshold',
612 Emacs asks for confirmation.
613
614 +++
615 *** require-final-newline now has two new possible values:
616
617 `visit' means add a newline (as an undoable change) if it's needed
618 when visiting the file.
619
620 `visit-save' means add a newline (as an undoable change) if it's
621 needed when visiting the file, and also add a newline if it's needed
622 when saving the file.
623
624 +++
625 *** The new option mode-require-final-newline controls how certain
626 major modes enable require-final-newline. Any major mode that's
627 designed for a kind of file that should normally end in a newline
628 sets require-final-newline based on mode-require-final-newline.
629 So you can customize mode-require-final-newline to control what these
630 modes do.
631
632 ** Minibuffer changes:
633
634 +++
635 *** There's a new face `minibuffer-prompt'.
636 Emacs adds this face to the list of text properties stored in the
637 variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', which is used to display the
638 prompt string.
639
640 ---
641 *** Enhanced visual feedback in `*Completions*' buffer.
642
643 Completions lists use faces to highlight what all completions
644 have in common and where they begin to differ.
645
646 The common prefix shared by all possible completions uses the face
647 `completions-common-part', while the first character that isn't the
648 same uses the face `completions-first-difference'. By default,
649 `completions-common-part' inherits from `default', and
650 `completions-first-difference' inherits from `bold'. The idea of
651 `completions-common-part' is that you can use it to make the common
652 parts less visible than normal, so that the rest of the differing
653 parts is, by contrast, slightly highlighted.
654
655 +++
656 *** File-name completion can now ignore specified directories.
657 If an element of the list in `completion-ignored-extensions' ends in a
658 slash `/', it indicates a subdirectory that should be ignored when
659 completing file names. Elements of `completion-ignored-extensions'
660 which do not end in a slash are never considered when a completion
661 candidate is a directory.
662
663 +++
664 *** The completion commands TAB, SPC and ? in the minibuffer apply only
665 to the text before point. If there is text in the buffer after point,
666 it remains unchanged.
667
668 +++
669 *** New user option `history-delete-duplicates'.
670 If set to t when adding a new history element, all previous identical
671 elements are deleted.
672
673 ** Redisplay changes:
674
675 +++
676 *** The mode line position information now comes before the major mode.
677 When the file is maintained under version control, that information
678 appears between the position information and the major mode.
679
680 *** Easy to overlook single character negation is now font-locked.
681 You can use the new variable `font-lock-negation-char-face' and the face of
682 the same name to customize this. Currently the cc-modes, sh-script-mode,
683 cperl-mode and make-mode support this.
684
685 +++
686 *** Control characters and escape glyphs are now shown in the new
687 escape-glyph face.
688
689 +++
690 *** Non-breaking space and hyphens are now prefixed with an escape
691 character, unless the new user variable `show-nonbreak-escape' is set
692 to nil.
693
694 +++
695 *** The parameters of automatic hscrolling can now be customized.
696 The variable `hscroll-margin' determines how many columns away from
697 the window edge point is allowed to get before automatic hscrolling
698 will horizontally scroll the window. The default value is 5.
699
700 The variable `hscroll-step' determines how many columns automatic
701 hscrolling scrolls the window when point gets too close to the
702 window edge. If its value is zero, the default, Emacs scrolls the
703 window so as to center point. If its value is an integer, it says how
704 many columns to scroll. If the value is a floating-point number, it
705 gives the fraction of the window's width to scroll the window.
706
707 The variable `automatic-hscrolling' was renamed to
708 `auto-hscroll-mode'. The old name is still available as an alias.
709
710 *** Moving or scrolling through images (and other lines) taller that
711 the window now works sensibly, by automatically adjusting the window's
712 vscroll property.
713
714 +++
715 *** The new face `mode-line-inactive' is used to display the mode line
716 of non-selected windows. The `mode-line' face is now used to display
717 the mode line of the currently selected window.
718
719 The new variable `mode-line-in-non-selected-windows' controls whether
720 the `mode-line-inactive' face is used.
721
722 +++
723 *** You can now customize the use of window fringes. To control this
724 for all frames, use M-x fringe-mode or the Show/Hide submenu of the
725 top-level Options menu, or customize the `fringe-mode' variable. To
726 control this for a specific frame, use the command M-x
727 set-fringe-style.
728
729 +++
730 *** Angle icons in the fringes can indicate the buffer boundaries. In
731 addition, up and down arrow bitmaps in the fringe indicate which ways
732 the window can be scrolled.
733
734 This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
735 `indicate-buffer-boundaries' to a non-nil value. The default value of
736 this variable is found in `default-indicate-buffer-boundaries'.
737
738 If value is `left' or `right', both angle and arrow bitmaps are
739 displayed in the left or right fringe, resp.
740
741 The value can also be an alist which specifies the presense and
742 position of each bitmap individually.
743
744 For example, ((top . left) (t . right)) places the top angle bitmap
745 in left fringe, the bottom angle bitmap in right fringe, and both
746 arrow bitmaps in right fringe. To show just the angle bitmaps in the
747 left fringe, but no arrow bitmaps, use ((top . left) (bottom . left)).
748
749 +++
750 *** On window systems, lines which are exactly as wide as the window
751 (not counting the final newline character) are no longer broken into
752 two lines on the display (with just the newline on the second line).
753 Instead, the newline now "overflows" into the right fringe, and the
754 cursor will be displayed in the fringe when positioned on that newline.
755
756 The new user option 'overflow-newline-into-fringe' can be set to nil to
757 revert to the old behavior of continuing such lines.
758
759 +++
760 *** When a window has display margin areas, the fringes are now
761 displayed between the margins and the buffer's text area, rather than
762 outside those margins.
763
764 +++
765 *** A window can now have individual fringe and scroll-bar settings,
766 in addition to the individual display margin settings.
767
768 Such individual settings are now preserved when windows are split
769 horizontally or vertically, a saved window configuration is restored,
770 or when the frame is resized.
771
772 ** Cursor display changes:
773
774 +++
775 *** On X, MS Windows, and Mac OS, the blinking cursor's "off" state is
776 now controlled by the variable `blink-cursor-alist'.
777
778 +++
779 *** The X resource cursorBlink can be used to turn off cursor blinking.
780
781 +++
782 *** Emacs can produce an underscore-like (horizontal bar) cursor.
783 The underscore cursor is set by putting `(cursor-type . hbar)' in
784 default-frame-alist. It supports variable heights, like the `bar'
785 cursor does.
786
787 +++
788 *** Display of hollow cursors now obeys the buffer-local value (if any)
789 of `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' in the buffer that the cursor
790 appears in.
791
792 +++
793 *** The variable `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' can now be set to any
794 of the recognized cursor types.
795
796 ** Font-Lock changes:
797
798 +++
799 *** M-o now is the prefix key for setting text properties;
800 M-o M-o requests refontification.
801
802 +++
803 *** All modes now support using M-x font-lock-mode to toggle
804 fontification, even those such as Occur, Info, and comint-derived
805 modes that do their own fontification in a special way.
806
807 The variable `Info-fontify' is no longer applicable; to disable
808 fontification in Info, remove `turn-on-font-lock' from
809 `Info-mode-hook'.
810
811 +++
812 *** font-lock-lines-before specifies a number of lines before the
813 current line that should be refontified when you change the buffer.
814 The default value is 1.
815
816 +++
817 *** font-lock: in modes like C and Lisp where the fontification assumes that
818 an open-paren in column 0 is always outside of any string or comment,
819 font-lock now highlights any such open-paren-in-column-zero in bold-red
820 if it is inside a string or a comment, to indicate that it can cause
821 trouble with fontification and/or indentation.
822
823 ---
824 *** The default settings for JIT stealth lock parameters are changed.
825 The default value for the user option jit-lock-stealth-time is now 16
826 instead of 3, and the default value of jit-lock-stealth-nice is now
827 0.5 instead of 0.125. The new defaults should lower the CPU usage
828 when Emacs is fontifying in the background.
829
830 ---
831 *** jit-lock can now be delayed with `jit-lock-defer-time'.
832
833 If this variable is non-nil, its value should be the amount of Emacs
834 idle time in seconds to wait before starting fontification. For
835 example, if you set `jit-lock-defer-time' to 0.25, fontification will
836 only happen after 0.25s of idle time.
837
838 ---
839 *** contextual refontification is now separate from stealth fontification.
840
841 jit-lock-defer-contextually is renamed jit-lock-contextually and
842 jit-lock-context-time determines the delay after which contextual
843 refontification takes place.
844
845 ** Menu support:
846
847 ---
848 *** A menu item "Show/Hide" was added to the top-level menu "Options".
849 This menu allows you to turn various display features on and off (such
850 as the fringes, the tool bar, the speedbar, and the menu bar itself).
851 You can also move the vertical scroll bar to either side here or turn
852 it off completely. There is also a menu-item to toggle displaying of
853 current date and time, current line and column number in the
854 mode-line.
855
856 ---
857 *** Speedbar has moved from the "Tools" top level menu to "Show/Hide".
858
859 ---
860 *** You can exit dialog windows and menus by typing C-g.
861
862 ---
863 *** The menu item "Open File..." has been split into two items, "New File..."
864 and "Open File...". "Open File..." now opens only existing files. This is
865 to support existing GUI file selection dialogs better.
866
867 +++
868 *** The file selection dialog for Gtk+, Mac, W32 and Motif/Lesstif can be
869 disabled by customizing the variable `use-file-dialog'.
870
871 ---
872 *** The pop up menus for Lucid now stay up if you do a fast click and can
873 be navigated with the arrow keys (like Gtk+, Mac and W32).
874
875 +++
876 *** The Lucid menus can display multilingual text in your locale. You have
877 to explicitly specify a fontSet resource for this to work, for example
878 `-xrm "Emacs*fontSet: -*-helvetica-medium-r-*--*-120-*-*-*-*-*-*,*"'.
879
880 ---
881 *** Dialogs for Lucid/Athena and Lesstif/Motif now pops down when pressing
882 ESC, like they do for Gtk+, Mac and W32.
883
884 +++
885 *** For Gtk+ version 2.4, you can make Emacs use the old file dialog
886 by setting the variable `x-use-old-gtk-file-dialog' to t. Default is to use
887 the new dialog.
888
889 ** Mouse changes:
890
891 +++
892 *** New display feature: focus follows the mouse from one Emacs window
893 to another, even within a frame. If you set the variable
894 mouse-autoselect-window to non-nil value, moving the mouse to a
895 different Emacs window will select that window (minibuffer window can
896 be selected only when it is active). The default is nil, so that this
897 feature is not enabled.
898
899 +++
900 *** On X, when the window manager requires that you click on a frame to
901 select it (give it focus), the selected window and cursor position
902 normally changes according to the mouse click position. If you set
903 the variable x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position to t, the selected
904 window and cursor position do not change when you click on a frame
905 to give it focus.
906
907 +++
908 *** You can now follow links by clicking Mouse-1 on the link.
909
910 Traditionally, Emacs uses a Mouse-1 click to set point and a Mouse-2
911 click to follow a link, whereas most other applications use a Mouse-1
912 click for both purposes, depending on whether you click outside or
913 inside a link. Now the behavior of a Mouse-1 click has been changed
914 to match this context-sentitive dual behavior. (If you prefer the old
915 behavior, set the user option `mouse-1-click-follows-link' to nil.)
916
917 Depending on the current mode, a Mouse-2 click in Emacs can do much
918 more than just follow a link, so the new Mouse-1 behavior is only
919 activated for modes which explicitly mark a clickable text as a "link"
920 (see the new function `mouse-on-link-p' for details). The Lisp
921 packages that are included in release 22.1 have been adapted to do
922 this, but external packages may not yet support this. However, there
923 is no risk in using such packages, as the worst thing that could
924 happen is that you get the original Mouse-1 behavior when you click
925 on a link, which typically means that you set point where you click.
926
927 If you want to get the original Mouse-1 action also inside a link, you
928 just need to press the Mouse-1 button a little longer than a normal
929 click (i.e. press and hold the Mouse-1 button for half a second before
930 you release it).
931
932 Dragging the Mouse-1 inside a link still performs the original
933 drag-mouse-1 action, typically copy the text.
934
935 You can customize the new Mouse-1 behavior via the new user options
936 `mouse-1-click-follows-link' and `mouse-1-click-in-non-selected-windows'.
937
938 +++
939 *** Emacs normally highlights mouse sensitive text whenever the mouse
940 is over the text. By setting the new variable `mouse-highlight', you
941 can optionally enable mouse highlighting only after you move the
942 mouse, so that highlighting disappears when you press a key. You can
943 also disable mouse highlighting.
944
945 +++
946 *** You can now customize if selecting a region by dragging the mouse
947 shall not copy the selected text to the kill-ring by setting the new
948 variable mouse-drag-copy-region to nil.
949
950 ---
951 *** mouse-wheels can now scroll a specific fraction of the window
952 (rather than a fixed number of lines) and the scrolling is `progressive'.
953
954 ---
955 *** Unexpected yanking of text due to accidental clicking on the mouse
956 wheel button (typically mouse-2) during wheel scrolling is now avoided.
957 This behavior can be customized via the mouse-wheel-click-event and
958 mouse-wheel-inhibit-click-time variables.
959
960 +++
961 *** Under X, mouse-wheel-mode is turned on by default.
962
963 ** Mule changes:
964
965 ---
966 *** Language environment and various default coding systems are setup
967 more correctly according to the current locale name. If the locale
968 name doesn't specify a charset, the default is what glibc defines.
969 This change can result in using the different coding systems as
970 default in some locale (e.g. vi_VN).
971
972 +++
973 *** The keyboard-coding-system is now automatically set based on your
974 current locale settings if you are not using a window system. This
975 can mean that the META key doesn't work but generates non-ASCII
976 characters instead, depending on how the terminal (or terminal
977 emulator) works. Use `set-keyboard-coding-system' (or customize
978 keyboard-coding-system) if you prefer META to work (the old default)
979 or if the locale doesn't describe the character set actually generated
980 by the keyboard. See Info node `Single-Byte Character Support'.
981
982 +++
983 *** The new command `revert-buffer-with-coding-system' (C-x RET r)
984 revisits the current file using a coding system that you specify.
985
986 +++
987 *** New command `recode-region' decodes the region again by a specified
988 coding system.
989
990 +++
991 *** The new command `recode-file-name' changes the encoding of the name
992 of a file.
993
994 ---
995 *** New command `ucs-insert' inserts a character specified by its
996 unicode.
997
998 +++
999 *** The new command `set-file-name-coding-system' (C-x RET F) sets
1000 coding system for encoding and decoding file names. A new menu item
1001 (Options->Mule->Set Coding Systems->For File Name) invokes this
1002 command.
1003
1004 +++
1005 *** New command quail-show-key shows what key (or key sequence) to type
1006 in the current input method to input a character at point.
1007
1008 +++
1009 *** Limited support for character `unification' has been added.
1010 Emacs now knows how to translate between different representations of
1011 the same characters in various Emacs charsets according to standard
1012 Unicode mappings. This applies mainly to characters in the ISO 8859
1013 sets plus some other 8-bit sets, but can be extended. For instance,
1014 translation works amongst the Emacs ...-iso8859-... charsets and the
1015 mule-unicode-... ones.
1016
1017 By default this translation happens automatically on encoding.
1018 Self-inserting characters are translated to make the input conformant
1019 with the encoding of the buffer in which it's being used, where
1020 possible.
1021
1022 You can force a more complete unification with the user option
1023 unify-8859-on-decoding-mode. That maps all the Latin-N character sets
1024 into Unicode characters (from the latin-iso8859-1 and
1025 mule-unicode-0100-24ff charsets) on decoding. Note that this mode
1026 will often effectively clobber data with an iso-2022 encoding.
1027
1028 ---
1029 *** There is support for decoding Greek and Cyrillic characters into
1030 either Unicode (the mule-unicode charsets) or the iso-8859 charsets,
1031 when possible. The latter are more space-efficient. This is
1032 controlled by user option utf-fragment-on-decoding.
1033
1034 ---
1035 *** New language environments: French, Ukrainian, Tajik,
1036 Bulgarian, Belarusian, Ukrainian, UTF-8, Windows-1255, Welsh, Latin-6,
1037 Latin-7, Lithuanian, Latvian, Swedish, Slovenian, Croatian, Georgian,
1038 Italian, Russian, Malayalam, Tamil, Russian, Chinese-EUC-TW. (Set up
1039 automatically according to the locale.)
1040
1041 ---
1042 *** New input methods: latin-alt-postfix, latin-postfix, latin-prefix,
1043 ukrainian-computer, belarusian, bulgarian-bds, russian-computer,
1044 vietnamese-telex, lithuanian-numeric, lithuanian-keyboard,
1045 latvian-keyboard, welsh, georgian, rfc1345, ucs, sgml,
1046 bulgarian-phonetic, dutch, slovenian, croatian, malayalam-inscript,
1047 tamil-inscript.
1048
1049 ---
1050 *** New input method chinese-sisheng for inputting Chinese Pinyin
1051 characters.
1052
1053 ---
1054 *** Improved Thai support. A new minor mode `thai-word-mode' (which is
1055 automatically activated if you select Thai as a language
1056 environment) changes key bindings of most word-oriented commands to
1057 versions which recognize Thai words. Affected commands are
1058 M-f (forward-word)
1059 M-b (backward-word)
1060 M-d (kill-word)
1061 M-DEL (backward-kill-word)
1062 M-t (transpose-words)
1063 M-q (fill-paragraph)
1064
1065 ---
1066 *** Indian support has been updated.
1067 The in-is13194 coding system is now Unicode-based. CDAC fonts are
1068 assumed. There is a framework for supporting various
1069 Indian scripts, but currently only Devanagari, Malayalam and Tamil are
1070 supported.
1071
1072 ---
1073 *** A UTF-7 coding system is available in the library `utf-7'.
1074
1075 ---
1076 *** The utf-8/16 coding systems have been enhanced.
1077 By default, untranslatable utf-8 sequences are simply composed into
1078 single quasi-characters. User option `utf-translate-cjk-mode' (it is
1079 turned on by default) arranges to translate many utf-8 CJK character
1080 sequences into real Emacs characters in a similar way to the Mule-UCS
1081 system. As this loads a fairly big data on demand, people who are not
1082 interested in CJK characters may want to customize it to nil.
1083 You can augment/amend the CJK translation via hash tables
1084 `ucs-mule-cjk-to-unicode' and `ucs-unicode-to-mule-cjk'. The utf-8
1085 coding system now also encodes characters from most of Emacs's
1086 one-dimensional internal charsets, specifically the ISO-8859 ones.
1087 The utf-16 coding system is affected similarly.
1088
1089 ---
1090 *** A new coding system `euc-tw' has been added for traditional Chinese
1091 in CNS encoding; it accepts both Big 5 and CNS as input; on saving,
1092 Big 5 is then converted to CNS.
1093
1094 ---
1095 *** Many new coding systems are available by loading the `code-pages'
1096 library. These include complete versions of most of those in
1097 codepage.el, based on Unicode mappings. `codepage-setup' is now
1098 obsolete and is used only in the MS-DOS port of Emacs. windows-1252
1099 and windows-1251 are preloaded since the former is so common and the
1100 latter is used by GNU locales.
1101
1102 ---
1103 *** New variable `utf-translate-cjk-unicode-range' controls which
1104 Unicode characters to translate in `utf-translate-cjk-mode'.
1105
1106 ---
1107 *** iso-10646-1 (`Unicode') fonts can be used to display any range of
1108 characters encodable by the utf-8 coding system. Just specify the
1109 fontset appropriately.
1110
1111 ** Customize changes:
1112
1113 +++
1114 *** The commands M-x customize-face and M-x customize-face-other-window
1115 now look at the character after point. If a face or faces are
1116 specified for that character, the commands by default customize those
1117 faces.
1118
1119 ---
1120 *** The face-customization widget has been reworked to be less confusing.
1121 In particular, when you enable a face attribute using the corresponding
1122 check-box, there's no longer a redundant `*' option in value selection
1123 for that attribute; the values you can choose are only those which make
1124 sense for the attribute. When an attribute is de-selected by unchecking
1125 its check-box, then the (now ignored, but still present temporarily in
1126 case you re-select the attribute) value is hidden.
1127
1128 +++
1129 *** When you set or reset a variable's value in a Customize buffer,
1130 the previous value becomes the "backup value" of the variable.
1131 You can go back to that backup value by selecting "Use Backup Value"
1132 under the "[State]" button.
1133
1134 ** Buffer Menu changes:
1135
1136 +++
1137 *** New command `Buffer-menu-toggle-files-only' toggles display of file
1138 buffers only in the Buffer Menu. It is bound to `T' in Buffer Menu
1139 mode.
1140
1141 +++
1142 *** `buffer-menu' and `list-buffers' now list buffers whose names begin
1143 with a space, when those buffers are visiting files. Normally buffers
1144 whose names begin with space are omitted.
1145
1146 ---
1147 *** The new options `buffers-menu-show-directories' and
1148 `buffers-menu-show-status' let you control how buffers are displayed
1149 in the menu dropped down when you click "Buffers" from the menu bar.
1150
1151 `buffers-menu-show-directories' controls whether the menu displays
1152 leading directories as part of the file name visited by the buffer.
1153 If its value is `unless-uniquify', the default, directories are
1154 shown unless uniquify-buffer-name-style' is non-nil. The value of nil
1155 and t turn the display of directories off and on, respectively.
1156
1157 `buffers-menu-show-status' controls whether the Buffers menu includes
1158 the modified and read-only status of the buffers. By default it is
1159 t, and the status is shown.
1160
1161 Setting these variables directly does not take effect until next time
1162 the Buffers menu is regenerated.
1163
1164 ** Dired mode:
1165
1166 ---
1167 *** New faces dired-header, dired-mark, dired-marked, dired-flagged,
1168 dired-ignored, dired-directory, dired-symlink, dired-warning
1169 introduced for Dired mode instead of font-lock faces.
1170
1171 +++
1172 *** New Dired command `dired-compare-directories' marks files
1173 with different file attributes in two dired buffers.
1174
1175 +++
1176 *** New Dired command `dired-do-touch' (bound to T) changes timestamps
1177 of marked files with the value entered in the minibuffer.
1178
1179 +++
1180 *** In Dired's ! command (dired-do-shell-command), `*' and `?' now
1181 control substitution of the file names only when they are surrounded
1182 by whitespace. This means you can now use them as shell wildcards
1183 too. If you want to use just plain `*' as a wildcard, type `*""'; the
1184 doublequotes make no difference in the shell, but they prevent
1185 special treatment in `dired-do-shell-command'.
1186
1187 +++
1188 *** In Dired, the w command now copies the current line's file name
1189 into the kill ring. With a zero prefix arg, copies absolute file names.
1190
1191 +++
1192 *** In Dired-x, Omitting files is now a minor mode, dired-omit-mode.
1193
1194 The mode toggling command is bound to M-o. A new command
1195 dired-mark-omitted, bound to * O, marks omitted files. The variable
1196 dired-omit-files-p is obsoleted, use the mode toggling function
1197 instead.
1198
1199 +++
1200 *** The variables dired-free-space-program and dired-free-space-args
1201 have been renamed to directory-free-space-program and
1202 directory-free-space-args, and they now apply whenever Emacs puts a
1203 directory listing into a buffer.
1204
1205 ** Comint changes:
1206
1207 ---
1208 *** The comint prompt can now be made read-only, using the new user
1209 option `comint-prompt-read-only'. This is not enabled by default,
1210 except in IELM buffers. The read-only status of IELM prompts can be
1211 controlled with the new user option `ielm-prompt-read-only', which
1212 overrides `comint-prompt-read-only'.
1213
1214 The new commands `comint-kill-whole-line' and `comint-kill-region'
1215 support editing comint buffers with read-only prompts.
1216
1217 `comint-kill-whole-line' is like `kill-whole-line', but ignores both
1218 read-only and field properties. Hence, it always kill entire
1219 lines, including any prompts.
1220
1221 `comint-kill-region' is like `kill-region', except that it ignores
1222 read-only properties, if it is safe to do so. This means that if any
1223 part of a prompt is deleted, then the entire prompt must be deleted
1224 and that all prompts must stay at the beginning of a line. If this is
1225 not the case, then `comint-kill-region' behaves just like
1226 `kill-region' if read-only are involved: it copies the text to the
1227 kill-ring, but does not delete it.
1228
1229 +++
1230 *** The new command `comint-insert-previous-argument' in comint-derived
1231 modes (shell-mode etc) inserts arguments from previous command lines,
1232 like bash's `ESC .' binding. It is bound by default to `C-c .', but
1233 otherwise behaves quite similarly to the bash version.
1234
1235 *** `comint-use-prompt-regexp-instead-of-fields' has been renamed
1236 `comint-use-prompt-regexp'. The old name has been kept as an alias,
1237 but declared obsolete.
1238
1239 ** M-x Compile changes:
1240
1241 ---
1242 *** M-x compile has become more robust and reliable
1243
1244 Quite a few more kinds of messages are recognized. Messages that are
1245 recognized as warnings or informational come in orange or green, instead of
1246 red. Informational messages are by default skipped with `next-error'
1247 (controlled by `compilation-skip-threshold').
1248
1249 Location data is collected on the fly as the *compilation* buffer changes.
1250 This means you could modify messages to make them point to different files.
1251 This also means you can not go to locations of messages you may have deleted.
1252
1253 The variable `compilation-error-regexp-alist' has now become customizable. If
1254 you had added your own regexps to this, you'll probably need to include a
1255 leading `^', otherwise they'll match anywhere on a line. There is now also a
1256 `compilation-mode-font-lock-keywords' and it nicely handles all the checks
1257 that configure outputs and -o options so you see at a glance where you are.
1258
1259 The new file etc/compilation.txt gives examples of each type of message.
1260
1261 +++
1262 *** New user option `compilation-environment'.
1263 This option allows you to specify environment variables for inferior
1264 compilation processes without affecting the environment that all
1265 subprocesses inherit.
1266
1267 +++
1268 *** New options `next-error-highlight' and `next-error-highlight-no-select'
1269 specify the method of highlighting of the corresponding source line
1270 in new face `next-error'.
1271
1272 +++
1273 *** A new minor mode `next-error-follow-minor-mode' can be used in
1274 compilation-mode, grep-mode, occur-mode, and diff-mode (i.e. all the
1275 modes that can use `next-error'). In this mode, cursor motion in the
1276 buffer causes automatic display in another window of the corresponding
1277 matches, compilation errors, etc. This minor mode can be toggled with
1278 C-c C-f.
1279
1280 ** Occur mode changes:
1281
1282 +++
1283 *** In the *Occur* buffer, `o' switches to it in another window, and
1284 C-o displays the current line's occurrence in another window without
1285 switching to it.
1286
1287 +++
1288 *** You can now use next-error (C-x `) and previous-error to advance to
1289 the next/previous matching line found by M-x occur.
1290
1291 +++
1292 *** The new command `multi-occur' is just like `occur', except it can
1293 search multiple buffers. There is also a new command
1294 `multi-occur-by-filename-regexp' which allows you to specify the
1295 buffers to search by their filename. Internally, Occur mode has been
1296 rewritten, and now uses font-lock, among other changes.
1297
1298 ** Grep changes:
1299
1300 +++
1301 *** Grep has been decoupled from compilation mode setup.
1302
1303 There's a new separate package grep.el, with its own submenu and
1304 customization group.
1305
1306 ---
1307 *** M-x grep provides highlighting support.
1308
1309 Hits are fontified in green, and hits in binary files in orange. Grep buffers
1310 can be saved and automatically revisited.
1311
1312 +++
1313 *** `grep-find' is now also available under the name `find-grep' where
1314 people knowing `find-grep-dired' would probably expect it.
1315
1316 ---
1317 *** The new variables `grep-window-height', `grep-auto-highlight', and
1318 `grep-scroll-output' override the corresponding compilation mode
1319 settings, for grep commands only.
1320
1321 +++
1322 *** New option `grep-highlight-matches' highlightes matches in *grep*
1323 buffer. It uses a special feature of some grep programs which accept
1324 --color option to output markers around matches. When going to the next
1325 match with `next-error' the exact match is highlighted in the source
1326 buffer. Otherwise, if `grep-highlight-matches' is nil, the whole
1327 source line is highlighted.
1328
1329 +++
1330 *** New key bindings in grep output window:
1331 SPC and DEL scrolls window up and down. C-n and C-p moves to next and
1332 previous match in the grep window. RET jumps to the source line of
1333 the current match. `n' and `p' shows next and previous match in
1334 other window, but does not switch buffer. `{' and `}' jumps to the
1335 previous or next file in the grep output. TAB also jumps to the next
1336 file.
1337
1338 +++
1339 *** M-x grep now tries to avoid appending `/dev/null' to the command line
1340 by using GNU grep `-H' option instead. M-x grep automatically
1341 detects whether this is possible or not the first time it is invoked.
1342 When `-H' is used, the grep command line supplied by the user is passed
1343 unchanged to the system to execute, which allows more complicated
1344 command lines to be used than was possible before.
1345
1346 ** X Windows Support:
1347
1348 +++
1349 *** Emacs now supports drag and drop for X. Dropping a file on a window
1350 opens it, dropping text inserts the text. Dropping a file on a dired
1351 buffer copies or moves the file to that directory.
1352
1353 +++
1354 *** Under X11, it is possible to swap Alt and Meta (and Super and Hyper).
1355 The new variables `x-alt-keysym', `x-hyper-keysym', `x-meta-keysym',
1356 and `x-super-keysym' can be used to choose which keysyms Emacs should
1357 use for the modifiers. For example, the following two lines swap
1358 Meta and Alt:
1359 (setq x-alt-keysym 'meta)
1360 (setq x-meta-keysym 'alt)
1361
1362 +++
1363 *** The X resource useXIM can be used to turn off use of XIM, which can
1364 speed up Emacs with slow networking to the X server.
1365
1366 If the configure option `--without-xim' was used to turn off use of
1367 XIM by default, the X resource useXIM can be used to turn it on.
1368
1369 ---
1370 *** The new variable `x-select-request-type' controls how Emacs
1371 requests X selection. The default value is nil, which means that
1372 Emacs requests X selection with types COMPOUND_TEXT and UTF8_STRING,
1373 and use the more appropriately result.
1374
1375 ---
1376 *** The scrollbar under LessTif or Motif has a smoother drag-scrolling.
1377 On the other hand, the size of the thumb does not represent the actual
1378 amount of text shown any more (only a crude approximation of it).
1379
1380 ** Xterm support:
1381
1382 ---
1383 *** Emacs now responds to mouse-clicks on the mode-line, header-line and
1384 display margin, when run in an xterm.
1385
1386 ---
1387 *** Improved key bindings support when running in an xterm.
1388 When emacs is running in an xterm more key bindings are available. The
1389 following should work:
1390 {C,S,C-S,A}-{right,left,up,down,prior,next,delete,insert,F1-12}.
1391 These key bindings work on xterm from X.org 6.8, they might not work on
1392 some older versions of xterm, or on some proprietary versions.
1393
1394 ** Character terminal color support changes:
1395
1396 +++
1397 *** The new command-line option --color=MODE lets you specify a standard
1398 mode for a tty color support. It is meant to be used on character
1399 terminals whose capabilities are not set correctly in the terminal
1400 database, or with terminal emulators which support colors, but don't
1401 set the TERM environment variable to a name of a color-capable
1402 terminal. "emacs --color" uses the same color commands as GNU `ls'
1403 when invoked with "ls --color", so if your terminal can support colors
1404 in "ls --color", it will support "emacs --color" as well. See the
1405 user manual for the possible values of the MODE parameter.
1406
1407 ---
1408 *** Emacs now supports several character terminals which provide more
1409 than 8 colors. For example, for `xterm', 16-color, 88-color, and
1410 256-color modes are supported. Emacs automatically notes at startup
1411 the extended number of colors, and defines the appropriate entries for
1412 all of these colors.
1413
1414 +++
1415 *** Emacs now uses the full range of available colors for the default
1416 faces when running on a color terminal, including 16-, 88-, and
1417 256-color xterms. This means that when you run "emacs -nw" on an
1418 88-color or 256-color xterm, you will see essentially the same face
1419 colors as on X.
1420
1421 ---
1422 *** There's a new support for colors on `rxvt' terminal emulator.
1423 \f
1424 * New Modes and Packages in Emacs 22.1
1425
1426 +++
1427 ** New package benchmark.el contains simple support for convenient
1428 timing measurements of code (including the garbage collection component).
1429
1430 +++
1431 ** Filesets are collections of files. You can define a fileset in
1432 various ways, such as based on a directory tree or based on
1433 program files that include other program files.
1434
1435 Once you have defined a fileset, you can perform various operations on
1436 all the files in it, such as visiting them or searching and replacing
1437 in them.
1438
1439 +++
1440 ** Calc is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1441
1442 Calc is an advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool written in
1443 Emacs Lisp. Its documentation is in a separate manual; within Emacs,
1444 type "C-h i m calc RET" to read that manual. A reference card is
1445 available in `etc/calccard.tex' and `etc/calccard.ps'.
1446
1447 ---
1448 ** `cfengine-mode' is a major mode for editing GNU Cfengine
1449 configuration files.
1450
1451 +++
1452 ** The new package conf-mode.el handles thousands of configuration files, with
1453 varying syntaxes for comments (;, #, //, /* */ or !), assignment (var = value,
1454 var : value, var value or keyword var value) and sections ([section] or
1455 section { }). Many files under /etc/, or with suffixes like .cf through
1456 .config, .properties (Java), .desktop (KDE/Gnome), .ini and many others are
1457 recognized.
1458
1459 ---
1460 ** CUA mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1461
1462 The new cua package provides CUA-like keybindings using C-x for
1463 cut (kill), C-c for copy, C-v for paste (yank), and C-z for undo.
1464 With cua, the region can be set and extended using shifted movement
1465 keys (like pc-selection-mode) and typed text replaces the active
1466 region (like delete-selection-mode). Do not enable these modes with
1467 cua-mode. Customize the variable `cua-mode' to enable cua.
1468
1469 In addition, cua provides unified rectangle support with visible
1470 rectangle highlighting: Use S-return to start a rectangle, extend it
1471 using the movement commands (or mouse-3), and cut or copy it using C-x
1472 or C-c (using C-w and M-w also works).
1473
1474 Use M-o and M-c to `open' or `close' the rectangle, use M-b or M-f, to
1475 fill it with blanks or another character, use M-u or M-l to upcase or
1476 downcase the rectangle, use M-i to increment the numbers in the
1477 rectangle, use M-n to fill the rectangle with a numeric sequence (such
1478 as 10 20 30...), use M-r to replace a regexp in the rectangle, and use
1479 M-' or M-/ to restrict command on the rectangle to a subset of the
1480 rows. See the commentary in cua-base.el for more rectangle commands.
1481
1482 Cua also provides unified support for registers: Use a numeric
1483 prefix argument between 0 and 9, i.e. M-0 .. M-9, for C-x, C-c, and
1484 C-v to cut or copy into register 0-9, or paste from register 0-9.
1485
1486 The last text deleted (not killed) is automatically stored in
1487 register 0. This includes text deleted by typing text.
1488
1489 Finally, cua provides a global mark which is set using S-C-space.
1490 When the global mark is active, any text which is cut or copied is
1491 automatically inserted at the global mark position. See the
1492 commentary in cua-base.el for more global mark related commands.
1493
1494 The features of cua also works with the standard emacs bindings for
1495 kill, copy, yank, and undo. If you want to use cua mode, but don't
1496 want the C-x, C-c, C-v, and C-z bindings, you can customize the
1497 `cua-enable-cua-keys' variable.
1498
1499 Note: This version of cua mode is not backwards compatible with older
1500 versions of cua.el and cua-mode.el. To ensure proper operation, you
1501 must remove older versions of cua.el or cua-mode.el as well as the
1502 loading and customization of those packages from the .emacs file.
1503
1504 +++
1505 ** The new package dns-mode.el add syntax highlight of DNS master files.
1506 The key binding C-c C-s (`dns-mode-soa-increment-serial') can be used
1507 to increment the SOA serial.
1508
1509 ---
1510 ** The new global minor mode `file-name-shadow-mode' modifies the way
1511 filenames being entered by the user in the minibuffer are displayed, so
1512 that it's clear when part of the entered filename will be ignored due to
1513 emacs' filename parsing rules. The ignored portion can be made dim,
1514 invisible, or otherwise less visually noticable. The display method can
1515 be displayed by customizing the variable `file-name-shadow-properties'.
1516
1517 +++
1518 ** The new package flymake.el does on-the-fly syntax checking of program
1519 source files. See the Flymake's Info manual for more details.
1520
1521 ---
1522 ** The new Lisp library fringe.el controls the appearance of fringes.
1523
1524 ---
1525 ** GDB-Script-mode is used for files like .gdbinit.
1526
1527 ---
1528 ** The new package ibuffer provides a powerful, completely
1529 customizable replacement for buff-menu.el.
1530
1531 ---
1532 ** Ido mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1533
1534 The ido (interactively do) package is an extension of the iswitchb
1535 package to do interactive opening of files and directories in addition
1536 to interactive buffer switching. Ido is a superset of iswitchb (with
1537 a few exceptions), so don't enable both packages.
1538
1539 +++
1540 ** Image files are normally visited in Image mode, which lets you toggle
1541 between viewing the image and viewing the text using C-c C-c.
1542
1543 +++
1544 ** The new keypad setup package provides several common bindings for
1545 the numeric keypad which is available on most keyboards. The numeric
1546 keypad typically has the digits 0 to 9, a decimal point, keys marked
1547 +, -, /, and *, an Enter key, and a NumLock toggle key. The keypad
1548 package only controls the use of the digit and decimal keys.
1549
1550 By customizing the variables `keypad-setup', `keypad-shifted-setup',
1551 `keypad-numlock-setup', and `keypad-numlock-shifted-setup', or by
1552 using the function `keypad-setup', you can rebind all digit keys and
1553 the decimal key of the keypad in one step for each of the four
1554 possible combinations of the Shift key state (not pressed/pressed) and
1555 the NumLock toggle state (off/on).
1556
1557 The choices for the keypad keys in each of the above states are:
1558 `Plain numeric keypad' where the keys generates plain digits,
1559 `Numeric keypad with decimal key' where the character produced by the
1560 decimal key can be customized individually (for internationalization),
1561 `Numeric Prefix Arg' where the keypad keys produce numeric prefix args
1562 for emacs editing commands, `Cursor keys' and `Shifted Cursor keys'
1563 where the keys work like (shifted) arrow keys, home/end, etc., and
1564 `Unspecified/User-defined' where the keypad keys (kp-0, kp-1, etc.)
1565 are left unspecified and can be bound individually through the global
1566 or local keymaps.
1567
1568 +++
1569 ** The new kmacro package provides a simpler user interface to
1570 emacs' keyboard macro facilities.
1571
1572 Basically, it uses two function keys (default F3 and F4) like this:
1573 F3 starts a macro, F4 ends the macro, and pressing F4 again executes
1574 the last macro. While defining the macro, F3 inserts a counter value
1575 which automatically increments every time the macro is executed.
1576
1577 There is now a keyboard macro ring which stores the most recently
1578 defined macros.
1579
1580 The C-x C-k sequence is now a prefix for the kmacro keymap which
1581 defines bindings for moving through the keyboard macro ring,
1582 C-x C-k C-p and C-x C-k C-n, editing the last macro C-x C-k C-e,
1583 manipulating the macro counter and format via C-x C-k C-c,
1584 C-x C-k C-a, and C-x C-k C-f. See the commentary in kmacro.el
1585 for more commands.
1586
1587 The normal macro bindings C-x (, C-x ), and C-x e now interfaces to
1588 the keyboard macro ring.
1589
1590 The C-x e command now automatically terminates the current macro
1591 before calling it, if used while defining a macro.
1592
1593 In addition, when ending or calling a macro with C-x e, the macro can
1594 be repeated immediately by typing just the `e'. You can customize
1595 this behavior via the variable kmacro-call-repeat-key and
1596 kmacro-call-repeat-with-arg.
1597
1598 Keyboard macros can now be debugged and edited interactively.
1599 C-x C-k SPC steps through the last keyboard macro one key sequence
1600 at a time, prompting for the actions to take.
1601
1602 +++
1603 ** The new package longlines.el provides a minor mode for editing text
1604 files composed of long lines, based on the `use-hard-newlines'
1605 mechanism. The long lines are broken up by inserting soft newlines,
1606 which are automatically removed when saving the file to disk or
1607 copying into the kill ring, clipboard, etc. By default, Longlines
1608 mode inserts soft newlines automatically during editing, a behavior
1609 referred to as "soft word wrap" in other text editors. This is
1610 similar to Refill mode, but more reliable. To turn the word wrap
1611 feature off, set `longlines-auto-wrap' to nil.
1612
1613 ** The printing package is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1614
1615 If you enable the printing package by including (require 'printing) in
1616 the .emacs file, the normal Print item on the File menu is replaced
1617 with a Print sub-menu which allows you to preview output through
1618 ghostview, use ghostscript to print (if you don't have a PostScript
1619 printer) or send directly to printer a PostScript code generated by
1620 `ps-print' package. Use M-x pr-help for more information.
1621
1622 +++
1623 ** The new python.el package is used to edit Python and Jython programs.
1624
1625 ---
1626 ** The minor mode Reveal mode makes text visible on the fly as you
1627 move your cursor into hidden regions of the buffer.
1628 It should work with any package that uses overlays to hide parts
1629 of a buffer, such as outline-minor-mode, hs-minor-mode, hide-ifdef-mode, ...
1630
1631 There is also Global Reveal mode which affects all buffers.
1632
1633 ---
1634 ** The ruler-mode.el library provides a minor mode for displaying an
1635 "active" ruler in the header line. You can use the mouse to visually
1636 change the `fill-column', `window-margins' and `tab-stop-list'
1637 settings.
1638
1639 +++
1640 ** SES mode (ses-mode) is a new major mode for creating and editing
1641 spreadsheet files. Besides the usual Emacs features (intuitive command
1642 letters, undo, cell formulas in Lisp, plaintext files, etc.) it also offers
1643 viral immunity and import/export of tab-separated values.
1644
1645 +++
1646 ** The new global minor mode `size-indication-mode' (off by default)
1647 shows the size of accessible part of the buffer on the mode line.
1648
1649 +++
1650 ** The new package table.el implements editable, WYSIWYG, embedded
1651 `text tables' in Emacs buffers. It simulates the effect of putting
1652 these tables in a special major mode. The package emulates WYSIWYG
1653 table editing available in modern word processors. The package also
1654 can generate a table source in typesetting and markup languages such
1655 as latex and html from the visually laid out text table.
1656
1657 +++
1658 ** The thumbs.el package allows you to preview image files as thumbnails
1659 and can be invoked from a Dired buffer.
1660
1661 +++
1662 ** Tramp is now part of the distribution.
1663
1664 This package is similar to Ange-FTP: it allows you to edit remote
1665 files. But whereas Ange-FTP uses FTP to access the remote host,
1666 Tramp uses a shell connection. The shell connection is always used
1667 for filename completion and directory listings and suchlike, but for
1668 the actual file transfer, you can choose between the so-called
1669 `inline' methods (which transfer the files through the shell
1670 connection using base64 or uu encoding) and the `out-of-band' methods
1671 (which invoke an external copying program such as `rcp' or `scp' or
1672 `rsync' to do the copying).
1673
1674 Shell connections can be acquired via `rsh', `ssh', `telnet' and also
1675 `su' and `sudo'. Ange-FTP is still supported via the `ftp' method.
1676
1677 If you want to disable Tramp you should set
1678
1679 (setq tramp-default-method "ftp")
1680
1681 ---
1682 ** The library tree-widget.el provides a new widget to display a set
1683 of hierarchical data as an outline. For example, the tree-widget is
1684 well suited to display a hierarchy of directories and files.
1685
1686 ---
1687 ** The URL package (which had been part of W3) is now part of Emacs.
1688
1689 ---
1690 ** New minor mode, Visible mode, toggles invisibility in the current buffer.
1691 When enabled, it makes all invisible text visible. When disabled, it
1692 restores the previous value of `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
1693
1694 +++
1695 ** The wdired.el package allows you to use normal editing commands on Dired
1696 buffers to change filenames, permissions, etc...
1697
1698 ---
1699 ** The TCL package tcl-mode.el was replaced by tcl.el.
1700 This was actually done in Emacs-21.1, and was not documented.
1701
1702 ** The new package bindat.el provides functions to unpack and pack
1703 binary data structures, such as network packets, to and from Lisp
1704 data structures.
1705
1706 +++
1707 ** The new package button.el implements simple and fast `clickable buttons'
1708 in emacs buffers. `buttons' are much lighter-weight than the `widgets'
1709 implemented by widget.el, and can be used by lisp code that doesn't
1710 require the full power of widgets. Emacs uses buttons for such things
1711 as help and apropos buffers.
1712
1713 ---
1714 ** master-mode.el implements a minor mode for scrolling a slave
1715 buffer without leaving your current buffer, the master buffer.
1716
1717 It can be used by sql.el, for example: the SQL buffer is the master
1718 and its SQLi buffer is the slave. This allows you to scroll the SQLi
1719 buffer containing the output from the SQL buffer containing the
1720 commands.
1721
1722 This is how to use sql.el and master.el together: the variable
1723 sql-buffer contains the slave buffer. It is a local variable in the
1724 SQL buffer.
1725
1726 (add-hook 'sql-mode-hook
1727 (function (lambda ()
1728 (master-mode t)
1729 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
1730 (add-hook 'sql-set-sqli-hook
1731 (function (lambda ()
1732 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
1733
1734 +++
1735 ** New Lisp library testcover.el works with edebug to help you determine
1736 whether you've tested all your Lisp code. Function testcover-start
1737 instruments all functions in a given file. Then test your code. Function
1738 testcover-mark-all adds overlay "splotches" to the Lisp file's buffer to
1739 show where coverage is lacking. Command testcover-next-mark (bind it to
1740 a key!) will move point forward to the next spot that has a splotch.
1741
1742 Normally, a red splotch indicates the form was never completely
1743 evaluated; a brown splotch means it always evaluated to the same
1744 value. The red splotches are skipped for forms that can't possibly
1745 complete their evaluation, such as `error'. The brown splotches are
1746 skipped for forms that are expected to always evaluate to the same
1747 value, such as (setq x 14).
1748
1749 For difficult cases, you can add do-nothing macros to your code to
1750 help out the test coverage tool. The macro `noreturn' suppresses a
1751 red splotch. It is an error if the argument to `noreturn' does
1752 return. The macro 1value suppresses a brown splotch for its argument.
1753 This macro is a no-op except during test-coverage -- then it signals
1754 an error if the argument actually returns differing values.
1755 \f
1756 * Changes in Specialized Modes and Packages in Emacs 22.1:
1757
1758 ** Makefile mode has now been split up into specialized modes for automake,
1759 gmake, makepp and BSD make. The former two couldn't be differentiated before,
1760 and the latter two are new. Font-locking is robust now and offers new
1761 customizable faces.
1762
1763 +++
1764 ** In Outline mode, hide-body no longer hides lines at the top
1765 of the file that precede the first header line.
1766
1767 +++
1768 ** Telnet now prompts you for a port number with C-u M-x telnet.
1769
1770 ---
1771 ** The terminal emulation code in term.el has been improved, it can
1772 run most curses applications now.
1773
1774 +++
1775 ** M-x diff uses diff-mode instead of compilation-mode.
1776
1777 +++
1778 ** You can now customize fill-nobreak-predicate to control where
1779 filling can break lines. The value is now normally a list of
1780 functions, but it can also be a single function, for compatibility.
1781
1782 We provide two sample predicates, fill-single-word-nobreak-p and
1783 fill-french-nobreak-p, for use in the value of fill-nobreak-predicate.
1784
1785 ---
1786 ** M-x view-file and commands that use it now avoid interfering
1787 with special modes such as Tar mode.
1788
1789 ---
1790 ** Commands winner-redo and winner-undo, from winner.el, are now bound to
1791 C-c <left> and C-c <right>, respectively. This is an incompatible change.
1792
1793 ---
1794 ** global-whitespace-mode is a new alias for whitespace-global-mode.
1795
1796 +++
1797 ** M-x compare-windows now can automatically skip non-matching text to
1798 resync points in both windows.
1799
1800 +++
1801 ** New user option `add-log-always-start-new-record'.
1802 When this option is enabled, M-x add-change-log-entry always
1803 starts a new record regardless of when the last record is.
1804
1805 ---
1806 ** PO translation files are decoded according to their MIME headers
1807 when Emacs visits them.
1808
1809 ** Info mode changes:
1810
1811 +++
1812 *** A numeric prefix argument of `info' selects an Info buffer
1813 with the number appended to the *info* buffer name (e.g. "*info*<2>").
1814
1815 ---
1816 *** isearch in Info uses Info-search and searches through multiple nodes.
1817 Before leaving the initial Info node isearch fails once with the error
1818 message [initial node], and with subsequent C-s/C-r continues through
1819 other nodes. When isearch fails for the rest of the manual, it wraps
1820 aroung the whole manual to the top/final node. The user option
1821 `Info-isearch-search' controls whether to use Info-search for isearch,
1822 or the default isearch search function that wraps around the current
1823 Info node.
1824
1825 *** New search commands: `Info-search-case-sensitively' (bound to S),
1826 `Info-search-backward', and `Info-search-next' which repeats the last
1827 search without prompting for a new search string.
1828
1829 *** New command `Info-history-forward' (bound to r and new toolbar icon)
1830 moves forward in history to the node you returned from after using
1831 `Info-history-back' (renamed from `Info-last').
1832
1833 *** New command `Info-history' (bound to L) displays a menu of visited nodes.
1834
1835 *** New command `Info-toc' (bound to T) creates a node with table of contents
1836 from the tree structure of menus of the current Info file.
1837
1838 *** New command `info-apropos' searches the indices of the known
1839 Info files on your system for a string, and builds a menu of the
1840 possible matches.
1841
1842 *** New command `Info-copy-current-node-name' (bound to w) copies
1843 the current Info node name into the kill ring. With a zero prefix
1844 arg, puts the node name inside the `info' function call.
1845
1846 ---
1847 *** New face `info-xref-visited' distinguishes visited nodes from unvisited
1848 and a new option `Info-fontify-visited-nodes' to control this.
1849
1850 *** http and ftp links in Info are now operational: they look like cross
1851 references and following them calls `browse-url'.
1852
1853 +++
1854 *** Info now hides node names in menus and cross references by default.
1855 If you prefer the old behavior, you can set the new user option
1856 `Info-hide-note-references' to nil.
1857
1858 ---
1859 *** Images in Info pages are supported.
1860 Info pages show embedded images, in Emacs frames with image support.
1861 Info documentation that includes images, processed with makeinfo
1862 version 4.7 or newer, compiles to Info pages with embedded images.
1863
1864 +++
1865 *** The default value for `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' is now nil.
1866
1867 ---
1868 *** Info-index offers completion.
1869
1870 ** Lisp mode changes:
1871
1872 ---
1873 *** Lisp mode now uses font-lock-doc-face for the docstrings.
1874
1875 +++
1876 *** A prefix argument of C-M-q in Emacs Lisp mode pretty-printifies the
1877 list starting after point.
1878
1879 *** New features in evaluation commands
1880
1881 +++
1882 *** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) called on defface reinitializes
1883 the face to the value specified in the defface expression.
1884
1885 +++
1886 *** Typing C-x C-e twice prints the value of the integer result
1887 in additional formats (octal, hexadecimal, character) specified
1888 by the new function `eval-expression-print-format'. The same
1889 function also defines the result format for `eval-expression' (M-:),
1890 `eval-print-last-sexp' (C-j) and some edebug evaluation functions.
1891
1892 +++
1893 ** CC mode changes.
1894
1895 *** Font lock support.
1896 CC Mode now provides font lock support for all its languages. This
1897 supersedes the font lock patterns that have been in the core font lock
1898 package for C, C++, Java and Objective-C. Like indentation, font
1899 locking is done in a uniform way across all languages (except the new
1900 AWK mode - see below). That means that the new font locking will be
1901 different from the old patterns in various details for most languages.
1902
1903 The main goal of the font locking in CC Mode is accuracy, to provide a
1904 dependable aid in recognizing the various constructs. Some, like
1905 strings and comments, are easy to recognize while others like
1906 declarations and types can be very tricky. CC Mode can go to great
1907 lengths to recognize declarations and casts correctly, especially when
1908 the types aren't recognized by standard patterns. This is a fairly
1909 demanding analysis which can be slow on older hardware, and it can
1910 therefore be disabled by choosing a lower decoration level with the
1911 variable font-lock-maximum-decoration.
1912
1913 Note that the most demanding font lock level has been tuned with lazy
1914 fontification in mind, i.e. there should be a support mode that waits
1915 with the fontification until the text is actually shown
1916 (e.g. Just-in-time Lock mode, which is the default, or Lazy Lock
1917 mode). Fontifying a file with several thousand lines in one go can
1918 take the better part of a minute.
1919
1920 **** The (c|c++|objc|java|idl|pike)-font-lock-extra-types variables
1921 are now used by CC Mode to recognize identifiers that are certain to
1922 be types. (They are also used in cases that aren't related to font
1923 locking.) At the maximum decoration level, types are often recognized
1924 properly anyway, so these variables should be fairly restrictive and
1925 not contain patterns for uncertain types.
1926
1927 **** Support for documentation comments.
1928 There is a "plugin" system to fontify documentation comments like
1929 Javadoc and the markup within them. It's independent of the host
1930 language, so it's possible to e.g. turn on Javadoc font locking in C
1931 buffers. See the variable c-doc-comment-style for details.
1932
1933 Currently two kinds of doc comment styles are recognized: Suns Javadoc
1934 and Autodoc which is used in Pike. This is by no means a complete
1935 list of the most common tools; if your doc comment extractor of choice
1936 is missing then please drop a note to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
1937
1938 **** Better handling of C++ templates.
1939 As a side effect of the more accurate font locking, C++ templates are
1940 now handled much better. The angle brackets that delimit them are
1941 given parenthesis syntax so that they can be navigated like other
1942 parens.
1943
1944 This also improves indentation of templates, although there still is
1945 work to be done in that area. E.g. it's required that multiline
1946 template clauses are written in full and then refontified to be
1947 recognized, and the indentation of nested templates is a bit odd and
1948 not as configurable as it ought to be.
1949
1950 **** Improved handling of Objective-C and CORBA IDL.
1951 Especially the support for Objective-C and IDL has gotten an overhaul.
1952 The special "@" declarations in Objective-C are handled correctly.
1953 All the keywords used in CORBA IDL, PSDL, and CIDL are recognized and
1954 handled correctly, also wrt indentation.
1955
1956 *** Support for the AWK language.
1957 Support for the AWK language has been introduced. The implementation is
1958 based around GNU AWK version 3.1, but it should work pretty well with
1959 any AWK. As yet, not all features of CC Mode have been adapted for AWK.
1960 Here is a summary:
1961
1962 **** Indentation Engine
1963 The CC Mode indentation engine fully supports AWK mode.
1964
1965 AWK mode handles code formatted in the conventional AWK fashion: `{'s
1966 which start actions, user-defined functions, or compound statements are
1967 placed on the same line as the associated construct; the matching `}'s
1968 are normally placed under the start of the respective pattern, function
1969 definition, or structured statement.
1970
1971 The predefined indentation functions haven't yet been adapted for AWK
1972 mode, though some of them may work serendipitously. There shouldn't be
1973 any problems writing custom indentation functions for AWK mode.
1974
1975 The command C-c C-q (c-indent-defun) hasn't yet been adapted for AWK,
1976 though in practice it works properly nearly all the time. Should it
1977 fail, explicitly set the region around the function (using C-u C-SPC:
1978 C-M-h probably won't work either) then do C-M-\ (indent-region).
1979
1980 **** Font Locking
1981 There is a single level of font locking in AWK mode, rather than the
1982 three distinct levels the other modes have. There are several
1983 idiosyncrasies in AWK mode's font-locking due to the peculiarities of
1984 the AWK language itself.
1985
1986 **** Comment Commands
1987 M-; (indent-for-comment) works fine. None of the other CC Mode
1988 comment formatting commands have yet been adapted for AWK mode.
1989
1990 **** Movement Commands
1991 Most of the movement commands work in AWK mode. The most important
1992 exceptions are M-a (c-beginning-of-statement) and M-e
1993 (c-end-of-statement) which haven't yet been adapted.
1994
1995 The notion of "defun" has been augmented to include AWK pattern-action
1996 pairs. C-M-a (c-awk-beginning-of-defun) and C-M-e (c-awk-end-of-defun)
1997 recognise these pattern-action pairs, as well as user defined
1998 functions.
1999
2000 **** Auto-newline Insertion and Clean-ups
2001 Auto-newline insertion hasn't yet been adapted for AWK. Some of
2002 the clean-ups can actually convert good AWK code into syntactically
2003 invalid code. These features are best disabled in AWK buffers.
2004
2005 *** New syntactic symbols in IDL mode.
2006 The top level constructs "module" and "composition" (from CIDL) are
2007 now handled like "namespace" in C++: They are given syntactic symbols
2008 module-open, module-close, inmodule, composition-open,
2009 composition-close, and incomposition.
2010
2011 *** New functions to do hungry delete without enabling hungry delete mode.
2012 The functions c-hungry-backspace and c-hungry-delete-forward can be
2013 bound to keys to get this feature without toggling a mode.
2014 Contributed by Kevin Ryde.
2015
2016 *** Better control over require-final-newline. The variable that
2017 controls how to handle a final newline when the buffer is saved,
2018 require-final-newline, is now customizable on a per-mode basis through
2019 c-require-final-newline. That is a list of modes, and only those
2020 modes set require-final-newline. By default that's C, C++ and
2021 Objective-C.
2022
2023 The specified modes set require-final-newline based on
2024 mode-require-final-newline, as usual.
2025
2026 *** Format change for syntactic context elements.
2027 The elements in the syntactic context returned by c-guess-basic-syntax
2028 and stored in c-syntactic-context has been changed somewhat to allow
2029 attaching more information. They are now lists instead of single cons
2030 cells. E.g. a line that previously had the syntactic analysis
2031
2032 ((inclass . 11) (topmost-intro . 13))
2033
2034 is now analysed as
2035
2036 ((inclass 11) (topmost-intro 13))
2037
2038 In some cases there are more than one position given for a syntactic
2039 symbol.
2040
2041 This change might affect code that call c-guess-basic-syntax directly,
2042 and custom lineup functions if they use c-syntactic-context. However,
2043 the argument given to lineup functions is still a single cons cell
2044 with nil or an integer in the cdr.
2045
2046 *** API changes for derived modes.
2047 There have been extensive changes "under the hood" which can affect
2048 derived mode writers. Some of these changes are likely to cause
2049 incompatibilities with existing derived modes, but on the other hand
2050 care has now been taken to make it possible to extend and modify CC
2051 Mode with less risk of such problems in the future.
2052
2053 **** New language variable system.
2054 See the comment blurb near the top of cc-langs.el.
2055
2056 **** New initialization functions.
2057 The initialization procedure has been split up into more functions to
2058 give better control: c-basic-common-init, c-font-lock-init, and
2059 c-init-language-vars.
2060
2061 *** Changes in analysis of nested syntactic constructs.
2062 The syntactic analysis engine has better handling of cases where
2063 several syntactic constructs appear nested on the same line. They are
2064 now handled as if each construct started on a line of its own.
2065
2066 This means that CC Mode now indents some cases differently, and
2067 although it's more consistent there might be cases where the old way
2068 gave results that's more to one's liking. So if you find a situation
2069 where you think that the indentation has become worse, please report
2070 it to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
2071
2072 **** New syntactic symbol substatement-label.
2073 This symbol is used when a label is inserted between a statement and
2074 its substatement. E.g:
2075
2076 if (x)
2077 x_is_true:
2078 do_stuff();
2079
2080 *** Better handling of multiline macros.
2081
2082 **** Syntactic indentation inside macros.
2083 The contents of multiline #define's are now analyzed and indented
2084 syntactically just like other code. This can be disabled by the new
2085 variable c-syntactic-indentation-in-macros. A new syntactic symbol
2086 cpp-define-intro has been added to control the initial indentation
2087 inside #define's.
2088
2089 **** New lineup function c-lineup-cpp-define.
2090 Now used by default to line up macro continuation lines. The behavior
2091 of this function closely mimics the indentation one gets if the macro
2092 is indented while the line continuation backslashes are temporarily
2093 removed. If syntactic indentation in macros is turned off, it works
2094 much line c-lineup-dont-change, which was used earlier, but handles
2095 empty lines within the macro better.
2096
2097 **** Automatically inserted newlines continues the macro if used within one.
2098 This applies to the newlines inserted by the auto-newline mode, and to
2099 c-context-line-break and c-context-open-line.
2100
2101 **** Better alignment of line continuation backslashes.
2102 c-backslash-region tries to adapt to surrounding backslashes. New
2103 variable c-backslash-max-column which put a limit on how far out
2104 backslashes can be moved.
2105
2106 **** Automatic alignment of line continuation backslashes.
2107 This is controlled by the new variable c-auto-align-backslashes. It
2108 affects c-context-line-break, c-context-open-line and newlines
2109 inserted in auto-newline mode.
2110
2111 **** Line indentation works better inside macros.
2112 Regardless whether syntactic indentation and syntactic indentation
2113 inside macros are enabled or not, line indentation now ignores the
2114 line continuation backslashes. This is most noticeable when syntactic
2115 indentation is turned off and there are empty lines (save for the
2116 backslash) in the macro.
2117
2118 *** indent-for-comment is more customizable.
2119 The behavior of M-; (indent-for-comment) is now configurable through
2120 the variable c-indent-comment-alist. The indentation behavior based
2121 on the preceding code on the line, e.g. to get two spaces after #else
2122 and #endif but indentation to comment-column in most other cases
2123 (something which was hardcoded earlier).
2124
2125 *** New function c-context-open-line.
2126 It's the open-line equivalent of c-context-line-break.
2127
2128 *** New lineup functions
2129
2130 **** c-lineup-string-cont
2131 This lineup function lines up a continued string under the one it
2132 continues. E.g:
2133
2134 result = prefix + "A message "
2135 "string."; <- c-lineup-string-cont
2136
2137 **** c-lineup-cascaded-calls
2138 Lines up series of calls separated by "->" or ".".
2139
2140 **** c-lineup-knr-region-comment
2141 Gives (what most people think is) better indentation of comments in
2142 the "K&R region" between the function header and its body.
2143
2144 **** c-lineup-gcc-asm-reg
2145 Provides better indentation inside asm blocks. Contributed by Kevin
2146 Ryde.
2147
2148 **** c-lineup-argcont
2149 Lines up continued function arguments after the preceding comma.
2150 Contributed by Kevin Ryde.
2151
2152 *** Better caching of the syntactic context.
2153 CC Mode caches the positions of the opening parentheses (of any kind)
2154 of the lists surrounding the point. Those positions are used in many
2155 places as anchor points for various searches. The cache is now
2156 improved so that it can be reused to a large extent when the point is
2157 moved. The less it moves, the less needs to be recalculated.
2158
2159 The effect is that CC Mode should be fast most of the time even when
2160 opening parens are hung (i.e. aren't in column zero). It's typically
2161 only the first time after the point is moved far down in a complex
2162 file that it'll take noticeable time to find out the syntactic
2163 context.
2164
2165 *** Statements are recognized in a more robust way.
2166 Statements are recognized most of the time even when they occur in an
2167 "invalid" context, e.g. in a function argument. In practice that can
2168 happen when macros are involved.
2169
2170 *** Improved the way c-indent-exp chooses the block to indent.
2171 It now indents the block for the closest sexp following the point
2172 whose closing paren ends on a different line. This means that the
2173 point doesn't have to be immediately before the block to indent.
2174 Also, only the block and the closing line is indented; the current
2175 line is left untouched.
2176
2177 *** Added toggle for syntactic indentation.
2178 The function c-toggle-syntactic-indentation can be used to toggle
2179 syntactic indentation.
2180
2181 ---
2182 ** Perl mode has a new variable `perl-indent-continued-arguments'.
2183
2184 ---
2185 ** The old Octave mode bindings C-c f and C-c i have been changed
2186 to C-c C-f and C-c C-i. The C-c C-i subcommands now have duplicate
2187 bindings on control characters--thus, C-c C-i C-b is the same as
2188 C-c C-i b, and so on.
2189
2190 ** Fortran mode changes:
2191
2192 ---
2193 *** Fortran mode does more font-locking by default. Use level 3
2194 highlighting for the old default.
2195
2196 +++
2197 *** Fortran mode has a new variable `fortran-directive-re'.
2198 Adapt this to match the format of any compiler directives you use.
2199 Lines that match are never indented, and are given distinctive font-locking.
2200
2201 +++
2202 *** F90 mode and Fortran mode have new navigation commands
2203 `f90-end-of-block', `f90-beginning-of-block', `f90-next-block',
2204 `f90-previous-block', `fortran-end-of-block',
2205 `fortran-beginning-of-block'.
2206
2207 ---
2208 *** F90 mode and Fortran mode have support for hs-minor-mode (hideshow).
2209 It cannot deal with every code format, but ought to handle a sizeable
2210 majority.
2211
2212 ---
2213 *** The new function `f90-backslash-not-special' can be used to change
2214 the syntax of backslashes in F90 buffers.
2215
2216 ---
2217 ** Prolog mode has a new variable `prolog-font-lock-keywords'
2218 to support use of font-lock.
2219
2220 ** HTML/SGML changes:
2221
2222 ---
2223 *** Emacs now tries to set up buffer coding systems for HTML/XML files
2224 automatically.
2225
2226 +++
2227 *** SGML mode has indentation and supports XML syntax.
2228 The new variable `sgml-xml-mode' tells SGML mode to use XML syntax.
2229 When this option is enabled, SGML tags are inserted in XML style,
2230 i.e., there is always a closing tag.
2231 By default, its setting is inferred on a buffer-by-buffer basis
2232 from the file name or buffer contents.
2233
2234 +++
2235 *** `xml-mode' is now an alias for `sgml-mode', which has XML support.
2236
2237 ** TeX modes:
2238
2239 +++
2240 *** C-c C-c prompts for a command to run, and tries to offer a good default.
2241
2242 +++
2243 *** The user option `tex-start-options-string' has been replaced
2244 by two new user options: `tex-start-options', which should hold
2245 command-line options to feed to TeX, and `tex-start-commands' which should hold
2246 TeX commands to use at startup.
2247
2248 ---
2249 *** verbatim environments are now highlighted in courier by font-lock
2250 and super/sub-scripts are made into super/sub-scripts.
2251
2252 +++
2253 *** New major mode doctex-mode for *.dtx files.
2254
2255 ** BibTeX mode:
2256 *** The new command bibtex-url browses a URL for the BibTeX entry at
2257 point (bound to C-c C-l and mouse-2, RET on clickable fields).
2258
2259 *** The new command bibtex-entry-update (bound to C-c C-u) updates
2260 an existing BibTeX entry.
2261
2262 *** New `bibtex-entry-format' option `required-fields', enabled by default.
2263
2264 *** bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries can take values `plain',
2265 `crossref', and `entry-class' which control the sorting scheme used
2266 for BibTeX entries. `bibtex-sort-entry-class' controls the sorting
2267 scheme `entry-class'. TAB completion for reference keys and
2268 automatic detection of duplicates does not require anymore that
2269 bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries is non-nil.
2270
2271 *** If the new variable bibtex-parse-keys-fast is non-nil,
2272 use fast but simplified algorithm for parsing BibTeX keys.
2273
2274 *** If the new variable bibtex-autoadd-commas is non-nil,
2275 automatically add missing commas at end of BibTeX fields.
2276
2277 *** The new variable bibtex-autofill-types contains a list of entry
2278 types for which fields are filled automatically (if possible).
2279
2280 *** The new command bibtex-complete completes word fragment before
2281 point according to context (bound to M-tab).
2282
2283 *** The new commands bibtex-find-entry and bibtex-find-crossref
2284 locate entries and crossref'd entries (bound to C-c C-s and C-c C-x).
2285 Crossref fields are clickable (bound to mouse-2, RET).
2286
2287 *** In BibTeX mode the command fill-paragraph (bound to M-q) fills
2288 individual fields of a BibTeX entry.
2289
2290 *** The new variables bibtex-files and bibtex-file-path define a set
2291 of BibTeX files that are searched for entry keys.
2292
2293 *** The new command bibtex-validate-globally checks for duplicate keys
2294 in multiple BibTeX files.
2295
2296 *** The new command bibtex-copy-summary-as-kill pushes summary
2297 of BibTeX entry to kill ring (bound to C-c C-t).
2298
2299 +++
2300 ** In Enriched mode, `set-left-margin' and `set-right-margin' are now
2301 by default bound to `C-c [' and `C-c ]' instead of the former `C-c C-l'
2302 and `C-c C-r'.
2303
2304 ** GUD changes:
2305
2306 +++
2307 *** In GUD mode, when talking to GDB, C-x C-a C-j "jumps" the program
2308 counter to the specified source line (the one where point is).
2309
2310 ---
2311 *** GUD mode has its own tool bar for controlling execution of the inferior
2312 and other common debugger commands.
2313
2314 +++
2315 *** The new package gdb-ui.el provides an enhanced graphical interface to
2316 GDB. You can interact with GDB through the GUD buffer in the usual way, but
2317 there are also further buffers which control the execution and describe the
2318 state of your program. It separates the input/output of your program from
2319 that of GDB and watches expressions in the speedbar. It also uses features of
2320 Emacs 21 such as the display margin for breakpoints, and the toolbar.
2321
2322 Use M-x gdba to start GDB-UI.
2323
2324 *** GUD tooltips can be toggled independently of normal tooltips
2325 with the minor mode, gud-tooltip-mode.
2326
2327 +++
2328 *** In graphical mode, with a C program, GUD Tooltips have been extended to
2329 display the #define directive associated with an identifier when program is
2330 not executing.
2331
2332 ---
2333 ** GUD mode improvements for jdb:
2334
2335 *** Search for source files using jdb classpath and class
2336 information. Fast startup since there is no need to scan all
2337 source files up front. There is also no need to create and maintain
2338 lists of source directories to scan. Look at `gud-jdb-use-classpath'
2339 and `gud-jdb-classpath' customization variables documentation.
2340
2341 *** Supports the standard breakpoint (gud-break, gud-clear)
2342 set/clear operations from java source files under the classpath, stack
2343 traversal (gud-up, gud-down), and run until current stack finish
2344 (gud-finish).
2345
2346 *** Supports new jdb (Java 1.2 and later) in addition to oldjdb
2347 (Java 1.1 jdb).
2348
2349 *** The previous method of searching for source files has been
2350 preserved in case someone still wants/needs to use it.
2351 Set gud-jdb-use-classpath to nil.
2352
2353 Added Customization Variables
2354
2355 *** gud-jdb-command-name. What command line to use to invoke jdb.
2356
2357 *** gud-jdb-use-classpath. Allows selection of java source file searching
2358 method: set to t for new method, nil to scan gud-jdb-directories for
2359 java sources (previous method).
2360
2361 *** gud-jdb-directories. List of directories to scan and search for java
2362 classes using the original gud-jdb method (if gud-jdb-use-classpath
2363 is nil).
2364
2365 Minor Improvements
2366
2367 *** The STARTTLS elisp wrapper (starttls.el) can now use GNUTLS
2368 instead of the OpenSSL based "starttls" tool. For backwards
2369 compatibility, it prefers "starttls", but you can toggle
2370 `starttls-use-gnutls' to switch to GNUTLS (or simply remove the
2371 "starttls" tool).
2372
2373 *** Do not allow debugger output history variable to grow without bounds.
2374
2375 ** Auto-Revert changes:
2376
2377 +++
2378 *** You can now use Auto Revert mode to `tail' a file.
2379 If point is at the end of a file buffer before reverting, Auto Revert
2380 mode keeps it at the end after reverting. Similarly if point is
2381 displayed at the end of a file buffer in any window, it stays at
2382 the end of the buffer in that window. This allows to tail a file:
2383 just put point at the end of the buffer and it stays there. This
2384 rule applies to file buffers. For non-file buffers, the behavior can
2385 be mode dependent.
2386
2387 If you are sure that the file will only change by growing at the end,
2388 then you can tail the file more efficiently by using the new minor
2389 mode Auto Revert Tail mode. The function `auto-revert-tail-mode'
2390 toggles this mode.
2391
2392 +++
2393 *** Auto Revert mode is now more careful to avoid excessive reverts and
2394 other potential problems when deciding which non-file buffers to
2395 revert. This matters especially if Global Auto Revert mode is enabled
2396 and `global-auto-revert-non-file-buffers' is non-nil. Auto Revert
2397 mode only reverts a non-file buffer if the buffer has a non-nil
2398 `revert-buffer-function' and a non-nil `buffer-stale-function', which
2399 decides whether the buffer should be reverted. Currently, this means
2400 that auto reverting works for Dired buffers (although this may not
2401 work properly on all operating systems) and for the Buffer Menu.
2402
2403 +++
2404 *** If the new user option `auto-revert-check-vc-info' is non-nil, Auto
2405 Revert mode reliably updates version control info (such as the version
2406 control number in the mode line), in all version controlled buffers in
2407 which it is active. If the option is nil, the default, then this info
2408 only gets updated whenever the buffer gets reverted.
2409
2410 ---
2411 ** recentf changes.
2412
2413 The recent file list is now automatically cleanup when recentf mode is
2414 enabled. The new option `recentf-auto-cleanup' controls when to do
2415 automatic cleanup.
2416
2417 The `recentf-keep' option replaces `recentf-keep-non-readable-files-p'
2418 and provides a more general mechanism to customize which file names to
2419 keep in the recent list.
2420
2421 With the more advanced option: `recentf-filename-handler', you can
2422 specify a function that transforms filenames handled by recentf. For
2423 example, if set to `file-truename', the same file will not be in the
2424 recent list with different symbolic links.
2425
2426 To follow naming convention, `recentf-menu-append-commands-flag'
2427 replaces the misnamed option `recentf-menu-append-commands-p'. The
2428 old name remains available as alias, but has been marked obsolete.
2429
2430 +++
2431 ** Desktop package
2432
2433 +++
2434 *** Desktop saving is now a minor mode, desktop-save-mode. Variable
2435 desktop-enable is obsolete. Customize desktop-save-mode to enable desktop
2436 saving.
2437
2438 ---
2439 *** Buffers are saved in the desktop file in the same order as that in the
2440 buffer list.
2441
2442 +++
2443 *** The desktop package can be customized to restore only some buffers immediately,
2444 remaining buffers are restored lazily (when Emacs is idle).
2445
2446 +++
2447 *** New commands:
2448 - desktop-revert reverts to the last loaded desktop.
2449 - desktop-change-dir kills current desktop and loads a new.
2450 - desktop-save-in-desktop-dir saves desktop in the directory from which
2451 it was loaded.
2452 - desktop-lazy-complete runs the desktop load to completion.
2453 - desktop-lazy-abort aborts lazy loading of the desktop.
2454
2455 ---
2456 *** New customizable variables:
2457 - desktop-save. Determins whether the desktop should be saved when it is
2458 killed.
2459 - desktop-file-name-format. Format in which desktop file names should be saved.
2460 - desktop-path. List of directories in which to lookup the desktop file.
2461 - desktop-locals-to-save. List of local variables to save.
2462 - desktop-globals-to-clear. List of global variables that `desktop-clear' will clear.
2463 - desktop-clear-preserve-buffers-regexp. Regexp identifying buffers that `desktop-clear'
2464 should not delete.
2465 - desktop-restore-eager. Number of buffers to restore immediately. Remaining buffers are
2466 restored lazily (when Emacs is idle).
2467 - desktop-lazy-verbose. Verbose reporting of lazily created buffers.
2468 - desktop-lazy-idle-delay. Idle delay before starting to create buffers.
2469
2470 +++
2471 *** New command line option --no-desktop
2472
2473 ---
2474 *** New hooks:
2475 - desktop-after-read-hook run after a desktop is loaded.
2476 - desktop-no-desktop-file-hook run when no desktop file is found.
2477
2478 ---
2479 ** The saveplace.el package now filters out unreadable files.
2480 When you exit Emacs, the saved positions in visited files no longer
2481 include files that aren't readable, e.g. files that don't exist.
2482 Customize the new option `save-place-forget-unreadable-files' to nil
2483 to get the old behavior. The new options `save-place-save-skipped'
2484 and `save-place-skip-check-regexp' allow further fine-tuning of this
2485 feature.
2486
2487 ** EDiff changes.
2488
2489 +++
2490 *** When comparing directories.
2491 Typing D brings up a buffer that lists the differences between the contents of
2492 directories. Now it is possible to use this buffer to copy the missing files
2493 from one directory to another.
2494
2495 +++
2496 *** When comparing files or buffers.
2497 Typing the = key now offers to perform the word-by-word comparison of the
2498 currently highlighted regions in an inferior Ediff session. If you answer 'n'
2499 then it reverts to the old behavior and asks the user to select regions for
2500 comparison.
2501
2502 *** The new command `ediff-backup' compares a file with its most recent
2503 backup using `ediff'. If you specify the name of a backup file,
2504 `ediff-backup' compares it with the file of which it is a backup.
2505
2506 +++
2507 ** Etags changes.
2508
2509 *** New regular expressions features
2510
2511 **** New syntax for regular expressions, multi-line regular expressions.
2512 The syntax --ignore-case-regexp=/regex/ is now undocumented and retained
2513 only for backward compatibility. The new equivalent syntax is
2514 --regex=/regex/i. More generally, it is --regex=/TAGREGEX/TAGNAME/MODS,
2515 where `/TAGNAME' is optional, as usual, and MODS is a string of 0 or
2516 more characters among `i' (ignore case), `m' (multi-line) and `s'
2517 (single-line). The `m' and `s' modifiers behave as in Perl regular
2518 expressions: `m' allows regexps to match more than one line, while `s'
2519 (which implies `m') means that `.' matches newlines. The ability to
2520 span newlines allows writing of much more powerful regular expressions
2521 and rapid prototyping for tagging new languages.
2522
2523 **** Regular expressions can use char escape sequences as in Gcc.
2524 The escaped character sequence \a, \b, \d, \e, \f, \n, \r, \t, \v,
2525 respectively, stand for the ASCII characters BEL, BS, DEL, ESC, FF, NL,
2526 CR, TAB, VT,
2527
2528 **** Regular expressions can be bound to a given language.
2529 The syntax --regex={LANGUAGE}REGEX means that REGEX is used to make tags
2530 only for files of language LANGUAGE, and ignored otherwise. This is
2531 particularly useful when storing regexps in a file.
2532
2533 **** Regular expressions can be read from a file.
2534 The --regex=@regexfile option means read the regexps from a file, one
2535 per line. Lines beginning with space or tab are ignored.
2536
2537 *** New language parsing features
2538
2539 **** The `::' qualifier triggers C++ parsing in C file.
2540 Previously, only the `template' and `class' keywords had this effect.
2541
2542 **** The gnucc __attribute__ keyword is now recognised and ignored.
2543
2544 **** New language HTML.
2545 Title and h1, h2, h3 are tagged. Also, tags are generated when name= is
2546 used inside an anchor and whenever id= is used.
2547
2548 **** In Makefiles, constants are tagged.
2549 If you want the old behavior instead, thus avoiding to increase the
2550 size of the tags file, use the --no-globals option.
2551
2552 **** New language Lua.
2553 All functions are tagged.
2554
2555 **** In Perl, packages are tags.
2556 Subroutine tags are named from their package. You can jump to sub tags
2557 as you did before, by the sub name, or additionally by looking for
2558 package::sub.
2559
2560 **** In Prolog, etags creates tags for rules in addition to predicates.
2561
2562 **** New language PHP.
2563 Tags are functions, classes and defines.
2564 If the --members option is specified to etags, tags are variables also.
2565
2566 **** New default keywords for TeX.
2567 The new keywords are def, newcommand, renewcommand, newenvironment and
2568 renewenvironment.
2569
2570 *** Honour #line directives.
2571 When Etags parses an input file that contains C preprocessor's #line
2572 directives, it creates tags using the file name and line number
2573 specified in those directives. This is useful when dealing with code
2574 created from Cweb source files. When Etags tags the generated file, it
2575 writes tags pointing to the source file.
2576
2577 *** New option --parse-stdin=FILE.
2578 This option is mostly useful when calling etags from programs. It can
2579 be used (only once) in place of a file name on the command line. Etags
2580 reads from standard input and marks the produced tags as belonging to
2581 the file FILE.
2582
2583 ** VC Changes
2584
2585 +++
2586 *** The key C-x C-q no longer checks files in or out, it only changes
2587 the read-only state of the buffer (toggle-read-only). We made this
2588 change because we held a poll and found that many users were unhappy
2589 with the previous behavior. If you do prefer this behavior, you
2590 can bind `vc-toggle-read-only' to C-x C-q in your .emacs:
2591
2592 (global-set-key "\C-x\C-q" 'vc-toggle-read-only)
2593
2594 The function `vc-toggle-read-only' will continue to exist.
2595
2596 +++
2597 *** There is a new user option `vc-cvs-global-switches' that allows
2598 you to specify switches that are passed to any CVS command invoked
2599 by VC. These switches are used as "global options" for CVS, which
2600 means they are inserted before the command name. For example, this
2601 allows you to specify a compression level using the "-z#" option for
2602 CVS.
2603
2604 +++
2605 *** New backends for Subversion and Meta-CVS.
2606
2607 +++
2608 *** vc-annotate-mode enhancements
2609
2610 In vc-annotate mode, you can now use the following key bindings for
2611 enhanced functionality to browse the annotations of past revisions, or
2612 to view diffs or log entries directly from vc-annotate-mode:
2613
2614 P: annotates the previous revision
2615 N: annotates the next revision
2616 J: annotates the revision at line
2617 A: annotates the revision previous to line
2618 D: shows the diff of the revision at line with its previous revision
2619 L: shows the log of the revision at line
2620 W: annotates the workfile (most up to date) version
2621
2622 ** pcl-cvs changes:
2623
2624 +++
2625 *** In pcl-cvs mode, there is a new `d y' command to view the diffs
2626 between the local version of the file and yesterday's head revision
2627 in the repository.
2628
2629 +++
2630 *** In pcl-cvs mode, there is a new `d r' command to view the changes
2631 anyone has committed to the repository since you last executed
2632 "checkout", "update" or "commit". That means using cvs diff options
2633 -rBASE -rHEAD.
2634
2635 +++
2636 ** There is a new user option `mail-default-directory' that allows you
2637 to specify the value of `default-directory' for mail buffers. This
2638 directory is used for auto-save files of mail buffers. It defaults to
2639 "~/".
2640
2641 +++
2642 ** Emacs can now indicate in the mode-line the presence of new e-mail
2643 in a directory or in a file. See the documentation of the user option
2644 `display-time-mail-directory'.
2645
2646 ** Rmail changes:
2647
2648 ---
2649 *** Rmail now displays 5-digit message ids in its summary buffer.
2650
2651 +++
2652 *** Support for `movemail' from GNU mailutils was added to Rmail.
2653 This version of `movemail' allows to read mail from a wide range of
2654 mailbox formats, including remote POP3 and IMAP4 mailboxes with or
2655 without TLS encryption. If GNU mailutils is installed on the system
2656 and its version of `movemail' can be found in exec-path, it will be
2657 used instead of the native one.
2658
2659 ** Gnus package
2660
2661 ---
2662 *** Gnus now includes Sieve and PGG
2663 Sieve is a library for managing Sieve scripts. PGG is a library to handle
2664 PGP/MIME.
2665
2666 ---
2667 *** There are many news features, bug fixes and improvements.
2668 See the file GNUS-NEWS or the node "Oort Gnus" in the Gnus manual for details.
2669
2670 ---
2671 ** MH-E changes.
2672
2673 Upgraded to MH-E version 7.82. There have been major changes since
2674 version 5.0.2; see MH-E-NEWS for details.
2675
2676 ** Calendar changes:
2677
2678 +++
2679 *** There is a new calendar package, icalendar.el, that can be used to
2680 convert Emacs diary entries to/from the iCalendar format.
2681
2682 +++
2683 *** Diary sexp entries can have custom marking in the calendar.
2684 Diary sexp functions which only apply to certain days (such as
2685 `diary-block' or `diary-cyclic') now take an optional parameter MARK,
2686 which is the name of a face or a single-character string indicating
2687 how to highlight the day in the calendar display. Specifying a
2688 single-character string as @var{mark} places the character next to the
2689 day in the calendar. Specifying a face highlights the day with that
2690 face. This lets you have different colors or markings for vacations,
2691 appointments, paydays or anything else using a sexp.
2692
2693 +++
2694 *** The new function `calendar-goto-day-of-year' (g D) prompts for a
2695 year and day number, and moves to that date. Negative day numbers
2696 count backward from the end of the year.
2697
2698 +++
2699 *** The new Calendar function `calendar-goto-iso-week' (g w)
2700 prompts for a year and a week number, and moves to the first
2701 day of that ISO week.
2702
2703 ---
2704 *** The new variable `calendar-minimum-window-height' affects the
2705 window generated by the function `generate-calendar-window'.
2706
2707 ---
2708 *** The functions `holiday-easter-etc' and `holiday-advent' now take
2709 optional arguments, in order to only report on the specified holiday
2710 rather than all. This makes customization of variables such as
2711 `christian-holidays' simpler.
2712
2713 ---
2714 *** The function `simple-diary-display' now by default sets a header line.
2715 This can be controlled through the variables `diary-header-line-flag'
2716 and `diary-header-line-format'.
2717
2718 +++
2719 *** The procedure for activating appointment reminders has changed: use
2720 the new function `appt-activate'. The new variable
2721 `appt-display-format' controls how reminders are displayed, replacing
2722 appt-issue-message, appt-visible, and appt-msg-window.
2723
2724 +++
2725 *** The new functions `diary-from-outlook', `diary-from-outlook-gnus',
2726 and `diary-from-outlook-rmail' can be used to import diary entries
2727 from Outlook-format appointments in mail messages. The variable
2728 `diary-outlook-formats' can be customized to recognize additional
2729 formats.
2730
2731 ---
2732 ** sql changes.
2733
2734 *** The variable `sql-product' controls the highlightng of different
2735 SQL dialects. This variable can be set globally via Customize, on a
2736 buffer-specific basis via local variable settings, or for the current
2737 session using the new SQL->Product submenu. (This menu replaces the
2738 SQL->Highlighting submenu.)
2739
2740 The following values are supported:
2741
2742 ansi ANSI Standard (default)
2743 db2 DB2
2744 informix Informix
2745 ingres Ingres
2746 interbase Interbase
2747 linter Linter
2748 ms Microsoft
2749 mysql MySQL
2750 oracle Oracle
2751 postgres Postgres
2752 solid Solid
2753 sqlite SQLite
2754 sybase Sybase
2755
2756 The current product name will be shown on the mode line following the
2757 SQL mode indicator.
2758
2759 The technique of setting `sql-mode-font-lock-defaults' directly in
2760 your .emacs will no longer establish the default highlighting -- Use
2761 `sql-product' to accomplish this.
2762
2763 ANSI keywords are always highlighted.
2764
2765 *** The function `sql-add-product-keywords' can be used to add
2766 font-lock rules to the product specific rules. For example, to have
2767 all identifiers ending in "_t" under MS SQLServer treated as a type,
2768 you would use the following line in your .emacs file:
2769
2770 (sql-add-product-keywords 'ms
2771 '(("\\<\\w+_t\\>" . font-lock-type-face)))
2772
2773 *** Oracle support includes keyword highlighting for Oracle 9i. Most
2774 SQL and PL/SQL keywords are implemented. SQL*Plus commands are
2775 highlighted in `font-lock-doc-face'.
2776
2777 *** Microsoft SQLServer support has been significantly improved.
2778 Keyword highlighting for SqlServer 2000 is implemented.
2779 sql-interactive-mode defaults to use osql, rather than isql, because
2780 osql flushes its error stream more frequently. Thus error messages
2781 are displayed when they occur rather than when the session is
2782 terminated.
2783
2784 If the username and password are not provided to `sql-ms', osql is
2785 called with the -E command line argument to use the operating system
2786 credentials to authenticate the user.
2787
2788 *** Postgres support is enhanced.
2789 Keyword highlighting of Postgres 7.3 is implemented. Prompting for
2790 the username and the pgsql `-U' option is added.
2791
2792 *** MySQL support is enhanced.
2793 Keyword higlighting of MySql 4.0 is implemented.
2794
2795 *** Imenu support has been enhanced to locate tables, views, indexes,
2796 packages, procedures, functions, triggers, sequences, rules, and
2797 defaults.
2798
2799 *** Added SQL->Start SQLi Session menu entry which calls the
2800 appropriate sql-interactive-mode wrapper for the current setting of
2801 `sql-product'.
2802
2803 ---
2804 *** Support for the SQLite interpreter has been added to sql.el by calling
2805 'sql-sqlite'.
2806
2807 ** FFAP changes:
2808
2809 +++
2810 *** New ffap commands and keybindings: C-x C-r (`ffap-read-only'),
2811 C-x C-v (`ffap-alternate-file'), C-x C-d (`ffap-list-directory'),
2812 C-x 4 r (`ffap-read-only-other-window'), C-x 4 d (`ffap-dired-other-window'),
2813 C-x 5 r (`ffap-read-only-other-frame'), C-x 5 d (`ffap-dired-other-frame').
2814
2815 ---
2816 *** FFAP accepts wildcards in a file name by default. C-x C-f passes
2817 it to `find-file' with non-nil WILDCARDS argument, which visits
2818 multiple files, and C-x d passes it to `dired'.
2819
2820 ---
2821 ** skeleton.el now supports using - to mark the skeleton-point without
2822 interregion interaction. @ has reverted to only setting
2823 skeleton-positions and no longer sets skeleton-point. Skeletons
2824 which used @ to mark skeleton-point independent of _ should now use -
2825 instead. The updated skeleton-insert docstring explains these new
2826 features along with other details of skeleton construction.
2827
2828 ---
2829 ** New variable `hs-set-up-overlay' allows customization of the overlay
2830 used to effect hiding for hideshow minor mode. Integration with isearch
2831 handles the overlay property `display' specially, preserving it during
2832 temporary overlay showing in the course of an isearch operation.
2833
2834 +++
2835 ** hide-ifdef-mode now uses overlays rather than selective-display
2836 to hide its text. This should be mostly transparent but slightly
2837 changes the behavior of motion commands like C-e and C-p.
2838
2839 ---
2840 ** partial-completion-mode now does partial completion on directory names.
2841
2842 ---
2843 ** The type-break package now allows `type-break-file-name' to be nil
2844 and if so, doesn't store any data across sessions. This is handy if
2845 you don't want the .type-break file in your home directory or are
2846 annoyed by the need for interaction when you kill Emacs.
2847
2848 ---
2849 ** `ps-print' can now print characters from the mule-unicode charsets.
2850
2851 Printing text with characters from the mule-unicode-* sets works with
2852 ps-print, provided that you have installed the appropriate BDF fonts.
2853 See the file INSTALL for URLs where you can find these fonts.
2854
2855 ---
2856 ** New command `strokes-global-set-stroke-string'.
2857 This is like `strokes-global-set-stroke', but it allows you to bind
2858 the stroke directly to a string to insert. This is convenient for
2859 using strokes as an input method.
2860
2861 ** Emacs server changes:
2862
2863 +++
2864 *** You can have several Emacs servers on the same machine.
2865
2866 % emacs --eval '(setq server-name "foo")' -f server-start &
2867 % emacs --eval '(setq server-name "bar")' -f server-start &
2868 % emacsclient -s foo file1
2869 % emacsclient -s bar file2
2870
2871 +++
2872 *** The `emacsclient' command understands the options `--eval' and
2873 `--display' which tell Emacs respectively to evaluate the given elisp
2874 expression and to use the given display when visiting files.
2875
2876 +++
2877 *** User option `server-mode' can be used to start a server process.
2878
2879 ---
2880 ** LDAP support now defaults to ldapsearch from OpenLDAP version 2.
2881
2882 +++
2883 ** You can now disable pc-selection-mode after enabling it.
2884 M-x pc-selection-mode behaves like a proper minor mode, and with no
2885 argument it toggles the mode.
2886
2887 Turning off PC-Selection mode restores the global key bindings
2888 that were replaced by turning on the mode.
2889
2890 ---
2891 ** `uniquify-strip-common-suffix' tells uniquify to prefer
2892 `file|dir1' and `file|dir2' to `file|dir1/subdir' and `file|dir2/subdir'.
2893
2894 ---
2895 ** Support for `magic cookie' standout modes has been removed.
2896 Emacs will still work on terminals that require magic cookies in order
2897 to use standout mode, however they will not be able to display
2898 mode-lines in inverse-video.
2899
2900 ---
2901 ** The game `mpuz' is enhanced.
2902
2903 `mpuz' now allows the 2nd factor not to have two identical digits. By
2904 default, all trivial operations involving whole lines are performed
2905 automatically. The game uses faces for better visual feedback.
2906
2907 ---
2908 ** display-battery has been replaced by display-battery-mode.
2909
2910 ---
2911 ** calculator.el now has radix grouping mode, which is available when
2912 `calculator-output-radix' is non-nil. In this mode a separator
2913 character is used every few digits, making it easier to see byte
2914 boundries etc. For more info, see the documentation of the variable
2915 `calculator-radix-grouping-mode'.
2916
2917 ---
2918 ** fast-lock.el and lazy-lock.el are obsolete. Use jit-lock.el instead.
2919
2920 ---
2921 ** iso-acc.el is now obsolete. Use one of the latin input methods instead.
2922
2923 ---
2924 ** cplus-md.el has been removed to avoid problems with Custom.
2925 \f
2926 * Changes in Emacs 22.1 on non-free operating systems
2927
2928 +++
2929 ** Passing resources on the command line now works on MS Windows.
2930 You can use --xrm to pass resource settings to Emacs, overriding any
2931 existing values. For example:
2932
2933 emacs --xrm "Emacs.Background:red" --xrm "Emacs.Geometry:100x20"
2934
2935 will start up Emacs on an initial frame of 100x20 with red background,
2936 irrespective of geometry or background setting on the Windows registry.
2937
2938 ---
2939 ** On MS Windows, the "system caret" now follows the cursor.
2940 This enables Emacs to work better with programs that need to track
2941 the cursor, for example screen magnifiers and text to speech programs.
2942
2943 ---
2944 ** Tooltips now work on MS Windows.
2945 See the Emacs 21.1 NEWS entry for tooltips for details.
2946
2947 ---
2948 ** Images are now supported on MS Windows.
2949 PBM and XBM images are supported out of the box. Other image formats
2950 depend on external libraries. All of these libraries have been ported
2951 to Windows, and can be found in both source and binary form at
2952 http://gnuwin32.sourceforge.net/. Note that libpng also depends on
2953 zlib, and tiff depends on the version of jpeg that it was compiled
2954 against. For additional information, see nt/INSTALL.
2955
2956 ---
2957 ** Sound is now supported on MS Windows.
2958 WAV format is supported on all versions of Windows, other formats such
2959 as AU, AIFF and MP3 may be supported in the more recent versions of
2960 Windows, or when other software provides hooks into the system level
2961 sound support for those formats.
2962
2963 ---
2964 ** Different shaped mouse pointers are supported on MS Windows.
2965 The mouse pointer changes shape depending on what is under the pointer.
2966
2967 ---
2968 ** Pointing devices with more than 3 buttons are now supported on MS Windows.
2969 The new variable `w32-pass-extra-mouse-buttons-to-system' controls
2970 whether Emacs should handle the extra buttons itself (the default), or
2971 pass them to Windows to be handled with system-wide functions.
2972
2973 ---
2974 ** Emacs takes note of colors defined in Control Panel on MS-Windows.
2975 The Control Panel defines some default colors for applications in much
2976 the same way as wildcard X Resources do on X. Emacs now adds these
2977 colors to the colormap prefixed by System (eg SystemMenu for the
2978 default Menu background, SystemMenuText for the foreground), and uses
2979 some of them to initialize some of the default faces.
2980 `list-colors-display' shows the list of System color names, in case
2981 you wish to use them in other faces.
2982
2983 ---
2984 ** On MS Windows NT/W2K/XP, Emacs uses Unicode for clipboard operations.
2985 Those systems use Unicode internally, so this allows Emacs to share
2986 multilingual text with other applications. On other versions of
2987 MS Windows, Emacs now uses the appropriate locale coding-system, so
2988 the clipboard should work correctly for your local language without
2989 any customizations.
2990
2991 ---
2992 ** On Mac OS, the value of the variable `keyboard-coding-system' is
2993 now dynamically changed according to the current keyboard script. The
2994 variable `mac-keyboard-text-encoding' and the constants
2995 `kTextEncodingMacRoman', `kTextEncodingISOLatin1', and
2996 `kTextEncodingISOLatin2' are obsolete.
2997 \f
2998 * Incompatible Lisp Changes in Emacs 22.1
2999
3000 +++
3001 ** `suppress-keymap' now works by remapping `self-insert-command' to
3002 the command `undefined'. (In earlier Emacs versions, it used
3003 `substitute-key-definition' to rebind self inserting characters to
3004 `undefined'.)
3005
3006 +++
3007 ** Mode line display ignores text properties as well as the
3008 :propertize and :eval forms in the value of a variable whose
3009 `risky-local-variable' property is nil.
3010
3011 ---
3012 ** Support for Mocklisp has been removed.
3013 \f
3014 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 22.1
3015
3016 ** General Lisp changes:
3017
3018 +++
3019 *** The function `eql' is now available without requiring the CL package.
3020
3021 +++
3022 *** `makehash' is now obsolete. Use `make-hash-table' instead.
3023
3024 +++
3025 *** If optional third argument APPEND to `add-to-list' is non-nil, a
3026 new element gets added at the end of the list instead of at the
3027 beginning. This change actually occurred in Emacs-21.1, but was not
3028 documented.
3029
3030 +++
3031 *** New function `copy-tree' makes a copy of a tree, recursively copying
3032 both cars and cdrs.
3033
3034 +++
3035 *** New function `delete-dups' destructively removes `equal'
3036 duplicates from a list. Of several `equal' occurrences of an element
3037 in the list, the first one is kept.
3038
3039 +++
3040 *** `declare' is now a macro. This change was made mostly for
3041 documentation purposes and should have no real effect on Lisp code.
3042
3043 +++
3044 *** The new function `rassq-delete-all' deletes all elements from an
3045 alist whose cdr is `eq' to a specified value.
3046
3047 +++
3048 *** The function `number-sequence' returns a list of equally-separated
3049 numbers. For instance, (number-sequence 4 9) returns (4 5 6 7 8 9).
3050 By default, the separation is 1, but you can specify a different separation
3051 as the third argument. (number-sequence 1.5 6 2) returns (1.5 3.5 5.5).
3052
3053 +++
3054 *** The variables `most-positive-fixnum' and `most-negative-fixnum'
3055 hold the largest and smallest possible integer values.
3056
3057 +++
3058 *** The flags, width, and precision options for %-specifications in function
3059 `format' are now documented. Some flags that were accepted but not
3060 implemented (such as "*") are no longer accepted.
3061
3062 +++
3063 *** Functions `get' and `plist-get' no longer signals an error for
3064 a malformed property list. They also detect cyclic lists.
3065
3066 +++
3067 *** The new functions `lax-plist-get' and `lax-plist-put' are like
3068 `plist-get' and `plist-put', except that they compare the property
3069 name using `equal' rather than `eq'.
3070
3071 +++
3072 *** The new variable `print-continuous-numbering', when non-nil, says
3073 that successive calls to print functions should use the same
3074 numberings for circular structure references. This is only relevant
3075 when `print-circle' is non-nil.
3076
3077 When you bind `print-continuous-numbering' to t, you should
3078 also bind `print-number-table' to nil.
3079
3080 +++
3081 *** New function `macroexpand-all' expands all macros in a form.
3082
3083 It is similar to the Common-Lisp function of the same name.
3084 One difference is that it guarantees to return the original argument
3085 if no expansion is done, which can be tested using `eq'.
3086
3087 +++
3088 *** The function `atan' now accepts an optional second argument.
3089
3090 When called with 2 arguments, as in `(atan Y X)', `atan' returns the
3091 angle in radians between the vector [X, Y] and the X axis. (This is
3092 equivalent to the standard C library function `atan2'.)
3093
3094 +++
3095 *** A function's doc string can now specify the calling pattern.
3096
3097 You put this in the doc string's last line, which should match the
3098 regexp "\n\n(fn.*)\\'".
3099
3100 +++
3101 *** New macro `with-local-quit' temporarily sets `inhibit-quit' to nil.
3102
3103 This is for use around potentially blocking or long-running code in
3104 timers and `post-command-hook' functions.
3105
3106 *** `define-obsolete-function-alias'
3107 combines `defalias' and `make-obsolete'.
3108
3109 +++
3110 *** New function `unsafep' returns nil if the given Lisp form can't
3111 possibly do anything dangerous; otherwise it returns a reason why the
3112 form might be unsafe (calls unknown function, alters global variable,
3113 etc).
3114
3115 ** Lisp code indentation features:
3116
3117 +++
3118 *** The `defmacro' form can contain declarations specifying how to
3119 indent the macro in Lisp mode and how to debug it with Edebug. The
3120 syntax of defmacro has been extended to
3121
3122 (defmacro NAME LAMBDA-LIST [DOC-STRING] [DECLARATION ...] ...)
3123
3124 DECLARATION is a list `(declare DECLARATION-SPECIFIER ...)'. The
3125 declaration specifiers supported are:
3126
3127 (indent INDENT)
3128 Set NAME's `lisp-indent-function' property to INDENT.
3129
3130 (edebug DEBUG)
3131 Set NAME's `edebug-form-spec' property to DEBUG. (This is
3132 equivalent to writing a `def-edebug-spec' for the macro.
3133
3134 ---
3135 *** cl-indent now allows customization of Indentation of backquoted forms.
3136
3137 See the new user option `lisp-backquote-indentation'.
3138
3139 ---
3140 *** cl-indent now handles indentation of simple and extended `loop' forms.
3141
3142 The new user options `lisp-loop-keyword-indentation',
3143 `lisp-loop-forms-indentation', and `lisp-simple-loop-indentation' can
3144 be used to customize the indentation of keywords and forms in loop
3145 forms.
3146
3147 +++
3148 ** Variable aliases:
3149
3150 *** defvaralias ALIAS-VAR BASE-VAR [DOCSTRING]
3151
3152 This function defines the symbol ALIAS-VAR as a variable alias for
3153 symbol BASE-VAR. This means that retrieving the value of ALIAS-VAR
3154 returns the value of BASE-VAR, and changing the value of ALIAS-VAR
3155 changes the value of BASE-VAR.
3156
3157 DOCSTRING, if present, is the documentation for ALIAS-VAR; else it has
3158 the same documentation as BASE-VAR.
3159
3160 *** indirect-variable VARIABLE
3161
3162 This function returns the variable at the end of the chain of aliases
3163 of VARIABLE. If VARIABLE is not a symbol, or if VARIABLE is not
3164 defined as an alias, the function returns VARIABLE.
3165
3166 It might be noteworthy that variables aliases work for all kinds of
3167 variables, including buffer-local and frame-local variables.
3168
3169 +++
3170 *** The macro `define-obsolete-variable-alias' combines `defvaralias' and
3171 `make-obsolete-variable'.
3172
3173 ** defcustom changes:
3174
3175 +++
3176 *** defcustom and other custom declarations now use a default group
3177 (the last prior group defined in the same file) when no :group was given.
3178
3179 ---
3180 *** The new customization type `float' specifies numbers with floating
3181 point (no integers are allowed).
3182
3183 ** String changes:
3184
3185 +++
3186 *** The escape sequence \s is now interpreted as a SPACE character,
3187 unless it is followed by a `-' in a character constant (e.g. ?\s-A),
3188 in which case it is still interpreted as the super modifier.
3189 In strings, \s is always interpreted as a space.
3190
3191 +++
3192 *** A hex escape in a string forces the string to be multibyte.
3193 An octal escape makes it unibyte.
3194
3195 +++
3196 *** `split-string' now includes null substrings in the returned list if
3197 the optional argument SEPARATORS is non-nil and there are matches for
3198 SEPARATORS at the beginning or end of the string. If SEPARATORS is
3199 nil, or if the new optional third argument OMIT-NULLS is non-nil, all
3200 empty matches are omitted from the returned list.
3201
3202 +++
3203 *** New function `string-to-multibyte' converts a unibyte string to a
3204 multibyte string with the same individual character codes.
3205
3206 +++
3207 *** New function `substring-no-properties returns a substring without
3208 text properties.
3209
3210 +++
3211 *** The new function `assoc-string' replaces `assoc-ignore-case' and
3212 `assoc-ignore-representation', which are still available, but have
3213 been declared obsolete.
3214
3215 ** Buffer/variable changes:
3216
3217 +++
3218 *** The new function `buffer-local-value' returns the buffer-local
3219 binding of VARIABLE (a symbol) in buffer BUFFER. If VARIABLE does not
3220 have a buffer-local binding in buffer BUFFER, it returns the default
3221 value of VARIABLE instead.
3222
3223 +++
3224 ** There is a new facility for displaying warnings to the user.
3225
3226 See the functions `warn' and `display-warning' .
3227
3228 +++
3229 ** Progress reporters.
3230
3231 These provide a simple and uniform way for commands to present
3232 progress messages for the user.
3233
3234 See the new functions `make-progress-reporter',
3235 `progress-reporter-update', `progress-reporter-force-update',
3236 `progress-reporter-done', and `dotimes-with-progress-reporter'.
3237
3238 ** Buffer positions:
3239
3240 +++
3241 *** Function `compute-motion' now calculates the usable window
3242 width if the WIDTH argument is nil. If the TOPOS argument is nil,
3243 the usable window height and width is used.
3244
3245 +++
3246 *** The `line-move', `scroll-up', and `scroll-down' functions will now
3247 modify the window vscroll to scroll through display rows that are
3248 taller that the height of the window, for example in the presense of
3249 large images. To disable this feature, Lisp code can bind the new
3250 variable `auto-window-vscroll' to nil.
3251
3252 +++
3253 *** The argument to `forward-word', `backward-word',
3254 `forward-to-indentation' and `backward-to-indentation' is now
3255 optional, and defaults to 1.
3256
3257 +++
3258 *** Lisp code can now test if a given buffer position is inside a
3259 clickable link with the new function `mouse-on-link-p'. This is the
3260 function used by the new `mouse-1-click-follows-link' functionality.
3261
3262 +++
3263 *** New function `line-number-at-pos' returns the line number of the
3264 current line in the current buffer, or if optional buffer position is
3265 given, line number of corresponding line in current buffer.
3266
3267 +++
3268 *** `field-beginning' and `field-end' now accept an additional optional
3269 argument, LIMIT.
3270
3271 +++
3272 *** Function `pos-visible-in-window-p' now returns the pixel coordinates
3273 and partial visiblity state of the corresponding row, if the PARTIALLY
3274 arg is non-nil.
3275
3276 +++
3277 *** New functions `posn-at-point' and `posn-at-x-y' return
3278 click-event-style position information for a given visible buffer
3279 position or for a given window pixel coordinate.
3280
3281 ** Text modification:
3282
3283 +++
3284 *** The new function `insert-buffer-substring-as-yank' works like
3285 `insert-buffer-substring', but removes the text properties in the
3286 `yank-excluded-properties' list.
3287
3288 +++
3289 *** The new function `insert-buffer-substring-no-properties' is like
3290 insert-buffer-substring, but removes all text properties from the
3291 inserted substring.
3292
3293 +++
3294 *** The new function `filter-buffer-substring' extracts a buffer
3295 substring, passes it through a set of filter functions, and returns
3296 the filtered substring. It is used instead of `buffer-substring' or
3297 `delete-and-extract-region' when copying text into a user-accessible
3298 data structure, like the kill-ring, X clipboard, or a register. The
3299 list of filter function is specified by the new variable
3300 `buffer-substring-filters'. For example, Longlines mode uses
3301 `buffer-substring-filters' to remove soft newlines from the copied
3302 text.
3303
3304 +++
3305 *** Function `translate-region' accepts also a char-table as TABLE
3306 argument.
3307
3308 +++
3309 *** The new translation table `translation-table-for-input'
3310 is used for customizing self-insertion. The character to
3311 be inserted is translated through it.
3312
3313 ---
3314 *** Text clones.
3315
3316 The new function `text-clone-create'. Text clones are chunks of text
3317 that are kept identical by transparently propagating changes from one
3318 clone to the other.
3319
3320 ---
3321 *** The function `insert-string' is now obsolete.
3322
3323 ** Syntax table changes:
3324
3325 +++
3326 *** The macro `with-syntax-table' does not copy the table any more.
3327
3328 +++
3329 *** The new function `syntax-after' returns the syntax code
3330 of the character after a specified buffer position, taking account
3331 of text properties as well as the character code.
3332
3333 +++
3334 *** `syntax-class' extracts the class of a syntax code (as returned
3335 by syntax-after).
3336
3337 *** The new package `syntax.el' provides an efficient way to find the
3338 current syntactic context (as returned by `parse-partial-sexp').
3339
3340 ** GC changes:
3341
3342 +++
3343 *** New variables `gc-elapsed' and `gcs-done' provide extra information
3344 on garbage collection.
3345
3346 +++
3347 *** Functions from `post-gc-hook' are run at the end of garbage
3348 collection. The hook is run with GC inhibited, so use it with care.
3349
3350 ** Buffer-related changes:
3351
3352 ---
3353 *** `list-buffers-noselect' now takes an additional argument, BUFFER-LIST.
3354 If it is non-nil, it specifies which buffers to list.
3355
3356 +++
3357 *** `kill-buffer-hook' is now a permanent local.
3358
3359 ** Local variables lists:
3360
3361 +++
3362 *** Text properties in local variables.
3363
3364 A file local variables list cannot specify a string with text
3365 properties--any specified text properties are discarded.
3366
3367 +++
3368 *** The variable `safe-local-eval-forms' specifies a list of forms that
3369 are ok to evaluate when they appear in an `eval' local variables
3370 specification. Normally Emacs asks for confirmation before evaluating
3371 such a form, but if the form appears in this list, no confirmation is
3372 needed.
3373
3374 ---
3375 *** If a function has a non-nil `safe-local-eval-function' property,
3376 that means it is ok to evaluate some calls to that function when it
3377 appears in an `eval' local variables specification. If the property
3378 is t, then any form calling that function with constant arguments is
3379 ok. If the property is a function or list of functions, they are called
3380 with the form as argument, and if any returns t, the form is ok to call.
3381
3382 If the form is not "ok to call", that means Emacs asks for
3383 confirmation as before.
3384
3385 ** Abbrev changes:
3386
3387 *** The new function copy-abbrev-table returns a new abbrev table that
3388 is a copy of a given abbrev table.
3389
3390 +++
3391 *** define-abbrev now accepts an optional argument SYSTEM-FLAG. If
3392 non-nil, this marks the abbrev as a "system" abbrev, which means that
3393 it won't be stored in the user's abbrevs file if he saves the abbrevs.
3394 Major modes that predefine some abbrevs should always specify this
3395 flag.
3396
3397 ** Undo changes:
3398
3399 +++
3400 *** An element of buffer-undo-list can now have the form (apply FUNNAME
3401 . ARGS), where FUNNAME is a symbol other than t or nil. That stands
3402 for a high-level change that should be undone by evaluating (apply
3403 FUNNAME ARGS).
3404
3405 These entries can also have the form (apply DELTA BEG END FUNNAME . ARGS)
3406 which indicates that the change which took place was limited to the
3407 range BEG...END and increased the buffer size by DELTA.
3408
3409 +++
3410 *** If the buffer's undo list for the current command gets longer than
3411 undo-outer-limit, garbage collection empties it. This is to prevent
3412 it from using up the available memory and choking Emacs.
3413
3414 +++
3415 ** New `yank-handler' text property can be used to control how
3416 previously killed text on the kill-ring is reinserted.
3417
3418 The value of the yank-handler property must be a list with one to four
3419 elements with the following format:
3420 (FUNCTION PARAM NOEXCLUDE UNDO).
3421
3422 The `insert-for-yank' function looks for a yank-handler property on
3423 the first character on its string argument (typically the first
3424 element on the kill-ring). If a yank-handler property is found,
3425 the normal behavior of `insert-for-yank' is modified in various ways:
3426
3427 When FUNCTION is present and non-nil, it is called instead of `insert'
3428 to insert the string. FUNCTION takes one argument--the object to insert.
3429 If PARAM is present and non-nil, it replaces STRING as the object
3430 passed to FUNCTION (or `insert'); for example, if FUNCTION is
3431 `yank-rectangle', PARAM should be a list of strings to insert as a
3432 rectangle.
3433 If NOEXCLUDE is present and non-nil, the normal removal of the
3434 yank-excluded-properties is not performed; instead FUNCTION is
3435 responsible for removing those properties. This may be necessary
3436 if FUNCTION adjusts point before or after inserting the object.
3437 If UNDO is present and non-nil, it is a function that will be called
3438 by `yank-pop' to undo the insertion of the current object. It is
3439 called with two arguments, the start and end of the current region.
3440 FUNCTION can set `yank-undo-function' to override the UNDO value.
3441
3442 *** The functions kill-new, kill-append, and kill-region now have an
3443 optional argument to specify the yank-handler text property to put on
3444 the killed text.
3445
3446 *** The function yank-pop will now use a non-nil value of the variable
3447 `yank-undo-function' (instead of delete-region) to undo the previous
3448 yank or yank-pop command (or a call to insert-for-yank). The function
3449 insert-for-yank automatically sets that variable according to the UNDO
3450 element of the string argument's yank-handler text property if present.
3451
3452 *** The function `insert-for-yank' now supports strings where the
3453 `yank-handler' property does not span the first character of the
3454 string. The old behavior is available if you call
3455 `insert-for-yank-1' instead.
3456
3457 *** The new function insert-for-yank normally works like `insert', but
3458 removes the text properties in the `yank-excluded-properties' list.
3459 However, the insertion of the text can be modified by a `yank-handler'
3460 text property.
3461
3462 ** File operation changes:
3463
3464 +++
3465 *** New vars `exec-suffixes' and `load-suffixes' used when
3466 searching for an executable resp. an elisp file.
3467
3468 +++
3469 *** The new primitive `set-file-times' sets a file's access and
3470 modification times. Magic file name handlers can handle this
3471 operation.
3472
3473 +++
3474 *** The new function `file-remote-p' tests a file name and returns
3475 non-nil if it specifies a remote file (one that Emacs accesses using
3476 its own special methods and not directly through the file system).
3477 The value in that case is an identifier for the remote file system.
3478
3479 +++
3480 *** `auto-save-file-format' has been renamed to
3481 `buffer-auto-save-file-format' and made into a permanent local.
3482
3483 +++
3484 *** Functions `file-name-sans-extension' and `file-name-extension' now
3485 ignore the leading dots in file names, so that file names such as
3486 `.emacs' are treated as extensionless.
3487
3488 +++
3489 *** copy-file now takes an additional option arg MUSTBENEW.
3490
3491 This argument works like the MUSTBENEW argument of write-file.
3492
3493 +++
3494 *** If the second argument to `copy-file' is the name of a directory,
3495 the file is copied to that directory instead of signaling an error.
3496
3497 +++
3498 *** `visited-file-modtime' and `calendar-time-from-absolute' now return
3499 a list of two integers, instead of a cons.
3500
3501 +++
3502 *** `file-chase-links' now takes an optional second argument LIMIT which
3503 specifies the maximum number of links to chase through. If after that
3504 many iterations the file name obtained is still a symbolic link,
3505 `file-chase-links' returns it anyway.
3506
3507 +++
3508 *** The new hook `before-save-hook' is invoked by `basic-save-buffer'
3509 before saving buffers. This allows packages to perform various final
3510 tasks, for example; it can be used by the copyright package to make
3511 sure saved files have the current year in any copyright headers.
3512
3513 +++
3514 *** If a buffer sets buffer-save-without-query to non-nil,
3515 save-some-buffers will always save that buffer without asking
3516 (if it's modified).
3517
3518 *** New function `locate-file' searches for a file in a list of directories.
3519 `locate-file' accepts a name of a file to search (a string), and two
3520 lists: a list of directories to search in and a list of suffixes to
3521 try; typical usage might use `exec-path' and `load-path' for the list
3522 of directories, and `exec-suffixes' and `load-suffixes' for the list
3523 of suffixes. The function also accepts a predicate argument to
3524 further filter candidate files.
3525
3526 One advantage of using this function is that the list of suffixes in
3527 `exec-suffixes' is OS-dependant, so this function will find
3528 executables without polluting Lisp code with OS dependancies.
3529
3530 ---
3531 *** The precedence of file-name-handlers has been changed.
3532 Instead of blindly choosing the first handler that matches,
3533 find-file-name-handler now gives precedence to a file-name handler
3534 that matches near the end of the file name. More specifically, the
3535 handler whose (match-beginning 0) is the largest is chosen.
3536 In case of ties, the old "first matched" rule applies.
3537
3538 +++
3539 *** A file name handler can declare which operations it handles.
3540
3541 You do this by putting an `operation' property on the handler name
3542 symbol. The property value should be a list of the operations that
3543 the handler really handles. It won't be called for any other
3544 operations.
3545
3546 This is useful for autoloaded handlers, to prevent them from being
3547 autoloaded when not really necessary.
3548
3549 ** Input changes:
3550
3551 +++
3552 *** An interactive specification can now use the code letter 'U' to get
3553 the up-event that was discarded in case the last key sequence read for a
3554 previous 'k' or 'K' argument was a down-event; otherwise nil is used.
3555
3556 +++
3557 *** The new interactive-specification `G' reads a file name
3558 much like `F', but if the input is a directory name (even defaulted),
3559 it returns just the directory name.
3560
3561 ---
3562 *** Functions y-or-n-p, read-char, read-key-sequence and the like, that
3563 display a prompt but don't use the minibuffer, now display the prompt
3564 using the text properties (esp. the face) of the prompt string.
3565
3566 +++
3567 *** (while-no-input BODY...) runs BODY, but only so long as no input
3568 arrives. If the user types or clicks anything, BODY stops as if a
3569 quit had occurred. while-no-input returns the value of BODY, if BODY
3570 finishes. It returns nil if BODY was aborted.
3571
3572 ** Minibuffer changes:
3573
3574 *** The new function `minibufferp' returns non-nil if its optional
3575 buffer argument is a minibuffer. If the argument is omitted, it
3576 defaults to the current buffer.
3577
3578 +++
3579 *** New function minibuffer-selected-window returns the window which
3580 was selected when entering the minibuffer.
3581
3582 +++
3583 *** read-from-minibuffer now accepts an additional argument KEEP-ALL
3584 saying to put all inputs in the history list, even empty ones.
3585
3586 +++
3587 *** The `read-file-name' function now takes an additional argument which
3588 specifies a predicate which the file name read must satify. The
3589 new variable `read-file-name-predicate' contains the predicate argument
3590 while reading the file name from the minibuffer; the predicate in this
3591 variable is used by read-file-name-internal to filter the completion list.
3592
3593 ---
3594 *** The new variable `read-file-name-function' can be used by lisp code
3595 to override the internal read-file-name function.
3596
3597 +++
3598 *** The new variable `read-file-name-completion-ignore-case' specifies
3599 whether completion ignores case when reading a file name with the
3600 `read-file-name' function.
3601
3602 +++
3603 *** The new function `read-directory-name' can be used instead of
3604 `read-file-name' to read a directory name; when used, completion
3605 will only show directories.
3606
3607 ** Searching and matching changes:
3608
3609 +++
3610 *** New function `looking-back' checks whether a regular expression matches
3611 the text before point. Specifying the LIMIT argument bounds how far
3612 back the match can start; this is a way to keep it from taking too long.
3613
3614 +++
3615 *** The new variable search-spaces-regexp controls how to search
3616 for spaces in a regular expression. If it is non-nil, it should be a
3617 regular expression, and any series of spaces stands for that regular
3618 expression. If it is nil, spaces stand for themselves.
3619
3620 Spaces inside of constructs such as [..] and *, +, ? are never
3621 replaced with search-spaces-regexp.
3622
3623 +++
3624 *** There are now two new regular expression operators, \_< and \_>,
3625 for matching the beginning and end of a symbol. A symbol is a
3626 non-empty sequence of either word or symbol constituent characters, as
3627 specified by the syntax table.
3628
3629 +++
3630 *** skip-chars-forward and skip-chars-backward now handle
3631 character classes such as [:alpha:], along with individual characters
3632 and ranges.
3633
3634 ---
3635 *** In `replace-match', the replacement text no longer inherits
3636 properties from surrounding text.
3637
3638 +++
3639 *** The list returned by `(match-data t)' now has the buffer as a final
3640 element, if the last match was on a buffer. `set-match-data'
3641 accepts such a list for restoring the match state.
3642
3643 ---
3644 *** rx.el has new corresponding `symbol-end' and `symbol-start' elements.
3645
3646 +++
3647 *** The default value of `sentence-end' is now defined using the new
3648 variable `sentence-end-without-space', which contains such characters
3649 that end a sentence without following spaces.
3650
3651 The function `sentence-end' should be used to obtain the value of the
3652 variable `sentence-end'. If the variable `sentence-end' is nil, then
3653 this function returns the regexp constructed from the variables
3654 `sentence-end-without-period', `sentence-end-double-space' and
3655 `sentence-end-without-space'.
3656
3657 +++
3658 ** Enhancements to keymaps.
3659
3660 *** Cleaner way to enter key sequences.
3661
3662 You can enter a constant key sequence in a more natural format, the
3663 same one used for saving keyboard macros, using the macro `kbd'. For
3664 example,
3665
3666 (kbd "C-x C-f") => "\^x\^f"
3667
3668 *** Interactive commands can be remapped through keymaps.
3669
3670 This is an alternative to using defadvice or substitute-key-definition
3671 to modify the behavior of a key binding using the normal keymap
3672 binding and lookup functionality.
3673
3674 When a key sequence is bound to a command, and that command is
3675 remapped to another command, that command is run instead of the
3676 original command.
3677
3678 Example:
3679 Suppose that minor mode my-mode has defined the commands
3680 my-kill-line and my-kill-word, and it wants C-k (and any other key
3681 bound to kill-line) to run the command my-kill-line instead of
3682 kill-line, and likewise it wants to run my-kill-word instead of
3683 kill-word.
3684
3685 Instead of rebinding C-k and the other keys in the minor mode map,
3686 command remapping allows you to directly map kill-line into
3687 my-kill-line and kill-word into my-kill-word through the minor mode
3688 map using define-key:
3689
3690 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-line] 'my-kill-line)
3691 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-word] 'my-kill-word)
3692
3693 Now, when my-mode is enabled, and the user enters C-k or M-d,
3694 the commands my-kill-line and my-kill-word are run.
3695
3696 Notice that only one level of remapping is supported. In the above
3697 example, this means that if my-kill-line is remapped to other-kill,
3698 then C-k still runs my-kill-line.
3699
3700 The following changes have been made to provide command remapping:
3701
3702 - Command remappings are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
3703 `remap', i.e. `(define-key MAP [remap CMD] DEF)' remaps command CMD
3704 to definition DEF in keymap MAP. The definition is not limited to
3705 another command; it can be anything accepted for a normal binding.
3706
3707 - The new function `command-remapping' returns the binding for a
3708 remapped command in the current keymaps, or nil if not remapped.
3709
3710 - key-binding now remaps interactive commands unless the optional
3711 third argument NO-REMAP is non-nil.
3712
3713 - where-is-internal now returns nil for a remapped command (e.g.
3714 kill-line if my-mode is enabled), and the actual key binding for
3715 the command it is remapped to (e.g. C-k for my-kill-line).
3716 It also has a new optional fifth argument, NO-REMAP, which inhibits
3717 remapping if non-nil (e.g. it returns C-k for kill-line and
3718 <kill-line> for my-kill-line).
3719
3720 - The new variable `this-original-command' contains the original
3721 command before remapping. It is equal to `this-command' when the
3722 command was not remapped.
3723
3724 *** If text has a `keymap' property, that keymap takes precedence
3725 over minor mode keymaps.
3726
3727 *** The `keymap' property now also works at the ends of overlays and
3728 text-properties, according to their stickiness. This also means that it
3729 works with empty overlays. The same hold for the `local-map' property.
3730
3731 *** Dense keymaps now handle inheritance correctly.
3732 Previously a dense keymap would hide all of the simple-char key
3733 bindings of the parent keymap.
3734
3735 *** `define-key-after' now accepts keys longer than 1.
3736
3737 *** New function `current-active-maps' returns a list of currently
3738 active keymaps.
3739
3740 *** New function `describe-buffer-bindings' inserts the list of all
3741 defined keys and their definitions.
3742
3743 *** New function `keymap-prompt' returns the prompt-string of a keymap
3744
3745 *** (map-keymap FUNCTION KEYMAP) applies the function to each binding
3746 in the keymap.
3747
3748 *** New variable emulation-mode-map-alists.
3749
3750 Lisp packages using many minor mode keymaps can now maintain their own
3751 keymap alist separate from minor-mode-map-alist by adding their keymap
3752 alist to this list.
3753
3754 +++
3755 ** Atomic change groups.
3756
3757 To perform some changes in the current buffer "atomically" so that
3758 they either all succeed or are all undone, use `atomic-change-group'
3759 around the code that makes changes. For instance:
3760
3761 (atomic-change-group
3762 (insert foo)
3763 (delete-region x y))
3764
3765 If an error (or other nonlocal exit) occurs inside the body of
3766 `atomic-change-group', it unmakes all the changes in that buffer that
3767 were during the execution of the body. The change group has no effect
3768 on any other buffers--any such changes remain.
3769
3770 If you need something more sophisticated, you can directly call the
3771 lower-level functions that `atomic-change-group' uses. Here is how.
3772
3773 To set up a change group for one buffer, call `prepare-change-group'.
3774 Specify the buffer as argument; it defaults to the current buffer.
3775 This function returns a "handle" for the change group. You must save
3776 the handle to activate the change group and then finish it.
3777
3778 Before you change the buffer again, you must activate the change
3779 group. Pass the handle to `activate-change-group' afterward to
3780 do this.
3781
3782 After you make the changes, you must finish the change group. You can
3783 either accept the changes or cancel them all. Call
3784 `accept-change-group' to accept the changes in the group as final;
3785 call `cancel-change-group' to undo them all.
3786
3787 You should use `unwind-protect' to make sure the group is always
3788 finished. The call to `activate-change-group' should be inside the
3789 `unwind-protect', in case the user types C-g just after it runs.
3790 (This is one reason why `prepare-change-group' and
3791 `activate-change-group' are separate functions.) Once you finish the
3792 group, don't use the handle again--don't try to finish the same group
3793 twice.
3794
3795 To make a multibuffer change group, call `prepare-change-group' once
3796 for each buffer you want to cover, then use `nconc' to combine the
3797 returned values, like this:
3798
3799 (nconc (prepare-change-group buffer-1)
3800 (prepare-change-group buffer-2))
3801
3802 You can then activate the multibuffer change group with a single call
3803 to `activate-change-group', and finish it with a single call to
3804 `accept-change-group' or `cancel-change-group'.
3805
3806 Nested use of several change groups for the same buffer works as you
3807 would expect. Non-nested use of change groups for the same buffer
3808 will lead to undesirable results, so don't let it happen; the first
3809 change group you start for any given buffer should be the last one
3810 finished.
3811
3812 +++
3813 ** Enhancements to process support
3814
3815 *** Function list-processes now has an optional argument; if non-nil,
3816 only the processes whose query-on-exit flag is set are listed.
3817
3818 *** New set-process-query-on-exit-flag and process-query-on-exit-flag
3819 functions. The existing process-kill-without-query function is still
3820 supported, but new code should use the new functions.
3821
3822 *** Function signal-process now accepts a process object or process
3823 name in addition to a process id to identify the signalled process.
3824
3825 *** Processes now have an associated property list where programs can
3826 maintain process state and other per-process related information.
3827
3828 The new functions process-get and process-put are used to access, add,
3829 and modify elements on this property list.
3830
3831 The new low-level functions process-plist and set-process-plist are
3832 used to access and replace the entire property list of a process.
3833
3834 *** Function accept-process-output now has an optional fourth arg
3835 `just-this-one'. If non-nil, only output from the specified process
3836 is handled, suspending output from other processes. If value is an
3837 integer, also inhibit running timers. This feature is generally not
3838 recommended, but may be necessary for specific applications, such as
3839 speech synthesis.
3840
3841 *** Adaptive read buffering of subprocess output.
3842
3843 On some systems, when emacs reads the output from a subprocess, the
3844 output data is read in very small blocks, potentially resulting in
3845 very poor performance. This behavior can be remedied to some extent
3846 by setting the new variable process-adaptive-read-buffering to a
3847 non-nil value (the default), as it will automatically delay reading
3848 from such processes, to allowing them to produce more output before
3849 emacs tries to read it.
3850
3851 *** The new function `call-process-shell-command'.
3852
3853 This executes a shell command command synchronously in a separate
3854 process.
3855
3856 *** The new function `process-file' is similar to `call-process', but
3857 obeys file handlers. The file handler is chosen based on
3858 `default-directory'.
3859
3860 *** A filter function of a process is called with a multibyte string
3861 if the filter's multibyteness is t. That multibyteness is decided by
3862 the value of `default-enable-multibyte-characters' when the process is
3863 created and can be changed later by `set-process-filter-multibyte'.
3864
3865 *** The new function `set-process-filter-multibyte' sets the
3866 multibyteness of the strings passed to the process's filter.
3867
3868 *** The new function `process-filter-multibyte-p' returns the
3869 multibyteness of the strings passed to the process's filter.
3870
3871 *** If a process's coding system is `raw-text' or `no-conversion' and its
3872 buffer is multibyte, the output of the process is at first converted
3873 to multibyte by `string-to-multibyte' then inserted in the buffer.
3874 Previously, it was converted to multibyte by `string-as-multibyte',
3875 which was not compatible with the behavior of file reading.
3876
3877 +++
3878 ** Enhanced networking support.
3879
3880 *** There is a new `make-network-process' function which supports
3881 opening of stream and datagram connections to a server, as well as
3882 create a stream or datagram server inside emacs.
3883
3884 - A server is started using :server t arg.
3885 - Datagram connection is selected using :type 'datagram arg.
3886 - A server can open on a random port using :service t arg.
3887 - Local sockets are supported using :family 'local arg.
3888 - Non-blocking connect is supported using :nowait t arg.
3889 - The process' property list can be initialized using :plist PLIST arg;
3890 a copy of the server process' property list is automatically inherited
3891 by new client processes created to handle incoming connections.
3892
3893 To test for the availability of a given feature, use featurep like this:
3894 (featurep 'make-network-process '(:type datagram))
3895
3896 *** Original open-network-stream is now emulated using make-network-process.
3897
3898 *** New function open-network-stream-nowait.
3899
3900 This function initiates a non-blocking connect and returns immediately
3901 without waiting for the connection to be established. It takes the
3902 filter and sentinel functions as arguments; when the non-blocking
3903 connect completes, the sentinel is called with a status string
3904 matching "open" or "failed".
3905
3906 *** New function open-network-stream-server.
3907
3908 This function creates a network server process for a TCP service.
3909 When a client connects to the specified service, a new subprocess
3910 is created to handle the new connection, and the sentinel function
3911 is called for the new process.
3912
3913 *** New functions process-datagram-address and set-process-datagram-address.
3914
3915 These functions are used with datagram-based network processes to get
3916 and set the current address of the remote partner.
3917
3918 *** New function format-network-address.
3919
3920 This function reformats the lisp representation of a network address
3921 to a printable string. For example, an IP address A.B.C.D and port
3922 number P is represented as a five element vector [A B C D P], and the
3923 printable string returned for this vector is "A.B.C.D:P". See the doc
3924 string for other formatting options.
3925
3926 *** By default, the function process-contact still returns (HOST SERVICE)
3927 for a network process. Using the new optional KEY arg, the complete list
3928 of network process properties or a specific property can be selected.
3929
3930 Using :local and :remote as the KEY, the address of the local or
3931 remote end-point is returned. An Inet address is represented as a 5
3932 element vector, where the first 4 elements contain the IP address and
3933 the fifth is the port number.
3934
3935 *** Network processes can now be stopped and restarted with
3936 `stop-process' and `continue-process'. For a server process, no
3937 connections are accepted in the stopped state. For a client process,
3938 no input is received in the stopped state.
3939
3940 *** New function network-interface-list.
3941
3942 This function returns a list of network interface names and their
3943 current network addresses.
3944
3945 *** New function network-interface-info.
3946
3947 This function returns the network address, hardware address, current
3948 status, and other information about a specific network interface.
3949
3950 *** The sentinel is now called when a network process is deleted with
3951 delete-process. The status message passed to the sentinel for a
3952 deleted network process is "deleted". The message passed to the
3953 sentinel when the connection is closed by the remote peer has been
3954 changed to "connection broken by remote peer".
3955
3956 ** Using window objects:
3957
3958 +++
3959 *** New function `window-body-height'.
3960
3961 This is like `window-height' but does not count the mode line or the
3962 header line.
3963
3964 +++
3965 *** New function `window-body-height'.
3966
3967 This is like window-height but does not count the mode line
3968 or the header line.
3969
3970 +++
3971 *** You can now make a window as short as one line.
3972
3973 A window that is just one line tall does not display either a mode
3974 line or a header line, even if the variables `mode-line-format' and
3975 `header-line-format' call for them. A window that is two lines tall
3976 cannot display both a mode line and a header line at once; if the
3977 variables call for both, only the mode line actually appears.
3978
3979 +++
3980 *** The new function `window-inside-edges' returns the edges of the
3981 actual text portion of the window, not including the scroll bar or
3982 divider line, the fringes, the display margins, the header line and
3983 the mode line.
3984
3985 +++
3986 *** The new functions `window-pixel-edges' and `window-inside-pixel-edges'
3987 return window edges in units of pixels, rather than columns and lines.
3988
3989 +++
3990 *** The new macro `with-selected-window' temporarily switches the
3991 selected window without impacting the order of `buffer-list'.
3992
3993 +++
3994 *** `select-window' takes an optional second argument `norecord'.
3995
3996 This is like `switch-to-buffer'.
3997
3998 +++
3999 *** `save-selected-window' now saves and restores the selected window
4000 of every frame. This way, it restores everything that can be changed
4001 by calling `select-window'.
4002
4003 +++
4004 *** `set-window-buffer' has an optional argument KEEP-MARGINS.
4005
4006 If non-nil, that says to preserve the window's current margin, fringe,
4007 and scroll-bar settings.
4008
4009 +++
4010 ** Customizable fringe bitmaps
4011
4012 *** New function `define-fringe-bitmap' can now be used to create new
4013 fringe bitmaps, as well as change the built-in fringe bitmaps.
4014
4015 To change a built-in bitmap, do (require 'fringe) and use the symbol
4016 identifing the bitmap such as `left-truncation or `continued-line'.
4017
4018 *** New function `destroy-fringe-bitmap' deletes a fringe bitmap
4019 or restores a built-in one to its default value.
4020
4021 *** New function `set-fringe-bitmap-face' can now be used to set a
4022 specific face to be used for a specific fringe bitmap. The face is
4023 automatically merged with the `fringe' face, so normally, the face
4024 should only specify the foreground color of the bitmap.
4025
4026 *** There are new display properties, `left-fringe; and `right-fringe',
4027 that can be used to show a specific bitmap in the left or right fringe
4028 bitmap of the display line.
4029
4030 Format is `display (left-fringe BITMAP [FACE])', where BITMAP is a
4031 symbol identifying a fringe bitmap, either built-in or defined with
4032 `define-fringe-bitmap', and FACE is an optional face name to be used
4033 for displaying the bitmap instead of the default `fringe' face.
4034 When specified, FACE is automatically merged with the `fringe' face.
4035
4036 *** New function `fringe-bitmaps-at-pos' returns the current fringe
4037 bitmaps in the display line at a given buffer position.
4038
4039 ** Other window fringe features:
4040
4041 +++
4042 *** Controlling the default left and right fringe widths.
4043
4044 The default left and right fringe widths for all windows of a frame
4045 can now be controlled by setting the `left-fringe' and `right-fringe'
4046 frame parameters to an integer value specifying the width in pixels.
4047 Setting the width to 0 effectively removes the corresponding fringe.
4048
4049 The actual default fringe widths for the frame may deviate from the
4050 specified widths, since the combined fringe widths must match an
4051 integral number of columns. The extra width is distributed evenly
4052 between the left and right fringe. For force a specific fringe width,
4053 specify the width as a negative integer (if both widths are negative,
4054 only the left fringe gets the specified width).
4055
4056 Setting the width to nil (the default), restores the default fringe
4057 width which is the minimum number of pixels necessary to display any
4058 of the currently defined fringe bitmaps. The width of the built-in
4059 fringe bitmaps is 8 pixels.
4060
4061 +++
4062 *** Per-window fringe and scrollbar settings
4063
4064 **** Windows can now have their own individual fringe widths and
4065 position settings.
4066
4067 To control the fringe widths of a window, either set the buffer-local
4068 variables `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', or call
4069 `set-window-fringes'.
4070
4071 To control the fringe position in a window, that is, whether fringes
4072 are positioned between the display margins and the window's text area,
4073 or at the edges of the window, either set the buffer-local variable
4074 `fringes-outside-margins' or call `set-window-fringes'.
4075
4076 The function `window-fringes' can be used to obtain the current
4077 settings. To make `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', and
4078 `fringes-outside-margins' take effect, you must set them before
4079 displaying the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force
4080 an update of the display margins.
4081
4082 **** Windows can now have their own individual scroll-bar settings
4083 controlling the width and position of scroll-bars.
4084
4085 To control the scroll-bar of a window, either set the buffer-local
4086 variables `scroll-bar-mode' and `scroll-bar-width', or call
4087 `set-window-scroll-bars'. The function `window-scroll-bars' can be
4088 used to obtain the current settings. To make `scroll-bar-mode' and
4089 `scroll-bar-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
4090 the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
4091 of the display margins.
4092
4093 ** Redisplay features:
4094
4095 +++
4096 *** `sit-for' can now be called with args (SECONDS &optional NODISP).
4097
4098 +++
4099 *** New function `force-window-update' can initiate a full redisplay of
4100 one or all windows. Normally, this is not needed as changes in window
4101 contents are detected automatically. However, certain implicit
4102 changes to mode lines, header lines, or display properties may require
4103 forcing an explicit window update.
4104
4105 +++
4106 *** (char-displayable-p CHAR) returns non-nil if Emacs ought to be able
4107 to display CHAR. More precisely, if the selected frame's fontset has
4108 a font to display the character set that CHAR belongs to.
4109
4110 Fontsets can specify a font on a per-character basis; when the fontset
4111 does that, this value cannot be accurate.
4112
4113 +++
4114 *** You can define multiple overlay arrows via the new
4115 variable `overlay-arrow-variable-list'.
4116
4117 It contains a list of varibles which contain overlay arrow position
4118 markers, including the original `overlay-arrow-position' variable.
4119
4120 Each variable on this list can have individual `overlay-arrow-string'
4121 and `overlay-arrow-bitmap' properties that specify an overlay arrow
4122 string (for non-window terminals) or fringe bitmap (for window
4123 systems) to display at the corresponding overlay arrow position.
4124 If either property is not set, the default `overlay-arrow-string' or
4125 'overlay-arrow-fringe-bitmap' will be used.
4126
4127 +++
4128 *** New `line-height' and `line-spacing' properties for newline characters
4129
4130 A newline can now have `line-height' and `line-spacing' text or overlay
4131 properties that control the height of the corresponding display row.
4132
4133 If the `line-height' property value is t, the newline does not
4134 contribute to the height of the display row; instead the height of the
4135 newline glyph is reduced. Also, a `line-spacing' property on this
4136 newline is ignored. This can be used to tile small images or image
4137 slices without adding blank areas between the images.
4138
4139 If the `line-height' property value is a positive integer, the value
4140 specifies the minimum line height in pixels. If necessary, the line
4141 height it increased by increasing the line's ascent.
4142
4143 If the `line-height' property value is a float, the minimum line
4144 height is calculated by multiplying the default frame line height by
4145 the given value.
4146
4147 If the `line-height' property value is a cons (FACE . RATIO), the
4148 minimum line height is calculated as RATIO * height of named FACE.
4149 RATIO is int or float. If FACE is t, it specifies the current face.
4150
4151 If the `line-height' property value is a cons (nil . RATIO), the line
4152 height is calculated as RATIO * actual height of the line's contents.
4153
4154 If the `line-height' value is a cons (HEIGHT . TOTAL), HEIGHT specifies
4155 the line height as described above, while TOTAL is any of the forms
4156 described above and specifies the total height of the line, causing a
4157 varying number of pixels to be inserted after the line to make it line
4158 exactly that many pixels high.
4159
4160 If the `line-spacing' property value is an positive integer, the value
4161 is used as additional pixels to insert after the display line; this
4162 overrides the default frame `line-spacing' and any buffer local value of
4163 the `line-spacing' variable.
4164
4165 If the `line-spacing' property is a float or cons, the line spacing
4166 is calculated as specified above for the `line-height' property.
4167
4168 +++
4169 *** The buffer local line-spacing variable can now have a float value,
4170 which is used as a height relative to the default frame line height.
4171
4172 +++
4173 *** Enhancements to stretch display properties
4174
4175 The display property stretch specification form `(space PROPS)', where
4176 PROPS is a property list now allows pixel based width and height
4177 specifications, as well as enhanced horizontal text alignment.
4178
4179 The value of these properties can now be a (primitive) expression
4180 which is evaluated during redisplay. The following expressions
4181 are supported:
4182
4183 EXPR ::= NUM | (NUM) | UNIT | ELEM | POS | IMAGE | FORM
4184 NUM ::= INTEGER | FLOAT | SYMBOL
4185 UNIT ::= in | mm | cm | width | height
4186 ELEM ::= left-fringe | right-fringe | left-margin | right-margin
4187 | scroll-bar | text
4188 POS ::= left | center | right
4189 FORM ::= (NUM . EXPR) | (OP EXPR ...)
4190 OP ::= + | -
4191
4192 The form `NUM' specifies a fractional width or height of the default
4193 frame font size. The form `(NUM)' specifies an absolute number of
4194 pixels. If a symbol is specified, its buffer-local variable binding
4195 is used. The `in', `mm', and `cm' units specifies the number of
4196 pixels per inch, milli-meter, and centi-meter, resp. The `width' and
4197 `height' units correspond to the width and height of the current face
4198 font. An image specification corresponds to the width or height of
4199 the image.
4200
4201 The `left-fringe', `right-fringe', `left-margin', `right-margin',
4202 `scroll-bar', and `text' elements specify to the width of the
4203 corresponding area of the window.
4204
4205 The `left', `center', and `right' positions can be used with :align-to
4206 to specify a position relative to the left edge, center, or right edge
4207 of the text area. One of the above window elements (except `text')
4208 can also be used with :align-to to specify that the position is
4209 relative to the left edge of the given area. Once the base offset for
4210 a relative position has been set (by the first occurrence of one of
4211 these symbols), further occurences of these symbols are interpreted as
4212 the width of the area.
4213
4214 For example, to align to the center of the left-margin, use
4215 :align-to (+ left-margin (0.5 . left-margin))
4216
4217 If no specific base offset is set for alignment, it is always relative
4218 to the left edge of the text area. For example, :align-to 0 in a
4219 header-line aligns with the first text column in the text area.
4220
4221 The value of the form `(NUM . EXPR)' is the value of NUM multiplied by
4222 the value of the expression EXPR. For example, (2 . in) specifies a
4223 width of 2 inches, while (0.5 . IMAGE) specifies half the width (or
4224 height) of the specified image.
4225
4226 The form `(+ EXPR ...)' adds up the value of the expressions.
4227 The form `(- EXPR ...)' negates or subtracts the value of the expressions.
4228
4229 +++
4230 *** Normally, the cursor is displayed at the end of any overlay and
4231 text property string that may be present at the current window
4232 position. The cursor can now be placed on any character of such
4233 strings by giving that character a non-nil `cursor' text property.
4234
4235 +++
4236 *** The display space :width and :align-to text properties are now
4237 supported on text terminals.
4238
4239 +++
4240 *** Support for displaying image slices
4241
4242 **** New display property (slice X Y WIDTH HEIGHT) can be used with
4243 an image property to display only a specific slice of the image.
4244
4245 **** Function insert-image has new optional fourth arg to
4246 specify image slice (X Y WIDTH HEIGHT).
4247
4248 **** New function insert-sliced-image inserts a given image as a
4249 specified number of evenly sized slices (rows x columns).
4250
4251 +++
4252 *** Images can now have an associated image map via the :map property.
4253
4254 An image map is an alist where each element has the format (AREA ID PLIST).
4255 An AREA is specified as either a rectangle, a circle, or a polygon:
4256 A rectangle is a cons (rect . ((X0 . Y0) . (X1 . Y1))) specifying the
4257 pixel coordinates of the upper left and bottom right corners.
4258 A circle is a cons (circle . ((X0 . Y0) . R)) specifying the center
4259 and the radius of the circle; R can be a float or integer.
4260 A polygon is a cons (poly . [X0 Y0 X1 Y1 ...]) where each pair in the
4261 vector describes one corner in the polygon.
4262
4263 When the mouse pointer is above a hot-spot area of an image, the
4264 PLIST of that hot-spot is consulted; if it contains a `help-echo'
4265 property it defines a tool-tip for the hot-spot, and if it contains
4266 a `pointer' property, it defines the shape of the mouse cursor when
4267 it is over the hot-spot. See the variable 'void-area-text-pointer'
4268 for possible pointer shapes.
4269
4270 When you click the mouse when the mouse pointer is over a hot-spot,
4271 an event is composed by combining the ID of the hot-spot with the
4272 mouse event, e.g. [area4 mouse-1] if the hot-spot's ID is `area4'.
4273
4274 ** Mouse pointer features:
4275
4276 +++ (lispref)
4277 ??? (man)
4278 *** The mouse pointer shape in void text areas (i.e. after the end of a
4279 line or below the last line in the buffer) of the text window is now
4280 controlled by the new variable `void-text-area-pointer'. The default
4281 is to use the `arrow' (non-text) pointer. Other choices are `text'
4282 (or nil), `hand', `vdrag', `hdrag', `modeline', and `hourglass'.
4283
4284 +++
4285 *** The mouse pointer shape over an image can now be controlled by the
4286 :pointer image property.
4287
4288 +++
4289 *** The mouse pointer shape over ordinary text or images can now be
4290 controlled/overriden via the `pointer' text property.
4291
4292 ** Mouse event enhancements:
4293
4294 +++
4295 *** Mouse clicks on fringes now generates left-fringe or right-fringes
4296 events, rather than a text area click event.
4297
4298 +++
4299 *** Mouse clicks in the left and right marginal areas now includes a
4300 sensible buffer position corresponding to the first character in the
4301 corresponding text row.
4302
4303 +++
4304 *** Function `mouse-set-point' now works for events outside text area.
4305
4306 +++
4307 *** Mouse events now includes buffer position for all event types.
4308
4309 +++
4310 *** `posn-point' now returns buffer position for non-text area events.
4311
4312 +++
4313 *** New function `posn-area' returns window area clicked on (nil means
4314 text area).
4315
4316 +++
4317 *** Mouse events include actual glyph column and row for all event types.
4318
4319 +++
4320 *** New function `posn-actual-col-row' returns actual glyph coordinates.
4321
4322 +++
4323 *** Mouse events can now include image object in addition to string object.
4324
4325 +++
4326 *** Mouse events include relative x and y pixel coordinates relative to
4327 the top left corner of the object (image or character) clicked on.
4328
4329 +++
4330 *** Mouse events include the pixel width and height of the object
4331 (image or character) clicked on.
4332
4333 +++
4334 *** New functions 'posn-object', 'posn-object-x-y', and
4335 'posn-object-width-height' return the image or string object of a mouse
4336 click, the x and y pixel coordinates relative to the top left corner
4337 of that object, and the total width and height of that object.
4338
4339 ** Text property and overlay changes:
4340
4341 +++
4342 *** Arguments for remove-overlays are now optional, so that you can
4343 remove all overlays in the buffer by just calling (remove-overlays).
4344
4345 +++
4346 *** New variable char-property-alias-alist.
4347
4348 This variable allows you to create alternative names for text
4349 properties. It works at the same level as `default-text-properties',
4350 although it applies to overlays as well. This variable was introduced
4351 to implement the `font-lock-face' property.
4352
4353 +++
4354 *** New function `get-char-property-and-overlay' accepts the same
4355 arguments as `get-char-property' and returns a cons whose car is the
4356 return value of `get-char-property' called with those arguments and
4357 whose cdr is the overlay in which the property was found, or nil if
4358 it was found as a text property or not found at all.
4359
4360 +++
4361 *** The new function remove-list-of-text-properties is almost the same
4362 as `remove-text-properties'. The only difference is that it takes a
4363 list of property names as argument rather than a property list.
4364
4365 ** Face changes
4366
4367 +++
4368 *** The new face attribute condition `min-colors' can be used to tailor
4369 the face color to the number of colors supported by a display, and
4370 define the foreground and background colors accordingly so that they
4371 look best on a terminal that supports at least this many colors. This
4372 is now the preferred method for defining default faces in a way that
4373 makes a good use of the capabilities of the display.
4374
4375 +++
4376 *** New function display-supports-face-attributes-p can be used to test
4377 whether a given set of face attributes is actually displayable.
4378
4379 A new predicate `supports' has also been added to the `defface' face
4380 specification language, which can be used to do this test for faces
4381 defined with defface.
4382
4383 ---
4384 *** The special treatment of faces whose names are of the form `fg:COLOR'
4385 or `bg:COLOR' has been removed. Lisp programs should use the
4386 `defface' facility for defining faces with specific colors, or use
4387 the feature of specifying the face attributes :foreground and :background
4388 directly in the `face' property instead of using a named face.
4389
4390 +++
4391 *** The first face specification element in a defface can specify
4392 `default' instead of frame classification. Then its attributes act as
4393 defaults that apply to all the subsequent cases (and can be overridden
4394 by them).
4395
4396 +++
4397 *** The variable `face-font-rescale-alist' specifies how much larger
4398 (or smaller) font we should use. For instance, if the value is
4399 '((SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN . 1.3)) and a face requests a font of 10
4400 point, we actually use a font of 13 point if the font matches
4401 SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN.
4402
4403 ---
4404 *** The function `face-differs-from-default-p' now truly checks
4405 whether the given face displays differently from the default face or
4406 not (previously it did only a very cursory check).
4407
4408 +++
4409 *** `face-attribute', `face-foreground', `face-background', and
4410 `face-stipple' now accept a new optional argument, INHERIT, which
4411 controls how face inheritance is used when determining the value of a
4412 face attribute.
4413
4414 +++
4415 *** New functions `face-attribute-relative-p' and `merge-face-attribute'
4416 help with handling relative face attributes.
4417
4418 +++
4419 *** The priority of faces in an :inherit attribute face list is reversed.
4420
4421 If a face contains an :inherit attribute with a list of faces, earlier
4422 faces in the list override later faces in the list; in previous
4423 releases of Emacs, the order was the opposite. This change was made
4424 so that :inherit face lists operate identically to face lists in text
4425 `face' properties.
4426
4427 +++
4428 *** New standard font-lock face `font-lock-preprocessor-face'.
4429
4430 ---
4431 *** `set-fontset-font', `fontset-info', `fontset-font' now operate on
4432 the default fontset if the argument NAME is nil..
4433
4434 ** Font-Lock changes:
4435
4436 +++
4437 *** New special text property `font-lock-face'.
4438
4439 This property acts like the `face' property, but it is controlled by
4440 M-x font-lock-mode. It is not, strictly speaking, a builtin text
4441 property. Instead, it is implemented inside font-core.el, using the
4442 new variable `char-property-alias-alist'.
4443
4444 +++
4445 *** font-lock can manage arbitrary text-properties beside `face'.
4446
4447 *** the FACENAME returned in `font-lock-keywords' can be a list of the
4448 form (face FACE PROP1 VAL1 PROP2 VAL2 ...) so you can set other
4449 properties than `face'.
4450
4451 *** `font-lock-extra-managed-props' can be set to make sure those
4452 extra properties are automatically cleaned up by font-lock.
4453
4454 ---
4455 *** jit-lock obeys a new text-property `jit-lock-defer-multiline'.
4456
4457 If a piece of text with that property gets contextually refontified
4458 (see `jit-lock-defer-contextually'), then all of that text will
4459 be refontified. This is useful when the syntax of a textual element
4460 depends on text several lines further down (and when `font-lock-multiline'
4461 is not appropriate to solve that problem). For example in Perl:
4462
4463 s{
4464 foo
4465 }{
4466 bar
4467 }e
4468
4469 Adding/removing the last `e' changes the `bar' from being a piece of
4470 text to being a piece of code, so you'd put a `jit-lock-defer-multiline'
4471 property over the second half of the command to force (deferred)
4472 refontification of `bar' whenever the `e' is added/removed.
4473
4474 ** Major mode mechanism changes:
4475
4476 +++
4477 *** `set-auto-mode' now gives the interpreter magic line (if present)
4478 precedence over the file name. Likewise an `<?xml' or `<!DOCTYPE'
4479 declaration will give the buffer XML or SGML mode, based on the new
4480 var `magic-mode-alist'.
4481
4482 +++
4483 *** Major mode functions now run the new normal hook
4484 `after-change-major-mode-hook', at their very end, after the mode hooks.
4485
4486 ---
4487 *** If a major mode function has a non-nil `no-clone-indirect'
4488 property, `clone-indirect-buffer' signals an error if you use
4489 it in that buffer.
4490
4491 +++
4492 *** Major modes can define `eldoc-documentation-function'
4493 locally to provide Eldoc functionality by some method appropriate to
4494 the language.
4495
4496 +++
4497 *** `define-derived-mode' by default creates a new empty abbrev table.
4498 It does not copy abbrevs from the parent mode's abbrev table.
4499
4500 +++
4501 *** The new function `run-mode-hooks' and the new macro `delay-mode-hooks'
4502 are used by `define-derived-mode' to make sure the mode hook for the
4503 parent mode is run at the end of the child mode.
4504
4505 ** Minor mode changes:
4506
4507 +++
4508 *** `define-minor-mode' now accepts arbitrary additional keyword arguments
4509 and simply passes them to `defcustom', if applicable.
4510
4511 +++
4512 *** `minor-mode-list' now holds a list of minor mode commands.
4513
4514 ---
4515 *** `define-global-minor-mode'.
4516
4517 This is a new name for what was formerly called
4518 `easy-mmode-define-global-mode'. The old name remains as an alias.
4519
4520 ** Command loop changes:
4521
4522 +++
4523 *** The new function `called-interactively-p' does what many people
4524 have mistakenly believed `interactive-p' did: it returns t if the
4525 calling function was called through `call-interactively'. This should
4526 only be used when you cannot solve the problem by adding a new
4527 INTERACTIVE argument to the command.
4528
4529 +++
4530 *** The function `commandp' takes an additional optional argument.
4531
4532 If it is non-nil, then `commandp' checks for a function that could be
4533 called with `call-interactively', and does not return t for keyboard
4534 macros.
4535
4536 +++
4537 *** When a command returns, the command loop moves point out from
4538 within invisible text, in the same way it moves out from within text
4539 covered by an image or composition property.
4540
4541 This makes it generally unnecessary to mark invisible text as intangible.
4542 This is particularly good because the intangible property often has
4543 unexpected side-effects since the property applies to everything
4544 (including `goto-char', ...) whereas this new code is only run after
4545 `post-command-hook' and thus does not care about intermediate states.
4546
4547 +++
4548 *** If a command sets `transient-mark-mode' to `only', that
4549 enables Transient Mark mode for the following command only.
4550 During that following command, the value of `transient-mark-mode'
4551 is `identity'. If it is still `identity' at the end of the command,
4552 the next return to the command loop changes to nil.
4553
4554 +++
4555 *** Both the variable and the function `disabled-command-hook' have
4556 been renamed to `disabled-command-function'. The variable
4557 `disabled-command-hook' has been kept as an obsolete alias.
4558
4559 +++
4560 *** `emacsserver' now runs `pre-command-hook' and `post-command-hook'
4561 when it receives a request from emacsclient.
4562
4563 ** Minibuffer changes:
4564
4565 +++
4566 *** The functions all-completions and try-completion now accept lists
4567 of strings as well as hash-tables additionally to alists, obarrays
4568 and functions. Furthermore, the function `test-completion' is now
4569 exported to Lisp. The keys in alists and hash tables can be either
4570 strings or symbols, which are automatically converted with to strings.
4571
4572 +++
4573 *** The new macro `dynamic-completion-table' supports using functions
4574 as a dynamic completion table.
4575
4576 (dynamic-completion-table FUN)
4577
4578 FUN is called with one argument, the string for which completion is required,
4579 and it should return an alist containing all the intended possible
4580 completions. This alist can be a full list of possible completions so that FUN
4581 can ignore the value of its argument. If completion is performed in the
4582 minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer from which the minibuffer was
4583 entered. `dynamic-completion-table' then computes the completion.
4584
4585 +++
4586 *** The new macro `lazy-completion-table' initializes a variable
4587 as a lazy completion table.
4588
4589 (lazy-completion-table VAR FUN &rest ARGS)
4590
4591 If the completion table VAR is used for the first time (e.g., by passing VAR
4592 as an argument to `try-completion'), the function FUN is called with arguments
4593 ARGS. FUN must return the completion table that will be stored in VAR. If
4594 completion is requested in the minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer
4595 from which the minibuffer was entered. The return value of
4596 `lazy-completion-table' must be used to initialize the value of VAR.
4597
4598 ** Lisp file loading changes:
4599
4600 +++
4601 *** `load-history' can now have elements of the form (t . FUNNAME),
4602 which means FUNNAME was previously defined as an autoload (before the
4603 current file redefined it).
4604
4605 +++
4606 *** `load-history' now records (defun . FUNNAME) when a function is
4607 defined. For a variable, it records just the variable name.
4608
4609 +++
4610 *** The function symbol-file can now search specifically for function or
4611 variable definitions.
4612
4613 +++
4614 *** `provide' and `featurep' now accept an optional second argument
4615 to test/provide subfeatures. Also `provide' now checks `after-load-alist'
4616 and runs any code associated with the provided feature.
4617
4618 ---
4619 *** The variable `recursive-load-depth-limit' has been deleted.
4620 Emacs now signals an error if the same file is loaded with more
4621 than 3 levels of nesting.
4622
4623 +++
4624 ** Byte compiler changes:
4625
4626 *** The byte-compiler now displays the actual line and character
4627 position of errors, where possible. Additionally, the form of its
4628 warning and error messages have been brought more in line with the
4629 output of other GNU tools.
4630
4631 *** The new macro `with-no-warnings' suppresses all compiler warnings
4632 inside its body. In terms of execution, it is equivalent to `progn'.
4633
4634 *** You can avoid warnings for possibly-undefined symbols with a
4635 simple convention that the compiler understands. (This is mostly
4636 useful in code meant to be portable to different Emacs versions.)
4637 Write forms like the following, or code that macroexpands into such
4638 forms:
4639
4640 (if (fboundp 'foo) <then> <else>)
4641 (if (boundp 'foo) <then> <else)
4642
4643 In the first case, using `foo' as a function inside the <then> form
4644 won't produce a warning if it's not defined as a function, and in the
4645 second case, using `foo' as a variable won't produce a warning if it's
4646 unbound. The test must be in exactly one of the above forms (after
4647 macro expansion), but such tests can be nested. Note that `when' and
4648 `unless' expand to `if', but `cond' doesn't.
4649
4650 *** `(featurep 'xemacs)' is treated by the compiler as nil. This
4651 helps to avoid noisy compiler warnings in code meant to run under both
4652 Emacs and XEmacs and can sometimes make the result significantly more
4653 efficient. Since byte code from recent versions of XEmacs won't
4654 generally run in Emacs and vice versa, this optimization doesn't lose
4655 you anything.
4656
4657 *** The local variable `no-byte-compile' in elisp files is now obeyed.
4658
4659 ---
4660 *** When a Lisp file uses CL functions at run-time, compiling the file
4661 now issues warnings about these calls, unless the file performs
4662 (require 'cl) when loaded.
4663
4664 ** Frame operations:
4665
4666 +++
4667 *** New functions `frame-current-scroll-bars' and `window-current-scroll-bars'.
4668
4669 These functions return the current locations of the vertical and
4670 horizontal scroll bars in a frame or window.
4671
4672 +++
4673 *** The new function `modify-all-frames-parameters' modifies parameters
4674 for all (existing and future) frames.
4675
4676 +++
4677 *** The new frame parameter `tty-color-mode' specifies the mode to use
4678 for color support on character terminal frames. Its value can be a
4679 number of colors to support, or a symbol. See the Emacs Lisp
4680 Reference manual for more detailed documentation.
4681
4682 +++
4683 *** When using non-toolkit scroll bars with the default width,
4684 the `scroll-bar-width' frame parameter value is nil.
4685
4686 ** Mule changes:
4687
4688 +++
4689 *** Already true in Emacs 21.1, but not emphasized clearly enough:
4690
4691 Multibyte buffers can now faithfully record all 256 character codes
4692 from 0 to 255. As a result, most of the past reasons to use unibyte
4693 buffers no longer exist. We only know of three reasons to use them
4694 now:
4695
4696 1. If you prefer to use unibyte text all of the time.
4697
4698 2. For reading files into temporary buffers, when you want to avoid
4699 the time it takes to convert the format.
4700
4701 3. For binary files where format conversion would be pointless and
4702 wasteful.
4703
4704 ---
4705 *** set-buffer-file-coding-system now takes an additional argument,
4706 NOMODIFY. If it is non-nil, it means don't mark the buffer modified.
4707
4708 +++
4709 *** The new variable `auto-coding-functions' lets you specify functions
4710 to examine a file being visited and deduce the proper coding system
4711 for it. (If the coding system is detected incorrectly for a specific
4712 file, you can put a `coding:' tags to override it.)
4713
4714 ---
4715 *** The new function `merge-coding-systems' fills in unspecified aspects
4716 of one coding system from another coding system.
4717
4718 ---
4719 *** New coding system property `mime-text-unsuitable' indicates that
4720 the coding system's `mime-charset' is not suitable for MIME text
4721 parts, e.g. utf-16.
4722
4723 +++
4724 *** New function `decode-coding-inserted-region' decodes a region as if
4725 it is read from a file without decoding.
4726
4727 ---
4728 *** New CCL functions `lookup-character' and `lookup-integer' access
4729 hash tables defined by the Lisp function `define-translation-hash-table'.
4730
4731 ---
4732 *** New function quail-find-key returns a list of keys to type in the
4733 current input method to input a character.
4734
4735 ** Mode line changes:
4736
4737 +++
4738 *** New function `format-mode-line'.
4739
4740 This returns the mode-line or header-line of the selected (or a
4741 specified) window as a string with or without text properties.
4742
4743 +++
4744 *** The new mode-line construct `(:propertize ELT PROPS...)' can be
4745 used to add text properties to mode-line elements.
4746
4747 +++
4748 *** The new `%i' and `%I' constructs for `mode-line-format' can be used
4749 to display the size of the accessible part of the buffer on the mode
4750 line.
4751
4752 ** Menu manipulation changes:
4753
4754 ---
4755 *** To manipulate the File menu using easy-menu, you must specify the
4756 proper name "file". In previous Emacs versions, you had to specify
4757 "files", even though the menu item itself was changed to say "File"
4758 several versions ago.
4759
4760 ---
4761 *** The dummy function keys made by easy-menu are now always lower case.
4762 If you specify the menu item name "Ada", for instance, it uses `ada'
4763 as the "key" bound by that key binding.
4764
4765 This is relevant only if Lisp code looks for the bindings that were
4766 made with easy-menu.
4767
4768 ---
4769 *** `easy-menu-define' now allows you to use nil for the symbol name
4770 if you don't need to give the menu a name. If you install the menu
4771 into other keymaps right away (MAPS is non-nil), it usually doesn't
4772 need to have a name.
4773
4774 ** Operating system access:
4775
4776 +++
4777 *** The new primitive `get-internal-run-time' returns the processor
4778 run time used by Emacs since start-up.
4779
4780 +++
4781 *** Functions `user-uid' and `user-real-uid' now return floats if the
4782 user UID doesn't fit in a Lisp integer. Function `user-full-name'
4783 accepts a float as UID parameter.
4784
4785 +++
4786 *** New function `locale-info' accesses locale information.
4787
4788 ---
4789 *** On MS Windows, locale-coding-system is used to interact with the OS.
4790 The Windows specific variable w32-system-coding-system, which was
4791 formerly used for that purpose is now an alias for locale-coding-system.
4792
4793 ---
4794 *** New function `redirect-debugging-output' can be used to redirect
4795 debugging output on the stderr file handle to a file.
4796
4797 ** Miscellaneous:
4798
4799 +++
4800 *** A number of hooks have been renamed to better follow the conventions:
4801
4802 find-file-hooks to find-file-hook,
4803 find-file-not-found-hooks to find-file-not-found-functions,
4804 write-file-hooks to write-file-functions,
4805 write-contents-hooks to write-contents-functions,
4806 x-lost-selection-hooks to x-lost-selection-functions,
4807 x-sent-selection-hooks to x-sent-selection-functions,
4808 delete-frame-hook to delete-frame-functions.
4809
4810 In each case the old name remains as an alias for the moment.
4811
4812 +++
4813 *** local-write-file-hooks is marked obsolete
4814
4815 Use the LOCAL arg of `add-hook'.
4816
4817 ---
4818 *** New function `x-send-client-message' sends a client message when
4819 running under X.
4820 \f
4821 * Installation changes in Emacs 21.3
4822
4823 ** Support for GNU/Linux on little-endian MIPS and on IBM S390 has
4824 been added.
4825
4826 \f
4827 * Changes in Emacs 21.3
4828
4829 ** The obsolete C mode (c-mode.el) has been removed to avoid problems
4830 with Custom.
4831
4832 ** UTF-16 coding systems are available, encoding the same characters
4833 as mule-utf-8.
4834
4835 ** There is a new language environment for UTF-8 (set up automatically
4836 in UTF-8 locales).
4837
4838 ** Translation tables are available between equivalent characters in
4839 different Emacs charsets -- for instance `e with acute' coming from the
4840 Latin-1 and Latin-2 charsets. User options `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode'
4841 and `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' respectively turn on translation
4842 between ISO 8859 character sets (`unification') on encoding
4843 (e.g. writing a file) and decoding (e.g. reading a file). Note that
4844 `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is useful and safe, but
4845 `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' can cause text to change when you read
4846 it and write it out again without edits, so it is not generally advisable.
4847 By default `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is turned on.
4848
4849 ** In Emacs running on the X window system, the default value of
4850 `selection-coding-system' is now `compound-text-with-extensions'.
4851
4852 If you want the old behavior, set selection-coding-system to
4853 compound-text, which may be significantly more efficient. Using
4854 compound-text-with-extensions seems to be necessary only for decoding
4855 text from applications under XFree86 4.2, whose behavior is actually
4856 contrary to the compound text specification.
4857
4858 \f
4859 * Installation changes in Emacs 21.2
4860
4861 ** Support for BSD/OS 5.0 has been added.
4862
4863 ** Support for AIX 5.1 was added.
4864
4865 \f
4866 * Changes in Emacs 21.2
4867
4868 ** Emacs now supports compound-text extended segments in X selections.
4869
4870 X applications can use `extended segments' to encode characters in
4871 compound text that belong to character sets which are not part of the
4872 list of approved standard encodings for X, e.g. Big5. To paste
4873 selections with such characters into Emacs, use the new coding system
4874 compound-text-with-extensions as the value of selection-coding-system.
4875
4876 ** The default values of `tooltip-delay' and `tooltip-hide-delay'
4877 were changed.
4878
4879 ** On terminals whose erase-char is ^H (Backspace), Emacs
4880 now uses normal-erase-is-backspace-mode.
4881
4882 ** When the *scratch* buffer is recreated, its mode is set from
4883 initial-major-mode, which normally is lisp-interaction-mode,
4884 instead of using default-major-mode.
4885
4886 ** The new option `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' causes Info to behave
4887 like the stand-alone Info reader (from the GNU Texinfo package) as far
4888 as motion between nodes and their subnodes is concerned. If it is t
4889 (the default), Emacs behaves as before when you type SPC in a menu: it
4890 visits the subnode pointed to by the first menu entry. If this option
4891 is nil, SPC scrolls to the end of the current node, and only then goes
4892 to the first menu item, like the stand-alone reader does.
4893
4894 This change was already in Emacs 21.1, but wasn't advertised in the
4895 NEWS.
4896
4897 \f
4898 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 21.2
4899
4900 ** The meanings of scroll-up-aggressively and scroll-down-aggressively
4901 have been interchanged, so that the former now controls scrolling up,
4902 and the latter now controls scrolling down.
4903
4904 ** The variable `compilation-parse-errors-filename-function' can
4905 be used to transform filenames found in compilation output.
4906
4907 \f
4908 * Installation Changes in Emacs 21.1
4909
4910 See the INSTALL file for information on installing extra libraries and
4911 fonts to take advantage of the new graphical features and extra
4912 charsets in this release.
4913
4914 ** Support for GNU/Linux on IA64 machines has been added.
4915
4916 ** Support for LynxOS has been added.
4917
4918 ** There are new configure options associated with the support for
4919 images and toolkit scrollbars. Use the --help option in `configure'
4920 to list them.
4921
4922 ** You can build a 64-bit Emacs for SPARC/Solaris systems which
4923 support 64-bit executables and also on Irix 6.5. This increases the
4924 maximum buffer size. See etc/MACHINES for instructions. Changes to
4925 build on other 64-bit systems should be straightforward modulo any
4926 necessary changes to unexec.
4927
4928 ** There is a new configure option `--disable-largefile' to omit
4929 Unix-98-style support for large files if that is available.
4930
4931 ** There is a new configure option `--without-xim' that instructs
4932 Emacs to not use X Input Methods (XIM), if these are available.
4933
4934 ** `movemail' defaults to supporting POP. You can turn this off using
4935 the --without-pop configure option, should that be necessary.
4936
4937 ** This version can be built for the Macintosh, but does not implement
4938 all of the new display features described below. The port currently
4939 lacks unexec, asynchronous processes, and networking support. See the
4940 "Emacs and the Mac OS" appendix in the Emacs manual, for the
4941 description of aspects specific to the Mac.
4942
4943 ** Note that the MS-Windows port does not yet implement various of the
4944 new display features described below.
4945
4946 \f
4947 * Changes in Emacs 21.1
4948
4949 ** Emacs has a new redisplay engine.
4950
4951 The new redisplay handles characters of variable width and height.
4952 Italic text can be used without redisplay problems. Fonts containing
4953 oversized characters, i.e. characters larger than the logical height
4954 of a font can be used. Images of various formats can be displayed in
4955 the text.
4956
4957 ** Emacs has a new face implementation.
4958
4959 The new faces no longer fundamentally use X font names to specify the
4960 font. Instead, each face has several independent attributes--family,
4961 height, width, weight and slant--that it may or may not specify.
4962 These attributes can be merged from various faces, and then together
4963 specify a font.
4964
4965 Faces are supported on terminals that can display color or fonts.
4966 These terminal capabilities are auto-detected. Details can be found
4967 under Lisp changes, below.
4968
4969 ** Emacs can display faces on TTY frames.
4970
4971 Emacs automatically detects terminals that are able to display colors.
4972 Faces with a weight greater than normal are displayed extra-bright, if
4973 the terminal supports it. Faces with a weight less than normal and
4974 italic faces are displayed dimmed, if the terminal supports it.
4975 Underlined faces are displayed underlined if possible. Other face
4976 attributes such as `overline', `strike-through', and `box' are ignored
4977 on terminals.
4978
4979 The command-line options `-fg COLOR', `-bg COLOR', and `-rv' are now
4980 supported on character terminals.
4981
4982 Emacs automatically remaps all X-style color specifications to one of
4983 the colors supported by the terminal. This means you could have the
4984 same color customizations that work both on a windowed display and on
4985 a TTY or when Emacs is invoked with the -nw option.
4986
4987 ** New default font is Courier 12pt under X.
4988
4989 ** Sound support
4990
4991 Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and FreeBSD (Voxware
4992 driver and native BSD driver, a.k.a. Luigi's driver). Currently
4993 supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio (*.au).
4994 You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes' to enable
4995 sound support.
4996
4997 ** Emacs now resizes mini-windows if appropriate.
4998
4999 If a message is longer than one line, or minibuffer contents are
5000 longer than one line, Emacs can resize the minibuffer window unless it
5001 is on a frame of its own. You can control resizing and the maximum
5002 minibuffer window size by setting the following variables:
5003
5004 - User option: max-mini-window-height
5005
5006 Maximum height for resizing mini-windows. If a float, it specifies a
5007 fraction of the mini-window frame's height. If an integer, it
5008 specifies a number of lines.
5009
5010 Default is 0.25.
5011
5012 - User option: resize-mini-windows
5013
5014 How to resize mini-windows. If nil, don't resize. If t, always
5015 resize to fit the size of the text. If `grow-only', let mini-windows
5016 grow only, until they become empty, at which point they are shrunk
5017 again.
5018
5019 Default is `grow-only'.
5020
5021 ** LessTif support.
5022
5023 Emacs now runs with the LessTif toolkit (see
5024 <http://www.lesstif.org>). You will need version 0.92.26, or later.
5025
5026 ** LessTif/Motif file selection dialog.
5027
5028 When Emacs is configured to use LessTif or Motif, reading a file name
5029 from a menu will pop up a file selection dialog if `use-dialog-box' is
5030 non-nil.
5031
5032 ** File selection dialog on MS-Windows is supported.
5033
5034 When a file is visited by clicking File->Open, the MS-Windows version
5035 now pops up a standard file selection dialog where you can select a
5036 file to visit. File->Save As also pops up that dialog.
5037
5038 ** Toolkit scroll bars.
5039
5040 Emacs now uses toolkit scroll bars if available. When configured for
5041 LessTif/Motif, it will use that toolkit's scroll bar. Otherwise, when
5042 configured for Lucid and Athena widgets, it will use the Xaw3d scroll
5043 bar if Xaw3d is available. You can turn off the use of toolkit scroll
5044 bars by specifying `--with-toolkit-scroll-bars=no' when configuring
5045 Emacs.
5046
5047 When you encounter problems with the Xaw3d scroll bar, watch out how
5048 Xaw3d is compiled on your system. If the Makefile generated from
5049 Xaw3d's Imakefile contains a `-DNARROWPROTO' compiler option, and your
5050 Emacs system configuration file `s/your-system.h' does not contain a
5051 define for NARROWPROTO, you might consider adding it. Take
5052 `s/freebsd.h' as an example.
5053
5054 Alternatively, if you don't have access to the Xaw3d source code, take
5055 a look at your system's imake configuration file, for example in the
5056 directory `/usr/X11R6/lib/X11/config' (paths are different on
5057 different systems). You will find files `*.cf' there. If your
5058 system's cf-file contains a line like `#define NeedWidePrototypes NO',
5059 add a `#define NARROWPROTO' to your Emacs system configuration file.
5060
5061 The reason for this is that one Xaw3d function uses `double' or
5062 `float' function parameters depending on the setting of NARROWPROTO.
5063 This is not a problem when Imakefiles are used because each system's
5064 imake configuration file contains the necessary information. Since
5065 Emacs doesn't use imake, this has do be done manually.
5066
5067 ** Tool bar support.
5068
5069 Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. For details
5070 of how to define a tool bar, see the page describing Lisp-level
5071 changes. Tool-bar global minor mode controls whether or not it is
5072 displayed and is on by default. The appearance of the bar is improved
5073 if Emacs has been built with XPM image support. Otherwise monochrome
5074 icons will be used.
5075
5076 To make the tool bar more useful, we need contributions of extra icons
5077 for specific modes (with copyright assignments).
5078
5079 ** Tooltips.
5080
5081 Tooltips are small X windows displaying a help string at the current
5082 mouse position. The Lisp package `tooltip' implements them. You can
5083 turn them off via the user option `tooltip-mode'.
5084
5085 Tooltips also provides support for GUD debugging. If activated,
5086 variable values can be displayed in tooltips by pointing at them with
5087 the mouse in source buffers. You can customize various aspects of the
5088 tooltip display in the group `tooltip'.
5089
5090 ** Automatic Hscrolling
5091
5092 Horizontal scrolling now happens automatically if
5093 `automatic-hscrolling' is set (the default). This setting can be
5094 customized.
5095
5096 If a window is scrolled horizontally with set-window-hscroll, or
5097 scroll-left/scroll-right (C-x <, C-x >), this serves as a lower bound
5098 for automatic horizontal scrolling. Automatic scrolling will scroll
5099 the text more to the left if necessary, but won't scroll the text more
5100 to the right than the column set with set-window-hscroll etc.
5101
5102 ** When using a windowing terminal, each Emacs window now has a cursor
5103 of its own. By default, when a window is selected, the cursor is
5104 solid; otherwise, it is hollow. The user-option
5105 `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' controls how to display the
5106 cursor in non-selected windows. If nil, no cursor is shown, if
5107 non-nil a hollow box cursor is shown.
5108
5109 ** Fringes to the left and right of windows are used to display
5110 truncation marks, continuation marks, overlay arrows and alike. The
5111 foreground, background, and stipple of these areas can be changed by
5112 customizing face `fringe'.
5113
5114 ** The mode line under X is now drawn with shadows by default.
5115 You can change its appearance by modifying the face `mode-line'.
5116 In particular, setting the `:box' attribute to nil turns off the 3D
5117 appearance of the mode line. (The 3D appearance makes the mode line
5118 occupy more space, and thus might cause the first or the last line of
5119 the window to be partially obscured.)
5120
5121 The variable `mode-line-inverse-video', which was used in older
5122 versions of emacs to make the mode-line stand out, is now deprecated.
5123 However, setting it to nil will cause the `mode-line' face to be
5124 ignored, and mode-lines to be drawn using the default text face.
5125
5126 ** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
5127
5128 Different parts of the mode line have been made mouse-sensitive on all
5129 systems which support the mouse. Moving the mouse to a
5130 mouse-sensitive part in the mode line changes the appearance of the
5131 mouse pointer to an arrow, and help about available mouse actions is
5132 displayed either in the echo area, or in the tooltip window if you
5133 have enabled one.
5134
5135 Currently, the following actions have been defined:
5136
5137 - Mouse-1 on the buffer name in the mode line goes to the next buffer.
5138
5139 - Mouse-3 on the buffer-name goes to the previous buffer.
5140
5141 - Mouse-2 on the read-only or modified status in the mode line (`%' or
5142 `*') toggles the status.
5143
5144 - Mouse-3 on the mode name displays a minor-mode menu.
5145
5146 ** Hourglass pointer
5147
5148 Emacs can optionally display an hourglass pointer under X. You can
5149 turn the display on or off by customizing group `cursor'.
5150
5151 ** Blinking cursor
5152
5153 M-x blink-cursor-mode toggles a blinking cursor under X and on
5154 terminals having terminal capabilities `vi', `vs', and `ve'. Blinking
5155 and related parameters like frequency and delay can be customized in
5156 the group `cursor'.
5157
5158 ** New font-lock support mode `jit-lock-mode'.
5159
5160 This support mode is roughly equivalent to `lazy-lock' but is
5161 generally faster. It supports stealth and deferred fontification.
5162 See the documentation of the function `jit-lock-mode' for more
5163 details.
5164
5165 Font-lock uses jit-lock-mode as default support mode, so you don't
5166 have to do anything to activate it.
5167
5168 ** The default binding of the Delete key has changed.
5169
5170 The new user-option `normal-erase-is-backspace' can be set to
5171 determine the effect of the Delete and Backspace function keys.
5172
5173 On window systems, the default value of this option is chosen
5174 according to the keyboard used. If the keyboard has both a Backspace
5175 key and a Delete key, and both are mapped to their usual meanings, the
5176 option's default value is set to t, so that Backspace can be used to
5177 delete backward, and Delete can be used to delete forward. On
5178 keyboards which either have only one key (usually labeled DEL), or two
5179 keys DEL and BS which produce the same effect, the option's value is
5180 set to nil, and these keys delete backward.
5181
5182 If not running under a window system, setting this option accomplishes
5183 a similar effect by mapping C-h, which is usually generated by the
5184 Backspace key, to DEL, and by mapping DEL to C-d via
5185 `keyboard-translate'. The former functionality of C-h is available on
5186 the F1 key. You should probably not use this setting on a text-only
5187 terminal if you don't have both Backspace, Delete and F1 keys.
5188
5189 Programmatically, you can call function normal-erase-is-backspace-mode
5190 to toggle the behavior of the Delete and Backspace keys.
5191
5192 ** The default for user-option `next-line-add-newlines' has been
5193 changed to nil, i.e. C-n will no longer add newlines at the end of a
5194 buffer by default.
5195
5196 ** The <home> and <end> keys now move to the beginning or end of the
5197 current line, respectively. C-<home> and C-<end> move to the
5198 beginning and end of the buffer.
5199
5200 ** Emacs now checks for recursive loads of Lisp files. If the
5201 recursion depth exceeds `recursive-load-depth-limit', an error is
5202 signaled.
5203
5204 ** When an error is signaled during the loading of the user's init
5205 file, Emacs now pops up the *Messages* buffer.
5206
5207 ** Emacs now refuses to load compiled Lisp files which weren't
5208 compiled with Emacs. Set `load-dangerous-libraries' to t to change
5209 this behavior.
5210
5211 The reason for this change is an incompatible change in XEmacs's byte
5212 compiler. Files compiled with XEmacs can contain byte codes that let
5213 Emacs dump core.
5214
5215 ** Toggle buttons and radio buttons in menus.
5216
5217 When compiled with LessTif (or Motif) support, Emacs uses toolkit
5218 widgets for radio and toggle buttons in menus. When configured for
5219 Lucid, Emacs draws radio buttons and toggle buttons similar to Motif.
5220
5221 ** The menu bar configuration has changed. The new configuration is
5222 more CUA-compliant. The most significant change is that Options is
5223 now a separate menu-bar item, with Mule and Customize as its submenus.
5224
5225 ** Item Save Options on the Options menu allows saving options set
5226 using that menu.
5227
5228 ** Highlighting of trailing whitespace.
5229
5230 When `show-trailing-whitespace' is non-nil, Emacs displays trailing
5231 whitespace in the face `trailing-whitespace'. Trailing whitespace is
5232 defined as spaces or tabs at the end of a line. To avoid busy
5233 highlighting when entering new text, trailing whitespace is not
5234 displayed if point is at the end of the line containing the
5235 whitespace.
5236
5237 ** C-x 5 1 runs the new command delete-other-frames which deletes
5238 all frames except the selected one.
5239
5240 ** The new user-option `confirm-kill-emacs' can be customized to
5241 let Emacs ask for confirmation before exiting.
5242
5243 ** The header line in an Info buffer is now displayed as an emacs
5244 header-line (which is like a mode-line, but at the top of the window),
5245 so that it remains visible even when the buffer has been scrolled.
5246 This behavior may be disabled by customizing the option
5247 `Info-use-header-line'.
5248
5249 ** Polish, Czech, German, and French translations of Emacs' reference card
5250 have been added. They are named `pl-refcard.tex', `cs-refcard.tex',
5251 `de-refcard.tex' and `fr-refcard.tex'. Postscript files are included.
5252
5253 ** An `Emacs Survival Guide', etc/survival.tex, is available.
5254
5255 ** A reference card for Dired has been added. Its name is
5256 `dired-ref.tex'. A French translation is available in
5257 `fr-drdref.tex'.
5258
5259 ** C-down-mouse-3 is bound differently. Now if the menu bar is not
5260 displayed it pops up a menu containing the items which would be on the
5261 menu bar. If the menu bar is displayed, it pops up the major mode
5262 menu or the Edit menu if there is no major mode menu.
5263
5264 ** Variable `load-path' is no longer customizable through Customize.
5265
5266 You can no longer use `M-x customize-variable' to customize `load-path'
5267 because it now contains a version-dependent component. You can still
5268 use `add-to-list' and `setq' to customize this variable in your
5269 `~/.emacs' init file or to modify it from any Lisp program in general.
5270
5271 ** C-u C-x = provides detailed information about the character at
5272 point in a pop-up window.
5273
5274 ** Emacs can now support 'wheeled' mice (such as the MS IntelliMouse)
5275 under XFree86. To enable this, use the `mouse-wheel-mode' command, or
5276 customize the variable `mouse-wheel-mode'.
5277
5278 The variables `mouse-wheel-follow-mouse' and `mouse-wheel-scroll-amount'
5279 determine where and by how much buffers are scrolled.
5280
5281 ** Emacs' auto-save list files are now by default stored in a
5282 sub-directory `.emacs.d/auto-save-list/' of the user's home directory.
5283 (On MS-DOS, this subdirectory's name is `_emacs.d/auto-save.list/'.)
5284 You can customize `auto-save-list-file-prefix' to change this location.
5285
5286 ** The function `getenv' is now callable interactively.
5287
5288 ** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
5289 to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
5290
5291 ** The new command M-x delete-trailing-whitespace RET will delete the
5292 trailing whitespace within the current restriction. You can also add
5293 this function to `write-file-hooks' or `local-write-file-hooks'.
5294
5295 ** When visiting a file with M-x find-file-literally, no newlines will
5296 be added to the end of the buffer even if `require-final-newline' is
5297 non-nil.
5298
5299 ** The new user-option `find-file-suppress-same-file-warnings' can be
5300 set to suppress warnings ``X and Y are the same file'' when visiting a
5301 file that is already visited under a different name.
5302
5303 ** The new user-option `electric-help-shrink-window' can be set to
5304 nil to prevent adjusting the help window size to the buffer size.
5305
5306 ** New command M-x describe-character-set reads a character set name
5307 and displays information about that.
5308
5309 ** The new variable `auto-mode-interpreter-regexp' contains a regular
5310 expression matching interpreters, for file mode determination.
5311
5312 This regular expression is matched against the first line of a file to
5313 determine the file's mode in `set-auto-mode' when Emacs can't deduce a
5314 mode from the file's name. If it matches, the file is assumed to be
5315 interpreted by the interpreter matched by the second group of the
5316 regular expression. The mode is then determined as the mode
5317 associated with that interpreter in `interpreter-mode-alist'.
5318
5319 ** New function executable-make-buffer-file-executable-if-script-p is
5320 suitable as an after-save-hook as an alternative to `executable-chmod'.
5321
5322 ** The most preferred coding-system is now used to save a buffer if
5323 buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and it is safe for the buffer
5324 contents. (The most preferred is set by set-language-environment or
5325 by M-x prefer-coding-system.) Thus if you visit an ASCII file and
5326 insert a non-ASCII character from your current language environment,
5327 the file will be saved silently with the appropriate coding.
5328 Previously you would be prompted for a safe coding system.
5329
5330 ** The many obsolete language `setup-...-environment' commands have
5331 been removed -- use `set-language-environment'.
5332
5333 ** The new Custom option `keyboard-coding-system' specifies a coding
5334 system for keyboard input.
5335
5336 ** New variable `inhibit-iso-escape-detection' determines if Emacs'
5337 coding system detection algorithm should pay attention to ISO2022's
5338 escape sequences. If this variable is non-nil, the algorithm ignores
5339 such escape sequences. The default value is nil, and it is
5340 recommended not to change it except for the special case that you
5341 always want to read any escape code verbatim. If you just want to
5342 read a specific file without decoding escape codes, use C-x RET c
5343 (`universal-coding-system-argument'). For instance, C-x RET c latin-1
5344 RET C-x C-f filename RET.
5345
5346 ** Variable `default-korean-keyboard' is initialized properly from the
5347 environment variable `HANGUL_KEYBOARD_TYPE'.
5348
5349 ** New command M-x list-charset-chars reads a character set name and
5350 displays all characters in that character set.
5351
5352 ** M-x set-terminal-coding-system (C-x RET t) now allows CCL-based
5353 coding systems such as cpXXX and cyrillic-koi8.
5354
5355 ** Emacs now attempts to determine the initial language environment
5356 and preferred and locale coding systems systematically from the
5357 LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG environment variables during startup.
5358
5359 ** New language environments `Polish', `Latin-8' and `Latin-9'.
5360 Latin-8 and Latin-9 correspond respectively to the ISO character sets
5361 8859-14 (Celtic) and 8859-15 (updated Latin-1, with the Euro sign).
5362 GNU Intlfonts doesn't support these yet but recent X releases have
5363 8859-15. See etc/INSTALL for information on obtaining extra fonts.
5364 There are new Leim input methods for Latin-8 and Latin-9 prefix (only)
5365 and Polish `slash'.
5366
5367 ** New language environments `Dutch' and `Spanish'.
5368 These new environments mainly select appropriate translations
5369 of the tutorial.
5370
5371 ** In Ethiopic language environment, special key bindings for
5372 function keys are changed as follows. This is to conform to "Emacs
5373 Lisp Coding Convention".
5374
5375 new command old-binding
5376 --- ------- -----------
5377 f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-buffer f5
5378 S-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-region f5
5379 C-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-mail-or-marker f5
5380
5381 f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-buffer unchanged
5382 S-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-region unchanged
5383 C-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-mail-or-marker unchanged
5384
5385 S-f5 ethio-toggle-punctuation f3
5386 S-f6 ethio-modify-vowel f6
5387 S-f7 ethio-replace-space f7
5388 S-f8 ethio-input-special-character f8
5389 S-f9 ethio-replace-space unchanged
5390 C-f9 ethio-toggle-space f2
5391
5392 ** There are new Leim input methods.
5393 New input methods "turkish-postfix", "turkish-alt-postfix",
5394 "greek-mizuochi", "TeX", and "greek-babel" are now part of the Leim
5395 package.
5396
5397 ** The rule of input method "slovak" is slightly changed. Now the
5398 rules for translating "q" and "Q" to "`" (backquote) are deleted, thus
5399 typing them inserts "q" and "Q" respectively. Rules for translating
5400 "=q", "+q", "=Q", and "+Q" to "`" are also deleted. Now, to input
5401 "`", you must type "=q".
5402
5403 ** When your terminal can't display characters from some of the ISO
5404 8859 character sets but can display Latin-1, you can display
5405 more-or-less mnemonic sequences of ASCII/Latin-1 characters instead of
5406 empty boxes (under a window system) or question marks (not under a
5407 window system). Customize the option `latin1-display' to turn this
5408 on.
5409
5410 ** M-; now calls comment-dwim which tries to do something clever based
5411 on the context. M-x kill-comment is now an alias to comment-kill,
5412 defined in newcomment.el. You can choose different styles of region
5413 commenting with the variable `comment-style'.
5414
5415 ** New user options `display-time-mail-face' and
5416 `display-time-use-mail-icon' control the appearance of mode-line mail
5417 indicator used by the display-time package. On a suitable display the
5418 indicator can be an icon and is mouse-sensitive.
5419
5420 ** On window-systems, additional space can be put between text lines
5421 on the display using several methods
5422
5423 - By setting frame parameter `line-spacing' to PIXELS. PIXELS must be
5424 a positive integer, and specifies that PIXELS number of pixels should
5425 be put below text lines on the affected frame or frames.
5426
5427 - By setting X resource `lineSpacing', class `LineSpacing'. This is
5428 equivalent to specifying the frame parameter.
5429
5430 - By specifying `--line-spacing=N' or `-lsp N' on the command line.
5431
5432 - By setting buffer-local variable `line-spacing'. The meaning is
5433 the same, but applies to the a particular buffer only.
5434
5435 ** The new command `clone-indirect-buffer' can be used to create
5436 an indirect buffer that is a twin copy of the current buffer. The
5437 command `clone-indirect-buffer-other-window', bound to C-x 4 c,
5438 does the same but displays the indirect buffer in another window.
5439
5440 ** New user options `backup-directory-alist' and
5441 `make-backup-file-name-function' control the placement of backups,
5442 typically in a single directory or in an invisible sub-directory.
5443
5444 ** New commands iso-iso2sgml and iso-sgml2iso convert between Latin-1
5445 characters and the corresponding SGML (HTML) entities.
5446
5447 ** New X resources recognized
5448
5449 *** The X resource `synchronous', class `Synchronous', specifies
5450 whether Emacs should run in synchronous mode. Synchronous mode
5451 is useful for debugging X problems.
5452
5453 Example:
5454
5455 emacs.synchronous: true
5456
5457 *** The X resource `visualClass, class `VisualClass', specifies the
5458 visual Emacs should use. The resource's value should be a string of
5459 the form `CLASS-DEPTH', where CLASS is the name of the visual class,
5460 and DEPTH is the requested color depth as a decimal number. Valid
5461 visual class names are
5462
5463 TrueColor
5464 PseudoColor
5465 DirectColor
5466 StaticColor
5467 GrayScale
5468 StaticGray
5469
5470 Visual class names specified as X resource are case-insensitive, i.e.
5471 `pseudocolor', `Pseudocolor' and `PseudoColor' all have the same
5472 meaning.
5473
5474 The program `xdpyinfo' can be used to list the visual classes
5475 supported on your display, and which depths they have. If
5476 `visualClass' is not specified, Emacs uses the display's default
5477 visual.
5478
5479 Example:
5480
5481 emacs.visualClass: TrueColor-8
5482
5483 *** The X resource `privateColormap', class `PrivateColormap',
5484 specifies that Emacs should use a private colormap if it is using the
5485 default visual, and that visual is of class PseudoColor. Recognized
5486 resource values are `true' or `on'.
5487
5488 Example:
5489
5490 emacs.privateColormap: true
5491
5492 ** Faces and frame parameters.
5493
5494 There are four new faces `scroll-bar', `border', `cursor' and `mouse'.
5495 Setting the frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
5496 `scroll-bar-background' sets foreground and background color of face
5497 `scroll-bar' and vice versa. Setting frame parameter `border-color'
5498 sets the background color of face `border' and vice versa. Likewise
5499 for frame parameters `cursor-color' and face `cursor', and frame
5500 parameter `mouse-color' and face `mouse'.
5501
5502 Changing frame parameter `font' sets font-related attributes of the
5503 `default' face and vice versa. Setting frame parameters
5504 `foreground-color' or `background-color' sets the colors of the
5505 `default' face and vice versa.
5506
5507 ** New face `menu'.
5508
5509 The face `menu' can be used to change colors and font of Emacs' menus.
5510
5511 ** New frame parameter `screen-gamma' for gamma correction.
5512
5513 The new frame parameter `screen-gamma' specifies gamma-correction for
5514 colors. Its value may be nil, the default, in which case no gamma
5515 correction occurs, or a number > 0, usually a float, that specifies
5516 the screen gamma of a frame's display.
5517
5518 PC monitors usually have a screen gamma of 2.2. smaller values result
5519 in darker colors. You might want to try a screen gamma of 1.5 for LCD
5520 color displays. The viewing gamma Emacs uses is 0.4545. (1/2.2).
5521
5522 The X resource name of this parameter is `screenGamma', class
5523 `ScreenGamma'.
5524
5525 ** Tabs and variable-width text.
5526
5527 Tabs are now displayed with stretch properties; the width of a tab is
5528 defined as a multiple of the normal character width of a frame, and is
5529 independent of the fonts used in the text where the tab appears.
5530 Thus, tabs can be used to line up text in different fonts.
5531
5532 ** Enhancements of the Lucid menu bar
5533
5534 *** The Lucid menu bar now supports the resource "margin".
5535
5536 emacs.pane.menubar.margin: 5
5537
5538 The default margin is 4 which makes the menu bar appear like the
5539 LessTif/Motif one.
5540
5541 *** Arrows that indicate sub-menus are now drawn with shadows, as in
5542 LessTif and Motif.
5543
5544 ** A block cursor can be drawn as wide as the glyph under it under X.
5545
5546 As an example: if a block cursor is over a tab character, it will be
5547 drawn as wide as that tab on the display. To do this, set
5548 `x-stretch-cursor' to a non-nil value.
5549
5550 ** Empty display lines at the end of a buffer may be marked with a
5551 bitmap (this is similar to the tilde displayed by vi and Less).
5552
5553 This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
5554 `indicate-empty-lines' to a non-nil value. The default value of this
5555 variable is found in `default-indicate-empty-lines'.
5556
5557 ** There is a new "aggressive" scrolling method.
5558
5559 When scrolling up because point is above the window start, if the
5560 value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-up-aggressively' is a
5561 number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
5562 fraction of the window's height from the top of the window.
5563
5564 When scrolling down because point is below the window end, if the
5565 value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-down-aggressively' is a
5566 number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
5567 fraction of the window's height from the bottom of the window.
5568
5569 ** You can now easily create new *Info* buffers using either
5570 M-x clone-buffer, C-u m <entry> RET or C-u g <entry> RET.
5571 M-x clone-buffer can also be used on *Help* and several other special
5572 buffers.
5573
5574 ** The command `Info-search' now uses a search history.
5575
5576 ** Listing buffers with M-x list-buffers (C-x C-b) now shows
5577 abbreviated file names. Abbreviations can be customized by changing
5578 `directory-abbrev-alist'.
5579
5580 ** A new variable, backup-by-copying-when-privileged-mismatch, gives
5581 the highest file uid for which backup-by-copying-when-mismatch will be
5582 forced on. The assumption is that uids less than or equal to this
5583 value are special uids (root, bin, daemon, etc.--not real system
5584 users) and that files owned by these users should not change ownership,
5585 even if your system policy allows users other than root to edit them.
5586
5587 The default is 200; set the variable to nil to disable the feature.
5588
5589 ** The rectangle commands now avoid inserting undesirable spaces,
5590 notably at the end of lines.
5591
5592 All these functions have been rewritten to avoid inserting unwanted
5593 spaces, and an optional prefix now allows them to behave the old way.
5594
5595 ** The function `replace-rectangle' is an alias for `string-rectangle'.
5596
5597 ** The new command M-x string-insert-rectangle is like `string-rectangle',
5598 but inserts text instead of replacing it.
5599
5600 ** The new command M-x query-replace-regexp-eval acts like
5601 query-replace-regexp, but takes a Lisp expression which is evaluated
5602 after each match to get the replacement text.
5603
5604 ** M-x query-replace recognizes a new command `e' (or `E') that lets
5605 you edit the replacement string.
5606
5607 ** The new command mail-abbrev-complete-alias, bound to `M-TAB'
5608 (if you load the library `mailabbrev'), lets you complete mail aliases
5609 in the text, analogous to lisp-complete-symbol.
5610
5611 ** The variable `echo-keystrokes' may now have a floating point value.
5612
5613 ** If your init file is compiled (.emacs.elc), `user-init-file' is set
5614 to the source name (.emacs.el), if that exists, after loading it.
5615
5616 ** The help string specified for a menu-item whose definition contains
5617 the property `:help HELP' is now displayed under X, on MS-Windows, and
5618 MS-DOS, either in the echo area or with tooltips. Many standard menus
5619 displayed by Emacs now have help strings.
5620
5621 --
5622 ** New user option `read-mail-command' specifies a command to use to
5623 read mail from the menu etc.
5624
5625 ** The environment variable `EMACSLOCKDIR' is no longer used on MS-Windows.
5626 This environment variable was used when creating lock files. Emacs on
5627 MS-Windows does not use this variable anymore. This change was made
5628 before Emacs 21.1, but wasn't documented until now.
5629
5630 ** Highlighting of mouse-sensitive regions is now supported in the
5631 MS-DOS version of Emacs.
5632
5633 ** The new command `msdos-set-mouse-buttons' forces the MS-DOS version
5634 of Emacs to behave as if the mouse had a specified number of buttons.
5635 This comes handy with mice that don't report their number of buttons
5636 correctly. One example is the wheeled mice, which report 3 buttons,
5637 but clicks on the middle button are not passed to the MS-DOS version
5638 of Emacs.
5639
5640 ** Customize changes
5641
5642 *** Customize now supports comments about customized items. Use the
5643 `State' menu to add comments, or give a prefix argument to
5644 M-x customize-set-variable or M-x customize-set-value. Note that
5645 customization comments will cause the customizations to fail in
5646 earlier versions of Emacs.
5647
5648 *** The new option `custom-buffer-done-function' says whether to kill
5649 Custom buffers when you've done with them or just bury them (the
5650 default).
5651
5652 *** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
5653 does not allow you to save customizations in your `~/.emacs' init
5654 file. This is because saving customizations from such a session would
5655 wipe out all the other customizationss you might have on your init
5656 file.
5657
5658 ** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
5659 does not save disabled and enabled commands for future sessions, to
5660 avoid overwriting existing customizations of this kind that are
5661 already in your init file.
5662
5663 ** New features in evaluation commands
5664
5665 *** The commands to evaluate Lisp expressions, such as C-M-x in Lisp
5666 modes, C-j in Lisp Interaction mode, and M-:, now bind the variables
5667 print-level, print-length, and debug-on-error based on the new
5668 customizable variables eval-expression-print-level,
5669 eval-expression-print-length, and eval-expression-debug-on-error.
5670
5671 The default values for the first two of these variables are 12 and 4
5672 respectively, which means that `eval-expression' now prints at most
5673 the first 12 members of a list and at most 4 nesting levels deep (if
5674 the list is longer or deeper than that, an ellipsis `...' is
5675 printed).
5676
5677 <RET> or <mouse-2> on the printed text toggles between an abbreviated
5678 printed representation and an unabbreviated one.
5679
5680 The default value of eval-expression-debug-on-error is t, so any error
5681 during evaluation produces a backtrace.
5682
5683 *** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) now loads Edebug and instruments
5684 code when called with a prefix argument.
5685
5686 ** CC mode changes.
5687
5688 Note: This release contains changes that might not be compatible with
5689 current user setups (although it's believed that these
5690 incompatibilities will only show in very uncommon circumstances).
5691 However, since the impact is uncertain, these changes may be rolled
5692 back depending on user feedback. Therefore there's no forward
5693 compatibility guarantee wrt the new features introduced in this
5694 release.
5695
5696 *** The hardcoded switch to "java" style in Java mode is gone.
5697 CC Mode used to automatically set the style to "java" when Java mode
5698 is entered. This has now been removed since it caused too much
5699 confusion.
5700
5701 However, to keep backward compatibility to a certain extent, the
5702 default value for c-default-style now specifies the "java" style for
5703 java-mode, but "gnu" for all other modes (as before). So you won't
5704 notice the change if you haven't touched that variable.
5705
5706 *** New cleanups, space-before-funcall and compact-empty-funcall.
5707 Two new cleanups have been added to c-cleanup-list:
5708
5709 space-before-funcall causes a space to be inserted before the opening
5710 parenthesis of a function call, which gives the style "foo (bar)".
5711
5712 compact-empty-funcall causes any space before a function call opening
5713 parenthesis to be removed if there are no arguments to the function.
5714 It's typically useful together with space-before-funcall to get the
5715 style "foo (bar)" and "foo()".
5716
5717 *** Some keywords now automatically trigger reindentation.
5718 Keywords like "else", "while", "catch" and "finally" have been made
5719 "electric" to make them reindent automatically when they continue an
5720 earlier statement. An example:
5721
5722 for (i = 0; i < 17; i++)
5723 if (a[i])
5724 res += a[i]->offset;
5725 else
5726
5727 Here, the "else" should be indented like the preceding "if", since it
5728 continues that statement. CC Mode will automatically reindent it after
5729 the "else" has been typed in full, since it's not until then it's
5730 possible to decide whether it's a new statement or a continuation of
5731 the preceding "if".
5732
5733 CC Mode uses Abbrev mode to achieve this, which is therefore turned on
5734 by default.
5735
5736 *** M-a and M-e now moves by sentence in multiline strings.
5737 Previously these two keys only moved by sentence in comments, which
5738 meant that sentence movement didn't work in strings containing
5739 documentation or other natural language text.
5740
5741 The reason it's only activated in multiline strings (i.e. strings that
5742 contain a newline, even when escaped by a '\') is to avoid stopping in
5743 the short strings that often reside inside statements. Multiline
5744 strings almost always contain text in a natural language, as opposed
5745 to other strings that typically contain format specifications,
5746 commands, etc. Also, it's not that bothersome that M-a and M-e misses
5747 sentences in single line strings, since they're short anyway.
5748
5749 *** Support for autodoc comments in Pike mode.
5750 Autodoc comments for Pike are used to extract documentation from the
5751 source, like Javadoc in Java. Pike mode now recognize this markup in
5752 comment prefixes and paragraph starts.
5753
5754 *** The comment prefix regexps on c-comment-prefix may be mode specific.
5755 When c-comment-prefix is an association list, it specifies the comment
5756 line prefix on a per-mode basis, like c-default-style does. This
5757 change came about to support the special autodoc comment prefix in
5758 Pike mode only.
5759
5760 *** Better handling of syntactic errors.
5761 The recovery after unbalanced parens earlier in the buffer has been
5762 improved; CC Mode now reports them by dinging and giving a message
5763 stating the offending line, but still recovers and indent the
5764 following lines in a sane way (most of the time). An "else" with no
5765 matching "if" is handled similarly. If an error is discovered while
5766 indenting a region, the whole region is still indented and the error
5767 is reported afterwards.
5768
5769 *** Lineup functions may now return absolute columns.
5770 A lineup function can give an absolute column to indent the line to by
5771 returning a vector with the desired column as the first element.
5772
5773 *** More robust and warning-free byte compilation.
5774 Although this is strictly not a user visible change (well, depending
5775 on the view of a user), it's still worth mentioning that CC Mode now
5776 can be compiled in the standard ways without causing trouble. Some
5777 code have also been moved between the subpackages to enhance the
5778 modularity somewhat. Thanks to Martin Buchholz for doing the
5779 groundwork.
5780
5781 *** c-style-variables-are-local-p now defaults to t.
5782 This is an incompatible change that has been made to make the behavior
5783 of the style system wrt global variable settings less confusing for
5784 non-advanced users. If you know what this variable does you might
5785 want to set it to nil in your .emacs, otherwise you probably don't
5786 have to bother.
5787
5788 Defaulting c-style-variables-are-local-p to t avoids the confusing
5789 situation that occurs when a user sets some style variables globally
5790 and edits both a Java and a non-Java file in the same Emacs session.
5791 If the style variables aren't buffer local in this case, loading of
5792 the second file will cause the default style (either "gnu" or "java"
5793 by default) to override the global settings made by the user.
5794
5795 *** New initialization procedure for the style system.
5796 When the initial style for a buffer is determined by CC Mode (from the
5797 variable c-default-style), the global values of style variables now
5798 take precedence over the values specified by the chosen style. This
5799 is different than the old behavior: previously, the style-specific
5800 settings would override the global settings. This change makes it
5801 possible to do simple configuration in the intuitive way with
5802 Customize or with setq lines in one's .emacs file.
5803
5804 By default, the global value of every style variable is the new
5805 special symbol set-from-style, which causes the value to be taken from
5806 the style system. This means that in effect, only an explicit setting
5807 of a style variable will cause the "overriding" behavior described
5808 above.
5809
5810 Also note that global settings override style-specific settings *only*
5811 when the initial style of a buffer is chosen by a CC Mode major mode
5812 function. When a style is chosen in other ways --- for example, by a
5813 call like (c-set-style "gnu") in a hook, or via M-x c-set-style ---
5814 then the style-specific values take precedence over any global style
5815 values. In Lisp terms, global values override style-specific values
5816 only when the new second argument to c-set-style is non-nil; see the
5817 function documentation for more info.
5818
5819 The purpose of these changes is to make it easier for users,
5820 especially novice users, to do simple customizations with Customize or
5821 with setq in their .emacs files. On the other hand, the new system is
5822 intended to be compatible with advanced users' customizations as well,
5823 such as those that choose styles in hooks or whatnot. This new system
5824 is believed to be almost entirely compatible with current
5825 configurations, in spite of the changed precedence between style and
5826 global variable settings when a buffer's default style is set.
5827
5828 (Thanks to Eric Eide for clarifying this explanation a bit.)
5829
5830 **** c-offsets-alist is now a customizable variable.
5831 This became possible as a result of the new initialization behavior.
5832
5833 This variable is treated slightly differently from the other style
5834 variables; instead of using the symbol set-from-style, it will be
5835 completed with the syntactic symbols it doesn't already contain when
5836 the style is first initialized. This means it now defaults to the
5837 empty list to make all syntactic elements get their values from the
5838 style system.
5839
5840 **** Compatibility variable to restore the old behavior.
5841 In case your configuration doesn't work with this change, you can set
5842 c-old-style-variable-behavior to non-nil to get the old behavior back
5843 as far as possible.
5844
5845 *** Improvements to line breaking and text filling.
5846 CC Mode now handles this more intelligently and seamlessly wrt the
5847 surrounding code, especially inside comments. For details see the new
5848 chapter about this in the manual.
5849
5850 **** New variable to recognize comment line prefix decorations.
5851 The variable c-comment-prefix-regexp has been added to properly
5852 recognize the line prefix in both block and line comments. It's
5853 primarily used to initialize the various paragraph recognition and
5854 adaptive filling variables that the text handling functions uses.
5855
5856 **** New variable c-block-comment-prefix.
5857 This is a generalization of the now obsolete variable
5858 c-comment-continuation-stars to handle arbitrary strings.
5859
5860 **** CC Mode now uses adaptive fill mode.
5861 This to make it adapt better to the paragraph style inside comments.
5862
5863 It's also possible to use other adaptive filling packages inside CC
5864 Mode, notably Kyle E. Jones' Filladapt mode (http://wonderworks.com/).
5865 A new convenience function c-setup-filladapt sets up Filladapt for use
5866 inside CC Mode.
5867
5868 Note though that the 2.12 version of Filladapt lacks a feature that
5869 causes it to work suboptimally when c-comment-prefix-regexp can match
5870 the empty string (which it commonly does). A patch for that is
5871 available from the CC Mode web site (http://www.python.org/emacs/
5872 cc-mode/).
5873
5874 **** The variables `c-hanging-comment-starter-p' and
5875 `c-hanging-comment-ender-p', which controlled how comment starters and
5876 enders were filled, are not used anymore. The new version of the
5877 function `c-fill-paragraph' keeps the comment starters and enders as
5878 they were before the filling.
5879
5880 **** It's now possible to selectively turn off auto filling.
5881 The variable c-ignore-auto-fill is used to ignore auto fill mode in
5882 specific contexts, e.g. in preprocessor directives and in string
5883 literals.
5884
5885 **** New context sensitive line break function c-context-line-break.
5886 It works like newline-and-indent in normal code, and adapts the line
5887 prefix according to the comment style when used inside comments. If
5888 you're normally using newline-and-indent, you might want to switch to
5889 this function.
5890
5891 *** Fixes to IDL mode.
5892 It now does a better job in recognizing only the constructs relevant
5893 to IDL. E.g. it no longer matches "class" as the beginning of a
5894 struct block, but it does match the CORBA 2.3 "valuetype" keyword.
5895 Thanks to Eric Eide.
5896
5897 *** Improvements to the Whitesmith style.
5898 It now keeps the style consistently on all levels and both when
5899 opening braces hangs and when they don't.
5900
5901 **** New lineup function c-lineup-whitesmith-in-block.
5902
5903 *** New lineup functions c-lineup-template-args and c-indent-multi-line-block.
5904 See their docstrings for details. c-lineup-template-args does a
5905 better job of tracking the brackets used as parens in C++ templates,
5906 and is used by default to line up continued template arguments.
5907
5908 *** c-lineup-comment now preserves alignment with a comment on the
5909 previous line. It used to instead preserve comments that started in
5910 the column specified by comment-column.
5911
5912 *** c-lineup-C-comments handles "free form" text comments.
5913 In comments with a long delimiter line at the start, the indentation
5914 is kept unchanged for lines that start with an empty comment line
5915 prefix. This is intended for the type of large block comments that
5916 contain documentation with its own formatting. In these you normally
5917 don't want CC Mode to change the indentation.
5918
5919 *** The `c' syntactic symbol is now relative to the comment start
5920 instead of the previous line, to make integers usable as lineup
5921 arguments.
5922
5923 *** All lineup functions have gotten docstrings.
5924
5925 *** More preprocessor directive movement functions.
5926 c-down-conditional does the reverse of c-up-conditional.
5927 c-up-conditional-with-else and c-down-conditional-with-else are
5928 variants of these that also stops at "#else" lines (suggested by Don
5929 Provan).
5930
5931 *** Minor improvements to many movement functions in tricky situations.
5932
5933 ** Dired changes
5934
5935 *** New variable `dired-recursive-deletes' determines if the delete
5936 command will delete non-empty directories recursively. The default
5937 is, delete only empty directories.
5938
5939 *** New variable `dired-recursive-copies' determines if the copy
5940 command will copy directories recursively. The default is, do not
5941 copy directories recursively.
5942
5943 *** In command `dired-do-shell-command' (usually bound to `!') a `?'
5944 in the shell command has a special meaning similar to `*', but with
5945 the difference that the command will be run on each file individually.
5946
5947 *** The new command `dired-find-alternate-file' (usually bound to `a')
5948 replaces the Dired buffer with the buffer for an alternate file or
5949 directory.
5950
5951 *** The new command `dired-show-file-type' (usually bound to `y') shows
5952 a message in the echo area describing what type of file the point is on.
5953 This command invokes the external program `file' do its work, and so
5954 will only work on systems with that program, and will be only as
5955 accurate or inaccurate as it is.
5956
5957 *** Dired now properly handles undo changes of adding/removing `-R'
5958 from ls switches.
5959
5960 *** Dired commands that prompt for a destination file now allow the use
5961 of the `M-n' command in the minibuffer to insert the source filename,
5962 which the user can then edit. This only works if there is a single
5963 source file, not when operating on multiple marked files.
5964
5965 ** Gnus changes.
5966
5967 The Gnus NEWS entries are short, but they reflect sweeping changes in
5968 four areas: Article display treatment, MIME treatment,
5969 internationalization and mail-fetching.
5970
5971 *** The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
5972 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
5973
5974 If you used procmail like in
5975
5976 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
5977 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
5978 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
5979 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
5980
5981 this now has changed to
5982
5983 (setq mail-sources
5984 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
5985 :suffix ".in")))
5986
5987 More information is available in the info doc at Select Methods ->
5988 Getting Mail -> Mail Sources
5989
5990 *** Gnus is now a MIME-capable reader. This affects many parts of
5991 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
5992 Separate MIME packages like RMIME, mime-compose etc., will probably no
5993 longer work; remove them and use the native facilities.
5994
5995 The FLIM/SEMI package still works with Emacs 21, but if you want to
5996 use the native facilities, you must remove any mailcap.el[c] that was
5997 installed by FLIM/SEMI version 1.13 or earlier.
5998
5999 *** Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too many
6000 parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables. There
6001 are built-in facilities equivalent to those of gnus-mule.el, which is
6002 now just a compatibility layer.
6003
6004 *** gnus-mule.el is now just a compatibility layer over the built-in
6005 Gnus facilities.
6006
6007 *** gnus-auto-select-first can now be a function to be
6008 called to position point.
6009
6010 *** The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
6011 summary buffers and NOV files.
6012
6013 *** `gnus-article-display-hook' has been removed. Instead, a number
6014 of variables starting with `gnus-treat-' have been added.
6015
6016 *** The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now work in a
6017 subtly different manner.
6018
6019 *** New web-based backends have been added: nnslashdot, nnwarchive
6020 and nnultimate. nnweb has been revamped, again, to keep up with
6021 ever-changing layouts.
6022
6023 *** Gnus can now read IMAP mail via nnimap.
6024
6025 *** There is image support of various kinds and some sound support.
6026
6027 ** Changes in Texinfo mode.
6028
6029 *** A couple of new key bindings have been added for inserting Texinfo
6030 macros
6031
6032 Key binding Macro
6033 -------------------------
6034 C-c C-c C-s @strong
6035 C-c C-c C-e @emph
6036 C-c C-c u @uref
6037 C-c C-c q @quotation
6038 C-c C-c m @email
6039 C-c C-o @<block> ... @end <block>
6040 M-RET @item
6041
6042 *** The " key now inserts either " or `` or '' depending on context.
6043
6044 ** Changes in Outline mode.
6045
6046 There is now support for Imenu to index headings. A new command
6047 `outline-headers-as-kill' copies the visible headings in the region to
6048 the kill ring, e.g. to produce a table of contents.
6049
6050 ** Changes to Emacs Server
6051
6052 *** The new option `server-kill-new-buffers' specifies what to do
6053 with buffers when done with them. If non-nil, the default, buffers
6054 are killed, unless they were already present before visiting them with
6055 Emacs Server. If nil, `server-temp-file-regexp' specifies which
6056 buffers to kill, as before.
6057
6058 Please note that only buffers are killed that still have a client,
6059 i.e. buffers visited with `emacsclient --no-wait' are never killed in
6060 this way.
6061
6062 ** Both emacsclient and Emacs itself now accept command line options
6063 of the form +LINE:COLUMN in addition to +LINE.
6064
6065 ** Changes to Show Paren mode.
6066
6067 *** Overlays used by Show Paren mode now use a priority property.
6068 The new user option show-paren-priority specifies the priority to
6069 use. Default is 1000.
6070
6071 ** New command M-x check-parens can be used to find unbalanced paren
6072 groups and strings in buffers in Lisp mode (or other modes).
6073
6074 ** Changes to hideshow.el
6075
6076 *** Generalized block selection and traversal
6077
6078 A block is now recognized by its start and end regexps (both strings),
6079 and an integer specifying which sub-expression in the start regexp
6080 serves as the place where a `forward-sexp'-like function can operate.
6081 See the documentation of variable `hs-special-modes-alist'.
6082
6083 *** During incremental search, if Hideshow minor mode is active,
6084 hidden blocks are temporarily shown. The variable `hs-headline' can
6085 be used in the mode line format to show the line at the beginning of
6086 the open block.
6087
6088 *** User option `hs-hide-all-non-comment-function' specifies a
6089 function to be called at each top-level block beginning, instead of
6090 the normal block-hiding function.
6091
6092 *** The command `hs-show-region' has been removed.
6093
6094 *** The key bindings have changed to fit the Emacs conventions,
6095 roughly imitating those of Outline minor mode. Notably, the prefix
6096 for all bindings is now `C-c @'. For details, see the documentation
6097 for `hs-minor-mode'.
6098
6099 *** The variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' has been removed, and
6100 hideshow.el now always behaves as if this variable were set to t.
6101
6102 ** Changes to Change Log mode and Add-Log functions
6103
6104 *** If you invoke `add-change-log-entry' from a backup file, it makes
6105 an entry appropriate for the file's parent. This is useful for making
6106 log entries by comparing a version with deleted functions.
6107
6108 **** New command M-x change-log-merge merges another log into the
6109 current buffer.
6110
6111 *** New command M-x change-log-redate fixes any old-style date entries
6112 in a log file.
6113
6114 *** Change Log mode now adds a file's version number to change log
6115 entries if user-option `change-log-version-info-enabled' is non-nil.
6116 Unless the file is under version control the search for a file's
6117 version number is performed based on regular expressions from
6118 `change-log-version-number-regexp-list' which can be customized.
6119 Version numbers are only found in the first 10 percent of a file.
6120
6121 *** Change Log mode now defines its own faces for font-lock highlighting.
6122
6123 ** Changes to cmuscheme
6124
6125 *** The user-option `scheme-program-name' has been renamed
6126 `cmuscheme-program-name' due to conflicts with xscheme.el.
6127
6128 ** Changes in Font Lock
6129
6130 *** The new function `font-lock-remove-keywords' can be used to remove
6131 font-lock keywords from the current buffer or from a specific major mode.
6132
6133 *** Multi-line patterns are now supported. Modes using this, should
6134 set font-lock-multiline to t in their font-lock-defaults.
6135
6136 *** `font-lock-syntactic-face-function' allows major-modes to choose
6137 the face used for each string/comment.
6138
6139 *** A new standard face `font-lock-doc-face'.
6140 Meant for Lisp docstrings, Javadoc comments and other "documentation in code".
6141
6142 ** Changes to Shell mode
6143
6144 *** The `shell' command now accepts an optional argument to specify the buffer
6145 to use, which defaults to "*shell*". When used interactively, a
6146 non-default buffer may be specified by giving the `shell' command a
6147 prefix argument (causing it to prompt for the buffer name).
6148
6149 ** Comint (subshell) changes
6150
6151 These changes generally affect all modes derived from comint mode, which
6152 include shell-mode, gdb-mode, scheme-interaction-mode, etc.
6153
6154 *** Comint now by default interprets some carriage-control characters.
6155 Comint now removes CRs from CR LF sequences, and treats single CRs and
6156 BSs in the output in a way similar to a terminal (by deleting to the
6157 beginning of the line, or deleting the previous character,
6158 respectively). This is achieved by adding `comint-carriage-motion' to
6159 the `comint-output-filter-functions' hook by default.
6160
6161 *** By default, comint no longer uses the variable `comint-prompt-regexp'
6162 to distinguish prompts from user-input. Instead, it notices which
6163 parts of the text were output by the process, and which entered by the
6164 user, and attaches `field' properties to allow emacs commands to use
6165 this information. Common movement commands, notably beginning-of-line,
6166 respect field boundaries in a fairly natural manner. To disable this
6167 feature, and use the old behavior, customize the user option
6168 `comint-use-prompt-regexp-instead-of-fields'.
6169
6170 *** Comint now includes new features to send commands to running processes
6171 and redirect the output to a designated buffer or buffers.
6172
6173 *** The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command reads a command and
6174 buffer name from the mini-buffer. The command is sent to the current
6175 buffer's process, and its output is inserted into the specified buffer.
6176
6177 The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command-to-process acts like
6178 M-x comint-redirect-send-command but additionally reads the name of
6179 the buffer whose process should be used from the mini-buffer.
6180
6181 *** Packages based on comint now highlight user input and program prompts,
6182 and support choosing previous input with mouse-2. To control these features,
6183 see the user-options `comint-highlight-input' and `comint-highlight-prompt'.
6184
6185 *** The new command `comint-write-output' (usually bound to `C-c C-s')
6186 saves the output from the most recent command to a file. With a prefix
6187 argument, it appends to the file.
6188
6189 *** The command `comint-kill-output' has been renamed `comint-delete-output'
6190 (usually bound to `C-c C-o'); the old name is aliased to it for
6191 compatibility.
6192
6193 *** The new function `comint-add-to-input-history' adds commands to the input
6194 ring (history).
6195
6196 *** The new variable `comint-input-history-ignore' is a regexp for
6197 identifying history lines that should be ignored, like tcsh time-stamp
6198 strings, starting with a `#'. The default value of this variable is "^#".
6199
6200 ** Changes to Rmail mode
6201
6202 *** The new user-option rmail-user-mail-address-regexp can be
6203 set to fine tune the identification of the correspondent when
6204 receiving new mail. If it matches the address of the sender, the
6205 recipient is taken as correspondent of a mail. If nil, the default,
6206 `user-login-name' and `user-mail-address' are used to exclude yourself
6207 as correspondent.
6208
6209 Usually you don't have to set this variable, except if you collect
6210 mails sent by you under different user names. Then it should be a
6211 regexp matching your mail addresses.
6212
6213 *** The new user-option rmail-confirm-expunge controls whether and how
6214 to ask for confirmation before expunging deleted messages from an
6215 Rmail file. You can choose between no confirmation, confirmation
6216 with y-or-n-p, or confirmation with yes-or-no-p. Default is to ask
6217 for confirmation with yes-or-no-p.
6218
6219 *** RET is now bound in the Rmail summary to rmail-summary-goto-msg,
6220 like `j'.
6221
6222 *** There is a new user option `rmail-digest-end-regexps' that
6223 specifies the regular expressions to detect the line that ends a
6224 digest message.
6225
6226 *** The new user option `rmail-automatic-folder-directives' specifies
6227 in which folder to put messages automatically.
6228
6229 *** The new function `rmail-redecode-body' allows to fix a message
6230 with non-ASCII characters if Emacs happens to decode it incorrectly
6231 due to missing or malformed "charset=" header.
6232
6233 ** The new user-option `mail-envelope-from' can be used to specify
6234 an envelope-from address different from user-mail-address.
6235
6236 ** The variable mail-specify-envelope-from controls whether to
6237 use the -f option when sending mail.
6238
6239 ** The Rmail command `o' (`rmail-output-to-rmail-file') now writes the
6240 current message in the internal `emacs-mule' encoding, rather than in
6241 the encoding taken from the variable `buffer-file-coding-system'.
6242 This allows to save messages whose characters cannot be safely encoded
6243 by the buffer's coding system, and makes sure the message will be
6244 displayed correctly when you later visit the target Rmail file.
6245
6246 If you want your Rmail files be encoded in a specific coding system
6247 other than `emacs-mule', you can customize the variable
6248 `rmail-file-coding-system' to set its value to that coding system.
6249
6250 ** Changes to TeX mode
6251
6252 *** The default mode has been changed from `plain-tex-mode' to
6253 `latex-mode'.
6254
6255 *** latex-mode now has a simple indentation algorithm.
6256
6257 *** M-f and M-p jump around \begin...\end pairs.
6258
6259 *** Added support for outline-minor-mode.
6260
6261 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
6262
6263 *** RefTeX has new support for index generation. Index entries can be
6264 created with `C-c <', with completion available on index keys.
6265 Pressing `C-c /' indexes the word at the cursor with a default
6266 macro. `C-c >' compiles all index entries into an alphabetically
6267 sorted *Index* buffer which looks like the final index. Entries
6268 can be edited from that buffer.
6269
6270 *** Label and citation key selection now allow to select several
6271 items and reference them together (use `m' to mark items, `a' or
6272 `A' to use all marked entries).
6273
6274 *** reftex.el has been split into a number of smaller files to reduce
6275 memory use when only a part of RefTeX is being used.
6276
6277 *** a new command `reftex-view-crossref-from-bibtex' (bound to `C-c &'
6278 in BibTeX-mode) can be called in a BibTeX database buffer in order
6279 to show locations in LaTeX documents where a particular entry has
6280 been cited.
6281
6282 ** Emacs Lisp mode now allows multiple levels of outline headings.
6283 The level of a heading is determined from the number of leading
6284 semicolons in a heading line. Toplevel forms starting with a `('
6285 in column 1 are always made leaves.
6286
6287 ** The M-x time-stamp command (most commonly used on write-file-hooks)
6288 has the following new features:
6289
6290 *** The patterns for finding the time stamp and for updating a pattern
6291 may match text spanning multiple lines. For example, some people like
6292 to have the filename and date on separate lines. The new variable
6293 time-stamp-inserts-lines controls the matching for multi-line patterns.
6294
6295 *** More than one time stamp can be updated in the same file. This
6296 feature is useful if you need separate time stamps in a program source
6297 file to both include in formatted documentation and insert in the
6298 compiled binary. The same time-stamp will be written at each matching
6299 pattern. The variable time-stamp-count enables this new feature; it
6300 defaults to 1.
6301
6302 ** Partial Completion mode now completes environment variables in
6303 file names.
6304
6305 ** Ispell changes
6306
6307 *** The command `ispell' now spell-checks a region if
6308 transient-mark-mode is on, and the mark is active. Otherwise it
6309 spell-checks the current buffer.
6310
6311 *** Support for synchronous subprocesses - DOS/Windoze - has been
6312 added.
6313
6314 *** An "alignment error" bug was fixed when a manual spelling
6315 correction is made and re-checked.
6316
6317 *** Italian, Portuguese, and Slovak dictionary definitions have been added.
6318
6319 *** Region skipping performance has been vastly improved in some
6320 cases.
6321
6322 *** Spell checking HTML buffers has been improved and isn't so strict
6323 on syntax errors.
6324
6325 *** The buffer-local words are now always placed on a new line at the
6326 end of the buffer.
6327
6328 *** Spell checking now works in the MS-DOS version of Emacs.
6329
6330 ** Makefile mode changes
6331
6332 *** The mode now uses the abbrev table `makefile-mode-abbrev-table'.
6333
6334 *** Conditionals and include statements are now highlighted when
6335 Fontlock mode is active.
6336
6337 ** Isearch changes
6338
6339 *** Isearch now puts a call to `isearch-resume' in the command history,
6340 so that searches can be resumed.
6341
6342 *** In Isearch mode, C-M-s and C-M-r are now bound like C-s and C-r,
6343 respectively, i.e. you can repeat a regexp isearch with the same keys
6344 that started the search.
6345
6346 *** In Isearch mode, mouse-2 in the echo area now yanks the current
6347 selection into the search string rather than giving an error.
6348
6349 *** There is a new lazy highlighting feature in incremental search.
6350
6351 Lazy highlighting is switched on/off by customizing variable
6352 `isearch-lazy-highlight'. When active, all matches for the current
6353 search string are highlighted. The current match is highlighted as
6354 before using face `isearch' or `region'. All other matches are
6355 highlighted using face `isearch-lazy-highlight-face' which defaults to
6356 `secondary-selection'.
6357
6358 The extra highlighting makes it easier to anticipate where the cursor
6359 will end up each time you press C-s or C-r to repeat a pending search.
6360 Highlighting of these additional matches happens in a deferred fashion
6361 using "idle timers," so the cycles needed do not rob isearch of its
6362 usual snappy response.
6363
6364 If `isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup' is set to t, highlights for
6365 matches are automatically cleared when you end the search. If it is
6366 set to nil, you can remove the highlights manually with `M-x
6367 isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup'.
6368
6369 ** VC Changes
6370
6371 VC has been overhauled internally. It is now modular, making it
6372 easier to plug-in arbitrary version control backends. (See Lisp
6373 Changes for details on the new structure.) As a result, the mechanism
6374 to enable and disable support for particular version systems has
6375 changed: everything is now controlled by the new variable
6376 `vc-handled-backends'. Its value is a list of symbols that identify
6377 version systems; the default is '(RCS CVS SCCS). When finding a file,
6378 each of the backends in that list is tried in order to see whether the
6379 file is registered in that backend.
6380
6381 When registering a new file, VC first tries each of the listed
6382 backends to see if any of them considers itself "responsible" for the
6383 directory of the file (e.g. because a corresponding subdirectory for
6384 master files exists). If none of the backends is responsible, then
6385 the first backend in the list that could register the file is chosen.
6386 As a consequence, the variable `vc-default-back-end' is now obsolete.
6387
6388 The old variable `vc-master-templates' is also obsolete, although VC
6389 still supports it for backward compatibility. To define templates for
6390 RCS or SCCS, you should rather use the new variables
6391 vc-{rcs,sccs}-master-templates. (There is no such feature under CVS
6392 where it doesn't make sense.)
6393
6394 The variables `vc-ignore-vc-files' and `vc-handle-cvs' are also
6395 obsolete now, you must set `vc-handled-backends' to nil or exclude
6396 `CVS' from the list, respectively, to achieve their effect now.
6397
6398 *** General Changes
6399
6400 The variable `vc-checkout-carefully' is obsolete: the corresponding
6401 checks are always done now.
6402
6403 VC Dired buffers are now kept up-to-date during all version control
6404 operations.
6405
6406 `vc-diff' output is now displayed in `diff-mode'.
6407 `vc-print-log' uses `log-view-mode'.
6408 `vc-log-mode' (used for *VC-Log*) has been replaced by `log-edit-mode'.
6409
6410 The command C-x v m (vc-merge) now accepts an empty argument as the
6411 first revision number. This means that any recent changes on the
6412 current branch should be picked up from the repository and merged into
6413 the working file (``merge news'').
6414
6415 The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
6416 (vc-retrieve-snapshot) now ask for a directory name from which to work
6417 downwards.
6418
6419 *** Multiple Backends
6420
6421 VC now lets you register files in more than one backend. This is
6422 useful, for example, if you are working with a slow remote CVS
6423 repository. You can then use RCS for local editing, and occasionally
6424 commit your changes back to CVS, or pick up changes from CVS into your
6425 local RCS archives.
6426
6427 To make this work, the ``more local'' backend (RCS in our example)
6428 should come first in `vc-handled-backends', and the ``more remote''
6429 backend (CVS) should come later. (The default value of
6430 `vc-handled-backends' already has it that way.)
6431
6432 You can then commit changes to another backend (say, RCS), by typing
6433 C-u C-x v v RCS RET (i.e. vc-next-action now accepts a backend name as
6434 a revision number). VC registers the file in the more local backend
6435 if that hasn't already happened, and commits to a branch based on the
6436 current revision number from the more remote backend.
6437
6438 If a file is registered in multiple backends, you can switch to
6439 another one using C-x v b (vc-switch-backend). This does not change
6440 any files, it only changes VC's perspective on the file. Use this to
6441 pick up changes from CVS while working under RCS locally.
6442
6443 After you are done with your local RCS editing, you can commit your
6444 changes back to CVS using C-u C-x v v CVS RET. In this case, the
6445 local RCS archive is removed after the commit, and the log entry
6446 buffer is initialized to contain the entire RCS change log of the file.
6447
6448 *** Changes for CVS
6449
6450 There is a new user option, `vc-cvs-stay-local'. If it is `t' (the
6451 default), then VC avoids network queries for files registered in
6452 remote repositories. The state of such files is then only determined
6453 by heuristics and past information. `vc-cvs-stay-local' can also be a
6454 regexp to match against repository hostnames; only files from hosts
6455 that match it are treated locally. If the variable is nil, then VC
6456 queries the repository just as often as it does for local files.
6457
6458 If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, then VC also makes local backups of
6459 repository versions. This means that ordinary diffs (C-x v =) and
6460 revert operations (C-x v u) can be done completely locally, without
6461 any repository interactions at all. The name of a local version
6462 backup of FILE is FILE.~REV.~, where REV is the repository version
6463 number. This format is similar to that used by C-x v ~
6464 (vc-version-other-window), except for the trailing dot. As a matter
6465 of fact, the two features can each use the files created by the other,
6466 the only difference being that files with a trailing `.' are deleted
6467 automatically after commit. (This feature doesn't work on MS-DOS,
6468 since DOS disallows more than a single dot in the trunk of a file
6469 name.)
6470
6471 If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, and there have been changes in the
6472 repository, VC notifies you about it when you actually try to commit.
6473 If you want to check for updates from the repository without trying to
6474 commit, you can either use C-x v m RET to perform an update on the
6475 current file, or you can use C-x v r RET to get an update for an
6476 entire directory tree.
6477
6478 The new user option `vc-cvs-use-edit' indicates whether VC should call
6479 "cvs edit" to make files writeable; it defaults to `t'. (This option
6480 is only meaningful if the CVSREAD variable is set, or if files are
6481 "watched" by other developers.)
6482
6483 The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
6484 (vc-retrieve-snapshot) are now also implemented for CVS. If you give
6485 an empty snapshot name to the latter, that performs a `cvs update',
6486 starting at the given directory.
6487
6488 *** Lisp Changes in VC
6489
6490 VC has been restructured internally to make it modular. You can now
6491 add support for arbitrary version control backends by writing a
6492 library that provides a certain set of backend-specific functions, and
6493 then telling VC to use that library. For example, to add support for
6494 a version system named SYS, you write a library named vc-sys.el, which
6495 provides a number of functions vc-sys-... (see commentary at the top
6496 of vc.el for a detailed list of them). To make VC use that library,
6497 you need to put it somewhere into Emacs' load path and add the symbol
6498 `SYS' to the list `vc-handled-backends'.
6499
6500 ** The customizable EDT emulation package now supports the EDT
6501 SUBS command and EDT scroll margins. It also works with more
6502 terminal/keyboard configurations and it now works under XEmacs.
6503 See etc/edt-user.doc for more information.
6504
6505 ** New modes and packages
6506
6507 *** The new global minor mode `minibuffer-electric-default-mode'
6508 automatically hides the `(default ...)' part of minibuffer prompts when
6509 the default is not applicable.
6510
6511 *** Artist is an Emacs lisp package that allows you to draw lines,
6512 rectangles and ellipses by using your mouse and/or keyboard. The
6513 shapes are made up with the ascii characters |, -, / and \.
6514
6515 Features are:
6516
6517 - Intersecting: When a `|' intersects with a `-', a `+' is
6518 drawn, like this: | \ /
6519 --+-- X
6520 | / \
6521
6522 - Rubber-banding: When drawing lines you can interactively see the
6523 result while holding the mouse button down and moving the mouse. If
6524 your machine is not fast enough (a 386 is a bit too slow, but a
6525 pentium is well enough), you can turn this feature off. You will
6526 then see 1's and 2's which mark the 1st and 2nd endpoint of the line
6527 you are drawing.
6528
6529 - Arrows: After having drawn a (straight) line or a (straight)
6530 poly-line, you can set arrows on the line-ends by typing < or >.
6531
6532 - Flood-filling: You can fill any area with a certain character by
6533 flood-filling.
6534
6535 - Cut copy and paste: You can cut, copy and paste rectangular
6536 regions. Artist also interfaces with the rect package (this can be
6537 turned off if it causes you any trouble) so anything you cut in
6538 artist can be yanked with C-x r y and vice versa.
6539
6540 - Drawing with keys: Everything you can do with the mouse, you can
6541 also do without the mouse.
6542
6543 - Aspect-ratio: You can set the variable artist-aspect-ratio to
6544 reflect the height-width ratio for the font you are using. Squares
6545 and circles are then drawn square/round. Note, that once your
6546 ascii-file is shown with font with a different height-width ratio,
6547 the squares won't be square and the circles won't be round.
6548
6549 - Drawing operations: The following drawing operations are implemented:
6550
6551 lines straight-lines
6552 rectangles squares
6553 poly-lines straight poly-lines
6554 ellipses circles
6555 text (see-thru) text (overwrite)
6556 spray-can setting size for spraying
6557 vaporize line vaporize lines
6558 erase characters erase rectangles
6559
6560 Straight lines are lines that go horizontally, vertically or
6561 diagonally. Plain lines go in any direction. The operations in
6562 the right column are accessed by holding down the shift key while
6563 drawing.
6564
6565 It is possible to vaporize (erase) entire lines and connected lines
6566 (rectangles for example) as long as the lines being vaporized are
6567 straight and connected at their endpoints. Vaporizing is inspired
6568 by the drawrect package by Jari Aalto <jari.aalto@poboxes.com>.
6569
6570 - Picture mode compatibility: Artist is picture mode compatible (this
6571 can be turned off).
6572
6573 *** The new package Eshell is an operating system command shell
6574 implemented entirely in Emacs Lisp. Use `M-x eshell' to invoke it.
6575 It functions similarly to bash and zsh, and allows running of Lisp
6576 functions and external commands using the same syntax. It supports
6577 history lists, aliases, extended globbing, smart scrolling, etc. It
6578 will work on any platform Emacs has been ported to. And since most of
6579 the basic commands -- ls, rm, mv, cp, ln, du, cat, etc. -- have been
6580 rewritten in Lisp, it offers an operating-system independent shell,
6581 all within the scope of your Emacs process.
6582
6583 *** The new package timeclock.el is a mode is for keeping track of time
6584 intervals. You can use it for whatever purpose you like, but the
6585 typical scenario is to keep track of how much time you spend working
6586 on certain projects.
6587
6588 *** The new package hi-lock.el provides commands to highlight matches
6589 of interactively entered regexps. For example,
6590
6591 M-x highlight-regexp RET clearly RET RET
6592
6593 will highlight all occurrences of `clearly' using a yellow background
6594 face. New occurrences of `clearly' will be highlighted as they are
6595 typed. `M-x unhighlight-regexp RET' will remove the highlighting.
6596 Any existing face can be used for highlighting and a set of
6597 appropriate faces is provided. The regexps can be written into the
6598 current buffer in a form that will be recognized the next time the
6599 corresponding file is read. There are commands to highlight matches
6600 to phrases and to highlight entire lines containing a match.
6601
6602 *** The new package zone.el plays games with Emacs' display when
6603 Emacs is idle.
6604
6605 *** The new package tildify.el allows to add hard spaces or other text
6606 fragments in accordance with the current major mode.
6607
6608 *** The new package xml.el provides a simple but generic XML
6609 parser. It doesn't parse the DTDs however.
6610
6611 *** The comment operations are now provided by the newcomment.el
6612 package which allows different styles of comment-region and should
6613 be more robust while offering the same functionality.
6614 `comment-region' now doesn't always comment a-line-at-a-time, but only
6615 comments the region, breaking the line at point if necessary.
6616
6617 *** The Ebrowse package implements a C++ class browser and tags
6618 facilities tailored for use with C++. It is documented in a
6619 separate Texinfo file.
6620
6621 *** The PCL-CVS package available by either running M-x cvs-examine or
6622 by visiting a CVS administrative directory (with a prefix argument)
6623 provides an alternative interface to VC-dired for CVS. It comes with
6624 `log-view-mode' to view RCS and SCCS logs and `log-edit-mode' used to
6625 enter check-in log messages.
6626
6627 *** The new package called `woman' allows to browse Unix man pages
6628 without invoking external programs.
6629
6630 The command `M-x woman' formats manual pages entirely in Emacs Lisp
6631 and then displays them, like `M-x manual-entry' does. Unlike
6632 `manual-entry', `woman' does not invoke any external programs, so it
6633 is useful on systems such as MS-DOS/MS-Windows where the `man' and
6634 Groff or `troff' commands are not readily available.
6635
6636 The command `M-x woman-find-file' asks for the file name of a man
6637 page, then formats and displays it like `M-x woman' does.
6638
6639 *** The new command M-x re-builder offers a convenient interface for
6640 authoring regular expressions with immediate visual feedback.
6641
6642 The buffer from which the command was called becomes the target for
6643 the regexp editor popping up in a separate window. Matching text in
6644 the target buffer is immediately color marked during the editing.
6645 Each sub-expression of the regexp will show up in a different face so
6646 even complex regexps can be edited and verified on target data in a
6647 single step.
6648
6649 On displays not supporting faces the matches instead blink like
6650 matching parens to make them stand out. On such a setup you will
6651 probably also want to use the sub-expression mode when the regexp
6652 contains such to get feedback about their respective limits.
6653
6654 *** glasses-mode is a minor mode that makes
6655 unreadableIdentifiersLikeThis readable. It works as glasses, without
6656 actually modifying content of a buffer.
6657
6658 *** The package ebnf2ps translates an EBNF to a syntactic chart in
6659 PostScript.
6660
6661 Currently accepts ad-hoc EBNF, ISO EBNF and Bison/Yacc.
6662
6663 The ad-hoc default EBNF syntax has the following elements:
6664
6665 ; comment (until end of line)
6666 A non-terminal
6667 "C" terminal
6668 ?C? special
6669 $A default non-terminal
6670 $"C" default terminal
6671 $?C? default special
6672 A = B. production (A is the header and B the body)
6673 C D sequence (C occurs before D)
6674 C | D alternative (C or D occurs)
6675 A - B exception (A excluding B, B without any non-terminal)
6676 n * A repetition (A repeats n (integer) times)
6677 (C) group (expression C is grouped together)
6678 [C] optional (C may or not occurs)
6679 C+ one or more occurrences of C
6680 {C}+ one or more occurrences of C
6681 {C}* zero or more occurrences of C
6682 {C} zero or more occurrences of C
6683 C / D equivalent to: C {D C}*
6684 {C || D}+ equivalent to: C {D C}*
6685 {C || D}* equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
6686 {C || D} equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
6687
6688 Please, see ebnf2ps documentation for EBNF syntax and how to use it.
6689
6690 *** The package align.el will align columns within a region, using M-x
6691 align. Its mode-specific rules, based on regular expressions,
6692 determine where the columns should be split. In C and C++, for
6693 example, it will align variable names in declaration lists, or the
6694 equal signs of assignments.
6695
6696 *** `paragraph-indent-minor-mode' is a new minor mode supporting
6697 paragraphs in the same style as `paragraph-indent-text-mode'.
6698
6699 *** bs.el is a new package for buffer selection similar to
6700 list-buffers or electric-buffer-list. Use M-x bs-show to display a
6701 buffer menu with this package. See the Custom group `bs'.
6702
6703 *** find-lisp.el is a package emulating the Unix find command in Lisp.
6704
6705 *** calculator.el is a small calculator package that is intended to
6706 replace desktop calculators such as xcalc and calc.exe. Actually, it
6707 is not too small - it has more features than most desktop calculators,
6708 and can be customized easily to get many more functions. It should
6709 not be confused with "calc" which is a much bigger mathematical tool
6710 which answers different needs.
6711
6712 *** The minor modes cwarn-mode and global-cwarn-mode highlights
6713 suspicious C and C++ constructions. Currently, assignments inside
6714 expressions, semicolon following `if', `for' and `while' (except, of
6715 course, after a `do .. while' statement), and C++ functions with
6716 reference parameters are recognized. The modes require font-lock mode
6717 to be enabled.
6718
6719 *** smerge-mode.el provides `smerge-mode', a simple minor-mode for files
6720 containing diff3-style conflict markers, such as generated by RCS.
6721
6722 *** 5x5.el is a simple puzzle game.
6723
6724 *** hl-line.el provides `hl-line-mode', a minor mode to highlight the
6725 current line in the current buffer. It also provides
6726 `global-hl-line-mode' to provide the same behavior in all buffers.
6727
6728 *** ansi-color.el translates ANSI terminal escapes into text-properties.
6729
6730 Please note: if `ansi-color-for-comint-mode' and
6731 `global-font-lock-mode' are non-nil, loading ansi-color.el will
6732 disable font-lock and add `ansi-color-apply' to
6733 `comint-preoutput-filter-functions' for all shell-mode buffers. This
6734 displays the output of "ls --color=yes" using the correct foreground
6735 and background colors.
6736
6737 *** delphi.el provides a major mode for editing the Delphi (Object
6738 Pascal) language.
6739
6740 *** quickurl.el provides a simple method of inserting a URL based on
6741 the text at point.
6742
6743 *** sql.el provides an interface to SQL data bases.
6744
6745 *** fortune.el uses the fortune program to create mail/news signatures.
6746
6747 *** whitespace.el is a package for warning about and cleaning bogus
6748 whitespace in a file.
6749
6750 *** PostScript mode (ps-mode) is a new major mode for editing PostScript
6751 files. It offers: interaction with a PostScript interpreter, including
6752 (very basic) error handling; fontification, easily customizable for
6753 interpreter messages; auto-indentation; insertion of EPSF templates and
6754 often used code snippets; viewing of BoundingBox; commenting out /
6755 uncommenting regions; conversion of 8bit characters to PostScript octal
6756 codes. All functionality is accessible through a menu.
6757
6758 *** delim-col helps to prettify columns in a text region or rectangle.
6759
6760 Here is an example of columns:
6761
6762 horse apple bus
6763 dog pineapple car EXTRA
6764 porcupine strawberry airplane
6765
6766 Doing the following settings:
6767
6768 (setq delimit-columns-str-before "[ ")
6769 (setq delimit-columns-str-after " ]")
6770 (setq delimit-columns-str-separator ", ")
6771 (setq delimit-columns-separator "\t")
6772
6773
6774 Selecting the lines above and typing:
6775
6776 M-x delimit-columns-region
6777
6778 It results:
6779
6780 [ horse , apple , bus , ]
6781 [ dog , pineapple , car , EXTRA ]
6782 [ porcupine, strawberry, airplane, ]
6783
6784 delim-col has the following options:
6785
6786 delimit-columns-str-before Specify a string to be inserted
6787 before all columns.
6788
6789 delimit-columns-str-separator Specify a string to be inserted
6790 between each column.
6791
6792 delimit-columns-str-after Specify a string to be inserted
6793 after all columns.
6794
6795 delimit-columns-separator Specify a regexp which separates
6796 each column.
6797
6798 delim-col has the following commands:
6799
6800 delimit-columns-region Prettify all columns in a text region.
6801 delimit-columns-rectangle Prettify all columns in a text rectangle.
6802
6803 *** Recentf mode maintains a menu for visiting files that were
6804 operated on recently. User option recentf-menu-filter specifies a
6805 menu filter function to change the menu appearance. For example, the
6806 recent file list can be displayed:
6807
6808 - organized by major modes, directories or user defined rules.
6809 - sorted by file paths, file names, ascending or descending.
6810 - showing paths relative to the current default-directory
6811
6812 The `recentf-filter-changer' menu filter function allows to
6813 dynamically change the menu appearance.
6814
6815 *** elide-head.el provides a mechanism for eliding boilerplate header
6816 text.
6817
6818 *** footnote.el provides `footnote-mode', a minor mode supporting use
6819 of footnotes. It is intended for use with Message mode, but isn't
6820 specific to Message mode.
6821
6822 *** diff-mode.el provides `diff-mode', a major mode for
6823 viewing/editing context diffs (patches). It is selected for files
6824 with extension `.diff', `.diffs', `.patch' and `.rej'.
6825
6826 *** EUDC, the Emacs Unified Directory Client, provides a common user
6827 interface to access directory servers using different directory
6828 protocols. It has a separate manual.
6829
6830 *** autoconf.el provides a major mode for editing configure.in files
6831 for Autoconf, selected automatically.
6832
6833 *** windmove.el provides moving between windows.
6834
6835 *** crm.el provides a facility to read multiple strings from the
6836 minibuffer with completion.
6837
6838 *** todo-mode.el provides management of TODO lists and integration
6839 with the diary features.
6840
6841 *** autoarg.el provides a feature reported from Twenex Emacs whereby
6842 numeric keys supply prefix args rather than self inserting.
6843
6844 *** The function `turn-off-auto-fill' unconditionally turns off Auto
6845 Fill mode.
6846
6847 *** pcomplete.el is a library that provides programmable completion
6848 facilities for Emacs, similar to what zsh and tcsh offer. The main
6849 difference is that completion functions are written in Lisp, meaning
6850 they can be profiled, debugged, etc.
6851
6852 *** antlr-mode is a new major mode for editing ANTLR grammar files.
6853 It is automatically turned on for files whose names have the extension
6854 `.g'.
6855
6856 ** Changes in sort.el
6857
6858 The function sort-numeric-fields interprets numbers starting with `0'
6859 as octal and numbers starting with `0x' or `0X' as hexadecimal. The
6860 new user-option sort-numeric-base can be used to specify a default
6861 numeric base.
6862
6863 ** Changes to Ange-ftp
6864
6865 *** Ange-ftp allows you to specify of a port number in remote file
6866 names cleanly. It is appended to the host name, separated by a hash
6867 sign, e.g. `/foo@bar.org#666:mumble'. (This syntax comes from EFS.)
6868
6869 *** If the new user-option `ange-ftp-try-passive-mode' is set, passive
6870 ftp mode will be used if the ftp client supports that.
6871
6872 *** Ange-ftp handles the output of the w32-style clients which
6873 output ^M at the end of lines.
6874
6875 ** The recommended way of using Iswitchb is via the new global minor
6876 mode `iswitchb-mode'.
6877
6878 ** Just loading the msb package doesn't switch on Msb mode anymore.
6879 If you have `(require 'msb)' in your .emacs, please replace it with
6880 `(msb-mode 1)'.
6881
6882 ** Flyspell mode has various new options. See the `flyspell' Custom
6883 group.
6884
6885 ** The user option `backward-delete-char-untabify-method' controls the
6886 behavior of `backward-delete-char-untabify'. The following values
6887 are recognized:
6888
6889 `untabify' -- turn a tab to many spaces, then delete one space;
6890 `hungry' -- delete all whitespace, both tabs and spaces;
6891 `all' -- delete all whitespace, including tabs, spaces and newlines;
6892 nil -- just delete one character.
6893
6894 Default value is `untabify'.
6895
6896 [This change was made in Emacs 20.3 but not mentioned then.]
6897
6898 ** In Cperl mode `cperl-invalid-face' should now be a normal face
6899 symbol, not double-quoted.
6900
6901 ** Some packages are declared obsolete, to be removed in a future
6902 version. They are: auto-show, c-mode, hilit19, hscroll, ooutline,
6903 profile, rnews, rnewspost, and sc. Their implementations have been
6904 moved to lisp/obsolete.
6905
6906 ** auto-compression mode is no longer enabled just by loading jka-compr.el.
6907 To control it, set `auto-compression-mode' via Custom or use the
6908 `auto-compression-mode' command.
6909
6910 ** `browse-url-gnome-moz' is a new option for
6911 `browse-url-browser-function', invoking Mozilla in GNOME, and
6912 `browse-url-kde' can be chosen for invoking the KDE browser.
6913
6914 ** The user-option `browse-url-new-window-p' has been renamed to
6915 `browse-url-new-window-flag'.
6916
6917 ** The functions `keep-lines', `flush-lines' and `how-many' now
6918 operate on the active region in Transient Mark mode.
6919
6920 ** `gnus-user-agent' is a new possibility for `mail-user-agent'. It
6921 is like `message-user-agent', but with all the Gnus paraphernalia.
6922
6923 ** The Strokes package has been updated. If your Emacs has XPM
6924 support, you can use it for pictographic editing. In Strokes mode,
6925 use C-mouse-2 to compose a complex stoke and insert it into the
6926 buffer. You can encode or decode a strokes buffer with new commands
6927 M-x strokes-encode-buffer and M-x strokes-decode-buffer. There is a
6928 new command M-x strokes-list-strokes.
6929
6930 ** Hexl contains a new command `hexl-insert-hex-string' which inserts
6931 a string of hexadecimal numbers read from the mini-buffer.
6932
6933 ** Hexl mode allows to insert non-ASCII characters.
6934
6935 The non-ASCII characters are encoded using the same encoding as the
6936 file you are visiting in Hexl mode.
6937
6938 ** Shell script mode changes.
6939
6940 Shell script mode (sh-script) can now indent scripts for shells
6941 derived from sh and rc. The indentation style is customizable, and
6942 sh-script can attempt to "learn" the current buffer's style.
6943
6944 ** Etags changes.
6945
6946 *** In DOS, etags looks for file.cgz if it cannot find file.c.
6947
6948 *** New option --ignore-case-regex is an alternative to --regex. It is now
6949 possible to bind a regexp to a language, by prepending the regexp with
6950 {lang}, where lang is one of the languages that `etags --help' prints out.
6951 This feature is useful especially for regex files, where each line contains
6952 a regular expression. The manual contains details.
6953
6954 *** In C and derived languages, etags creates tags for function
6955 declarations when given the --declarations option.
6956
6957 *** In C++, tags are created for "operator". The tags have the form
6958 "operator+", without spaces between the keyword and the operator.
6959
6960 *** You shouldn't generally need any more the -C or -c++ option: etags
6961 automatically switches to C++ parsing when it meets the `class' or
6962 `template' keywords.
6963
6964 *** Etags now is able to delve at arbitrary deeps into nested structures in
6965 C-like languages. Previously, it was limited to one or two brace levels.
6966
6967 *** New language Ada: tags are functions, procedures, packages, tasks, and
6968 types.
6969
6970 *** In Fortran, `procedure' is not tagged.
6971
6972 *** In Java, tags are created for "interface".
6973
6974 *** In Lisp, "(defstruct (foo", "(defun (operator" and similar constructs
6975 are now tagged.
6976
6977 *** In makefiles, tags the targets.
6978
6979 *** In Perl, the --globals option tags global variables. my and local
6980 variables are tagged.
6981
6982 *** New language Python: def and class at the beginning of a line are tags.
6983
6984 *** .ss files are Scheme files, .pdb is Postscript with C syntax, .psw is
6985 for PSWrap.
6986
6987 ** Changes in etags.el
6988
6989 *** The new user-option tags-case-fold-search can be used to make
6990 tags operations case-sensitive or case-insensitive. The default
6991 is to use the same setting as case-fold-search.
6992
6993 *** You can display additional output with M-x tags-apropos by setting
6994 the new variable tags-apropos-additional-actions.
6995
6996 If non-nil, the variable's value should be a list of triples (TITLE
6997 FUNCTION TO-SEARCH). For each triple, M-x tags-apropos processes
6998 TO-SEARCH and lists tags from it. TO-SEARCH should be an alist,
6999 obarray, or symbol. If it is a symbol, the symbol's value is used.
7000
7001 TITLE is a string to use to label the list of tags from TO-SEARCH.
7002
7003 FUNCTION is a function to call when an entry is selected in the Tags
7004 List buffer. It is called with one argument, the selected symbol.
7005
7006 A useful example value for this variable might be something like:
7007
7008 '(("Emacs Lisp" Info-goto-emacs-command-node obarray)
7009 ("Common Lisp" common-lisp-hyperspec common-lisp-hyperspec-obarray)
7010 ("SCWM" scwm-documentation scwm-obarray))
7011
7012 *** The face tags-tag-face can be used to customize the appearance
7013 of tags in the output of M-x tags-apropos.
7014
7015 *** Setting tags-apropos-verbose to a non-nil value displays the
7016 names of tags files in the *Tags List* buffer.
7017
7018 *** You can now search for tags that are part of the filename itself.
7019 If you have tagged the files topfile.c subdir/subfile.c
7020 /tmp/tempfile.c, you can now search for tags "topfile.c", "subfile.c",
7021 "dir/sub", "tempfile", "tempfile.c". If the tag matches the file name,
7022 point will go to the beginning of the file.
7023
7024 *** Compressed files are now transparently supported if
7025 auto-compression-mode is active. You can tag (with Etags) and search
7026 (with find-tag) both compressed and uncompressed files.
7027
7028 *** Tags commands like M-x tags-search no longer change point
7029 in buffers where no match is found. In buffers where a match is
7030 found, the original value of point is pushed on the marker ring.
7031
7032 ** Fortran mode has a new command `fortran-strip-sequence-nos' to
7033 remove text past column 72. The syntax class of `\' in Fortran is now
7034 appropriate for C-style escape sequences in strings.
7035
7036 ** SGML mode's default `sgml-validate-command' is now `nsgmls'.
7037
7038 ** A new command `view-emacs-problems' (C-h P) displays the PROBLEMS file.
7039
7040 ** The Dabbrev package has a new user-option `dabbrev-ignored-regexps'
7041 containing a list of regular expressions. Buffers matching a regular
7042 expression from that list, are not checked.
7043
7044 ** Emacs can now figure out modification times of remote files.
7045 When you do C-x C-f /user@host:/path/file RET and edit the file,
7046 and someone else modifies the file, you will be prompted to revert
7047 the buffer, just like for the local files.
7048
7049 ** The buffer menu (C-x C-b) no longer lists the *Buffer List* buffer.
7050
7051 ** When invoked with a prefix argument, the command `list-abbrevs' now
7052 displays local abbrevs, only.
7053
7054 ** Refill minor mode provides preliminary support for keeping
7055 paragraphs filled as you modify them.
7056
7057 ** The variable `double-click-fuzz' specifies how much the mouse
7058 may be moved between clicks that are recognized as a pair. Its value
7059 is measured in pixels.
7060
7061 ** The new global minor mode `auto-image-file-mode' allows image files
7062 to be visited as images.
7063
7064 ** Two new user-options `grep-command' and `grep-find-command'
7065 were added to compile.el.
7066
7067 ** Withdrawn packages
7068
7069 *** mldrag.el has been removed. mouse.el provides the same
7070 functionality with aliases for the mldrag functions.
7071
7072 *** eval-reg.el has been obsoleted by changes to edebug.el and removed.
7073
7074 *** ph.el has been obsoleted by EUDC and removed.
7075
7076 \f
7077 * Incompatible Lisp changes
7078
7079 There are a few Lisp changes which are not backwards-compatible and
7080 may require changes to existing code. Here is a list for reference.
7081 See the sections below for details.
7082
7083 ** Since `format' preserves text properties, the idiom
7084 `(format "%s" foo)' no longer works to copy and remove properties.
7085 Use `copy-sequence' to copy the string, then use `set-text-properties'
7086 to remove the properties of the copy.
7087
7088 ** Since the `keymap' text property now has significance, some code
7089 which uses both `local-map' and `keymap' properties (for portability)
7090 may, for instance, give rise to duplicate menus when the keymaps from
7091 these properties are active.
7092
7093 ** The change in the treatment of non-ASCII characters in search
7094 ranges may affect some code.
7095
7096 ** A non-nil value for the LOCAL arg of add-hook makes the hook
7097 buffer-local even if `make-local-hook' hasn't been called, which might
7098 make a difference to some code.
7099
7100 ** The new treatment of the minibuffer prompt might affect code which
7101 operates on the minibuffer.
7102
7103 ** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
7104 cause `no-conversion' and `emacs-mule-unix' coding systems to produce
7105 different results when reading files with non-ASCII characters
7106 (previously, both coding systems would produce the same results).
7107 Specifically, `no-conversion' interprets each 8-bit byte as a separate
7108 character. This makes `no-conversion' inappropriate for reading
7109 multibyte text, e.g. buffers written to disk in their internal MULE
7110 encoding (auto-saving does that, for example). If a Lisp program
7111 reads such files with `no-conversion', each byte of the multibyte
7112 sequence, including the MULE leading codes such as \201, is treated as
7113 a separate character, which prevents them from being interpreted in
7114 the buffer as multibyte characters.
7115
7116 Therefore, Lisp programs that read files which contain the internal
7117 MULE encoding should use `emacs-mule-unix'. `no-conversion' is only
7118 appropriate for reading truly binary files.
7119
7120 ** Code that relies on the obsolete `before-change-function' and
7121 `after-change-function' to detect buffer changes will now fail. Use
7122 `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions' instead.
7123
7124 ** Code that uses `concat' with integer args now gets an error, as
7125 long promised. So does any code that uses derivatives of `concat',
7126 such as `mapconcat'.
7127
7128 ** The function base64-decode-string now always returns a unibyte
7129 string.
7130
7131 ** Not a Lisp incompatibility as such but, with the introduction of
7132 extra private charsets, there is now only one slot free for a new
7133 dimension-2 private charset. User code which tries to add more than
7134 one extra will fail unless you rebuild Emacs with some standard
7135 charset(s) removed; that is probably inadvisable because it changes
7136 the emacs-mule encoding. Also, files stored in the emacs-mule
7137 encoding using Emacs 20 with additional private charsets defined will
7138 probably not be read correctly by Emacs 21.
7139
7140 ** The variable `directory-sep-char' is slated for removal.
7141 Not really a change (yet), but a projected one that you should be
7142 aware of: The variable `directory-sep-char' is deprecated, and should
7143 not be used. It was always ignored on GNU/Linux and Unix systems and
7144 on MS-DOS, but the MS-Windows port tried to support it by adapting the
7145 behavior of certain primitives to the value of this variable. It
7146 turned out that such support cannot be reliable, so it was decided to
7147 remove this variable in the near future. Lisp programs are well
7148 advised not to set it to anything but '/', because any different value
7149 will not have any effect when support for this variable is removed.
7150
7151 \f
7152 * Lisp changes made after edition 2.6 of the Emacs Lisp Manual,
7153 (Display-related features are described in a page of their own below.)
7154
7155 ** Function assq-delete-all replaces function assoc-delete-all.
7156
7157 ** The new function animate-string, from lisp/play/animate.el
7158 allows the animated display of strings.
7159
7160 ** The new function `interactive-form' can be used to obtain the
7161 interactive form of a function.
7162
7163 ** The keyword :set-after in defcustom allows to specify dependencies
7164 between custom options. Example:
7165
7166 (defcustom default-input-method nil
7167 "*Default input method for multilingual text (a string).
7168 This is the input method activated automatically by the command
7169 `toggle-input-method' (\\[toggle-input-method])."
7170 :group 'mule
7171 :type '(choice (const nil) string)
7172 :set-after '(current-language-environment))
7173
7174 This specifies that default-input-method should be set after
7175 current-language-environment even if default-input-method appears
7176 first in a custom-set-variables statement.
7177
7178 ** The new hook `kbd-macro-termination-hook' is run at the end of
7179 function execute-kbd-macro. Functions on this hook are called with no
7180 args. The hook is run independent of how the macro was terminated
7181 (signal or normal termination).
7182
7183 ** Functions `butlast' and `nbutlast' for removing trailing elements
7184 from a list are now available without requiring the CL package.
7185
7186 ** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
7187 to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
7188
7189 ** The user-option `face-font-registry-alternatives' specifies
7190 alternative font registry names to try when looking for a font.
7191
7192 ** Function `md5' calculates the MD5 "message digest"/"checksum".
7193
7194 ** Function `delete-frame' runs `delete-frame-hook' before actually
7195 deleting the frame. The hook is called with one arg, the frame
7196 being deleted.
7197
7198 ** `add-hook' now makes the hook local if called with a non-nil LOCAL arg.
7199
7200 ** The treatment of non-ASCII characters in search ranges has changed.
7201 If a range in a regular expression or the arg of
7202 skip-chars-forward/backward starts with a unibyte character C and ends
7203 with a multibyte character C2, the range is divided into two: one is
7204 C..?\377, the other is C1..C2, where C1 is the first character of C2's
7205 charset.
7206
7207 ** The new function `display-message-or-buffer' displays a message in
7208 the echo area or pops up a buffer, depending on the length of the
7209 message.
7210
7211 ** The new macro `with-auto-compression-mode' allows evaluating an
7212 expression with auto-compression-mode enabled.
7213
7214 ** In image specifications, `:heuristic-mask' has been replaced
7215 with the more general `:mask' property.
7216
7217 ** Image specifications accept more `:conversion's.
7218
7219 ** A `?' can be used in a symbol name without escaping it with a
7220 backslash.
7221
7222 ** Reading from the mini-buffer now reads from standard input if Emacs
7223 is running in batch mode. For example,
7224
7225 (message "%s" (read t))
7226
7227 will read a Lisp expression from standard input and print the result
7228 to standard output.
7229
7230 ** The argument of `down-list', `backward-up-list', `up-list',
7231 `kill-sexp', `backward-kill-sexp' and `mark-sexp' is now optional.
7232
7233 ** If `display-buffer-reuse-frames' is set, function `display-buffer'
7234 will raise frames displaying a buffer, instead of creating a new
7235 frame or window.
7236
7237 ** Two new functions for removing elements from lists/sequences
7238 were added
7239
7240 - Function: remove ELT SEQ
7241
7242 Return a copy of SEQ with all occurrences of ELT removed. SEQ must be
7243 a list, vector, or string. The comparison is done with `equal'.
7244
7245 - Function: remq ELT LIST
7246
7247 Return a copy of LIST with all occurrences of ELT removed. The
7248 comparison is done with `eq'.
7249
7250 ** The function `delete' now also works with vectors and strings.
7251
7252 ** The meaning of the `:weakness WEAK' argument of make-hash-table
7253 has been changed: WEAK can now have new values `key-or-value' and
7254 `key-and-value', in addition to `nil', `key', `value', and `t'.
7255
7256 ** Function `aset' stores any multibyte character in any string
7257 without signaling "Attempt to change char length of a string". It may
7258 convert a unibyte string to multibyte if necessary.
7259
7260 ** The value of the `help-echo' text property is called as a function
7261 or evaluated, if it is not a string already, to obtain a help string.
7262
7263 ** Function `make-obsolete' now has an optional arg to say when the
7264 function was declared obsolete.
7265
7266 ** Function `plist-member' is renamed from `widget-plist-member' (which is
7267 retained as an alias).
7268
7269 ** Easy-menu's :filter now takes the unconverted form of the menu and
7270 the result is automatically converted to Emacs' form.
7271
7272 ** The new function `window-list' has been defined
7273
7274 - Function: window-list &optional FRAME WINDOW MINIBUF
7275
7276 Return a list of windows on FRAME, starting with WINDOW. FRAME nil or
7277 omitted means use the selected frame. WINDOW nil or omitted means use
7278 the selected window. MINIBUF t means include the minibuffer window,
7279 even if it isn't active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means include the
7280 minibuffer window only if it's active. MINIBUF neither nil nor t
7281 means never include the minibuffer window.
7282
7283 ** There's a new function `get-window-with-predicate' defined as follows
7284
7285 - Function: get-window-with-predicate PREDICATE &optional MINIBUF ALL-FRAMES DEFAULT
7286
7287 Return a window satisfying PREDICATE.
7288
7289 This function cycles through all visible windows using `walk-windows',
7290 calling PREDICATE on each one. PREDICATE is called with a window as
7291 argument. The first window for which PREDICATE returns a non-nil
7292 value is returned. If no window satisfies PREDICATE, DEFAULT is
7293 returned.
7294
7295 Optional second arg MINIBUF t means count the minibuffer window even
7296 if not active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means count the minibuffer iff
7297 it is active. MINIBUF neither t nor nil means not to count the
7298 minibuffer even if it is active.
7299
7300 Several frames may share a single minibuffer; if the minibuffer
7301 counts, all windows on all frames that share that minibuffer count
7302 too. Therefore, if you are using a separate minibuffer frame
7303 and the minibuffer is active and MINIBUF says it counts,
7304 `walk-windows' includes the windows in the frame from which you
7305 entered the minibuffer, as well as the minibuffer window.
7306
7307 ALL-FRAMES is the optional third argument.
7308 ALL-FRAMES nil or omitted means cycle within the frames as specified above.
7309 ALL-FRAMES = `visible' means include windows on all visible frames.
7310 ALL-FRAMES = 0 means include windows on all visible and iconified frames.
7311 ALL-FRAMES = t means include windows on all frames including invisible frames.
7312 If ALL-FRAMES is a frame, it means include windows on that frame.
7313 Anything else means restrict to the selected frame.
7314
7315 ** The function `single-key-description' now encloses function key and
7316 event names in angle brackets. When called with a second optional
7317 argument non-nil, angle brackets won't be printed.
7318
7319 ** If the variable `message-truncate-lines' is bound to t around a
7320 call to `message', the echo area will not be resized to display that
7321 message; it will be truncated instead, as it was done in 20.x.
7322 Default value is nil.
7323
7324 ** The user option `line-number-display-limit' can now be set to nil,
7325 meaning no limit.
7326
7327 ** The new user option `line-number-display-limit-width' controls
7328 the maximum width of lines in a buffer for which Emacs displays line
7329 numbers in the mode line. The default is 200.
7330
7331 ** `select-safe-coding-system' now also checks the most preferred
7332 coding-system if buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and
7333 DEFAULT-CODING-SYSTEM is not specified,
7334
7335 ** The function `subr-arity' provides information about the argument
7336 list of a primitive.
7337
7338 ** `where-is-internal' now also accepts a list of keymaps.
7339
7340 ** The text property `keymap' specifies a key map which overrides the
7341 buffer's local map and the map specified by the `local-map' property.
7342 This is probably what most current uses of `local-map' want, rather
7343 than replacing the local map.
7344
7345 ** The obsolete variables `before-change-function' and
7346 `after-change-function' are no longer acted upon and have been
7347 removed. Use `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions'
7348 instead.
7349
7350 ** The function `apropos-mode' runs the hook `apropos-mode-hook'.
7351
7352 ** `concat' no longer accepts individual integer arguments,
7353 as promised long ago.
7354
7355 ** The new function `float-time' returns the current time as a float.
7356
7357 ** The new variable auto-coding-regexp-alist specifies coding systems
7358 for reading specific files, analogous to auto-coding-alist, but
7359 patterns are checked against file contents instead of file names.
7360
7361 \f
7362 * Lisp changes in Emacs 21.1 (see following page for display-related features)
7363
7364 ** The new package rx.el provides an alternative sexp notation for
7365 regular expressions.
7366
7367 - Function: rx-to-string SEXP
7368
7369 Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
7370
7371 - Macro: rx SEXP
7372
7373 Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
7374
7375 The following are valid subforms of regular expressions in sexp
7376 notation.
7377
7378 STRING
7379 matches string STRING literally.
7380
7381 CHAR
7382 matches character CHAR literally.
7383
7384 `not-newline'
7385 matches any character except a newline.
7386 .
7387 `anything'
7388 matches any character
7389
7390 `(any SET)'
7391 matches any character in SET. SET may be a character or string.
7392 Ranges of characters can be specified as `A-Z' in strings.
7393
7394 '(in SET)'
7395 like `any'.
7396
7397 `(not (any SET))'
7398 matches any character not in SET
7399
7400 `line-start'
7401 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of a line
7402 in the text being matched
7403
7404 `line-end'
7405 is similar to `line-start' but matches only at the end of a line
7406
7407 `string-start'
7408 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
7409 string being matched against.
7410
7411 `string-end'
7412 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
7413 string being matched against.
7414
7415 `buffer-start'
7416 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
7417 buffer being matched against.
7418
7419 `buffer-end'
7420 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
7421 buffer being matched against.
7422
7423 `point'
7424 matches the empty string, but only at point.
7425
7426 `word-start'
7427 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
7428 word.
7429
7430 `word-end'
7431 matches the empty string, but only at the end of a word.
7432
7433 `word-boundary'
7434 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
7435 word.
7436
7437 `(not word-boundary)'
7438 matches the empty string, but not at the beginning or end of a
7439 word.
7440
7441 `digit'
7442 matches 0 through 9.
7443
7444 `control'
7445 matches ASCII control characters.
7446
7447 `hex-digit'
7448 matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
7449
7450 `blank'
7451 matches space and tab only.
7452
7453 `graphic'
7454 matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
7455 space, and DEL.
7456
7457 `printing'
7458 matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
7459 and DEL.
7460
7461 `alphanumeric'
7462 matches letters and digits. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7463 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
7464
7465 `letter'
7466 matches letters. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7467 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
7468
7469 `ascii'
7470 matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
7471
7472 `nonascii'
7473 matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
7474
7475 `lower'
7476 matches anything lower-case.
7477
7478 `upper'
7479 matches anything upper-case.
7480
7481 `punctuation'
7482 matches punctuation. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7483 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
7484
7485 `space'
7486 matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
7487
7488 `word'
7489 matches anything that has word syntax.
7490
7491 `(syntax SYNTAX)'
7492 matches a character with syntax SYNTAX. SYNTAX must be one
7493 of the following symbols.
7494
7495 `whitespace' (\\s- in string notation)
7496 `punctuation' (\\s.)
7497 `word' (\\sw)
7498 `symbol' (\\s_)
7499 `open-parenthesis' (\\s()
7500 `close-parenthesis' (\\s))
7501 `expression-prefix' (\\s')
7502 `string-quote' (\\s\")
7503 `paired-delimiter' (\\s$)
7504 `escape' (\\s\\)
7505 `character-quote' (\\s/)
7506 `comment-start' (\\s<)
7507 `comment-end' (\\s>)
7508
7509 `(not (syntax SYNTAX))'
7510 matches a character that has not syntax SYNTAX.
7511
7512 `(category CATEGORY)'
7513 matches a character with category CATEGORY. CATEGORY must be
7514 either a character to use for C, or one of the following symbols.
7515
7516 `consonant' (\\c0 in string notation)
7517 `base-vowel' (\\c1)
7518 `upper-diacritical-mark' (\\c2)
7519 `lower-diacritical-mark' (\\c3)
7520 `tone-mark' (\\c4)
7521 `symbol' (\\c5)
7522 `digit' (\\c6)
7523 `vowel-modifying-diacritical-mark' (\\c7)
7524 `vowel-sign' (\\c8)
7525 `semivowel-lower' (\\c9)
7526 `not-at-end-of-line' (\\c<)
7527 `not-at-beginning-of-line' (\\c>)
7528 `alpha-numeric-two-byte' (\\cA)
7529 `chinse-two-byte' (\\cC)
7530 `greek-two-byte' (\\cG)
7531 `japanese-hiragana-two-byte' (\\cH)
7532 `indian-two-byte' (\\cI)
7533 `japanese-katakana-two-byte' (\\cK)
7534 `korean-hangul-two-byte' (\\cN)
7535 `cyrillic-two-byte' (\\cY)
7536 `ascii' (\\ca)
7537 `arabic' (\\cb)
7538 `chinese' (\\cc)
7539 `ethiopic' (\\ce)
7540 `greek' (\\cg)
7541 `korean' (\\ch)
7542 `indian' (\\ci)
7543 `japanese' (\\cj)
7544 `japanese-katakana' (\\ck)
7545 `latin' (\\cl)
7546 `lao' (\\co)
7547 `tibetan' (\\cq)
7548 `japanese-roman' (\\cr)
7549 `thai' (\\ct)
7550 `vietnamese' (\\cv)
7551 `hebrew' (\\cw)
7552 `cyrillic' (\\cy)
7553 `can-break' (\\c|)
7554
7555 `(not (category CATEGORY))'
7556 matches a character that has not category CATEGORY.
7557
7558 `(and SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
7559 matches what SEXP1 matches, followed by what SEXP2 matches, etc.
7560
7561 `(submatch SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
7562 like `and', but makes the match accessible with `match-end',
7563 `match-beginning', and `match-string'.
7564
7565 `(group SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
7566 another name for `submatch'.
7567
7568 `(or SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
7569 matches anything that matches SEXP1 or SEXP2, etc. If all
7570 args are strings, use `regexp-opt' to optimize the resulting
7571 regular expression.
7572
7573 `(minimal-match SEXP)'
7574 produce a non-greedy regexp for SEXP. Normally, regexps matching
7575 zero or more occurrences of something are \"greedy\" in that they
7576 match as much as they can, as long as the overall regexp can
7577 still match. A non-greedy regexp matches as little as possible.
7578
7579 `(maximal-match SEXP)'
7580 produce a greedy regexp for SEXP. This is the default.
7581
7582 `(zero-or-more SEXP)'
7583 matches zero or more occurrences of what SEXP matches.
7584
7585 `(0+ SEXP)'
7586 like `zero-or-more'.
7587
7588 `(* SEXP)'
7589 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
7590
7591 `(*? SEXP)'
7592 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
7593
7594 `(one-or-more SEXP)'
7595 matches one or more occurrences of A.
7596
7597 `(1+ SEXP)'
7598 like `one-or-more'.
7599
7600 `(+ SEXP)'
7601 like `one-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
7602
7603 `(+? SEXP)'
7604 like `one-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
7605
7606 `(zero-or-one SEXP)'
7607 matches zero or one occurrences of A.
7608
7609 `(optional SEXP)'
7610 like `zero-or-one'.
7611
7612 `(? SEXP)'
7613 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a greedy regexp.
7614
7615 `(?? SEXP)'
7616 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
7617
7618 `(repeat N SEXP)'
7619 matches N occurrences of what SEXP matches.
7620
7621 `(repeat N M SEXP)'
7622 matches N to M occurrences of what SEXP matches.
7623
7624 `(eval FORM)'
7625 evaluate FORM and insert result. If result is a string,
7626 `regexp-quote' it.
7627
7628 `(regexp REGEXP)'
7629 include REGEXP in string notation in the result.
7630
7631 *** The features `md5' and `overlay' are now provided by default.
7632
7633 *** The special form `save-restriction' now works correctly even if the
7634 buffer is widened inside the save-restriction and changes made outside
7635 the original restriction. Previously, doing this would cause the saved
7636 restriction to be restored incorrectly.
7637
7638 *** The functions `find-charset-region' and `find-charset-string' include
7639 `eight-bit-control' and/or `eight-bit-graphic' in the returned list
7640 when they find 8-bit characters. Previously, they included `ascii' in a
7641 multibyte buffer and `unknown' in a unibyte buffer.
7642
7643 *** The functions `set-buffer-multibyte', `string-as-multibyte' and
7644 `string-as-unibyte' change the byte sequence of a buffer or a string
7645 if it contains a character from the `eight-bit-control' character set.
7646
7647 *** The handling of multibyte sequences in a multibyte buffer is
7648 changed. Previously, a byte sequence matching the pattern
7649 [\200-\237][\240-\377]+ was interpreted as a single character
7650 regardless of the length of the trailing bytes [\240-\377]+. Thus, if
7651 the sequence was longer than what the leading byte indicated, the
7652 extra trailing bytes were ignored by Lisp functions. Now such extra
7653 bytes are independent 8-bit characters belonging to the charset
7654 eight-bit-graphic.
7655
7656 ** Fontsets are now implemented using char-tables.
7657
7658 A fontset can now be specified for each independent character, for
7659 a group of characters or for a character set rather than just for a
7660 character set as previously.
7661
7662 *** The arguments of the function `set-fontset-font' are changed.
7663 They are NAME, CHARACTER, FONTNAME, and optional FRAME. The function
7664 modifies fontset NAME to use FONTNAME for CHARACTER.
7665
7666 CHARACTER may be a cons (FROM . TO), where FROM and TO are non-generic
7667 characters. In that case FONTNAME is used for all characters in the
7668 range FROM and TO (inclusive). CHARACTER may be a charset. In that
7669 case FONTNAME is used for all character in the charset.
7670
7671 FONTNAME may be a cons (FAMILY . REGISTRY), where FAMILY is the family
7672 name of a font and REGISTRY is a registry name of a font.
7673
7674 *** Variable x-charset-registry has been deleted. The default charset
7675 registries of character sets are set in the default fontset
7676 "fontset-default".
7677
7678 *** The function `create-fontset-from-fontset-spec' ignores the second
7679 argument STYLE-VARIANT. It never creates style-variant fontsets.
7680
7681 ** The method of composing characters is changed. Now character
7682 composition is done by a special text property `composition' in
7683 buffers and strings.
7684
7685 *** Charset composition is deleted. Emacs never creates a `composite
7686 character' which is an independent character with a unique character
7687 code. Thus the following functions handling `composite characters'
7688 have been deleted: composite-char-component,
7689 composite-char-component-count, composite-char-composition-rule,
7690 composite-char-composition-rule and decompose-composite-char delete.
7691 The variables leading-code-composition and min-composite-char have
7692 also been deleted.
7693
7694 *** Three more glyph reference points are added. They can be used to
7695 specify a composition rule. See the documentation of the variable
7696 `reference-point-alist' for more detail.
7697
7698 *** The function `compose-region' takes new arguments COMPONENTS and
7699 MODIFICATION-FUNC. With COMPONENTS, you can specify not only a
7700 composition rule but also characters to be composed. Such characters
7701 may differ between buffer and string text.
7702
7703 *** The function `compose-string' takes new arguments START, END,
7704 COMPONENTS, and MODIFICATION-FUNC.
7705
7706 *** The function `compose-string' puts text property `composition'
7707 directly on the argument STRING instead of returning a new string.
7708 Likewise, the function `decompose-string' just removes text property
7709 `composition' from STRING.
7710
7711 *** The new function `find-composition' returns information about
7712 a composition at a specified position in a buffer or a string.
7713
7714 *** The function `decompose-composite-char' is now labeled as
7715 obsolete.
7716
7717 ** The new coding system `mac-roman' is primarily intended for use on
7718 the Macintosh but may be used generally for Macintosh-encoded text.
7719
7720 ** The new character sets `mule-unicode-0100-24ff',
7721 `mule-unicode-2500-33ff', and `mule-unicode-e000-ffff' have been
7722 introduced for Unicode characters in the range U+0100..U+24FF,
7723 U+2500..U+33FF, U+E000..U+FFFF respectively.
7724
7725 Note that the character sets are not yet unified in Emacs, so
7726 characters which belong to charsets such as Latin-2, Greek, Hebrew,
7727 etc. and the same characters in the `mule-unicode-*' charsets are
7728 different characters, as far as Emacs is concerned. For example, text
7729 which includes Unicode characters from the Latin-2 locale cannot be
7730 encoded by Emacs with ISO 8859-2 coding system.
7731
7732 ** The new coding system `mule-utf-8' has been added.
7733 It provides limited support for decoding/encoding UTF-8 text. For
7734 details, please see the documentation string of this coding system.
7735
7736 ** The new character sets `japanese-jisx0213-1' and
7737 `japanese-jisx0213-2' have been introduced for the new Japanese
7738 standard JIS X 0213 Plane 1 and Plane 2.
7739
7740 ** The new character sets `latin-iso8859-14' and `latin-iso8859-15'
7741 have been introduced.
7742
7743 ** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
7744 have been introduced for 8-bit characters in the ranges 0x80..0x9F and
7745 0xA0..0xFF respectively. Note that the multibyte representation of
7746 eight-bit-control is never exposed; this leads to an exception in the
7747 emacs-mule coding system, which encodes everything else to the
7748 buffer/string internal representation. Note that to search for
7749 eight-bit-graphic characters in a multibyte buffer, the search string
7750 must be multibyte, otherwise such characters will be converted to
7751 their multibyte equivalent.
7752
7753 ** If the APPEND argument of `write-region' is an integer, it seeks to
7754 that offset in the file before writing.
7755
7756 ** The function `add-minor-mode' has been added for convenience and
7757 compatibility with XEmacs (and is used internally by define-minor-mode).
7758
7759 ** The function `shell-command' now sets the default directory of the
7760 `*Shell Command Output*' buffer to the default directory of the buffer
7761 from which the command was issued.
7762
7763 ** The functions `query-replace', `query-replace-regexp',
7764 `query-replace-regexp-eval' `map-query-replace-regexp',
7765 `replace-string', `replace-regexp', and `perform-replace' take two
7766 additional optional arguments START and END that specify the region to
7767 operate on.
7768
7769 ** The new function `count-screen-lines' is a more flexible alternative
7770 to `window-buffer-height'.
7771
7772 - Function: count-screen-lines &optional BEG END COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE WINDOW
7773
7774 Return the number of screen lines in the region between BEG and END.
7775 The number of screen lines may be different from the number of actual
7776 lines, due to line breaking, display table, etc.
7777
7778 Optional arguments BEG and END default to `point-min' and `point-max'
7779 respectively.
7780
7781 If region ends with a newline, ignore it unless optional third argument
7782 COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE is non-nil.
7783
7784 The optional fourth argument WINDOW specifies the window used for
7785 obtaining parameters such as width, horizontal scrolling, and so
7786 on. The default is to use the selected window's parameters.
7787
7788 Like `vertical-motion', `count-screen-lines' always uses the current
7789 buffer, regardless of which buffer is displayed in WINDOW. This makes
7790 possible to use `count-screen-lines' in any buffer, whether or not it
7791 is currently displayed in some window.
7792
7793 ** The new function `mapc' is like `mapcar' but doesn't collect the
7794 argument function's results.
7795
7796 ** The functions base64-decode-region and base64-decode-string now
7797 signal an error instead of returning nil if decoding fails. Also,
7798 `base64-decode-string' now always returns a unibyte string (in Emacs
7799 20, it returned a multibyte string when the result was a valid multibyte
7800 sequence).
7801
7802 ** The function sendmail-user-agent-compose now recognizes a `body'
7803 header in the list of headers passed to it.
7804
7805 ** The new function member-ignore-case works like `member', but
7806 ignores differences in case and text representation.
7807
7808 ** The buffer-local variable cursor-type can be used to specify the
7809 cursor to use in windows displaying a buffer. Values are interpreted
7810 as follows:
7811
7812 t use the cursor specified for the frame (default)
7813 nil don't display a cursor
7814 `bar' display a bar cursor with default width
7815 (bar . WIDTH) display a bar cursor with width WIDTH
7816 others display a box cursor.
7817
7818 ** The variable open-paren-in-column-0-is-defun-start controls whether
7819 an open parenthesis in column 0 is considered to be the start of a
7820 defun. If set, the default, it is considered a defun start. If not
7821 set, an open parenthesis in column 0 has no special meaning.
7822
7823 ** The new function `string-to-syntax' can be used to translate syntax
7824 specifications in string form as accepted by `modify-syntax-entry' to
7825 the cons-cell form that is used for the values of the `syntax-table'
7826 text property, and in `font-lock-syntactic-keywords'.
7827
7828 Example:
7829
7830 (string-to-syntax "()")
7831 => (4 . 41)
7832
7833 ** Emacs' reader supports CL read syntax for integers in bases
7834 other than 10.
7835
7836 *** `#BINTEGER' or `#bINTEGER' reads INTEGER in binary (radix 2).
7837 INTEGER optionally contains a sign.
7838
7839 #b1111
7840 => 15
7841 #b-1111
7842 => -15
7843
7844 *** `#OINTEGER' or `#oINTEGER' reads INTEGER in octal (radix 8).
7845
7846 #o666
7847 => 438
7848
7849 *** `#XINTEGER' or `#xINTEGER' reads INTEGER in hexadecimal (radix 16).
7850
7851 #xbeef
7852 => 48815
7853
7854 *** `#RADIXrINTEGER' reads INTEGER in radix RADIX, 2 <= RADIX <= 36.
7855
7856 #2R-111
7857 => -7
7858 #25rah
7859 => 267
7860
7861 ** The function `documentation-property' now evaluates the value of
7862 the given property to obtain a string if it doesn't refer to etc/DOC
7863 and isn't a string.
7864
7865 ** If called for a symbol, the function `documentation' now looks for
7866 a `function-documentation' property of that symbol. If it has a non-nil
7867 value, the documentation is taken from that value. If the value is
7868 not a string, it is evaluated to obtain a string.
7869
7870 ** The last argument of `define-key-after' defaults to t for convenience.
7871
7872 ** The new function `replace-regexp-in-string' replaces all matches
7873 for a regexp in a string.
7874
7875 ** `mouse-position' now runs the abnormal hook
7876 `mouse-position-function'.
7877
7878 ** The function string-to-number now returns a float for numbers
7879 that don't fit into a Lisp integer.
7880
7881 ** The variable keyword-symbols-constants-flag has been removed.
7882 Keywords are now always considered constants.
7883
7884 ** The new function `delete-and-extract-region' deletes text and
7885 returns it.
7886
7887 ** The function `clear-this-command-keys' now also clears the vector
7888 returned by function `recent-keys'.
7889
7890 ** Variables `beginning-of-defun-function' and `end-of-defun-function'
7891 can be used to define handlers for the functions that find defuns.
7892 Major modes can define these locally instead of rebinding C-M-a
7893 etc. if the normal conventions for defuns are not appropriate for the
7894 mode.
7895
7896 ** easy-mmode-define-minor-mode now takes an additional BODY argument
7897 and is renamed `define-minor-mode'.
7898
7899 ** If an abbrev has a hook function which is a symbol, and that symbol
7900 has a non-nil `no-self-insert' property, the return value of the hook
7901 function specifies whether an expansion has been done or not. If it
7902 returns nil, abbrev-expand also returns nil, meaning "no expansion has
7903 been performed."
7904
7905 When abbrev expansion is done by typing a self-inserting character,
7906 and the abbrev has a hook with the `no-self-insert' property, and the
7907 hook function returns non-nil meaning expansion has been done,
7908 then the self-inserting character is not inserted.
7909
7910 ** The function `intern-soft' now accepts a symbol as first argument.
7911 In this case, that exact symbol is looked up in the specified obarray,
7912 and the function's value is nil if it is not found.
7913
7914 ** The new macro `with-syntax-table' can be used to evaluate forms
7915 with the syntax table of the current buffer temporarily set to a
7916 specified table.
7917
7918 (with-syntax-table TABLE &rest BODY)
7919
7920 Evaluate BODY with syntax table of current buffer set to a copy of
7921 TABLE. The current syntax table is saved, BODY is evaluated, and the
7922 saved table is restored, even in case of an abnormal exit. Value is
7923 what BODY returns.
7924
7925 ** Regular expressions now support intervals \{n,m\} as well as
7926 Perl's shy-groups \(?:...\) and non-greedy *? +? and ?? operators.
7927 Also back-references like \2 are now considered as an error if the
7928 corresponding subgroup does not exist (or is not closed yet).
7929 Previously it would have been silently turned into `2' (ignoring the `\').
7930
7931 ** The optional argument BUFFER of function file-local-copy has been
7932 removed since it wasn't used by anything.
7933
7934 ** The file name argument of function `file-locked-p' is now required
7935 instead of being optional.
7936
7937 ** The new built-in error `text-read-only' is signaled when trying to
7938 modify read-only text.
7939
7940 ** New functions and variables for locales.
7941
7942 The new variable `locale-coding-system' specifies how to encode and
7943 decode strings passed to low-level message functions like strerror and
7944 time functions like strftime. The new variables
7945 `system-messages-locale' and `system-time-locale' give the system
7946 locales to be used when invoking these two types of functions.
7947
7948 The new function `set-locale-environment' sets the language
7949 environment, preferred coding system, and locale coding system from
7950 the system locale as specified by the LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG
7951 environment variables. Normally, it is invoked during startup and need
7952 not be invoked thereafter. It uses the new variables
7953 `locale-language-names', `locale-charset-language-names', and
7954 `locale-preferred-coding-systems' to make its decisions.
7955
7956 ** syntax tables now understand nested comments.
7957 To declare a comment syntax as allowing nesting, just add an `n'
7958 modifier to either of the characters of the comment end and the comment
7959 start sequences.
7960
7961 ** The function `pixmap-spec-p' has been renamed `bitmap-spec-p'
7962 because `bitmap' is more in line with the usual X terminology.
7963
7964 ** New function `propertize'
7965
7966 The new function `propertize' can be used to conveniently construct
7967 strings with text properties.
7968
7969 - Function: propertize STRING &rest PROPERTIES
7970
7971 Value is a copy of STRING with text properties assigned as specified
7972 by PROPERTIES. PROPERTIES is a sequence of pairs PROPERTY VALUE, with
7973 PROPERTY being the name of a text property and VALUE being the
7974 specified value of that property. Example:
7975
7976 (propertize "foo" 'face 'bold 'read-only t)
7977
7978 ** push and pop macros.
7979
7980 Simple versions of the push and pop macros of Common Lisp
7981 are now defined in Emacs Lisp. These macros allow only symbols
7982 as the place that holds the list to be changed.
7983
7984 (push NEWELT LISTNAME) add NEWELT to the front of LISTNAME's value.
7985 (pop LISTNAME) return first elt of LISTNAME, and remove it
7986 (thus altering the value of LISTNAME).
7987
7988 ** New dolist and dotimes macros.
7989
7990 Simple versions of the dolist and dotimes macros of Common Lisp
7991 are now defined in Emacs Lisp.
7992
7993 (dolist (VAR LIST [RESULT]) BODY...)
7994 Execute body once for each element of LIST,
7995 using the variable VAR to hold the current element.
7996 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
7997
7998 (dotimes (VAR COUNT [RESULT]) BODY...)
7999 Execute BODY with VAR bound to successive integers running from 0,
8000 inclusive, to COUNT, exclusive.
8001 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
8002
8003 ** Regular expressions now support Posix character classes such as
8004 [:alpha:], [:space:] and so on. These must be used within a character
8005 class--for instance, [-[:digit:].+] matches digits or a period
8006 or a sign.
8007
8008 [:digit:] matches 0 through 9
8009 [:cntrl:] matches ASCII control characters
8010 [:xdigit:] matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
8011 [:blank:] matches space and tab only
8012 [:graph:] matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
8013 space, and DEL.
8014 [:print:] matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
8015 and DEL.
8016 [:alnum:] matches letters and digits.
8017 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8018 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
8019 [:alpha:] matches letters.
8020 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8021 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
8022 [:ascii:] matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
8023 [:nonascii:] matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
8024 [:lower:] matches anything lower-case.
8025 [:punct:] matches punctuation.
8026 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8027 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
8028 [:space:] matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
8029 [:upper:] matches anything upper-case.
8030 [:word:] matches anything that has word syntax.
8031
8032 ** Emacs now has built-in hash tables.
8033
8034 The following functions are defined for hash tables:
8035
8036 - Function: make-hash-table ARGS
8037
8038 The argument list ARGS consists of keyword/argument pairs. All arguments
8039 are optional. The following arguments are defined:
8040
8041 :test TEST
8042
8043 TEST must be a symbol specifying how to compare keys. Default is `eql'.
8044 Predefined are `eq', `eql' and `equal'. If TEST is not predefined,
8045 it must have been defined with `define-hash-table-test'.
8046
8047 :size SIZE
8048
8049 SIZE must be an integer > 0 giving a hint to the implementation how
8050 many elements will be put in the hash table. Default size is 65.
8051
8052 :rehash-size REHASH-SIZE
8053
8054 REHASH-SIZE specifies by how much to grow a hash table once it becomes
8055 full. If REHASH-SIZE is an integer, add that to the hash table's old
8056 size to get the new size. Otherwise, REHASH-SIZE must be a float >
8057 1.0, and the new size is computed by multiplying REHASH-SIZE with the
8058 old size. Default rehash size is 1.5.
8059
8060 :rehash-threshold THRESHOLD
8061
8062 THRESHOLD must be a float > 0 and <= 1.0 specifying when to resize the
8063 hash table. It is resized when the ratio of (number of entries) /
8064 (size of hash table) is >= THRESHOLD. Default threshold is 0.8.
8065
8066 :weakness WEAK
8067
8068 WEAK must be either nil, one of the symbols `key, `value',
8069 `key-or-value', `key-and-value', or t, meaning the same as
8070 `key-and-value'. Entries are removed from weak tables during garbage
8071 collection if their key and/or value are not referenced elsewhere
8072 outside of the hash table. Default are non-weak hash tables.
8073
8074 - Function: makehash &optional TEST
8075
8076 Similar to make-hash-table, but only TEST can be specified.
8077
8078 - Function: hash-table-p TABLE
8079
8080 Returns non-nil if TABLE is a hash table object.
8081
8082 - Function: copy-hash-table TABLE
8083
8084 Returns a copy of TABLE. Only the table itself is copied, keys and
8085 values are shared.
8086
8087 - Function: hash-table-count TABLE
8088
8089 Returns the number of entries in TABLE.
8090
8091 - Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
8092
8093 Returns the rehash size of TABLE.
8094
8095 - Function: hash-table-rehash-threshold TABLE
8096
8097 Returns the rehash threshold of TABLE.
8098
8099 - Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
8100
8101 Returns the size of TABLE.
8102
8103 - Function: hash-table-test TABLE
8104
8105 Returns the test TABLE uses to compare keys.
8106
8107 - Function: hash-table-weakness TABLE
8108
8109 Returns the weakness specified for TABLE.
8110
8111 - Function: clrhash TABLE
8112
8113 Clear TABLE.
8114
8115 - Function: gethash KEY TABLE &optional DEFAULT
8116
8117 Look up KEY in TABLE and return its associated VALUE or DEFAULT if
8118 not found.
8119
8120 - Function: puthash KEY VALUE TABLE
8121
8122 Associate KEY with VALUE in TABLE. If KEY is already associated with
8123 another value, replace the old value with VALUE.
8124
8125 - Function: remhash KEY TABLE
8126
8127 Remove KEY from TABLE if it is there.
8128
8129 - Function: maphash FUNCTION TABLE
8130
8131 Call FUNCTION for all elements in TABLE. FUNCTION must take two
8132 arguments KEY and VALUE.
8133
8134 - Function: sxhash OBJ
8135
8136 Return a hash code for Lisp object OBJ.
8137
8138 - Function: define-hash-table-test NAME TEST-FN HASH-FN
8139
8140 Define a new hash table test named NAME. If NAME is specified as
8141 a test in `make-hash-table', the table created will use TEST-FN for
8142 comparing keys, and HASH-FN to compute hash codes for keys. Test
8143 and hash function are stored as symbol property `hash-table-test'
8144 of NAME with a value of (TEST-FN HASH-FN).
8145
8146 TEST-FN must take two arguments and return non-nil if they are the same.
8147
8148 HASH-FN must take one argument and return an integer that is the hash
8149 code of the argument. The function should use the whole range of
8150 integer values for hash code computation, including negative integers.
8151
8152 Example: The following creates a hash table whose keys are supposed to
8153 be strings that are compared case-insensitively.
8154
8155 (defun case-fold-string= (a b)
8156 (compare-strings a nil nil b nil nil t))
8157
8158 (defun case-fold-string-hash (a)
8159 (sxhash (upcase a)))
8160
8161 (define-hash-table-test 'case-fold 'case-fold-string=
8162 'case-fold-string-hash))
8163
8164 (make-hash-table :test 'case-fold)
8165
8166 ** The Lisp reader handles circular structure.
8167
8168 It now works to use the #N= and #N# constructs to represent
8169 circular structures. For example, #1=(a . #1#) represents
8170 a cons cell which is its own cdr.
8171
8172 ** The Lisp printer handles circular structure.
8173
8174 If you bind print-circle to a non-nil value, the Lisp printer outputs
8175 #N= and #N# constructs to represent circular and shared structure.
8176
8177 ** If the second argument to `move-to-column' is anything but nil or
8178 t, that means replace a tab with spaces if necessary to reach the
8179 specified column, but do not add spaces at the end of the line if it
8180 is too short to reach that column.
8181
8182 ** perform-replace has a new feature: the REPLACEMENTS argument may
8183 now be a cons cell (FUNCTION . DATA). This means to call FUNCTION
8184 after each match to get the replacement text. FUNCTION is called with
8185 two arguments: DATA, and the number of replacements already made.
8186
8187 If the FROM-STRING contains any upper-case letters,
8188 perform-replace also turns off `case-fold-search' temporarily
8189 and inserts the replacement text without altering case in it.
8190
8191 ** The function buffer-size now accepts an optional argument
8192 to specify which buffer to return the size of.
8193
8194 ** The calendar motion commands now run the normal hook
8195 calendar-move-hook after moving point.
8196
8197 ** The new variable small-temporary-file-directory specifies a
8198 directory to use for creating temporary files that are likely to be
8199 small. (Certain Emacs features use this directory.) If
8200 small-temporary-file-directory is nil, they use
8201 temporary-file-directory instead.
8202
8203 ** The variable `inhibit-modification-hooks', if non-nil, inhibits all
8204 the hooks that track changes in the buffer. This affects
8205 `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions', as well as
8206 hooks attached to text properties and overlay properties.
8207
8208 ** assq-delete-all is a new function that deletes all the
8209 elements of an alist which have a car `eq' to a particular value.
8210
8211 ** make-temp-file provides a more reliable way to create a temporary file.
8212
8213 make-temp-file is used like make-temp-name, except that it actually
8214 creates the file before it returns. This prevents a timing error,
8215 ensuring that no other job can use the same name for a temporary file.
8216
8217 ** New exclusive-open feature in `write-region'
8218
8219 The optional seventh arg is now called MUSTBENEW. If non-nil, it insists
8220 on a check for an existing file with the same name. If MUSTBENEW
8221 is `excl', that means to get an error if the file already exists;
8222 never overwrite. If MUSTBENEW is neither nil nor `excl', that means
8223 ask for confirmation before overwriting, but do go ahead and
8224 overwrite the file if the user gives confirmation.
8225
8226 If the MUSTBENEW argument in `write-region' is `excl',
8227 that means to use a special feature in the `open' system call
8228 to get an error if the file exists at that time.
8229 The error reported is `file-already-exists'.
8230
8231 ** Function `format' now handles text properties.
8232
8233 Text properties of the format string are applied to the result string.
8234 If the result string is longer than the format string, text properties
8235 ending at the end of the format string are extended to the end of the
8236 result string.
8237
8238 Text properties from string arguments are applied to the result
8239 string where arguments appear in the result string.
8240
8241 Example:
8242
8243 (let ((s1 "hello, %s")
8244 (s2 "world"))
8245 (put-text-property 0 (length s1) 'face 'bold s1)
8246 (put-text-property 0 (length s2) 'face 'italic s2)
8247 (format s1 s2))
8248
8249 results in a bold-face string with an italic `world' at the end.
8250
8251 ** Messages can now be displayed with text properties.
8252
8253 Text properties are handled as described above for function `format'.
8254 The following example displays a bold-face message with an italic
8255 argument in it.
8256
8257 (let ((msg "hello, %s!")
8258 (arg "world"))
8259 (put-text-property 0 (length msg) 'face 'bold msg)
8260 (put-text-property 0 (length arg) 'face 'italic arg)
8261 (message msg arg))
8262
8263 ** Sound support
8264
8265 Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and the free BSDs
8266 (Voxware driver and native BSD driver, aka as Luigi's driver).
8267
8268 Currently supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio
8269 (*.au). You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes'
8270 to enable sound support.
8271
8272 Sound files can be played by calling (play-sound SOUND). SOUND is a
8273 list of the form `(sound PROPERTY...)'. The function is only defined
8274 when sound support is present for the system on which Emacs runs. The
8275 functions runs `play-sound-functions' with one argument which is the
8276 sound to play, before playing the sound.
8277
8278 The following sound properties are supported:
8279
8280 - `:file FILE'
8281
8282 FILE is a file name. If FILE isn't an absolute name, it will be
8283 searched relative to `data-directory'.
8284
8285 - `:data DATA'
8286
8287 DATA is a string containing sound data. Either :file or :data
8288 may be present, but not both.
8289
8290 - `:volume VOLUME'
8291
8292 VOLUME must be an integer in the range 0..100 or a float in the range
8293 0..1. This property is optional.
8294
8295 - `:device DEVICE'
8296
8297 DEVICE is a string specifying the system device on which to play the
8298 sound. The default device is system-dependent.
8299
8300 Other properties are ignored.
8301
8302 An alternative interface is called as
8303 (play-sound-file FILE &optional VOLUME DEVICE).
8304
8305 ** `multimedia' is a new Finder keyword and Custom group.
8306
8307 ** keywordp is a new predicate to test efficiently for an object being
8308 a keyword symbol.
8309
8310 ** Changes to garbage collection
8311
8312 *** The function garbage-collect now additionally returns the number
8313 of live and free strings.
8314
8315 *** There is a new variable `strings-consed' holding the number of
8316 strings that have been consed so far.
8317
8318 \f
8319 * Lisp-level Display features added after release 2.6 of the Emacs
8320 Lisp Manual
8321
8322 ** The user-option `resize-mini-windows' controls how Emacs resizes
8323 mini-windows.
8324
8325 ** The function `pos-visible-in-window-p' now has a third optional
8326 argument, PARTIALLY. If a character is only partially visible, nil is
8327 returned, unless PARTIALLY is non-nil.
8328
8329 ** On window systems, `glyph-table' is no longer used.
8330
8331 ** Help strings in menu items are now used to provide `help-echo' text.
8332
8333 ** The function `image-size' can be used to determine the size of an
8334 image.
8335
8336 - Function: image-size SPEC &optional PIXELS FRAME
8337
8338 Return the size of an image as a pair (WIDTH . HEIGHT).
8339
8340 SPEC is an image specification. PIXELS non-nil means return sizes
8341 measured in pixels, otherwise return sizes measured in canonical
8342 character units (fractions of the width/height of the frame's default
8343 font). FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed.
8344 FRAME nil or omitted means use the selected frame.
8345
8346 ** The function `image-mask-p' can be used to determine if an image
8347 has a mask bitmap.
8348
8349 - Function: image-mask-p SPEC &optional FRAME
8350
8351 Return t if image SPEC has a mask bitmap.
8352 FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed. FRAME nil
8353 or omitted means use the selected frame.
8354
8355 ** The function `find-image' can be used to find a usable image
8356 satisfying one of a list of specifications.
8357
8358 ** The STRING argument of `put-image' and `insert-image' is now
8359 optional.
8360
8361 ** Image specifications may contain the property `:ascent center' (see
8362 below).
8363
8364 \f
8365 * New Lisp-level Display features in Emacs 21.1
8366
8367 ** The function tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors can be used
8368 to make Emacs avoid displaying text with bold black foreground on TTYs.
8369
8370 Some terminals, notably PC consoles, emulate bold text by displaying
8371 text in brighter colors. On such a console, a bold black foreground
8372 is displayed in a gray color. If this turns out to be hard to read on
8373 your monitor---the problem occurred with the mode line on
8374 laptops---you can instruct Emacs to ignore the text's boldness, and to
8375 just display it black instead.
8376
8377 This situation can't be detected automatically. You will have to put
8378 a line like
8379
8380 (tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors t)
8381
8382 in your `.emacs'.
8383
8384 ** New face implementation.
8385
8386 Emacs faces have been reimplemented from scratch. They don't use XLFD
8387 font names anymore and face merging now works as expected.
8388
8389 *** New faces.
8390
8391 Each face can specify the following display attributes:
8392
8393 1. Font family or fontset alias name.
8394
8395 2. Relative proportionate width, aka character set width or set
8396 width (swidth), e.g. `semi-compressed'.
8397
8398 3. Font height in 1/10pt
8399
8400 4. Font weight, e.g. `bold'.
8401
8402 5. Font slant, e.g. `italic'.
8403
8404 6. Foreground color.
8405
8406 7. Background color.
8407
8408 8. Whether or not characters should be underlined, and in what color.
8409
8410 9. Whether or not characters should be displayed in inverse video.
8411
8412 10. A background stipple, a bitmap.
8413
8414 11. Whether or not characters should be overlined, and in what color.
8415
8416 12. Whether or not characters should be strike-through, and in what
8417 color.
8418
8419 13. Whether or not a box should be drawn around characters, its
8420 color, the width of the box lines, and 3D appearance.
8421
8422 Faces are frame-local by nature because Emacs allows to define the
8423 same named face (face names are symbols) differently for different
8424 frames. Each frame has an alist of face definitions for all named
8425 faces. The value of a named face in such an alist is a Lisp vector
8426 with the symbol `face' in slot 0, and a slot for each of the face
8427 attributes mentioned above.
8428
8429 There is also a global face alist `face-new-frame-defaults'. Face
8430 definitions from this list are used to initialize faces of newly
8431 created frames.
8432
8433 A face doesn't have to specify all attributes. Those not specified
8434 have a nil value. Faces specifying all attributes are called
8435 `fully-specified'.
8436
8437 *** Face merging.
8438
8439 The display style of a given character in the text is determined by
8440 combining several faces. This process is called `face merging'. Any
8441 aspect of the display style that isn't specified by overlays or text
8442 properties is taken from the `default' face. Since it is made sure
8443 that the default face is always fully-specified, face merging always
8444 results in a fully-specified face.
8445
8446 *** Face realization.
8447
8448 After all face attributes for a character have been determined by
8449 merging faces of that character, that face is `realized'. The
8450 realization process maps face attributes to what is physically
8451 available on the system where Emacs runs. The result is a `realized
8452 face' in form of an internal structure which is stored in the face
8453 cache of the frame on which it was realized.
8454
8455 Face realization is done in the context of the charset of the
8456 character to display because different fonts and encodings are used
8457 for different charsets. In other words, for characters of different
8458 charsets, different realized faces are needed to display them.
8459
8460 Except for composite characters, faces are always realized for a
8461 specific character set and contain a specific font, even if the face
8462 being realized specifies a fontset. The reason is that the result of
8463 the new font selection stage is better than what can be done with
8464 statically defined font name patterns in fontsets.
8465
8466 In unibyte text, Emacs' charsets aren't applicable; function
8467 `char-charset' reports ASCII for all characters, including those >
8468 0x7f. The X registry and encoding of fonts to use is determined from
8469 the variable `face-default-registry' in this case. The variable is
8470 initialized at Emacs startup time from the font the user specified for
8471 Emacs.
8472
8473 Currently all unibyte text, i.e. all buffers with
8474 `enable-multibyte-characters' nil are displayed with fonts of the same
8475 registry and encoding `face-default-registry'. This is consistent
8476 with the fact that languages can also be set globally, only.
8477
8478 **** Clearing face caches.
8479
8480 The Lisp function `clear-face-cache' can be called to clear face caches
8481 on all frames. If called with a non-nil argument, it will also unload
8482 unused fonts.
8483
8484 *** Font selection.
8485
8486 Font selection tries to find the best available matching font for a
8487 given (charset, face) combination. This is done slightly differently
8488 for faces specifying a fontset, or a font family name.
8489
8490 If the face specifies a fontset name, that fontset determines a
8491 pattern for fonts of the given charset. If the face specifies a font
8492 family, a font pattern is constructed. Charset symbols have a
8493 property `x-charset-registry' for that purpose that maps a charset to
8494 an XLFD registry and encoding in the font pattern constructed.
8495
8496 Available fonts on the system on which Emacs runs are then matched
8497 against the font pattern. The result of font selection is the best
8498 match for the given face attributes in this font list.
8499
8500 Font selection can be influenced by the user.
8501
8502 The user can specify the relative importance he gives the face
8503 attributes width, height, weight, and slant by setting
8504 face-font-selection-order (faces.el) to a list of face attribute
8505 names. The default is (:width :height :weight :slant), and means
8506 that font selection first tries to find a good match for the font
8507 width specified by a face, then---within fonts with that width---tries
8508 to find a best match for the specified font height, etc.
8509
8510 Setting `face-font-family-alternatives' allows the user to specify
8511 alternative font families to try if a family specified by a face
8512 doesn't exist.
8513
8514 Setting `face-font-registry-alternatives' allows the user to specify
8515 all alternative font registry names to try for a face specifying a
8516 registry.
8517
8518 Please note that the interpretations of the above two variables are
8519 slightly different.
8520
8521 Setting face-ignored-fonts allows the user to ignore specific fonts.
8522
8523
8524 **** Scalable fonts
8525
8526 Emacs can make use of scalable fonts but doesn't do so by default,
8527 since the use of too many or too big scalable fonts may crash XFree86
8528 servers.
8529
8530 To enable scalable font use, set the variable
8531 `scalable-fonts-allowed'. A value of nil, the default, means never use
8532 scalable fonts. A value of t means any scalable font may be used.
8533 Otherwise, the value must be a list of regular expressions. A
8534 scalable font may then be used if it matches a regular expression from
8535 that list. Example:
8536
8537 (setq scalable-fonts-allowed '("muleindian-2$"))
8538
8539 allows the use of scalable fonts with registry `muleindian-2'.
8540
8541 *** Functions and variables related to font selection.
8542
8543 - Function: x-family-fonts &optional FAMILY FRAME
8544
8545 Return a list of available fonts of family FAMILY on FRAME. If FAMILY
8546 is omitted or nil, list all families. Otherwise, FAMILY must be a
8547 string, possibly containing wildcards `?' and `*'.
8548
8549 If FRAME is omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Each element of
8550 the result is a vector [FAMILY WIDTH POINT-SIZE WEIGHT SLANT FIXED-P
8551 FULL REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING]. FAMILY is the font family name.
8552 POINT-SIZE is the size of the font in 1/10 pt. WIDTH, WEIGHT, and
8553 SLANT are symbols describing the width, weight and slant of the font.
8554 These symbols are the same as for face attributes. FIXED-P is non-nil
8555 if the font is fixed-pitch. FULL is the full name of the font, and
8556 REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING is a string giving the registry and encoding of
8557 the font. The result list is sorted according to the current setting
8558 of the face font sort order.
8559
8560 - Function: x-font-family-list
8561
8562 Return a list of available font families on FRAME. If FRAME is
8563 omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Value is a list of conses
8564 (FAMILY . FIXED-P) where FAMILY is a font family, and FIXED-P is
8565 non-nil if fonts of that family are fixed-pitch.
8566
8567 - Variable: font-list-limit
8568
8569 Limit for font matching. If an integer > 0, font matching functions
8570 won't load more than that number of fonts when searching for a
8571 matching font. The default is currently 100.
8572
8573 *** Setting face attributes.
8574
8575 For the most part, the new face implementation is interface-compatible
8576 with the old one. Old face attribute related functions are now
8577 implemented in terms of the new functions `set-face-attribute' and
8578 `face-attribute'.
8579
8580 Face attributes are identified by their names which are keyword
8581 symbols. All attributes can be set to `unspecified'.
8582
8583 The following attributes are recognized:
8584
8585 `:family'
8586
8587 VALUE must be a string specifying the font family, e.g. ``courier'',
8588 or a fontset alias name. If a font family is specified, wild-cards `*'
8589 and `?' are allowed.
8590
8591 `:width'
8592
8593 VALUE specifies the relative proportionate width of the font to use.
8594 It must be one of the symbols `ultra-condensed', `extra-condensed',
8595 `condensed', `semi-condensed', `normal', `semi-expanded', `expanded',
8596 `extra-expanded', or `ultra-expanded'.
8597
8598 `:height'
8599
8600 VALUE must be either an integer specifying the height of the font to use
8601 in 1/10 pt, a floating point number specifying the amount by which to
8602 scale any underlying face, or a function, which is called with the old
8603 height (from the underlying face), and should return the new height.
8604
8605 `:weight'
8606
8607 VALUE specifies the weight of the font to use. It must be one of the
8608 symbols `ultra-bold', `extra-bold', `bold', `semi-bold', `normal',
8609 `semi-light', `light', `extra-light', `ultra-light'.
8610
8611 `:slant'
8612
8613 VALUE specifies the slant of the font to use. It must be one of the
8614 symbols `italic', `oblique', `normal', `reverse-italic', or
8615 `reverse-oblique'.
8616
8617 `:foreground', `:background'
8618
8619 VALUE must be a color name, a string.
8620
8621 `:underline'
8622
8623 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be underlined. If
8624 VALUE is t, underline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is
8625 a string, underline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly
8626 don't underline.
8627
8628 `:overline'
8629
8630 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be overlined. If
8631 VALUE is t, overline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is a
8632 string, overline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't
8633 overline.
8634
8635 `:strike-through'
8636
8637 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be drawn with a line
8638 striking through them. If VALUE is t, use the foreground color of the
8639 face. If VALUE is a string, strike-through with that color. If VALUE
8640 is nil, explicitly don't strike through.
8641
8642 `:box'
8643
8644 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should have a box drawn
8645 around them. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't draw boxes. If
8646 VALUE is t, draw a box with lines of width 1 in the foreground color
8647 of the face. If VALUE is a string, the string must be a color name,
8648 and the box is drawn in that color with a line width of 1. Otherwise,
8649 VALUE must be a property list of the form `(:line-width WIDTH
8650 :color COLOR :style STYLE)'. If a keyword/value pair is missing from
8651 the property list, a default value will be used for the value, as
8652 specified below. WIDTH specifies the width of the lines to draw; it
8653 defaults to 1. COLOR is the name of the color to draw in, default is
8654 the foreground color of the face for simple boxes, and the background
8655 color of the face for 3D boxes. STYLE specifies whether a 3D box
8656 should be draw. If STYLE is `released-button', draw a box looking
8657 like a released 3D button. If STYLE is `pressed-button' draw a box
8658 that appears like a pressed button. If STYLE is nil, the default if
8659 the property list doesn't contain a style specification, draw a 2D
8660 box.
8661
8662 `:inverse-video'
8663
8664 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be displayed in
8665 inverse video. VALUE must be one of t or nil.
8666
8667 `:stipple'
8668
8669 If VALUE is a string, it must be the name of a file of pixmap data.
8670 The directories listed in the `x-bitmap-file-path' variable are
8671 searched. Alternatively, VALUE may be a list of the form (WIDTH
8672 HEIGHT DATA) where WIDTH and HEIGHT are the size in pixels, and DATA
8673 is a string containing the raw bits of the bitmap. VALUE nil means
8674 explicitly don't use a stipple pattern.
8675
8676 For convenience, attributes `:family', `:width', `:height', `:weight',
8677 and `:slant' may also be set in one step from an X font name:
8678
8679 `:font'
8680
8681 Set font-related face attributes from VALUE. VALUE must be a valid
8682 XLFD font name. If it is a font name pattern, the first matching font
8683 is used--this is for compatibility with the behavior of previous
8684 versions of Emacs.
8685
8686 For compatibility with Emacs 20, keywords `:bold' and `:italic' can
8687 be used to specify that a bold or italic font should be used. VALUE
8688 must be t or nil in that case. A value of `unspecified' is not allowed."
8689
8690 Please see also the documentation of `set-face-attribute' and
8691 `defface'.
8692
8693 `:inherit'
8694
8695 VALUE is the name of a face from which to inherit attributes, or a list
8696 of face names. Attributes from inherited faces are merged into the face
8697 like an underlying face would be, with higher priority than underlying faces.
8698
8699 *** Face attributes and X resources
8700
8701 The following X resource names can be used to set face attributes
8702 from X resources:
8703
8704 Face attribute X resource class
8705 -----------------------------------------------------------------------
8706 :family attributeFamily . Face.AttributeFamily
8707 :width attributeWidth Face.AttributeWidth
8708 :height attributeHeight Face.AttributeHeight
8709 :weight attributeWeight Face.AttributeWeight
8710 :slant attributeSlant Face.AttributeSlant
8711 foreground attributeForeground Face.AttributeForeground
8712 :background attributeBackground . Face.AttributeBackground
8713 :overline attributeOverline Face.AttributeOverline
8714 :strike-through attributeStrikeThrough Face.AttributeStrikeThrough
8715 :box attributeBox Face.AttributeBox
8716 :underline attributeUnderline Face.AttributeUnderline
8717 :inverse-video attributeInverse Face.AttributeInverse
8718 :stipple attributeStipple Face.AttributeStipple
8719 or attributeBackgroundPixmap
8720 Face.AttributeBackgroundPixmap
8721 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
8722 :bold attributeBold Face.AttributeBold
8723 :italic attributeItalic . Face.AttributeItalic
8724 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
8725
8726 *** Text property `face'.
8727
8728 The value of the `face' text property can now be a single face
8729 specification or a list of such specifications. Each face
8730 specification can be
8731
8732 1. A symbol or string naming a Lisp face.
8733
8734 2. A property list of the form (KEYWORD VALUE ...) where each
8735 KEYWORD is a face attribute name, and VALUE is an appropriate value
8736 for that attribute. Please see the doc string of `set-face-attribute'
8737 for face attribute names.
8738
8739 3. Conses of the form (FOREGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) or
8740 (BACKGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) where COLOR is a color name. This is
8741 for compatibility with previous Emacs versions.
8742
8743 ** Support functions for colors on text-only terminals.
8744
8745 The function `tty-color-define' can be used to define colors for use
8746 on TTY and MSDOS frames. It maps a color name to a color number on
8747 the terminal. Emacs defines a couple of common color mappings by
8748 default. You can get defined colors with a call to
8749 `defined-colors'. The function `tty-color-clear' can be
8750 used to clear the mapping table.
8751
8752 ** Unified support for colors independent of frame type.
8753
8754 The new functions `defined-colors', `color-defined-p', `color-values',
8755 and `display-color-p' work for any type of frame. On frames whose
8756 type is neither x nor w32, these functions transparently map X-style
8757 color specifications to the closest colors supported by the frame
8758 display. Lisp programs should use these new functions instead of the
8759 old `x-defined-colors', `x-color-defined-p', `x-color-values', and
8760 `x-display-color-p'. (The old function names are still available for
8761 compatibility; they are now aliases of the new names.) Lisp programs
8762 should no more look at the value of the variable window-system to
8763 modify their color-related behavior.
8764
8765 The primitives `color-gray-p' and `color-supported-p' also work for
8766 any frame type.
8767
8768 ** Platform-independent functions to describe display capabilities.
8769
8770 The new functions `display-mouse-p', `display-popup-menus-p',
8771 `display-graphic-p', `display-selections-p', `display-screens',
8772 `display-pixel-width', `display-pixel-height', `display-mm-width',
8773 `display-mm-height', `display-backing-store', `display-save-under',
8774 `display-planes', `display-color-cells', `display-visual-class', and
8775 `display-grayscale-p' describe the basic capabilities of a particular
8776 display. Lisp programs should call these functions instead of testing
8777 the value of the variables `window-system' or `system-type', or calling
8778 platform-specific functions such as `x-display-pixel-width'.
8779
8780 The new function `display-images-p' returns non-nil if a particular
8781 display can display image files.
8782
8783 ** The minibuffer prompt is now actually inserted in the minibuffer.
8784
8785 This makes it possible to scroll through the prompt, if you want to.
8786 To disallow this completely (like previous versions of emacs), customize
8787 the variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', and turn on the
8788 `Inviolable' option.
8789
8790 The function `minibuffer-prompt-end' returns the current position of the
8791 end of the minibuffer prompt, if the minibuffer is current.
8792 Otherwise, it returns `(point-min)'.
8793
8794 ** New `field' abstraction in buffers.
8795
8796 There is now code to support an abstraction called `fields' in emacs
8797 buffers. A field is a contiguous region of text with the same `field'
8798 property (which can be a text property or an overlay).
8799
8800 Many emacs functions, such as forward-word, forward-sentence,
8801 forward-paragraph, beginning-of-line, etc., stop moving when they come
8802 to the boundary between fields; beginning-of-line and end-of-line will
8803 not let the point move past the field boundary, but other movement
8804 commands continue into the next field if repeated. Stopping at field
8805 boundaries can be suppressed programmatically by binding
8806 `inhibit-field-text-motion' to a non-nil value around calls to these
8807 functions.
8808
8809 Now that the minibuffer prompt is inserted into the minibuffer, it is in
8810 a separate field from the user-input part of the buffer, so that common
8811 editing commands treat the user's text separately from the prompt.
8812
8813 The following functions are defined for operating on fields:
8814
8815 - Function: constrain-to-field NEW-POS OLD-POS &optional ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE ONLY-IN-LINE INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY
8816
8817 Return the position closest to NEW-POS that is in the same field as OLD-POS.
8818
8819 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
8820 If NEW-POS is nil, then the current point is used instead, and set to the
8821 constrained position if that is different.
8822
8823 If OLD-POS is at the boundary of two fields, then the allowable
8824 positions for NEW-POS depends on the value of the optional argument
8825 ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE: If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is nil, then NEW-POS is
8826 constrained to the field that has the same `field' char-property
8827 as any new characters inserted at OLD-POS, whereas if ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
8828 is non-nil, NEW-POS is constrained to the union of the two adjacent
8829 fields. Additionally, if two fields are separated by another field with
8830 the special value `boundary', then any point within this special field is
8831 also considered to be `on the boundary'.
8832
8833 If the optional argument ONLY-IN-LINE is non-nil and constraining
8834 NEW-POS would move it to a different line, NEW-POS is returned
8835 unconstrained. This useful for commands that move by line, like
8836 C-n or C-a, which should generally respect field boundaries
8837 only in the case where they can still move to the right line.
8838
8839 If the optional argument INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY is non-nil, and OLD-POS has
8840 a non-nil property of that name, then any field boundaries are ignored.
8841
8842 Field boundaries are not noticed if `inhibit-field-text-motion' is non-nil.
8843
8844 - Function: delete-field &optional POS
8845
8846 Delete the field surrounding POS.
8847 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
8848 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
8849
8850 - Function: field-beginning &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
8851
8852 Return the beginning of the field surrounding POS.
8853 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
8854 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
8855 If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the beginning of its
8856 field, then the beginning of the *previous* field is returned.
8857
8858 - Function: field-end &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
8859
8860 Return the end of the field surrounding POS.
8861 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
8862 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
8863 If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the end of its field,
8864 then the end of the *following* field is returned.
8865
8866 - Function: field-string &optional POS
8867
8868 Return the contents of the field surrounding POS as a string.
8869 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
8870 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
8871
8872 - Function: field-string-no-properties &optional POS
8873
8874 Return the contents of the field around POS, without text-properties.
8875 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
8876 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
8877
8878 ** Image support.
8879
8880 Emacs can now display images. Images are inserted into text by giving
8881 strings or buffer text a `display' text property containing one of
8882 (AREA IMAGE) or IMAGE. The display of the `display' property value
8883 replaces the display of the characters having that property.
8884
8885 If the property value has the form (AREA IMAGE), AREA must be one of
8886 `(margin left-margin)', `(margin right-margin)' or `(margin nil)'. If
8887 AREA is `(margin nil)', IMAGE will be displayed in the text area of a
8888 window, otherwise it will be displayed in the left or right marginal
8889 area.
8890
8891 IMAGE is an image specification.
8892
8893 *** Image specifications
8894
8895 Image specifications are lists of the form `(image PROPS)' where PROPS
8896 is a property list whose keys are keyword symbols. Each
8897 specifications must contain a property `:type TYPE' with TYPE being a
8898 symbol specifying the image type, e.g. `xbm'. Properties not
8899 described below are ignored.
8900
8901 The following is a list of properties all image types share.
8902
8903 `:ascent ASCENT'
8904
8905 ASCENT must be a number in the range 0..100, or the symbol `center'.
8906 If it is a number, it specifies the percentage of the image's height
8907 to use for its ascent.
8908
8909 If not specified, ASCENT defaults to the value 50 which means that the
8910 image will be centered with the base line of the row it appears in.
8911
8912 If ASCENT is `center' the image is vertically centered around a
8913 centerline which is the vertical center of text drawn at the position
8914 of the image, in the manner specified by the text properties and
8915 overlays that apply to the image.
8916
8917 `:margin MARGIN'
8918
8919 MARGIN must be either a number >= 0 specifying how many pixels to put
8920 as margin around the image, or a pair (X . Y) with X specifying the
8921 horizontal margin and Y specifying the vertical margin. Default is 0.
8922
8923 `:relief RELIEF'
8924
8925 RELIEF is analogous to the `:relief' attribute of faces. Puts a relief
8926 around an image.
8927
8928 `:conversion ALGO'
8929
8930 Apply an image algorithm to the image before displaying it.
8931
8932 ALGO `laplace' or `emboss' means apply a Laplace or ``emboss''
8933 edge-detection algorithm to the image.
8934
8935 ALGO `(edge-detection :matrix MATRIX :color-adjust ADJUST)' means
8936 apply a general edge-detection algorithm. MATRIX must be either a
8937 nine-element list or a nine-element vector of numbers. A pixel at
8938 position x/y in the transformed image is computed from original pixels
8939 around that position. MATRIX specifies, for each pixel in the
8940 neighborhood of x/y, a factor with which that pixel will influence the
8941 transformed pixel; element 0 specifies the factor for the pixel at
8942 x-1/y-1, element 1 the factor for the pixel at x/y-1 etc. as shown
8943 below.
8944
8945 (x-1/y-1 x/y-1 x+1/y-1
8946 x-1/y x/y x+1/y
8947 x-1/y+1 x/y+1 x+1/y+1)
8948
8949 The resulting pixel is computed from the color intensity of the color
8950 resulting from summing up the RGB values of surrounding pixels,
8951 multiplied by the specified factors, and dividing that sum by the sum
8952 of the factors' absolute values.
8953
8954 Laplace edge-detection currently uses a matrix of
8955
8956 (1 0 0
8957 0 0 0
8958 9 9 -1)
8959
8960 Emboss edge-detection uses a matrix of
8961
8962 ( 2 -1 0
8963 -1 0 1
8964 0 1 -2)
8965
8966 ALGO `disabled' means transform the image so that it looks
8967 ``disabled''.
8968
8969 `:mask MASK'
8970
8971 If MASK is `heuristic' or `(heuristic BG)', build a clipping mask for
8972 the image, so that the background of a frame is visible behind the
8973 image. If BG is not specified, or if BG is t, determine the
8974 background color of the image by looking at the 4 corners of the
8975 image, assuming the most frequently occurring color from the corners is
8976 the background color of the image. Otherwise, BG must be a list `(RED
8977 GREEN BLUE)' specifying the color to assume for the background of the
8978 image.
8979
8980 If MASK is nil, remove a mask from the image, if it has one. Images
8981 in some formats include a mask which can be removed by specifying
8982 `:mask nil'.
8983
8984 `:file FILE'
8985
8986 Load image from FILE. If FILE is not absolute after expanding it,
8987 search for the image in `data-directory'. Some image types support
8988 building images from data. When this is done, no `:file' property
8989 may be present in the image specification.
8990
8991 `:data DATA'
8992
8993 Get image data from DATA. (As of this writing, this is not yet
8994 supported for image type `postscript'). Either :file or :data may be
8995 present in an image specification, but not both. All image types
8996 support strings as DATA, some types allow additional types of DATA.
8997
8998 *** Supported image types
8999
9000 **** XBM, image type `xbm'.
9001
9002 XBM images don't require an external library. Additional image
9003 properties supported are:
9004
9005 `:foreground FG'
9006
9007 FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
9008 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
9009
9010 `:background BG'
9011
9012 BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
9013 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
9014
9015 XBM images can be constructed from data instead of file. In this
9016 case, the image specification must contain the following properties
9017 instead of a `:file' property.
9018
9019 `:width WIDTH'
9020
9021 WIDTH specifies the width of the image in pixels.
9022
9023 `:height HEIGHT'
9024
9025 HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pixels.
9026
9027 `:data DATA'
9028
9029 DATA must be either
9030
9031 1. a string large enough to hold the bitmap data, i.e. it must
9032 have a size >= (WIDTH + 7) / 8 * HEIGHT
9033
9034 2. a bool-vector of size >= WIDTH * HEIGHT
9035
9036 3. a vector of strings or bool-vectors, one for each line of the
9037 bitmap.
9038
9039 4. a string that's an in-memory XBM file. Neither width nor
9040 height may be specified in this case because these are defined
9041 in the file.
9042
9043 **** XPM, image type `xpm'
9044
9045 XPM images require the external library `libXpm', package
9046 `xpm-3.4k.tar.gz', version 3.4k or later. Make sure the library is
9047 found when Emacs is configured by supplying appropriate paths via
9048 `--x-includes' and `--x-libraries'.
9049
9050 Additional image properties supported are:
9051
9052 `:color-symbols SYMBOLS'
9053
9054 SYMBOLS must be a list of pairs (NAME . COLOR), with NAME being the
9055 name of color as it appears in an XPM file, and COLOR being an X color
9056 name.
9057
9058 XPM images can be built from memory instead of files. In that case,
9059 add a `:data' property instead of a `:file' property.
9060
9061 The XPM library uses libz in its implementation so that it is able
9062 to display compressed images.
9063
9064 **** PBM, image type `pbm'
9065
9066 PBM images don't require an external library. Color, gray-scale and
9067 mono images are supported. Additional image properties supported for
9068 mono images are:
9069
9070 `:foreground FG'
9071
9072 FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
9073 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
9074
9075 `:background FG'
9076
9077 BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
9078 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
9079
9080 **** JPEG, image type `jpeg'
9081
9082 Support for JPEG images requires the external library `libjpeg',
9083 package `jpegsrc.v6a.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9084 properties defined.
9085
9086 **** TIFF, image type `tiff'
9087
9088 Support for TIFF images requires the external library `libtiff',
9089 package `tiff-v3.4-tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9090 properties defined.
9091
9092 **** GIF, image type `gif'
9093
9094 Support for GIF images requires the external library `libungif', package
9095 `libungif-4.1.0', or later.
9096
9097 Additional image properties supported are:
9098
9099 `:index INDEX'
9100
9101 INDEX must be an integer >= 0. Load image number INDEX from a
9102 multi-image GIF file. If INDEX is too large, the image displays
9103 as a hollow box.
9104
9105 This could be used to implement limited support for animated GIFs.
9106 For example, the following function displays a multi-image GIF file
9107 at point-min in the current buffer, switching between sub-images
9108 every 0.1 seconds.
9109
9110 (defun show-anim (file max)
9111 "Display multi-image GIF file FILE which contains MAX subimages."
9112 (display-anim (current-buffer) file 0 max t))
9113
9114 (defun display-anim (buffer file idx max first-time)
9115 (when (= idx max)
9116 (setq idx 0))
9117 (let ((img (create-image file nil nil :index idx)))
9118 (save-excursion
9119 (set-buffer buffer)
9120 (goto-char (point-min))
9121 (unless first-time (delete-char 1))
9122 (insert-image img "x"))
9123 (run-with-timer 0.1 nil 'display-anim buffer file (1+ idx) max nil)))
9124
9125 **** PNG, image type `png'
9126
9127 Support for PNG images requires the external library `libpng',
9128 package `libpng-1.0.2.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9129 properties defined.
9130
9131 **** Ghostscript, image type `postscript'.
9132
9133 Additional image properties supported are:
9134
9135 `:pt-width WIDTH'
9136
9137 WIDTH is width of the image in pt (1/72 inch). WIDTH must be an
9138 integer. This is a required property.
9139
9140 `:pt-height HEIGHT'
9141
9142 HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pt (1/72 inch). HEIGHT
9143 must be a integer. This is an required property.
9144
9145 `:bounding-box BOX'
9146
9147 BOX must be a list or vector of 4 integers giving the bounding box of
9148 the PS image, analogous to the `BoundingBox' comment found in PS
9149 files. This is an required property.
9150
9151 Part of the Ghostscript interface is implemented in Lisp. See
9152 lisp/gs.el.
9153
9154 *** Lisp interface.
9155
9156 The variable `image-types' contains a list of those image types
9157 which are supported in the current configuration.
9158
9159 Images are stored in an image cache and removed from the cache when
9160 they haven't been displayed for `image-cache-eviction-delay seconds.
9161 The function `clear-image-cache' can be used to clear the image cache
9162 manually. Images in the cache are compared with `equal', i.e. all
9163 images with `equal' specifications share the same image.
9164
9165 *** Simplified image API, image.el
9166
9167 The new Lisp package image.el contains functions that simplify image
9168 creation and putting images into text. The function `create-image'
9169 can be used to create images. The macro `defimage' can be used to
9170 define an image based on available image types. The functions
9171 `put-image' and `insert-image' can be used to insert an image into a
9172 buffer.
9173
9174 ** Display margins.
9175
9176 Windows can now have margins which are used for special text
9177 and images.
9178
9179 To give a window margins, either set the buffer-local variables
9180 `left-margin-width' and `right-margin-width', or call
9181 `set-window-margins'. The function `window-margins' can be used to
9182 obtain the current settings. To make `left-margin-width' and
9183 `right-margin-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
9184 the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
9185 of the display margins.
9186
9187 You can put text in margins by giving it a `display' text property
9188 containing a pair of the form `(LOCATION . VALUE)', where LOCATION is
9189 one of `left-margin' or `right-margin' or nil. VALUE can be either a
9190 string, an image specification or a stretch specification (see later
9191 in this file).
9192
9193 ** Help display
9194
9195 Emacs displays short help messages in the echo area, when the mouse
9196 moves over a tool-bar item or a piece of text that has a text property
9197 `help-echo'. This feature also applies to strings in the mode line
9198 that have a `help-echo' property.
9199
9200 If the value of the `help-echo' property is a function, that function
9201 is called with three arguments WINDOW, OBJECT and POSITION. WINDOW is
9202 the window in which the help was found.
9203
9204 If OBJECT is a buffer, POS is the position in the buffer where the
9205 `help-echo' text property was found.
9206
9207 If OBJECT is an overlay, that overlay has a `help-echo' property, and
9208 POS is the position in the overlay's buffer under the mouse.
9209
9210 If OBJECT is a string (an overlay string or a string displayed with
9211 the `display' property), POS is the position in that string under the
9212 mouse.
9213
9214 If the value of the `help-echo' property is neither a function nor a
9215 string, it is evaluated to obtain a help string.
9216
9217 For tool-bar and menu-bar items, their key definition is used to
9218 determine the help to display. If their definition contains a
9219 property `:help FORM', FORM is evaluated to determine the help string.
9220 For tool-bar items without a help form, the caption of the item is
9221 used as help string.
9222
9223 The hook `show-help-function' can be set to a function that displays
9224 the help string differently. For example, enabling a tooltip window
9225 causes the help display to appear there instead of in the echo area.
9226
9227 ** Vertical fractional scrolling.
9228
9229 The display of text in windows can be scrolled smoothly in pixels.
9230 This is useful, for example, for making parts of large images visible.
9231
9232 The function `window-vscroll' returns the current value of vertical
9233 scrolling, a non-negative fraction of the canonical character height.
9234 The function `set-window-vscroll' can be used to set the vertical
9235 scrolling value. Here is an example of how these function might be
9236 used.
9237
9238 (global-set-key [A-down]
9239 #'(lambda ()
9240 (interactive)
9241 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
9242 (+ 0.5 (window-vscroll)))))
9243 (global-set-key [A-up]
9244 #'(lambda ()
9245 (interactive)
9246 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
9247 (- (window-vscroll) 0.5)))))
9248
9249 ** New hook `fontification-functions'.
9250
9251 Functions from `fontification-functions' are called from redisplay
9252 when it encounters a region of text that is not yet fontified. This
9253 variable automatically becomes buffer-local when set. Each function
9254 is called with one argument, POS.
9255
9256 At least one of the hook functions should fontify one or more
9257 characters starting at POS in the current buffer. It should mark them
9258 as fontified by giving them a non-nil value of the `fontified' text
9259 property. It may be reasonable for these functions to check for the
9260 `fontified' property and not put it back on, but they do not have to.
9261
9262 ** Tool bar support.
9263
9264 Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. The frame
9265 parameter `tool-bar-lines' (X resource "toolBar", class "ToolBar")
9266 controls how may lines to reserve for the tool bar. A zero value
9267 suppresses the tool bar. If the value is non-zero and
9268 `auto-resize-tool-bars' is non-nil the tool bar's size will be changed
9269 automatically so that all tool bar items are visible.
9270
9271 *** Tool bar item definitions
9272
9273 Tool bar items are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
9274 `tool-bar'. For example `(define-key global-map [tool-bar item1] ITEM)'
9275 where ITEM is a list `(menu-item CAPTION BINDING PROPS...)'.
9276
9277 CAPTION is the caption of the item, If it's not a string, it is
9278 evaluated to get a string. The caption is currently not displayed in
9279 the tool bar, but it is displayed if the item doesn't have a `:help'
9280 property (see below).
9281
9282 BINDING is the tool bar item's binding. Tool bar items with keymaps as
9283 binding are currently ignored.
9284
9285 The following properties are recognized:
9286
9287 `:enable FORM'.
9288
9289 FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is enabled
9290 or disabled.
9291
9292 `:visible FORM'
9293
9294 FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is displayed.
9295
9296 `:filter FUNCTION'
9297
9298 FUNCTION is called with one parameter, the same list BINDING in which
9299 FUNCTION is specified as the filter. The value FUNCTION returns is
9300 used instead of BINDING to display this item.
9301
9302 `:button (TYPE SELECTED)'
9303
9304 TYPE must be one of `:radio' or `:toggle'. SELECTED is evaluated
9305 and specifies whether the button is selected (pressed) or not.
9306
9307 `:image IMAGES'
9308
9309 IMAGES is either a single image specification or a vector of four
9310 image specifications. If it is a vector, this table lists the
9311 meaning of each of the four elements:
9312
9313 Index Use when item is
9314 ----------------------------------------
9315 0 enabled and selected
9316 1 enabled and deselected
9317 2 disabled and selected
9318 3 disabled and deselected
9319
9320 If IMAGE is a single image specification, a Laplace edge-detection
9321 algorithm is used on that image to draw the image in disabled state.
9322
9323 `:help HELP-STRING'.
9324
9325 Gives a help string to display for the tool bar item. This help
9326 is displayed when the mouse is moved over the item.
9327
9328 The function `toolbar-add-item' is a convenience function for adding
9329 toolbar items generally, and `tool-bar-add-item-from-menu' can be used
9330 to define a toolbar item with a binding copied from an item on the
9331 menu bar.
9332
9333 The default bindings use a menu-item :filter to derive the tool-bar
9334 dynamically from variable `tool-bar-map' which may be set
9335 buffer-locally to override the global map.
9336
9337 *** Tool-bar-related variables.
9338
9339 If `auto-resize-tool-bar' is non-nil, the tool bar will automatically
9340 resize to show all defined tool bar items. It will never grow larger
9341 than 1/4 of the frame's size.
9342
9343 If `auto-raise-tool-bar-buttons' is non-nil, tool bar buttons will be
9344 raised when the mouse moves over them.
9345
9346 You can add extra space between tool bar items by setting
9347 `tool-bar-button-margin' to a positive integer specifying a number of
9348 pixels, or a pair of integers (X . Y) specifying horizontal and
9349 vertical margins . Default is 1.
9350
9351 You can change the shadow thickness of tool bar buttons by setting
9352 `tool-bar-button-relief' to an integer. Default is 3.
9353
9354 *** Tool-bar clicks with modifiers.
9355
9356 You can bind commands to clicks with control, shift, meta etc. on
9357 a tool bar item. If
9358
9359 (define-key global-map [tool-bar shell]
9360 '(menu-item "Shell" shell
9361 :image (image :type xpm :file "shell.xpm")))
9362
9363 is the original tool bar item definition, then
9364
9365 (define-key global-map [tool-bar S-shell] 'some-command)
9366
9367 makes a binding to run `some-command' for a shifted click on the same
9368 item.
9369
9370 ** Mode line changes.
9371
9372 *** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
9373
9374 The mode line can be made mouse-sensitive by displaying strings there
9375 that have a `local-map' text property. There are three ways to display
9376 a string with a `local-map' property in the mode line.
9377
9378 1. The mode line spec contains a variable whose string value has
9379 a `local-map' text property.
9380
9381 2. The mode line spec contains a format specifier (e.g. `%12b'), and
9382 that format specifier has a `local-map' property.
9383
9384 3. The mode line spec contains a list containing `:eval FORM'. FORM
9385 is evaluated. If the result is a string, and that string has a
9386 `local-map' property.
9387
9388 The same mechanism is used to determine the `face' and `help-echo'
9389 properties of strings in the mode line. See `bindings.el' for an
9390 example.
9391
9392 *** If a mode line element has the form `(:eval FORM)', FORM is
9393 evaluated and the result is used as mode line element.
9394
9395 *** You can suppress mode-line display by setting the buffer-local
9396 variable mode-line-format to nil.
9397
9398 *** A headerline can now be displayed at the top of a window.
9399
9400 This mode line's contents are controlled by the new variable
9401 `header-line-format' and `default-header-line-format' which are
9402 completely analogous to `mode-line-format' and
9403 `default-mode-line-format'. A value of nil means don't display a top
9404 line.
9405
9406 The appearance of top mode lines is controlled by the face
9407 `header-line'.
9408
9409 The function `coordinates-in-window-p' returns `header-line' for a
9410 position in the header-line.
9411
9412 ** Text property `display'
9413
9414 The `display' text property is used to insert images into text,
9415 replace text with other text, display text in marginal area, and it is
9416 also used to control other aspects of how text displays. The value of
9417 the `display' property should be a display specification, as described
9418 below, or a list or vector containing display specifications.
9419
9420 *** Replacing text, displaying text in marginal areas
9421
9422 To replace the text having the `display' property with some other
9423 text, use a display specification of the form `(LOCATION STRING)'.
9424
9425 If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)', STRING is displayed in the left
9426 marginal area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in
9427 the right marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' STRING
9428 is displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
9429 simpler form STRING as property value.
9430
9431 *** Variable width and height spaces
9432
9433 To display a space of fractional width or height, use a display
9434 specification of the form `(LOCATION STRECH)'. If LOCATION is
9435 `(margin left-margin)', the space is displayed in the left marginal
9436 area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in the right
9437 marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the space is
9438 displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
9439 simpler form STRETCH as property value.
9440
9441 The stretch specification STRETCH itself is a list of the form `(space
9442 PROPS)', where PROPS is a property list which can contain the
9443 properties described below.
9444
9445 The display of the fractional space replaces the display of the
9446 characters having the `display' property.
9447
9448 - :width WIDTH
9449
9450 Specifies that the space width should be WIDTH times the normal
9451 character width. WIDTH can be an integer or floating point number.
9452
9453 - :relative-width FACTOR
9454
9455 Specifies that the width of the stretch should be computed from the
9456 first character in a group of consecutive characters that have the
9457 same `display' property. The computation is done by multiplying the
9458 width of that character by FACTOR.
9459
9460 - :align-to HPOS
9461
9462 Specifies that the space should be wide enough to reach HPOS. The
9463 value HPOS is measured in units of the normal character width.
9464
9465 Exactly one of the above properties should be used.
9466
9467 - :height HEIGHT
9468
9469 Specifies the height of the space, as HEIGHT, measured in terms of the
9470 normal line height.
9471
9472 - :relative-height FACTOR
9473
9474 The height of the space is computed as the product of the height
9475 of the text having the `display' property and FACTOR.
9476
9477 - :ascent ASCENT
9478
9479 Specifies that ASCENT percent of the height of the stretch should be
9480 used for the ascent of the stretch, i.e. for the part above the
9481 baseline. The value of ASCENT must be a non-negative number less or
9482 equal to 100.
9483
9484 You should not use both `:height' and `:relative-height' together.
9485
9486 *** Images
9487
9488 A display specification for an image has the form `(LOCATION
9489 . IMAGE)', where IMAGE is an image specification. The image replaces,
9490 in the display, the characters having this display specification in
9491 their `display' text property. If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)',
9492 the image will be displayed in the left marginal area, if it is
9493 `(margin right-margin)' it will be displayed in the right marginal
9494 area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the image will be displayed in
9495 the text. In the latter case you can also use the simpler form IMAGE
9496 as display specification.
9497
9498 *** Other display properties
9499
9500 - (space-width FACTOR)
9501
9502 Specifies that space characters in the text having that property
9503 should be displayed FACTOR times as wide as normal; FACTOR must be an
9504 integer or float.
9505
9506 - (height HEIGHT)
9507
9508 Display text having this property in a font that is smaller or larger.
9509
9510 If HEIGHT is a list of the form `(+ N)', where N is an integer, that
9511 means to use a font that is N steps larger. If HEIGHT is a list of
9512 the form `(- N)', that means to use a font that is N steps smaller. A
9513 ``step'' is defined by the set of available fonts; each size for which
9514 a font is available counts as a step.
9515
9516 If HEIGHT is a number, that means to use a font that is HEIGHT times
9517 as tall as the frame's default font.
9518
9519 If HEIGHT is a symbol, it is called as a function with the current
9520 height as argument. The function should return the new height to use.
9521
9522 Otherwise, HEIGHT is evaluated to get the new height, with the symbol
9523 `height' bound to the current specified font height.
9524
9525 - (raise FACTOR)
9526
9527 FACTOR must be a number, specifying a multiple of the current
9528 font's height. If it is positive, that means to display the characters
9529 raised. If it is negative, that means to display them lower down. The
9530 amount of raising or lowering is computed without taking account of the
9531 `height' subproperty.
9532
9533 *** Conditional display properties
9534
9535 All display specifications can be conditionalized. If a specification
9536 has the form `(when CONDITION . SPEC)', the specification SPEC applies
9537 only when CONDITION yields a non-nil value when evaluated. During the
9538 evaluation, `object' is bound to the string or buffer having the
9539 conditional display property; `position' and `buffer-position' are
9540 bound to the position within `object' and the buffer position where
9541 the display property was found, respectively. Both positions can be
9542 different when object is a string.
9543
9544 The normal specification consisting of SPEC only is equivalent to
9545 `(when t . SPEC)'.
9546
9547 ** New menu separator types.
9548
9549 Emacs now supports more than one menu separator type. Menu items with
9550 item names consisting of dashes only (including zero dashes) are
9551 treated like before. In addition, the following item names are used
9552 to specify other menu separator types.
9553
9554 - `--no-line' or `--space', or `--:space', or `--:noLine'
9555
9556 No separator lines are drawn, but a small space is inserted where the
9557 separator occurs.
9558
9559 - `--single-line' or `--:singleLine'
9560
9561 A single line in the menu's foreground color.
9562
9563 - `--double-line' or `--:doubleLine'
9564
9565 A double line in the menu's foreground color.
9566
9567 - `--single-dashed-line' or `--:singleDashedLine'
9568
9569 A single dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
9570
9571 - `--double-dashed-line' or `--:doubleDashedLine'
9572
9573 A double dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
9574
9575 - `--shadow-etched-in' or `--:shadowEtchedIn'
9576
9577 A single line with 3D sunken appearance. This is the form
9578 displayed for item names consisting of dashes only.
9579
9580 - `--shadow-etched-out' or `--:shadowEtchedOut'
9581
9582 A single line with 3D raised appearance.
9583
9584 - `--shadow-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedInDash'
9585
9586 A single dashed line with 3D sunken appearance.
9587
9588 - `--shadow-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedOutDash'
9589
9590 A single dashed line with 3D raise appearance.
9591
9592 - `--shadow-double-etched-in' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedIn'
9593
9594 Two lines with 3D sunken appearance.
9595
9596 - `--shadow-double-etched-out' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOut'
9597
9598 Two lines with 3D raised appearance.
9599
9600 - `--shadow-double-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedInDash'
9601
9602 Two dashed lines with 3D sunken appearance.
9603
9604 - `--shadow-double-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOutDash'
9605
9606 Two dashed lines with 3D raised appearance.
9607
9608 Under LessTif/Motif, the last four separator types are displayed like
9609 the corresponding single-line separators.
9610
9611 ** New frame parameters for scroll bar colors.
9612
9613 The new frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
9614 `scroll-bar-background' can be used to change scroll bar colors.
9615 Their value must be either a color name, a string, or nil to specify
9616 that scroll bars should use a default color. For toolkit scroll bars,
9617 default colors are toolkit specific. For non-toolkit scroll bars, the
9618 default background is the background color of the frame, and the
9619 default foreground is black.
9620
9621 The X resource name of these parameters are `scrollBarForeground'
9622 (class ScrollBarForeground) and `scrollBarBackground' (class
9623 `ScrollBarBackground').
9624
9625 Setting these parameters overrides toolkit specific X resource
9626 settings for scroll bar colors.
9627
9628 ** You can set `redisplay-dont-pause' to a non-nil value to prevent
9629 display updates from being interrupted when input is pending.
9630
9631 ** Changing a window's width may now change its window start if it
9632 starts on a continuation line. The new window start is computed based
9633 on the window's new width, starting from the start of the continued
9634 line as the start of the screen line with the minimum distance from
9635 the original window start.
9636
9637 ** The variable `hscroll-step' and the functions
9638 `hscroll-point-visible' and `hscroll-window-column' have been removed
9639 now that proper horizontal scrolling is implemented.
9640
9641 ** Windows can now be made fixed-width and/or fixed-height.
9642
9643 A window is fixed-size if its buffer has a buffer-local variable
9644 `window-size-fixed' whose value is not nil. A value of `height' makes
9645 windows fixed-height, a value of `width' makes them fixed-width, any
9646 other non-nil value makes them both fixed-width and fixed-height.
9647
9648 The following code makes all windows displaying the current buffer
9649 fixed-width and fixed-height.
9650
9651 (set (make-local-variable 'window-size-fixed) t)
9652
9653 A call to enlarge-window on a window gives an error if that window is
9654 fixed-width and it is tried to change the window's width, or if the
9655 window is fixed-height, and it is tried to change its height. To
9656 change the size of a fixed-size window, bind `window-size-fixed'
9657 temporarily to nil, for example
9658
9659 (let ((window-size-fixed nil))
9660 (enlarge-window 10))
9661
9662 Likewise, an attempt to split a fixed-height window vertically,
9663 or a fixed-width window horizontally results in a error.
9664
9665 ** The cursor-type frame parameter is now supported on MS-DOS
9666 terminals. When Emacs starts, it by default changes the cursor shape
9667 to a solid box, as it does on Unix. The `cursor-type' frame parameter
9668 overrides this as it does on Unix, except that the bar cursor is
9669 horizontal rather than vertical (since the MS-DOS display doesn't
9670 support a vertical-bar cursor).
9671
9672
9673 \f
9674 * Emacs 20.7 is a bug-fix release with few user-visible changes
9675
9676 ** It is now possible to use CCL-based coding systems for keyboard
9677 input.
9678
9679 ** ange-ftp now handles FTP security extensions, like Kerberos.
9680
9681 ** Rmail has been extended to recognize more forms of digest messages.
9682
9683 ** Now, most coding systems set in keyboard coding system work not
9684 only for character input, but also in incremental search. The
9685 exceptions are such coding systems that handle 2-byte character sets
9686 (e.g euc-kr, euc-jp) and that use ISO's escape sequence
9687 (e.g. iso-2022-jp). They are ignored in incremental search.
9688
9689 ** Support for Macintosh PowerPC-based machines running GNU/Linux has
9690 been added.
9691
9692 \f
9693 * Emacs 20.6 is a bug-fix release with one user-visible change
9694
9695 ** Support for ARM-based non-RISCiX machines has been added.
9696
9697
9698 \f
9699 * Emacs 20.5 is a bug-fix release with no user-visible changes.
9700
9701 ** Not new, but not mentioned before:
9702 M-w when Transient Mark mode is enabled disables the mark.
9703 \f
9704 * Changes in Emacs 20.4
9705
9706 ** Init file may be called .emacs.el.
9707
9708 You can now call the Emacs init file `.emacs.el'.
9709 Formerly the name had to be `.emacs'. If you use the name
9710 `.emacs.el', you can byte-compile the file in the usual way.
9711
9712 If both `.emacs' and `.emacs.el' exist, the latter file
9713 is the one that is used.
9714
9715 ** shell-command, and shell-command-on-region, now return
9716 the exit code of the command (unless it is asynchronous).
9717 Also, you can specify a place to put the error output,
9718 separate from the command's regular output.
9719 Interactively, the variable shell-command-default-error-buffer
9720 says where to put error output; set it to a buffer name.
9721 In calls from Lisp, an optional argument ERROR-BUFFER specifies
9722 the buffer name.
9723
9724 When you specify a non-nil error buffer (or buffer name), any error
9725 output is inserted before point in that buffer, with \f\n to separate
9726 it from the previous batch of error output. The error buffer is not
9727 cleared, so error output from successive commands accumulates there.
9728
9729 ** Setting the default value of enable-multibyte-characters to nil in
9730 the .emacs file, either explicitly using setq-default, or via Custom,
9731 is now essentially equivalent to using --unibyte: all buffers
9732 created during startup will be made unibyte after loading .emacs.
9733
9734 ** C-x C-f now handles the wildcards * and ? in file names. For
9735 example, typing C-x C-f c*.c RET visits all the files whose names
9736 match c*.c. To visit a file whose name contains * or ?, add the
9737 quoting sequence /: to the beginning of the file name.
9738
9739 ** The M-x commands keep-lines, flush-lines and count-matches
9740 now have the same feature as occur and query-replace:
9741 if the pattern contains any upper case letters, then
9742 they never ignore case.
9743
9744 ** The end-of-line format conversion feature previously mentioned
9745 under `* Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows' actually
9746 applies to all operating systems. Emacs recognizes from the contents
9747 of a file what convention it uses to separate lines--newline, CRLF, or
9748 just CR--and automatically converts the contents to the normal Emacs
9749 convention (using newline to separate lines) for editing. This is a
9750 part of the general feature of coding system conversion.
9751
9752 If you subsequently save the buffer, Emacs converts the text back to
9753 the same format that was used in the file before.
9754
9755 You can turn off end-of-line conversion by setting the variable
9756 `inhibit-eol-conversion' to non-nil, e.g. with Custom in the MULE group.
9757
9758 ** The character set property `prefered-coding-system' has been
9759 renamed to `preferred-coding-system', for the sake of correct spelling.
9760 This is a fairly internal feature, so few programs should be affected.
9761
9762 ** Mode-line display of end-of-line format is changed.
9763 The indication of the end-of-line format of the file visited by a
9764 buffer is now more explicit when that format is not the usual one for
9765 your operating system. For example, the DOS-style end-of-line format
9766 is displayed as "(DOS)" on Unix and GNU/Linux systems. The usual
9767 end-of-line format is still displayed as a single character (colon for
9768 Unix, backslash for DOS and Windows, and forward slash for the Mac).
9769
9770 The values of the variables eol-mnemonic-unix, eol-mnemonic-dos,
9771 eol-mnemonic-mac, and eol-mnemonic-undecided, which are strings,
9772 control what is displayed in the mode line for each end-of-line
9773 format. You can now customize these variables.
9774
9775 ** In the previous version of Emacs, tar-mode didn't work well if a
9776 filename contained non-ASCII characters. Now this is fixed. Such a
9777 filename is decoded by file-name-coding-system if the default value of
9778 enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil.
9779
9780 ** The command temp-buffer-resize-mode toggles a minor mode
9781 in which temporary buffers (such as help buffers) are given
9782 windows just big enough to hold the whole contents.
9783
9784 ** If you use completion.el, you must now run the function
9785 dynamic-completion-mode to enable it. Just loading the file
9786 doesn't have any effect.
9787
9788 ** In Flyspell mode, the default is now to make just one Ispell process,
9789 not one per buffer.
9790
9791 ** If you use iswitchb but do not call (iswitchb-default-keybindings) to
9792 use the default keybindings, you will need to add the following line:
9793 (add-hook 'minibuffer-setup-hook 'iswitchb-minibuffer-setup)
9794
9795 ** Auto-show mode is no longer enabled just by loading auto-show.el.
9796 To control it, set `auto-show-mode' via Custom or use the
9797 `auto-show-mode' command.
9798
9799 ** Handling of X fonts' ascent/descent parameters has been changed to
9800 avoid redisplay problems. As a consequence, compared with previous
9801 versions the line spacing and frame size now differ with some font
9802 choices, typically increasing by a pixel per line. This change
9803 occurred in version 20.3 but was not documented then.
9804
9805 ** If you select the bar cursor style, it uses the frame's
9806 cursor-color, rather than the cursor foreground pixel.
9807
9808 ** In multibyte mode, Rmail decodes incoming MIME messages using the
9809 character set specified in the message. If you want to disable this
9810 feature, set the variable rmail-decode-mime-charset to nil.
9811
9812 ** Not new, but not mentioned previously in NEWS: when you use #! at
9813 the beginning of a file to make it executable and specify an
9814 interpreter program, Emacs looks on the second line for the -*- mode
9815 and variable specification, as well as on the first line.
9816
9817 ** Support for IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters.
9818
9819 The new command M-x codepage-setup creates a special coding system
9820 that can be used to convert text between a specific IBM codepage and
9821 one of the character sets built into Emacs which matches that
9822 codepage. For example, codepage 850 corresponds to Latin-1 character
9823 set, codepage 855 corresponds to Cyrillic-ISO character set, etc.
9824
9825 Windows codepages 1250, 1251 and some others, where Windows deviates
9826 from the corresponding ISO character set, are also supported.
9827
9828 IBM box-drawing characters and other glyphs which don't have
9829 equivalents in the corresponding ISO character set, are converted to
9830 a character defined by dos-unsupported-char-glyph on MS-DOS, and to
9831 `?' on other systems.
9832
9833 IBM codepages are widely used on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, so this
9834 feature is most useful on those platforms, but it can also be used on
9835 Unix.
9836
9837 Emacs compiled for MS-DOS automatically loads the support for the
9838 current codepage when it starts.
9839
9840 ** Mail changes
9841
9842 *** When mail is sent using compose-mail (C-x m), and if
9843 `mail-send-nonascii' is set to the new default value `mime',
9844 appropriate MIME headers are added. The headers are added only if
9845 non-ASCII characters are present in the body of the mail, and no other
9846 MIME headers are already present. For example, the following three
9847 headers are added if the coding system used in the *mail* buffer is
9848 latin-1:
9849
9850 MIME-version: 1.0
9851 Content-type: text/plain; charset=iso-8859-1
9852 Content-Transfer-Encoding: 8bit
9853
9854 *** The new variable default-sendmail-coding-system specifies the
9855 default way to encode outgoing mail. This has higher priority than
9856 default-buffer-file-coding-system but has lower priority than
9857 sendmail-coding-system and the local value of
9858 buffer-file-coding-system.
9859
9860 You should not set this variable manually. Instead, set
9861 sendmail-coding-system to specify a fixed encoding for all outgoing
9862 mail.
9863
9864 *** When you try to send a message that contains non-ASCII characters,
9865 if the coding system specified by those variables doesn't handle them,
9866 Emacs will ask you to select a suitable coding system while showing a
9867 list of possible coding systems.
9868
9869 ** CC Mode changes
9870
9871 *** c-default-style can now take an association list that maps major
9872 modes to style names. When this variable is an alist, Java mode no
9873 longer hardcodes a setting to "java" style. See the variable's
9874 docstring for details.
9875
9876 *** It's now possible to put a list as the offset on a syntactic
9877 symbol. The list is evaluated recursively until a non-nil offset is
9878 found. This is useful to combine several lineup functions to act in a
9879 prioritized order on a single line. However, none of the supplied
9880 lineup functions use this feature currently.
9881
9882 *** New syntactic symbol catch-clause, which is used on the "catch" and
9883 "finally" lines in try-catch constructs in C++ and Java.
9884
9885 *** New cleanup brace-catch-brace on c-cleanup-list, which does for
9886 "catch" lines what brace-elseif-brace does for "else if" lines.
9887
9888 *** The braces of Java anonymous inner classes are treated separately
9889 from the braces of other classes in auto-newline mode. Two new
9890 symbols inexpr-class-open and inexpr-class-close may be used on
9891 c-hanging-braces-alist to control the automatic newlines used for
9892 anonymous classes.
9893
9894 *** Support for the Pike language added, along with new Pike specific
9895 syntactic symbols: inlambda, lambda-intro-cont
9896
9897 *** Support for Java anonymous classes via new syntactic symbol
9898 inexpr-class. New syntactic symbol inexpr-statement for Pike
9899 support and gcc-style statements inside expressions. New lineup
9900 function c-lineup-inexpr-block.
9901
9902 *** New syntactic symbol brace-entry-open which is used in brace lists
9903 (i.e. static initializers) when a list entry starts with an open
9904 brace. These used to be recognized as brace-list-entry's.
9905 c-electric-brace also recognizes brace-entry-open braces
9906 (brace-list-entry's can no longer be electrified).
9907
9908 *** New command c-indent-line-or-region, not bound by default.
9909
9910 *** `#' is only electric when typed in the indentation of a line.
9911
9912 *** Parentheses are now electric (via the new command c-electric-paren)
9913 for auto-reindenting lines when parens are typed.
9914
9915 *** In "gnu" style, inline-open offset is now set to zero.
9916
9917 *** Uniform handling of the inclass syntactic symbol. The indentation
9918 associated with it is now always relative to the class opening brace.
9919 This means that the indentation behavior has changed in some
9920 circumstances, but only if you've put anything besides 0 on the
9921 class-open syntactic symbol (none of the default styles do that).
9922
9923 ** Gnus changes.
9924
9925 *** New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
9926 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added. See the
9927 Gnus manual for the full story.
9928
9929 *** The nndraft backend has returned, but works differently than
9930 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the nndraft
9931 group, which is created automatically.
9932
9933 *** `gnus-alter-header-function' can now be used to alter header
9934 values.
9935
9936 *** `gnus-summary-goto-article' now accept Message-ID's.
9937
9938 *** A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
9939 outside the region: `C-c C-v'.
9940
9941 *** You can now post to component group in nnvirtual groups with
9942 `C-u C-c C-c'.
9943
9944 *** `nntp-rlogin-program' -- new variable to ease customization.
9945
9946 *** `C-u C-c C-c' in `gnus-article-edit-mode' will now inhibit
9947 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
9948
9949 *** New element in `gnus-boring-article-headers' -- `long-to'.
9950
9951 *** `M-i' symbolic prefix command. See the section "Symbolic
9952 Prefixes" in the Gnus manual for details.
9953
9954 *** `L' and `I' in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
9955 `a' to add the score rule to the "all.SCORE" file.
9956
9957 *** `gnus-simplify-subject-functions' variable to allow greater
9958 control over simplification.
9959
9960 *** `A T' -- new command for fetching the current thread.
9961
9962 *** `/ T' -- new command for including the current thread in the
9963 limit.
9964
9965 *** `M-RET' is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
9966
9967 *** \\1-expressions are now valid in `nnmail-split-methods'.
9968
9969 *** The `custom-face-lookup' function has been removed.
9970 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
9971 rewrite them to use `face-spec-set' instead.
9972
9973 *** Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
9974 `a' forces normal posting method.
9975
9976 *** New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper text
9977 -- `W d'.
9978
9979 *** For easier debugging of nntp, you can set `nntp-record-commands'
9980 to a non-nil value.
9981
9982 *** nntp now uses ~/.authinfo, a .netrc-like file, for controlling
9983 where and how to send AUTHINFO to NNTP servers.
9984
9985 *** A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
9986 has been added.
9987
9988 *** A history of where mails have been split is available.
9989
9990 *** A new article date command has been added -- `article-date-iso8601'.
9991
9992 *** Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
9993 `gnus-score-thread-simplify'.
9994
9995 *** A new function for citing in Message has been added --
9996 `message-cite-original-without-signature'.
9997
9998 *** `article-strip-all-blank-lines' -- new article command.
9999
10000 *** A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
10001 been added.
10002
10003 *** A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
10004 `gnus-adaptive-word-minimum' variable.
10005
10006 *** The "lapsed date" article header can be kept continually
10007 updated by the `gnus-start-date-timer' command.
10008
10009 *** Web listserv archives can be read with the nnlistserv backend.
10010
10011 *** Old dejanews archives can now be read by nnweb.
10012
10013 *** `gnus-posting-styles' has been re-activated.
10014
10015 ** Changes to TeX and LaTeX mode
10016
10017 *** The new variable `tex-start-options-string' can be used to give
10018 options for the TeX run. The default value causes TeX to run in
10019 nonstopmode. For an interactive TeX run set it to nil or "".
10020
10021 *** The command `tex-feed-input' sends input to the Tex Shell. In a
10022 TeX buffer it is bound to the keys C-RET, C-c RET, and C-c C-m (some
10023 of these keys may not work on all systems). For instance, if you run
10024 TeX interactively and if the TeX run stops because of an error, you
10025 can continue it without leaving the TeX buffer by typing C-RET.
10026
10027 *** The Tex Shell Buffer is now in `compilation-shell-minor-mode'.
10028 All error-parsing commands of the Compilation major mode are available
10029 but bound to keys that don't collide with the shell. Thus you can use
10030 the Tex Shell for command line executions like a usual shell.
10031
10032 *** The commands `tex-validate-region' and `tex-validate-buffer' check
10033 the matching of braces and $'s. The errors are listed in a *Occur*
10034 buffer and you can use C-c C-c or mouse-2 to go to a particular
10035 mismatch.
10036
10037 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
10038
10039 *** The table of contents buffer can now also display labels and
10040 file boundaries in addition to sections. Use `l', `i', and `c' keys.
10041
10042 *** Labels derived from context (the section heading) are now
10043 lowercase by default. To make the label legal in LaTeX, latin-1
10044 characters will lose their accent. All Mule characters will be
10045 removed from the label.
10046
10047 *** The automatic display of cross reference information can also use
10048 a window instead of the echo area. See variable `reftex-auto-view-crossref'.
10049
10050 *** kpsewhich can be used by RefTeX to find TeX and BibTeX files. See the
10051 customization group `reftex-finding-files'.
10052
10053 *** The option `reftex-bibfile-ignore-list' has been renamed to
10054 `reftex-bibfile-ignore-regexps' and indeed can be fed with regular
10055 expressions.
10056
10057 *** Multiple Selection buffers are now hidden buffers.
10058
10059 ** New/deleted modes and packages
10060
10061 *** The package snmp-mode.el provides major modes for editing SNMP and
10062 SNMPv2 MIBs. It has entries on `auto-mode-alist'.
10063
10064 *** The package sql.el provides a major mode, M-x sql-mode, for
10065 editing SQL files, and M-x sql-interactive-mode for interacting with
10066 SQL interpreters. It has an entry on `auto-mode-alist'.
10067
10068 *** M-x highlight-changes-mode provides a minor mode displaying buffer
10069 changes with a special face.
10070
10071 *** ispell4.el has been deleted. It got in the way of ispell.el and
10072 this was hard to fix reliably. It has long been obsolete -- use
10073 Ispell 3.1 and ispell.el.
10074 \f
10075 * MS-DOS changes in Emacs 20.4
10076
10077 ** Emacs compiled for MS-DOS now supports MULE features better.
10078 This includes support for display of all ISO 8859-N character sets,
10079 conversion to and from IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters,
10080 and automatic setup of the MULE environment at startup. For details,
10081 check out the section `MS-DOS and MULE' in the manual.
10082
10083 The MS-DOS installation procedure automatically configures and builds
10084 Emacs with input method support if it finds an unpacked Leim
10085 distribution when the config.bat script is run.
10086
10087 ** Formerly, the value of lpr-command did not affect printing on
10088 MS-DOS unless print-region-function was set to nil, but now it
10089 controls whether an external program is invoked or output is written
10090 directly to a printer port. Similarly, in the previous version of
10091 Emacs, the value of ps-lpr-command did not affect PostScript printing
10092 on MS-DOS unless ps-printer-name was set to something other than a
10093 string (eg. t or `pipe'), but now it controls whether an external
10094 program is used. (These changes were made so that configuration of
10095 printing variables would be almost identical across all platforms.)
10096
10097 ** In the previous version of Emacs, PostScript and non-PostScript
10098 output was piped to external programs, but because most print programs
10099 available for MS-DOS and MS-Windows cannot read data from their standard
10100 input, on those systems the data to be output is now written to a
10101 temporary file whose name is passed as the last argument to the external
10102 program.
10103
10104 An exception is made for `print', a standard program on Windows NT,
10105 and `nprint', a standard program on Novell Netware. For both of these
10106 programs, the command line is constructed in the appropriate syntax
10107 automatically, using only the value of printer-name or ps-printer-name
10108 as appropriate--the value of the relevant `-switches' variable is
10109 ignored, as both programs have no useful switches.
10110
10111 ** The value of the variable dos-printer (cf. dos-ps-printer), if it has
10112 a value, overrides the value of printer-name (cf. ps-printer-name), on
10113 MS-DOS and MS-Windows only. This has been true since version 20.3, but
10114 was not documented clearly before.
10115
10116 ** All the Emacs games now work on MS-DOS terminals.
10117 This includes Tetris and Snake.
10118 \f
10119 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.4
10120
10121 ** New functions line-beginning-position and line-end-position
10122 return the position of the beginning or end of the current line.
10123 They both accept an optional argument, which has the same
10124 meaning as the argument to beginning-of-line or end-of-line.
10125
10126 ** find-file and allied functions now have an optional argument
10127 WILDCARD. If this is non-nil, they do wildcard processing,
10128 and visit all files that match the wildcard pattern.
10129
10130 ** Changes in the file-attributes function.
10131
10132 *** The file size returned by file-attributes may be an integer or a float.
10133 It is an integer if the size fits in a Lisp integer, float otherwise.
10134
10135 *** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
10136 the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a cons cell containing two
10137 integers.
10138
10139 ** The new function directory-files-and-attributes returns a list of
10140 files in a directory and their attributes. It accepts the same
10141 arguments as directory-files and has similar semantics, except that
10142 file names and attributes are returned.
10143
10144 ** The new function file-attributes-lessp is a helper function for
10145 sorting the list generated by directory-files-and-attributes. It
10146 accepts two arguments, each a list of a file name and its attributes.
10147 It compares the file names of each according to string-lessp and
10148 returns the result.
10149
10150 ** The new function file-expand-wildcards expands a wildcard-pattern
10151 to produce a list of existing files that match the pattern.
10152
10153 ** New functions for base64 conversion:
10154
10155 The function base64-encode-region converts a part of the buffer
10156 into the base64 code used in MIME. base64-decode-region
10157 performs the opposite conversion. Line-breaking is supported
10158 optionally.
10159
10160 Functions base64-encode-string and base64-decode-string do a similar
10161 job on the text in a string. They return the value as a new string.
10162
10163 **
10164 The new function process-running-child-p
10165 will tell you if a subprocess has given control of its
10166 terminal to its own child process.
10167
10168 ** interrupt-process and such functions have a new feature:
10169 when the second argument is `lambda', they send a signal
10170 to the running child of the subshell, if any, but if the shell
10171 itself owns its terminal, no signal is sent.
10172
10173 ** There are new widget types `plist' and `alist' which can
10174 be used for customizing variables whose values are plists or alists.
10175
10176 ** easymenu.el now understands `:key-sequence' and `:style button'.
10177 :included is an alias for :visible.
10178
10179 easy-menu-add-item now understands the values returned by
10180 easy-menu-remove-item and easy-menu-item-present-p. This can be used
10181 to move or copy menu entries.
10182
10183 ** Multibyte editing changes
10184
10185 *** The definitions of sref and char-bytes are changed. Now, sref is
10186 an alias of aref and char-bytes always returns 1. This change is to
10187 make some Emacs Lisp code which works on 20.2 and earlier also
10188 work on the latest Emacs. Such code uses a combination of sref and
10189 char-bytes in a loop typically as below:
10190 (setq char (sref str idx)
10191 idx (+ idx (char-bytes idx)))
10192 The byte-compiler now warns that this is obsolete.
10193
10194 If you want to know how many bytes a specific multibyte character
10195 (say, CH) occupies in a multibyte buffer, use this code:
10196 (charset-bytes (char-charset ch))
10197
10198 *** In multibyte mode, when you narrow a buffer to some region, and the
10199 region is preceded or followed by non-ASCII codes, inserting or
10200 deleting at the head or the end of the region may signal this error:
10201
10202 Byte combining across boundary of accessible buffer text inhibited
10203
10204 This is to avoid some bytes being combined together into a character
10205 across the boundary.
10206
10207 *** The functions find-charset-region and find-charset-string include
10208 `unknown' in the returned list in the following cases:
10209 o The current buffer or the target string is unibyte and
10210 contains 8-bit characters.
10211 o The current buffer or the target string is multibyte and
10212 contains invalid characters.
10213
10214 *** The functions decode-coding-region and encode-coding-region remove
10215 text properties of the target region. Ideally, they should correctly
10216 preserve text properties, but for the moment, it's hard. Removing
10217 text properties is better than preserving them in a less-than-correct
10218 way.
10219
10220 *** prefer-coding-system sets EOL conversion of default coding systems.
10221 If the argument to prefer-coding-system specifies a certain type of
10222 end of line conversion, the default coding systems set by
10223 prefer-coding-system will specify that conversion type for end of line.
10224
10225 *** The new function thai-compose-string can be used to properly
10226 compose Thai characters in a string.
10227
10228 ** The primitive `define-prefix-command' now takes an optional third
10229 argument NAME, which should be a string. It supplies the menu name
10230 for the created keymap. Keymaps created in order to be displayed as
10231 menus should always use the third argument.
10232
10233 ** The meanings of optional second arguments for read-char,
10234 read-event, and read-char-exclusive are flipped. Now the second
10235 arguments are INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. These functions use the current
10236 input method (if any) if and only if INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD is non-nil.
10237
10238 ** The new function clear-this-command-keys empties out the contents
10239 of the vector that (this-command-keys) returns. This is useful in
10240 programs that read passwords, to prevent the passwords from echoing
10241 inadvertently as part of the next command in certain cases.
10242
10243 ** The new macro `with-temp-message' displays a temporary message in
10244 the echo area, while executing some Lisp code. Like `progn', it
10245 returns the value of the last form, but it also restores the previous
10246 echo area contents.
10247
10248 (with-temp-message MESSAGE &rest BODY)
10249
10250 ** The function `require' now takes an optional third argument
10251 NOERROR. If it is non-nil, then there is no error if the
10252 requested feature cannot be loaded.
10253
10254 ** In the function modify-face, an argument of (nil) for the
10255 foreground color, background color or stipple pattern
10256 means to clear out that attribute.
10257
10258 ** The `outer-window-id' frame property of an X frame
10259 gives the window number of the outermost X window for the frame.
10260
10261 ** Temporary buffers made with with-output-to-temp-buffer are now
10262 read-only by default, and normally use the major mode Help mode
10263 unless you put them in some other non-Fundamental mode before the
10264 end of with-output-to-temp-buffer.
10265
10266 ** The new functions gap-position and gap-size return information on
10267 the gap of the current buffer.
10268
10269 ** The new functions position-bytes and byte-to-position provide a way
10270 to convert between character positions and byte positions in the
10271 current buffer.
10272
10273 ** vc.el defines two new macros, `edit-vc-file' and `with-vc-file', to
10274 facilitate working with version-controlled files from Lisp programs.
10275 These macros check out a given file automatically if needed, and check
10276 it back in after any modifications have been made.
10277 \f
10278 * Installation Changes in Emacs 20.3
10279
10280 ** The default value of load-path now includes most subdirectories of
10281 the site-specific directories /usr/local/share/emacs/site-lisp and
10282 /usr/local/share/emacs/VERSION/site-lisp, in addition to those
10283 directories themselves. Both immediate subdirectories and
10284 subdirectories multiple levels down are added to load-path.
10285
10286 Not all subdirectories are included, though. Subdirectories whose
10287 names do not start with a letter or digit are excluded.
10288 Subdirectories named RCS or CVS are excluded. Also, a subdirectory
10289 which contains a file named `.nosearch' is excluded. You can use
10290 these methods to prevent certain subdirectories from being searched.
10291
10292 Emacs finds these subdirectories and adds them to load-path when it
10293 starts up. While it would be cleaner to find the subdirectories each
10294 time Emacs loads a file, that would be much slower.
10295
10296 This feature is an incompatible change. If you have stored some Emacs
10297 Lisp files in a subdirectory of the site-lisp directory specifically
10298 to prevent them from being used, you will need to rename the
10299 subdirectory to start with a non-alphanumeric character, or create a
10300 `.nosearch' file in it, in order to continue to achieve the desired
10301 results.
10302
10303 ** Emacs no longer includes an old version of the C preprocessor from
10304 GCC. This was formerly used to help compile Emacs with C compilers
10305 that had limits on the significant length of an identifier, but in
10306 fact we stopped supporting such compilers some time ago.
10307 \f
10308 * Changes in Emacs 20.3
10309
10310 ** The new command C-x z (repeat) repeats the previous command
10311 including its argument. If you repeat the z afterward,
10312 it repeats the command additional times; thus, you can
10313 perform many repetitions with one keystroke per repetition.
10314
10315 ** Emacs now supports "selective undo" which undoes only within a
10316 specified region. To do this, set point and mark around the desired
10317 region and type C-u C-x u (or C-u C-_). You can then continue undoing
10318 further, within the same region, by repeating the ordinary undo
10319 command C-x u or C-_. This will keep undoing changes that were made
10320 within the region you originally specified, until either all of them
10321 are undone, or it encounters a change which crosses the edge of that
10322 region.
10323
10324 In Transient Mark mode, undoing when a region is active requests
10325 selective undo.
10326
10327 ** If you specify --unibyte when starting Emacs, then all buffers are
10328 unibyte, except when a Lisp program specifically creates a multibyte
10329 buffer. Setting the environment variable EMACS_UNIBYTE has the same
10330 effect. The --no-unibyte option overrides EMACS_UNIBYTE and directs
10331 Emacs to run normally in multibyte mode.
10332
10333 The option --unibyte does not affect the reading of Emacs Lisp files,
10334 though. If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode, use
10335 -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line. That will force Emacs to
10336 load that file in unibyte mode, regardless of how Emacs was started.
10337
10338 ** toggle-enable-multibyte-characters no longer has a key binding and
10339 no longer appears in the menu bar. We've realized that changing the
10340 enable-multibyte-characters variable in an existing buffer is
10341 something that most users not do.
10342
10343 ** You can specify a coding system to use for the next cut or paste
10344 operations through the window system with the command C-x RET X.
10345 The coding system can make a difference for communication with other
10346 applications.
10347
10348 C-x RET x specifies a coding system for all subsequent cutting and
10349 pasting operations.
10350
10351 ** You can specify the printer to use for commands that do printing by
10352 setting the variable `printer-name'. Just what a printer name looks
10353 like depends on your operating system. You can specify a different
10354 printer for the Postscript printing commands by setting
10355 `ps-printer-name'.
10356
10357 ** Emacs now supports on-the-fly spell checking by the means of a
10358 minor mode. It is called M-x flyspell-mode. You don't have to remember
10359 any other special commands to use it, and you will hardly notice it
10360 except when you make a spelling error. Flyspell works by highlighting
10361 incorrect words as soon as they are completed or as soon as the cursor
10362 hits a new word.
10363
10364 Flyspell mode works with whichever dictionary you have selected for
10365 Ispell in Emacs. In TeX mode, it understands TeX syntax so as not
10366 to be confused by TeX commands.
10367
10368 You can correct a misspelled word by editing it into something
10369 correct. You can also correct it, or accept it as correct, by
10370 clicking on the word with Mouse-2; that gives you a pop-up menu
10371 of various alternative replacements and actions.
10372
10373 Flyspell mode also proposes "automatic" corrections. M-TAB replaces
10374 the current misspelled word with a possible correction. If several
10375 corrections are made possible, M-TAB cycles through them in
10376 alphabetical order, or in order of decreasing likelihood if
10377 flyspell-sort-corrections is nil.
10378
10379 Flyspell mode also flags an error when a word is repeated, if
10380 flyspell-mark-duplications-flag is non-nil.
10381
10382 ** Changes in input method usage.
10383
10384 Now you can use arrow keys (right, left, down, up) for selecting among
10385 the alternatives just the same way as you do by C-f, C-b, C-n, and C-p
10386 respectively.
10387
10388 You can use the ENTER key to accept the current conversion.
10389
10390 If you type TAB to display a list of alternatives, you can select one
10391 of the alternatives with Mouse-2.
10392
10393 The meaning of the variable `input-method-verbose-flag' is changed so
10394 that you can set it to t, nil, `default', or `complex-only'.
10395
10396 If the value is nil, extra guidance is never given.
10397
10398 If the value is t, extra guidance is always given.
10399
10400 If the value is `complex-only', extra guidance is always given only
10401 when you are using complex input methods such as chinese-py.
10402
10403 If the value is `default' (this is the default), extra guidance is
10404 given in the following case:
10405 o When you are using a complex input method.
10406 o When you are using a simple input method but not in the minibuffer.
10407
10408 If you are using Emacs through a very slow line, setting
10409 input-method-verbose-flag to nil or to complex-only is a good choice,
10410 and if you are using an input method you are not familiar with,
10411 setting it to t is helpful.
10412
10413 The old command select-input-method is now called set-input-method.
10414
10415 In the language environment "Korean", you can use the following
10416 keys:
10417 Shift-SPC toggle-korean-input-method
10418 C-F9 quail-hangul-switch-symbol-ksc
10419 F9 quail-hangul-switch-hanja
10420 These key bindings are canceled when you switch to another language
10421 environment.
10422
10423 ** The minibuffer history of file names now records the specified file
10424 names, not the entire minibuffer input. For example, if the
10425 minibuffer starts out with /usr/foo/, you might type in /etc/passwd to
10426 get
10427
10428 /usr/foo//etc/passwd
10429
10430 which stands for the file /etc/passwd.
10431
10432 Formerly, this used to put /usr/foo//etc/passwd in the history list.
10433 Now this puts just /etc/passwd in the history list.
10434
10435 ** If you are root, Emacs sets backup-by-copying-when-mismatch to t
10436 at startup, so that saving a file will be sure to preserve
10437 its owner and group.
10438
10439 ** find-func.el can now also find the place of definition of Emacs
10440 Lisp variables in user-loaded libraries.
10441
10442 ** C-x r t (string-rectangle) now deletes the existing rectangle
10443 contents before inserting the specified string on each line.
10444
10445 ** There is a new command delete-whitespace-rectangle
10446 which deletes whitespace starting from a particular column
10447 in all the lines on a rectangle. The column is specified
10448 by the left edge of the rectangle.
10449
10450 ** You can now store a number into a register with C-u NUMBER C-x r n REG,
10451 increment it by INC with C-u INC C-x r + REG (to increment by one, omit
10452 C-u INC), and insert it in the buffer with C-x r g REG. This is useful
10453 for writing keyboard macros.
10454
10455 ** The new command M-x speedbar displays a frame in which directories,
10456 files, and tags can be displayed, manipulated, and jumped to. The
10457 frame defaults to 20 characters in width, and is the same height as
10458 the frame that it was started from. Some major modes define
10459 additional commands for the speedbar, including Rmail, GUD/GDB, and
10460 info.
10461
10462 ** query-replace-regexp is now bound to C-M-%.
10463
10464 ** In Transient Mark mode, when the region is active, M-x
10465 query-replace and the other replace commands now operate on the region
10466 contents only.
10467
10468 ** M-x write-region, when used interactively, now asks for
10469 confirmation before overwriting an existing file. When you call
10470 the function from a Lisp program, a new optional argument CONFIRM
10471 says whether to ask for confirmation in this case.
10472
10473 ** If you use find-file-literally and the file is already visited
10474 non-literally, the command asks you whether to revisit the file
10475 literally. If you say no, it signals an error.
10476
10477 ** Major modes defined with the "derived mode" feature
10478 now use the proper name for the mode hook: WHATEVER-mode-hook.
10479 Formerly they used the name WHATEVER-mode-hooks, but that is
10480 inconsistent with Emacs conventions.
10481
10482 ** shell-command-on-region (and shell-command) reports success or
10483 failure if the command produces no output.
10484
10485 ** Set focus-follows-mouse to nil if your window system or window
10486 manager does not transfer focus to another window when you just move
10487 the mouse.
10488
10489 ** mouse-menu-buffer-maxlen has been renamed to
10490 mouse-buffer-menu-maxlen to be consistent with the other related
10491 function and variable names.
10492
10493 ** The new variable auto-coding-alist specifies coding systems for
10494 reading specific files. This has higher priority than
10495 file-coding-system-alist.
10496
10497 ** If you set the variable unibyte-display-via-language-environment to
10498 t, then Emacs displays non-ASCII characters are displayed by
10499 converting them to the equivalent multibyte characters according to
10500 the current language environment. As a result, they are displayed
10501 according to the current fontset.
10502
10503 ** C-q's handling of codes in the range 0200 through 0377 is changed.
10504
10505 The codes in the range 0200 through 0237 are inserted as one byte of
10506 that code regardless of the values of nonascii-translation-table and
10507 nonascii-insert-offset.
10508
10509 For the codes in the range 0240 through 0377, if
10510 enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil and nonascii-translation-table
10511 nor nonascii-insert-offset can't convert them to valid multibyte
10512 characters, they are converted to Latin-1 characters.
10513
10514 ** If you try to find a file that is not read-accessible, you now get
10515 an error, rather than an empty buffer and a warning.
10516
10517 ** In the minibuffer history commands M-r and M-s, an upper case
10518 letter in the regular expression forces case-sensitive search.
10519
10520 ** In the *Help* buffer, cross-references to commands and variables
10521 are inferred and hyperlinked. Use C-h m in Help mode for the relevant
10522 command keys.
10523
10524 ** M-x apropos-command, with a prefix argument, no longer looks for
10525 user option variables--instead it looks for noninteractive functions.
10526
10527 Meanwhile, the command apropos-variable normally searches for
10528 user option variables; with a prefix argument, it looks at
10529 all variables that have documentation.
10530
10531 ** When you type a long line in the minibuffer, and the minibuffer
10532 shows just one line, automatically scrolling works in a special way
10533 that shows you overlap with the previous line of text. The variable
10534 minibuffer-scroll-overlap controls how many characters of overlap
10535 it should show; the default is 20.
10536
10537 Meanwhile, Resize Minibuffer mode is still available; in that mode,
10538 the minibuffer grows taller (up to a point) as needed to show the whole
10539 of your input.
10540
10541 ** The new command M-x customize-changed-options lets you customize
10542 all the options whose meanings or default values have changed in
10543 recent Emacs versions. You specify a previous Emacs version number as
10544 argument, and the command creates a customization buffer showing all
10545 the customizable options which were changed since that version.
10546 Newly added options are included as well.
10547
10548 If you don't specify a particular version number argument,
10549 then the customization buffer shows all the customizable options
10550 for which Emacs versions of changes are recorded.
10551
10552 This function is also bound to the Changed Options entry in the
10553 Customize menu.
10554
10555 ** When you run M-x grep with a prefix argument, it figures out
10556 the tag around point and puts that into the default grep command.
10557
10558 ** The new command M-* (pop-tag-mark) pops back through a history of
10559 buffer positions from which M-. or other tag-finding commands were
10560 invoked.
10561
10562 ** The new variable comment-padding specifies the number of spaces
10563 that `comment-region' will insert before the actual text of the comment.
10564 The default is 1.
10565
10566 ** In Fortran mode the characters `.', `_' and `$' now have symbol
10567 syntax, not word syntax. Fortran mode now supports `imenu' and has
10568 new commands fortran-join-line (M-^) and fortran-narrow-to-subprogram
10569 (C-x n d). M-q can be used to fill a statement or comment block
10570 sensibly.
10571
10572 ** GUD now supports jdb, the Java debugger, and pdb, the Python debugger.
10573
10574 ** If you set the variable add-log-keep-changes-together to a non-nil
10575 value, the command `C-x 4 a' will automatically notice when you make
10576 two entries in one day for one file, and combine them.
10577
10578 ** You can use the command M-x diary-mail-entries to mail yourself a
10579 reminder about upcoming diary entries. See the documentation string
10580 for a sample shell script for calling this function automatically
10581 every night.
10582
10583 ** Desktop changes
10584
10585 *** All you need to do to enable use of the Desktop package, is to set
10586 the variable desktop-enable to t with Custom.
10587
10588 *** Minor modes are now restored. Which minor modes are restored
10589 and how modes are restored is controlled by `desktop-minor-mode-table'.
10590
10591 ** There is no need to do anything special, now, to enable Gnus to
10592 read and post multi-lingual articles.
10593
10594 ** Outline mode has now support for showing hidden outlines when
10595 doing an isearch. In order for this to happen search-invisible should
10596 be set to open (the default). If an isearch match is inside a hidden
10597 outline the outline is made visible. If you continue pressing C-s and
10598 the match moves outside the formerly invisible outline, the outline is
10599 made invisible again.
10600
10601 ** Mail reading and sending changes
10602
10603 *** The Rmail e command now switches to displaying the whole header of
10604 the message before it lets you edit the message. This is so that any
10605 changes you make in the header will not be lost if you subsequently
10606 toggle.
10607
10608 *** The w command in Rmail, which writes the message body into a file,
10609 now works in the summary buffer as well. (The command to delete the
10610 summary buffer is now Q.) The default file name for the w command, if
10611 the message has no subject, is stored in the variable
10612 rmail-default-body-file.
10613
10614 *** Most of the commands and modes that operate on mail and netnews no
10615 longer depend on the value of mail-header-separator. Instead, they
10616 handle whatever separator the buffer happens to use.
10617
10618 *** If you set mail-signature to a value which is not t, nil, or a string,
10619 it should be an expression. When you send a message, this expression
10620 is evaluated to insert the signature.
10621
10622 *** The new Lisp library feedmail.el (version 8) enhances processing of
10623 outbound email messages. It works in coordination with other email
10624 handling packages (e.g., rmail, VM, gnus) and is responsible for
10625 putting final touches on messages and actually submitting them for
10626 transmission. Users of the emacs program "fakemail" might be
10627 especially interested in trying feedmail.
10628
10629 feedmail is not enabled by default. See comments at the top of
10630 feedmail.el for set-up instructions. Among the bigger features
10631 provided by feedmail are:
10632
10633 **** you can park outgoing messages into a disk-based queue and
10634 stimulate sending some or all of them later (handy for laptop users);
10635 there is also a queue for draft messages
10636
10637 **** you can get one last look at the prepped outbound message and
10638 be prompted for confirmation
10639
10640 **** does smart filling of address headers
10641
10642 **** can generate a MESSAGE-ID: line and a DATE: line; the date can be
10643 the time the message was written or the time it is being sent; this
10644 can make FCC copies more closely resemble copies that recipients get
10645
10646 **** you can specify an arbitrary function for actually transmitting
10647 the message; included in feedmail are interfaces for /bin/[r]mail,
10648 /usr/lib/sendmail, and elisp smtpmail; it's easy to write a new
10649 function for something else (10-20 lines of elisp)
10650
10651 ** Dired changes
10652
10653 *** The Dired function dired-do-toggle, which toggles marked and unmarked
10654 files, is now bound to "t" instead of "T".
10655
10656 *** dired-at-point has been added to ffap.el. It allows one to easily
10657 run Dired on the directory name at point.
10658
10659 *** Dired has a new command: %g. It searches the contents of
10660 files in the directory and marks each file that contains a match
10661 for a specified regexp.
10662
10663 ** VC Changes
10664
10665 *** New option vc-ignore-vc-files lets you turn off version control
10666 conveniently.
10667
10668 *** VC Dired has been completely rewritten. It is now much
10669 faster, especially for CVS, and works very similar to ordinary
10670 Dired.
10671
10672 VC Dired is invoked by typing C-x v d and entering the name of the
10673 directory to display. By default, VC Dired gives you a recursive
10674 listing of all files at or below the given directory which are
10675 currently locked (for CVS, all files not up-to-date are shown).
10676
10677 You can change the listing format by setting vc-dired-recurse to nil,
10678 then it shows only the given directory, and you may also set
10679 vc-dired-terse-display to nil, then it shows all files under version
10680 control plus the names of any subdirectories, so that you can type `i'
10681 on such lines to insert them manually, as in ordinary Dired.
10682
10683 All Dired commands operate normally in VC Dired, except for `v', which
10684 is redefined as the version control prefix. That means you may type
10685 `v l', `v =' etc. to invoke `vc-print-log', `vc-diff' and the like on
10686 the file named in the current Dired buffer line. `v v' invokes
10687 `vc-next-action' on this file, or on all files currently marked.
10688
10689 The new command `v t' (vc-dired-toggle-terse-mode) allows you to
10690 toggle between terse display (only locked files) and full display (all
10691 VC files plus subdirectories). There is also a special command,
10692 `* l', to mark all files currently locked.
10693
10694 Giving a prefix argument to C-x v d now does the same thing as in
10695 ordinary Dired: it allows you to supply additional options for the ls
10696 command in the minibuffer, to fine-tune VC Dired's output.
10697
10698 *** Under CVS, if you merge changes from the repository into a working
10699 file, and CVS detects conflicts, VC now offers to start an ediff
10700 session to resolve them.
10701
10702 Alternatively, you can use the new command `vc-resolve-conflicts' to
10703 resolve conflicts in a file at any time. It works in any buffer that
10704 contains conflict markers as generated by rcsmerge (which is what CVS
10705 uses as well).
10706
10707 *** You can now transfer changes between branches, using the new
10708 command vc-merge (C-x v m). It is implemented for RCS and CVS. When
10709 you invoke it in a buffer under version-control, you can specify
10710 either an entire branch or a pair of versions, and the changes on that
10711 branch or between the two versions are merged into the working file.
10712 If this results in any conflicts, they may be resolved interactively,
10713 using ediff.
10714
10715 ** Changes in Font Lock
10716
10717 *** The face and variable previously known as font-lock-reference-face
10718 are now called font-lock-constant-face to better reflect their typical
10719 use for highlighting constants and labels. (Its face properties are
10720 unchanged.) The variable font-lock-reference-face remains for now for
10721 compatibility reasons, but its value is font-lock-constant-face.
10722
10723 ** Frame name display changes
10724
10725 *** The command set-frame-name lets you set the name of the current
10726 frame. You can use the new command select-frame-by-name to select and
10727 raise a frame; this is mostly useful on character-only terminals, or
10728 when many frames are invisible or iconified.
10729
10730 *** On character-only terminal (not a window system), changing the
10731 frame name is now reflected on the mode line and in the Buffers/Frames
10732 menu.
10733
10734 ** Comint (subshell) changes
10735
10736 *** In Comint modes, the commands to kill, stop or interrupt a
10737 subjob now also kill pending input. This is for compatibility
10738 with ordinary shells, where the signal characters do this.
10739
10740 *** There are new commands in Comint mode.
10741
10742 C-c C-x fetches the "next" line from the input history;
10743 that is, the line after the last line you got.
10744 You can use this command to fetch successive lines, one by one.
10745
10746 C-c SPC accumulates lines of input. More precisely, it arranges to
10747 send the current line together with the following line, when you send
10748 the following line.
10749
10750 C-c C-a if repeated twice consecutively now moves to the process mark,
10751 which separates the pending input from the subprocess output and the
10752 previously sent input.
10753
10754 C-c M-r now runs comint-previous-matching-input-from-input;
10755 it searches for a previous command, using the current pending input
10756 as the search string.
10757
10758 *** New option compilation-scroll-output can be set to scroll
10759 automatically in compilation-mode windows.
10760
10761 ** C mode changes
10762
10763 *** Multiline macros are now handled, both as they affect indentation,
10764 and as recognized syntax. New syntactic symbol cpp-macro-cont is
10765 assigned to second and subsequent lines of a multiline macro
10766 definition.
10767
10768 *** A new style "user" which captures all non-hook-ified
10769 (i.e. top-level) .emacs file variable settings and customizations.
10770 Style "cc-mode" is an alias for "user" and is deprecated. "gnu"
10771 style is still the default however.
10772
10773 *** "java" style now conforms to Sun's JDK coding style.
10774
10775 *** There are new commands c-beginning-of-defun, c-end-of-defun which
10776 are alternatives which you could bind to C-M-a and C-M-e if you prefer
10777 them. They do not have key bindings by default.
10778
10779 *** New and improved implementations of M-a (c-beginning-of-statement)
10780 and M-e (c-end-of-statement).
10781
10782 *** C++ namespace blocks are supported, with new syntactic symbols
10783 namespace-open, namespace-close, and innamespace.
10784
10785 *** File local variable settings of c-file-style and c-file-offsets
10786 makes the style variables local to that buffer only.
10787
10788 *** New indentation functions c-lineup-close-paren,
10789 c-indent-one-line-block, c-lineup-dont-change.
10790
10791 *** Improvements (hopefully!) to the way CC Mode is loaded. You
10792 should now be able to do a (require 'cc-mode) to get the entire
10793 package loaded properly for customization in your .emacs file. A new
10794 variable c-initialize-on-load controls this and is t by default.
10795
10796 ** Changes to hippie-expand.
10797
10798 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-skip-space'. If
10799 non-nil, trailing spaces may be included in the abbreviation to search for,
10800 which then gives the same behavior as the original `dabbrev-expand'.
10801
10802 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-as-symbol'. If
10803 non-nil, characters of syntax '_' is considered part of the word when
10804 expanding dynamically.
10805
10806 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-no-restriction'. If
10807 non-nil, narrowed buffers are widened before they are searched.
10808
10809 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-only-buffers'. If
10810 non-empty, buffers searched are restricted to the types specified in
10811 this list. Useful for example when constructing new special-purpose
10812 expansion functions with `make-hippie-expand-function'.
10813
10814 *** Text properties of the expansion are no longer copied.
10815
10816 ** Changes in BibTeX mode.
10817
10818 *** Any titleword matching a regexp in the new variable
10819 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore (case sensitive) is ignored during
10820 automatic key generation. This replaces variable
10821 bibtex-autokey-titleword-first-ignore, which only checked for matches
10822 against the first word in the title.
10823
10824 *** Autokey generation now uses all words from the title, not just
10825 capitalized words. To avoid conflicts with existing customizations,
10826 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore is set up such that words starting with
10827 lowerkey characters will still be ignored. Thus, if you want to use
10828 lowercase words from the title, you will have to overwrite the
10829 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore standard setting.
10830
10831 *** Case conversion of names and title words for automatic key
10832 generation is more flexible. Variable bibtex-autokey-preserve-case is
10833 replaced by bibtex-autokey-titleword-case-convert and
10834 bibtex-autokey-name-case-convert.
10835
10836 ** Changes in vcursor.el.
10837
10838 *** Support for character terminals is available: there is a new keymap
10839 and the vcursor will appear as an arrow between buffer text. A
10840 variable `vcursor-interpret-input' allows input from the vcursor to be
10841 entered exactly as if typed. Numerous functions, including
10842 `vcursor-compare-windows', have been rewritten to improve consistency
10843 in the selection of windows and corresponding keymaps.
10844
10845 *** vcursor options can now be altered with M-x customize under the
10846 Editing group once the package is loaded.
10847
10848 *** Loading vcursor now does not define keys by default, as this is
10849 generally a bad side effect. Use M-x customize to set
10850 vcursor-key-bindings to t to restore the old behavior.
10851
10852 *** vcursor-auto-disable can be `copy', which turns off copying from the
10853 vcursor, but doesn't disable it, after any non-vcursor command.
10854
10855 ** Ispell changes.
10856
10857 *** You can now spell check comments and strings in the current
10858 buffer with M-x ispell-comments-and-strings. Comments and strings
10859 are identified by syntax tables in effect.
10860
10861 *** Generic region skipping implemented.
10862 A single buffer can be broken into a number of regions where text will
10863 and will not be checked. The definitions of the regions can be user
10864 defined. New applications and improvements made available by this
10865 include:
10866
10867 o URLs are automatically skipped
10868 o EMail message checking is vastly improved.
10869
10870 *** Ispell can highlight the erroneous word even on non-window terminals.
10871
10872 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
10873
10874 RefTeX has been updated in order to make it more usable with very
10875 large projects (like a several volume math book). The parser has been
10876 re-written from scratch. To get maximum speed from RefTeX, check the
10877 section `Optimizations' in the manual.
10878
10879 *** New recursive parser.
10880
10881 The old version of RefTeX created a single large buffer containing the
10882 entire multifile document in order to parse the document. The new
10883 recursive parser scans the individual files.
10884
10885 *** Parsing only part of a document.
10886
10887 Reparsing of changed document parts can now be made faster by enabling
10888 partial scans. To use this feature, read the documentation string of
10889 the variable `reftex-enable-partial-scans' and set the variable to t.
10890
10891 (setq reftex-enable-partial-scans t)
10892
10893 *** Storing parsing information in a file.
10894
10895 This can improve startup times considerably. To turn it on, use
10896
10897 (setq reftex-save-parse-info t)
10898
10899 *** Using multiple selection buffers
10900
10901 If the creation of label selection buffers is too slow (this happens
10902 for large documents), you can reuse these buffers by setting
10903
10904 (setq reftex-use-multiple-selection-buffers t)
10905
10906 *** References to external documents.
10907
10908 The LaTeX package `xr' allows to cross-reference labels in external
10909 documents. RefTeX can provide information about the external
10910 documents as well. To use this feature, set up the \externaldocument
10911 macros required by the `xr' package and rescan the document with
10912 RefTeX. The external labels can then be accessed with the `x' key in
10913 the selection buffer provided by `reftex-reference' (bound to `C-c )').
10914 The `x' key also works in the table of contents buffer.
10915
10916 *** Many more labeled LaTeX environments are recognized by default.
10917
10918 The built-in command list now covers all the standard LaTeX commands,
10919 and all of the major packages included in the LaTeX distribution.
10920
10921 Also, RefTeX now understands the \appendix macro and changes
10922 the enumeration of sections in the *toc* buffer accordingly.
10923
10924 *** Mouse support for selection and *toc* buffers
10925
10926 The mouse can now be used to select items in the selection and *toc*
10927 buffers. See also the new option `reftex-highlight-selection'.
10928
10929 *** New keymaps for selection and table of contents modes.
10930
10931 The selection processes for labels and citation keys, and the table of
10932 contents buffer now have their own keymaps: `reftex-select-label-map',
10933 `reftex-select-bib-map', `reftex-toc-map'. The selection processes
10934 have a number of new keys predefined. In particular, TAB lets you
10935 enter a label with completion. Check the on-the-fly help (press `?'
10936 at the selection prompt) or read the Info documentation to find out
10937 more.
10938
10939 *** Support for the varioref package
10940
10941 The `v' key in the label selection buffer toggles \ref versus \vref.
10942
10943 *** New hooks
10944
10945 Three new hooks can be used to redefine the way labels, references,
10946 and citations are created. These hooks are
10947 `reftex-format-label-function', `reftex-format-ref-function',
10948 `reftex-format-cite-function'.
10949
10950 *** Citations outside LaTeX
10951
10952 The command `reftex-citation' may also be used outside LaTeX (e.g. in
10953 a mail buffer). See the Info documentation for details.
10954
10955 *** Short context is no longer fontified.
10956
10957 The short context in the label menu no longer copies the
10958 fontification from the text in the buffer. If you prefer it to be
10959 fontified, use
10960
10961 (setq reftex-refontify-context t)
10962
10963 ** file-cache-minibuffer-complete now accepts a prefix argument.
10964 With a prefix argument, it does not try to do completion of
10965 the file name within its directory; it only checks for other
10966 directories that contain the same file name.
10967
10968 Thus, given the file name Makefile, and assuming that a file
10969 Makefile.in exists in the same directory, ordinary
10970 file-cache-minibuffer-complete will try to complete Makefile to
10971 Makefile.in and will therefore never look for other directories that
10972 have Makefile. A prefix argument tells it not to look for longer
10973 names such as Makefile.in, so that instead it will look for other
10974 directories--just as if the name were already complete in its present
10975 directory.
10976
10977 ** New modes and packages
10978
10979 *** There is a new alternative major mode for Perl, Cperl mode.
10980 It has many more features than Perl mode, and some people prefer
10981 it, but some do not.
10982
10983 *** There is a new major mode, M-x vhdl-mode, for editing files of VHDL
10984 code.
10985
10986 *** M-x which-function-mode enables a minor mode that displays the
10987 current function name continuously in the mode line, as you move
10988 around in a buffer.
10989
10990 Which Function mode is effective in major modes which support Imenu.
10991
10992 *** Gametree is a major mode for editing game analysis trees. The author
10993 uses it for keeping notes about his postal Chess games, but it should
10994 be helpful for other two-player games as well, as long as they have an
10995 established system of notation similar to Chess.
10996
10997 *** The new minor mode checkdoc-minor-mode provides Emacs Lisp
10998 documentation string checking for style and spelling. The style
10999 guidelines are found in the Emacs Lisp programming manual.
11000
11001 *** The net-utils package makes some common networking features
11002 available in Emacs. Some of these functions are wrappers around
11003 system utilities (ping, nslookup, etc); others are implementations of
11004 simple protocols (finger, whois) in Emacs Lisp. There are also
11005 functions to make simple connections to TCP/IP ports for debugging and
11006 the like.
11007
11008 *** highlight-changes-mode is a minor mode that uses colors to
11009 identify recently changed parts of the buffer text.
11010
11011 *** The new package `midnight' lets you specify things to be done
11012 within Emacs at midnight--by default, kill buffers that you have not
11013 used in a considerable time. To use this feature, customize
11014 the user option `midnight-mode' to t.
11015
11016 *** The file generic-x.el defines a number of simple major modes.
11017
11018 apache-generic-mode: For Apache and NCSA httpd configuration files
11019 samba-generic-mode: Samba configuration files
11020 fvwm-generic-mode: For fvwm initialization files
11021 x-resource-generic-mode: For X resource files
11022 hosts-generic-mode: For hosts files (.rhosts, /etc/hosts, etc)
11023 mailagent-rules-generic-mode: For mailagent .rules files
11024 javascript-generic-mode: For JavaScript files
11025 vrml-generic-mode: For VRML files
11026 java-manifest-generic-mode: For Java MANIFEST files
11027 java-properties-generic-mode: For Java property files
11028 mailrc-generic-mode: For .mailrc files
11029
11030 Platform-specific modes:
11031
11032 prototype-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V prototype files
11033 pkginfo-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V pkginfo files
11034 alias-generic-mode: For C shell alias files
11035 inf-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INF files
11036 ini-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INI files
11037 reg-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Registry files
11038 bat-generic-mode: For MS-Windows BAT scripts
11039 rc-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Resource files
11040 rul-generic-mode: For InstallShield scripts
11041 \f
11042 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 since the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
11043
11044 ** If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode,
11045 use -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line.
11046 That will force Emacs to read that file in unibyte mode.
11047 Otherwise, the file will be loaded and byte-compiled in multibyte mode.
11048
11049 Thus, each lisp file is read in a consistent way regardless of whether
11050 you started Emacs with --unibyte, so that a Lisp program gives
11051 consistent results regardless of how Emacs was started.
11052
11053 ** The new function assoc-default is useful for searching an alist,
11054 and using a default value if the key is not found there. You can
11055 specify a comparison predicate, so this function is useful for
11056 searching comparing a string against an alist of regular expressions.
11057
11058 ** The functions unibyte-char-to-multibyte and
11059 multibyte-char-to-unibyte convert between unibyte and multibyte
11060 character codes, in a way that is appropriate for the current language
11061 environment.
11062
11063 ** The functions read-event, read-char and read-char-exclusive now
11064 take two optional arguments. PROMPT, if non-nil, specifies a prompt
11065 string. SUPPRESS-INPUT-METHOD, if non-nil, says to disable the
11066 current input method for reading this one event.
11067
11068 ** Two new variables print-escape-nonascii and print-escape-multibyte
11069 now control whether to output certain characters as
11070 backslash-sequences. print-escape-nonascii applies to single-byte
11071 non-ASCII characters; print-escape-multibyte applies to multibyte
11072 characters. Both of these variables are used only when printing
11073 in readable fashion (prin1 uses them, princ does not).
11074 \f
11075 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 before the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
11076
11077 ** Compiled Emacs Lisp files made with the modified "MBSK" version
11078 of Emacs 20.2 do not work in Emacs 20.3.
11079
11080 ** Buffer positions are now measured in characters, as they were
11081 in Emacs 19 and before. This means that (forward-char 1)
11082 always increases point by 1.
11083
11084 The function chars-in-region now just subtracts its arguments. It is
11085 considered obsolete. The function char-boundary-p has been deleted.
11086
11087 See below for additional changes relating to multibyte characters.
11088
11089 ** defcustom, defface and defgroup now accept the keyword `:version'.
11090 Use this to specify in which version of Emacs a certain variable's
11091 default value changed. For example,
11092
11093 (defcustom foo-max 34 "*Maximum number of foo's allowed."
11094 :type 'integer
11095 :group 'foo
11096 :version "20.3")
11097
11098 (defgroup foo-group nil "The foo group."
11099 :version "20.3")
11100
11101 If an entire new group is added or the variables in it have the
11102 default values changed, then just add a `:version' to that group. It
11103 is recommended that new packages added to the distribution contain a
11104 `:version' in the top level group.
11105
11106 This information is used to control the customize-changed-options command.
11107
11108 ** It is now an error to change the value of a symbol whose name
11109 starts with a colon--if it is interned in the standard obarray.
11110
11111 However, setting such a symbol to its proper value, which is that
11112 symbol itself, is not an error. This is for the sake of programs that
11113 support previous Emacs versions by explicitly setting these variables
11114 to themselves.
11115
11116 If you set the variable keyword-symbols-constant-flag to nil,
11117 this error is suppressed, and you can set these symbols to any
11118 values whatever.
11119
11120 ** There is a new debugger command, R.
11121 It evaluates an expression like e, but saves the result
11122 in the buffer *Debugger-record*.
11123
11124 ** Frame-local variables.
11125
11126 You can now make a variable local to various frames. To do this, call
11127 the function make-variable-frame-local; this enables frames to have
11128 local bindings for that variable.
11129
11130 These frame-local bindings are actually frame parameters: you create a
11131 frame-local binding in a specific frame by calling
11132 modify-frame-parameters and specifying the variable name as the
11133 parameter name.
11134
11135 Buffer-local bindings take precedence over frame-local bindings.
11136 Thus, if the current buffer has a buffer-local binding, that binding is
11137 active; otherwise, if the selected frame has a frame-local binding,
11138 that binding is active; otherwise, the default binding is active.
11139
11140 It would not be hard to implement window-local bindings, but it is not
11141 clear that this would be very useful; windows tend to come and go in a
11142 very transitory fashion, so that trying to produce any specific effect
11143 through a window-local binding would not be very robust.
11144
11145 ** `sregexq' and `sregex' are two new functions for constructing
11146 "symbolic regular expressions." These are Lisp expressions that, when
11147 evaluated, yield conventional string-based regexps. The symbolic form
11148 makes it easier to construct, read, and maintain complex patterns.
11149 See the documentation in sregex.el.
11150
11151 ** parse-partial-sexp's return value has an additional element which
11152 is used to pass information along if you pass it to another call to
11153 parse-partial-sexp, starting its scan where the first call ended.
11154 The contents of this field are not yet finalized.
11155
11156 ** eval-region now accepts a fourth optional argument READ-FUNCTION.
11157 If it is non-nil, that function is used instead of `read'.
11158
11159 ** unload-feature by default removes the feature's functions from
11160 known hooks to avoid trouble, but a package providing FEATURE can
11161 define a hook FEATURE-unload-hook to be run by unload-feature instead.
11162
11163 ** read-from-minibuffer no longer returns the argument DEFAULT-VALUE
11164 when the user enters empty input. It now returns the null string, as
11165 it did in Emacs 19. The default value is made available in the
11166 history via M-n, but it is not applied here as a default.
11167
11168 The other, more specialized minibuffer-reading functions continue to
11169 return the default value (not the null string) when the user enters
11170 empty input.
11171
11172 ** The new variable read-buffer-function controls which routine to use
11173 for selecting buffers. For example, if you set this variable to
11174 `iswitchb-read-buffer', iswitchb will be used to read buffer names.
11175 Other functions can also be used if they accept the same arguments as
11176 `read-buffer' and return the selected buffer name as a string.
11177
11178 ** The new function read-passwd reads a password from the terminal,
11179 echoing a period for each character typed. It takes three arguments:
11180 a prompt string, a flag which says "read it twice to make sure", and a
11181 default password to use if the user enters nothing.
11182
11183 ** The variable fill-nobreak-predicate gives major modes a way to
11184 specify not to break a line at certain places. Its value is a
11185 function which is called with no arguments, with point located at the
11186 place where a break is being considered. If the function returns
11187 non-nil, then the line won't be broken there.
11188
11189 ** window-end now takes an optional second argument, UPDATE.
11190 If this is non-nil, then the function always returns an accurate
11191 up-to-date value for the buffer position corresponding to the
11192 end of the window, even if this requires computation.
11193
11194 ** other-buffer now takes an optional argument FRAME
11195 which specifies which frame's buffer list to use.
11196 If it is nil, that means use the selected frame's buffer list.
11197
11198 ** The new variable buffer-display-time, always local in every buffer,
11199 holds the value of (current-time) as of the last time that a window
11200 was directed to display this buffer.
11201
11202 ** It is now meaningful to compare two window-configuration objects
11203 with `equal'. Two window-configuration objects are equal if they
11204 describe equivalent arrangements of windows, in the same frame--in
11205 other words, if they would give the same results if passed to
11206 set-window-configuration.
11207
11208 ** compare-window-configurations is a new function that compares two
11209 window configurations loosely. It ignores differences in saved buffer
11210 positions and scrolling, and considers only the structure and sizes of
11211 windows and the choice of buffers to display.
11212
11213 ** The variable minor-mode-overriding-map-alist allows major modes to
11214 override the key bindings of a minor mode. The elements of this alist
11215 look like the elements of minor-mode-map-alist: (VARIABLE . KEYMAP).
11216
11217 If the VARIABLE in an element of minor-mode-overriding-map-alist has a
11218 non-nil value, the paired KEYMAP is active, and totally overrides the
11219 map (if any) specified for the same variable in minor-mode-map-alist.
11220
11221 minor-mode-overriding-map-alist is automatically local in all buffers,
11222 and it is meant to be set by major modes.
11223
11224 ** The function match-string-no-properties is like match-string
11225 except that it discards all text properties from the result.
11226
11227 ** The function load-average now accepts an optional argument
11228 USE-FLOATS. If it is non-nil, the load average values are returned as
11229 floating point numbers, rather than as integers to be divided by 100.
11230
11231 ** The new variable temporary-file-directory specifies the directory
11232 to use for creating temporary files. The default value is determined
11233 in a reasonable way for your operating system; on GNU and Unix systems
11234 it is based on the TMP and TMPDIR environment variables.
11235
11236 ** Menu changes
11237
11238 *** easymenu.el now uses the new menu item format and supports the
11239 keywords :visible and :filter. The existing keyword :keys is now
11240 better supported.
11241
11242 The variable `easy-menu-precalculate-equivalent-keybindings' controls
11243 a new feature which calculates keyboard equivalents for the menu when
11244 you define the menu. The default is t. If you rarely use menus, you
11245 can set the variable to nil to disable this precalculation feature;
11246 then the calculation is done only if you use the menu bar.
11247
11248 *** A new format for menu items is supported.
11249
11250 In a keymap, a key binding that has the format
11251 (STRING . REAL-BINDING) or (STRING HELP-STRING . REAL-BINDING)
11252 defines a menu item. Now a menu item definition may also be a list that
11253 starts with the symbol `menu-item'.
11254
11255 The format is:
11256 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) or
11257 (menu-item ITEM-NAME REAL-BINDING . ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST)
11258 where ITEM-NAME is an expression which evaluates to the menu item
11259 string, and ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST has the form of a property list.
11260 The supported properties include
11261
11262 :enable FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
11263 item is enabled.
11264 :visible FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
11265 item should appear in the menu.
11266 :filter FILTER-FN
11267 FILTER-FN is a function of one argument,
11268 which will be REAL-BINDING.
11269 It should return a binding to use instead.
11270 :keys DESCRIPTION
11271 DESCRIPTION is a string that describes an equivalent keyboard
11272 binding for REAL-BINDING. DESCRIPTION is expanded with
11273 `substitute-command-keys' before it is used.
11274 :key-sequence KEY-SEQUENCE
11275 KEY-SEQUENCE is a key-sequence for an equivalent
11276 keyboard binding.
11277 :key-sequence nil
11278 This means that the command normally has no
11279 keyboard equivalent.
11280 :help HELP HELP is the extra help string (not currently used).
11281 :button (TYPE . SELECTED)
11282 TYPE is :toggle or :radio.
11283 SELECTED is a form, to be evaluated, and its
11284 value says whether this button is currently selected.
11285
11286 Buttons are at the moment only simulated by prefixes in the menu.
11287 Eventually ordinary X-buttons may be supported.
11288
11289 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) defines unselectable item.
11290
11291 ** New event types
11292
11293 *** The new event type `mouse-wheel' is generated by a wheel on a
11294 mouse (such as the MS Intellimouse). The event contains a delta that
11295 corresponds to the amount and direction that the wheel is rotated,
11296 which is typically used to implement a scroll or zoom. The format is:
11297
11298 (mouse-wheel POSITION DELTA)
11299
11300 where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
11301 same format as a mouse-click event, and DELTA is a signed number
11302 indicating the number of increments by which the wheel was rotated. A
11303 negative DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated backwards, towards
11304 the user, and a positive DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated
11305 forward, away from the user.
11306
11307 As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
11308
11309 *** The new event type `drag-n-drop' is generated when a group of
11310 files is selected in an application outside of Emacs, and then dragged
11311 and dropped onto an Emacs frame. The event contains a list of
11312 filenames that were dragged and dropped, which are then typically
11313 loaded into Emacs. The format is:
11314
11315 (drag-n-drop POSITION FILES)
11316
11317 where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
11318 same format as a mouse-click event, and FILES is the list of filenames
11319 that were dragged and dropped.
11320
11321 As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
11322
11323 ** Changes relating to multibyte characters.
11324
11325 *** The variable enable-multibyte-characters is now read-only;
11326 any attempt to set it directly signals an error. The only way
11327 to change this value in an existing buffer is with set-buffer-multibyte.
11328
11329 *** In a string constant, `\ ' now stands for "nothing at all". You
11330 can use it to terminate a hex escape which is followed by a character
11331 that could otherwise be read as part of the hex escape.
11332
11333 *** String indices are now measured in characters, as they were
11334 in Emacs 19 and before.
11335
11336 The function chars-in-string has been deleted.
11337 The function concat-chars has been renamed to `string'.
11338
11339 *** The function set-buffer-multibyte sets the flag in the current
11340 buffer that says whether the buffer uses multibyte representation or
11341 unibyte representation. If the argument is nil, it selects unibyte
11342 representation. Otherwise it selects multibyte representation.
11343
11344 This function does not change the contents of the buffer, viewed
11345 as a sequence of bytes. However, it does change the contents
11346 viewed as characters; a sequence of two bytes which is treated as
11347 one character when the buffer uses multibyte representation
11348 will count as two characters using unibyte representation.
11349
11350 This function sets enable-multibyte-characters to record which
11351 representation is in use. It also adjusts various data in the buffer
11352 (including its markers, overlays and text properties) so that they are
11353 consistent with the new representation.
11354
11355 *** string-make-multibyte takes a string and converts it to multibyte
11356 representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care
11357 about the representation, because Emacs converts when necessary;
11358 however, it makes a difference when you compare strings.
11359
11360 The conversion of non-ASCII characters works by adding the value of
11361 nonascii-insert-offset to each character, or by translating them
11362 using the table nonascii-translation-table.
11363
11364 *** string-make-unibyte takes a string and converts it to unibyte
11365 representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care about the
11366 representation, but it makes a difference when you compare strings.
11367
11368 The conversion from multibyte to unibyte representation
11369 loses information; the only time Emacs performs it automatically
11370 is when inserting a multibyte string into a unibyte buffer.
11371
11372 *** string-as-multibyte takes a string, and returns another string
11373 which contains the same bytes, but treats them as multibyte.
11374
11375 *** string-as-unibyte takes a string, and returns another string
11376 which contains the same bytes, but treats them as unibyte.
11377
11378 *** The new function compare-strings lets you compare
11379 portions of two strings. Unibyte strings are converted to multibyte,
11380 so that a unibyte string can match a multibyte string.
11381 You can specify whether to ignore case or not.
11382
11383 *** assoc-ignore-case now uses compare-strings so that
11384 it can treat unibyte and multibyte strings as equal.
11385
11386 *** Regular expression operations and buffer string searches now
11387 convert the search pattern to multibyte or unibyte to accord with the
11388 buffer or string being searched.
11389
11390 One consequence is that you cannot always use \200-\377 inside of
11391 [...] to match all non-ASCII characters. This does still work when
11392 searching or matching a unibyte buffer or string, but not when
11393 searching or matching a multibyte string. Unfortunately, there is no
11394 obvious choice of syntax to use within [...] for that job. But, what
11395 you want is just to match all non-ASCII characters, the regular
11396 expression [^\0-\177] works for it.
11397
11398 *** Structure of coding system changed.
11399
11400 All coding systems (including aliases and subsidiaries) are named
11401 by symbols; the symbol's `coding-system' property is a vector
11402 which defines the coding system. Aliases share the same vector
11403 as the principal name, so that altering the contents of this
11404 vector affects the principal name and its aliases. You can define
11405 your own alias name of a coding system by the function
11406 define-coding-system-alias.
11407
11408 The coding system definition includes a property list of its own. Use
11409 the new functions `coding-system-get' and `coding-system-put' to
11410 access such coding system properties as post-read-conversion,
11411 pre-write-conversion, character-translation-table-for-decode,
11412 character-translation-table-for-encode, mime-charset, and
11413 safe-charsets. For instance, (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1
11414 'mime-charset) gives the corresponding MIME-charset parameter
11415 `iso-8859-1'.
11416
11417 Among the coding system properties listed above, safe-charsets is new.
11418 The value of this property is a list of character sets which this
11419 coding system can correctly encode and decode. For instance:
11420 (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1 'safe-charsets) => (ascii latin-iso8859-1)
11421
11422 Here, "correctly encode" means that the encoded character sets can
11423 also be handled safely by systems other than Emacs as far as they
11424 are capable of that coding system. Though, Emacs itself can encode
11425 the other character sets and read it back correctly.
11426
11427 *** The new function select-safe-coding-system can be used to find a
11428 proper coding system for encoding the specified region or string.
11429 This function requires a user interaction.
11430
11431 *** The new functions find-coding-systems-region and
11432 find-coding-systems-string are helper functions used by
11433 select-safe-coding-system. They return a list of all proper coding
11434 systems to encode a text in some region or string. If you don't want
11435 a user interaction, use one of these functions instead of
11436 select-safe-coding-system.
11437
11438 *** The explicit encoding and decoding functions, such as
11439 decode-coding-region and encode-coding-string, now set
11440 last-coding-system-used to reflect the actual way encoding or decoding
11441 was done.
11442
11443 *** The new function detect-coding-with-language-environment can be
11444 used to detect a coding system of text according to priorities of
11445 coding systems used by some specific language environment.
11446
11447 *** The functions detect-coding-region and detect-coding-string always
11448 return a list if the arg HIGHEST is nil. Thus, if only ASCII
11449 characters are found, they now return a list of single element
11450 `undecided' or its subsidiaries.
11451
11452 *** The new functions coding-system-change-eol-conversion and
11453 coding-system-change-text-conversion can be used to get a different
11454 coding system than what specified only in how end-of-line or text is
11455 converted.
11456
11457 *** The new function set-selection-coding-system can be used to set a
11458 coding system for communicating with other X clients.
11459
11460 *** The function `map-char-table' now passes as argument only valid
11461 character codes, plus generic characters that stand for entire
11462 character sets or entire subrows of a character set. In other words,
11463 each time `map-char-table' calls its FUNCTION argument, the key value
11464 either will be a valid individual character code, or will stand for a
11465 range of characters.
11466
11467 *** The new function `char-valid-p' can be used for checking whether a
11468 Lisp object is a valid character code or not.
11469
11470 *** The new function `charset-after' returns a charset of a character
11471 in the current buffer at position POS.
11472
11473 *** Input methods are now implemented using the variable
11474 input-method-function. If this is non-nil, its value should be a
11475 function; then, whenever Emacs reads an input event that is a printing
11476 character with no modifier bits, it calls that function, passing the
11477 event as an argument. Often this function will read more input, first
11478 binding input-method-function to nil.
11479
11480 The return value should be a list of the events resulting from input
11481 method processing. These events will be processed sequentially as
11482 input, before resorting to unread-command-events. Events returned by
11483 the input method function are not passed to the input method function,
11484 not even if they are printing characters with no modifier bits.
11485
11486 The input method function is not called when reading the second and
11487 subsequent events of a key sequence.
11488
11489 *** You can customize any language environment by using
11490 set-language-environment-hook and exit-language-environment-hook.
11491
11492 The hook `exit-language-environment-hook' should be used to undo
11493 customizations that you made with set-language-environment-hook. For
11494 instance, if you set up a special key binding for a specific language
11495 environment by set-language-environment-hook, you should set up
11496 exit-language-environment-hook to restore the normal key binding.
11497 \f
11498 * Changes in Emacs 20.1
11499
11500 ** Emacs has a new facility for customization of its many user
11501 options. It is called M-x customize. With this facility you can look
11502 at the many user options in an organized way; they are grouped into a
11503 tree structure.
11504
11505 M-x customize also knows what sorts of values are legitimate for each
11506 user option and ensures that you don't use invalid values.
11507
11508 With M-x customize, you can set options either for the present Emacs
11509 session or permanently. (Permanent settings are stored automatically
11510 in your .emacs file.)
11511
11512 ** Scroll bars are now on the left side of the window.
11513 You can change this with M-x customize-option scroll-bar-mode.
11514
11515 ** The mode line no longer includes the string `Emacs'.
11516 This makes more space in the mode line for other information.
11517
11518 ** When you select a region with the mouse, it is highlighted
11519 immediately afterward. At that time, if you type the DELETE key, it
11520 kills the region.
11521
11522 The BACKSPACE key, and the ASCII character DEL, do not do this; they
11523 delete the character before point, as usual.
11524
11525 ** In an incremental search the whole current match is highlighted
11526 on terminals which support this. (You can disable this feature
11527 by setting search-highlight to nil.)
11528
11529 ** In the minibuffer, in some cases, you can now use M-n to
11530 insert the default value into the minibuffer as text. In effect,
11531 the default value (if the minibuffer routines know it) is tacked
11532 onto the history "in the future". (The more normal use of the
11533 history list is to use M-p to insert minibuffer input used in the
11534 past.)
11535
11536 ** In Text mode, now only blank lines separate paragraphs.
11537 This makes it possible to get the full benefit of Adaptive Fill mode
11538 in Text mode, and other modes derived from it (such as Mail mode).
11539 TAB in Text mode now runs the command indent-relative; this
11540 makes a practical difference only when you use indented paragraphs.
11541
11542 As a result, the old Indented Text mode is now identical to Text mode,
11543 and is an alias for it.
11544
11545 If you want spaces at the beginning of a line to start a paragraph,
11546 use the new mode, Paragraph Indent Text mode.
11547
11548 ** Scrolling changes
11549
11550 *** Scroll commands to scroll a whole screen now preserve the screen
11551 position of the cursor, if scroll-preserve-screen-position is non-nil.
11552
11553 In this mode, if you scroll several screens back and forth, finishing
11554 on the same screen where you started, the cursor goes back to the line
11555 where it started.
11556
11557 *** If you set scroll-conservatively to a small number, then when you
11558 move point a short distance off the screen, Emacs will scroll the
11559 screen just far enough to bring point back on screen, provided that
11560 does not exceed `scroll-conservatively' lines.
11561
11562 *** The new variable scroll-margin says how close point can come to the
11563 top or bottom of a window. It is a number of screen lines; if point
11564 comes within that many lines of the top or bottom of the window, Emacs
11565 recenters the window.
11566
11567 ** International character set support (MULE)
11568
11569 Emacs now supports a wide variety of international character sets,
11570 including European variants of the Latin alphabet, as well as Chinese,
11571 Devanagari (Hindi and Marathi), Ethiopian, Greek, IPA, Japanese,
11572 Korean, Lao, Russian, Thai, Tibetan, and Vietnamese scripts. These
11573 features have been merged from the modified version of Emacs known as
11574 MULE (for "MULti-lingual Enhancement to GNU Emacs")
11575
11576 Users of these scripts have established many more-or-less standard
11577 coding systems for storing files. Emacs uses a single multibyte
11578 character encoding within Emacs buffers; it can translate from a wide
11579 variety of coding systems when reading a file and can translate back
11580 into any of these coding systems when saving a file.
11581
11582 Keyboards, even in the countries where these character sets are used,
11583 generally don't have keys for all the characters in them. So Emacs
11584 supports various "input methods", typically one for each script or
11585 language, to make it possible to type them.
11586
11587 The Emacs internal multibyte encoding represents a non-ASCII
11588 character as a sequence of bytes in the range 0200 through 0377.
11589
11590 The new prefix key C-x RET is used for commands that pertain
11591 to multibyte characters, coding systems, and input methods.
11592
11593 You can disable multibyte character support as follows:
11594
11595 (setq-default enable-multibyte-characters nil)
11596
11597 Calling the function standard-display-european turns off multibyte
11598 characters, unless you specify a non-nil value for the second
11599 argument, AUTO. This provides compatibility for people who are
11600 already using standard-display-european to continue using unibyte
11601 characters for their work until they want to change.
11602
11603 *** Input methods
11604
11605 An input method is a kind of character conversion which is designed
11606 specifically for interactive input. In Emacs, typically each language
11607 has its own input method (though sometimes several languages which use
11608 the same characters can share one input method). Some languages
11609 support several input methods.
11610
11611 The simplest kind of input method works by mapping ASCII letters into
11612 another alphabet. This is how the Greek and Russian input methods
11613 work.
11614
11615 A more powerful technique is composition: converting sequences of
11616 characters into one letter. Many European input methods use
11617 composition to produce a single non-ASCII letter from a sequence which
11618 consists of a letter followed by diacritics. For example, a' is one
11619 sequence of two characters that might be converted into a single
11620 letter.
11621
11622 The input methods for syllabic scripts typically use mapping followed
11623 by conversion. The input methods for Thai and Korean work this way.
11624 First, letters are mapped into symbols for particular sounds or tone
11625 marks; then, sequences of these which make up a whole syllable are
11626 mapped into one syllable sign--most often a "composite character".
11627
11628 None of these methods works very well for Chinese and Japanese, so
11629 they are handled specially. First you input a whole word using
11630 phonetic spelling; then, after the word is in the buffer, Emacs
11631 converts it into one or more characters using a large dictionary.
11632
11633 Since there is more than one way to represent a phonetically spelled
11634 word using Chinese characters, Emacs can only guess which one to use;
11635 typically these input methods give you a way to say "guess again" if
11636 the first guess is wrong.
11637
11638 *** The command C-x RET m (toggle-enable-multibyte-characters)
11639 turns multibyte character support on or off for the current buffer.
11640
11641 If multibyte character support is turned off in a buffer, then each
11642 byte is a single character, even codes 0200 through 0377--exactly as
11643 they did in Emacs 19.34. This includes the features for support for
11644 the European characters, ISO Latin-1 and ISO Latin-2.
11645
11646 However, there is no need to turn off multibyte character support to
11647 use ISO Latin-1 or ISO Latin-2; the Emacs multibyte character set
11648 includes all the characters in these character sets, and Emacs can
11649 translate automatically to and from either one.
11650
11651 *** Visiting a file in unibyte mode.
11652
11653 Turning off multibyte character support in the buffer after visiting a
11654 file with multibyte code conversion will display the multibyte
11655 sequences already in the buffer, byte by byte. This is probably not
11656 what you want.
11657
11658 If you want to edit a file of unibyte characters (Latin-1, for
11659 example), you can do it by specifying `no-conversion' as the coding
11660 system when reading the file. This coding system also turns off
11661 multibyte characters in that buffer.
11662
11663 If you turn off multibyte character support entirely, this turns off
11664 character conversion as well.
11665
11666 *** Displaying international characters on X Windows.
11667
11668 A font for X typically displays just one alphabet or script.
11669 Therefore, displaying the entire range of characters Emacs supports
11670 requires using many fonts.
11671
11672 Therefore, Emacs now supports "fontsets". Each fontset is a
11673 collection of fonts, each assigned to a range of character codes.
11674
11675 A fontset has a name, like a font. Individual fonts are defined by
11676 the X server; fontsets are defined within Emacs itself. But once you
11677 have defined a fontset, you can use it in a face or a frame just as
11678 you would use a font.
11679
11680 If a fontset specifies no font for a certain character, or if it
11681 specifies a font that does not exist on your system, then it cannot
11682 display that character. It will display an empty box instead.
11683
11684 The fontset height and width are determined by the ASCII characters
11685 (that is, by the font in the fontset which is used for ASCII
11686 characters).
11687
11688 *** Defining fontsets.
11689
11690 Emacs does not use any fontset by default. Its default font is still
11691 chosen as in previous versions. You can tell Emacs to use a fontset
11692 with the `-fn' option or the `Font' X resource.
11693
11694 Emacs creates a standard fontset automatically according to the value
11695 of standard-fontset-spec. This fontset's short name is
11696 `fontset-standard'. Bold, italic, and bold-italic variants of the
11697 standard fontset are created automatically.
11698
11699 If you specify a default ASCII font with the `Font' resource or `-fn'
11700 argument, a fontset is generated from it. This works by replacing the
11701 FOUNDARY, FAMILY, ADD_STYLE, and AVERAGE_WIDTH fields of the font name
11702 with `*' then using this to specify a fontset. This fontset's short
11703 name is `fontset-startup'.
11704
11705 Emacs checks resources of the form Fontset-N where N is 0, 1, 2...
11706 The resource value should have this form:
11707 FONTSET-NAME, [CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME]...
11708 FONTSET-NAME should have the form of a standard X font name, except:
11709 * most fields should be just the wild card "*".
11710 * the CHARSET_REGISTRY field should be "fontset"
11711 * the CHARSET_ENCODING field can be any nickname of the fontset.
11712 The construct CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME can be repeated any number
11713 of times; each time specifies the font for one character set.
11714 CHARSET-NAME should be the name of a character set, and FONT-NAME
11715 should specify an actual font to use for that character set.
11716
11717 Each of these fontsets has an alias which is made from the
11718 last two font name fields, CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING.
11719 You can refer to the fontset by that alias or by its full name.
11720
11721 For any character sets that you don't mention, Emacs tries to choose a
11722 font by substituting into FONTSET-NAME. For instance, with the
11723 following resource,
11724 Emacs*Fontset-0: -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-*-*-*-*-fontset-24
11725 the font for ASCII is generated as below:
11726 -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-ISO8859-1
11727 Here is the substitution rule:
11728 Change CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING to that of the charset
11729 defined in the variable x-charset-registries. For instance, ASCII has
11730 the entry (ascii . "ISO8859-1") in this variable. Then, reduce
11731 sequences of wild cards -*-...-*- with a single wildcard -*-.
11732 (This is to prevent use of auto-scaled fonts.)
11733
11734 The function which processes the fontset resource value to create the
11735 fontset is called create-fontset-from-fontset-spec. You can also call
11736 that function explicitly to create a fontset.
11737
11738 With the X resource Emacs.Font, you can specify a fontset name just
11739 like an actual font name. But be careful not to specify a fontset
11740 name in a wildcard resource like Emacs*Font--that tries to specify the
11741 fontset for other purposes including menus, and they cannot handle
11742 fontsets.
11743
11744 *** The command M-x set-language-environment sets certain global Emacs
11745 defaults for a particular choice of language.
11746
11747 Selecting a language environment typically specifies a default input
11748 method and which coding systems to recognize automatically when
11749 visiting files. However, it does not try to reread files you have
11750 already visited; the text in those buffers is not affected. The
11751 language environment may also specify a default choice of coding
11752 system for new files that you create.
11753
11754 It makes no difference which buffer is current when you use
11755 set-language-environment, because these defaults apply globally to the
11756 whole Emacs session.
11757
11758 For example, M-x set-language-environment RET Latin-1 RET
11759 chooses the Latin-1 character set. In the .emacs file, you can do this
11760 with (set-language-environment "Latin-1").
11761
11762 *** The command C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system)
11763 specifies the file coding system for the current buffer. This
11764 specifies what sort of character code translation to do when saving
11765 the file. As an argument, you must specify the name of one of the
11766 coding systems that Emacs supports.
11767
11768 *** The command C-x RET c (universal-coding-system-argument)
11769 lets you specify a coding system when you read or write a file.
11770 This command uses the minibuffer to read a coding system name.
11771 After you exit the minibuffer, the specified coding system
11772 is used for *the immediately following command*.
11773
11774 So if the immediately following command is a command to read or
11775 write a file, it uses the specified coding system for that file.
11776
11777 If the immediately following command does not use the coding system,
11778 then C-x RET c ultimately has no effect.
11779
11780 For example, C-x RET c iso-8859-1 RET C-x C-f temp RET
11781 visits the file `temp' treating it as ISO Latin-1.
11782
11783 *** You can specify the coding system for a file using the -*-
11784 construct. Include `coding: CODINGSYSTEM;' inside the -*-...-*-
11785 to specify use of coding system CODINGSYSTEM. You can also
11786 specify the coding system in a local variable list at the end
11787 of the file.
11788
11789 *** The command C-x RET t (set-terminal-coding-system) specifies
11790 the coding system for terminal output. If you specify a character
11791 code for terminal output, all characters output to the terminal are
11792 translated into that character code.
11793
11794 This feature is useful for certain character-only terminals built in
11795 various countries to support the languages of those countries.
11796
11797 By default, output to the terminal is not translated at all.
11798
11799 *** The command C-x RET k (set-keyboard-coding-system) specifies
11800 the coding system for keyboard input.
11801
11802 Character code translation of keyboard input is useful for terminals
11803 with keys that send non-ASCII graphic characters--for example,
11804 some terminals designed for ISO Latin-1 or subsets of it.
11805
11806 By default, keyboard input is not translated at all.
11807
11808 Character code translation of keyboard input is similar to using an
11809 input method, in that both define sequences of keyboard input that
11810 translate into single characters. However, input methods are designed
11811 to be convenient for interactive use, while the code translations are
11812 designed to work with terminals.
11813
11814 *** The command C-x RET p (set-buffer-process-coding-system)
11815 specifies the coding system for input and output to a subprocess.
11816 This command applies to the current buffer; normally, each subprocess
11817 has its own buffer, and thus you can use this command to specify
11818 translation to and from a particular subprocess by giving the command
11819 in the corresponding buffer.
11820
11821 By default, process input and output are not translated at all.
11822
11823 *** The variable file-name-coding-system specifies the coding system
11824 to use for encoding file names before operating on them.
11825 It is also used for decoding file names obtained from the system.
11826
11827 *** The command C-\ (toggle-input-method) activates or deactivates
11828 an input method. If no input method has been selected before, the
11829 command prompts for you to specify the language and input method you
11830 want to use.
11831
11832 C-u C-\ (select-input-method) lets you switch to a different input
11833 method. C-h C-\ (or C-h I) describes the current input method.
11834
11835 *** Some input methods remap the keyboard to emulate various keyboard
11836 layouts commonly used for particular scripts. How to do this
11837 remapping properly depends on your actual keyboard layout. To specify
11838 which layout your keyboard has, use M-x quail-set-keyboard-layout.
11839
11840 *** The command C-h C (describe-coding-system) displays
11841 the coding systems currently selected for various purposes, plus
11842 related information.
11843
11844 *** The command C-h h (view-hello-file) displays a file called
11845 HELLO, which has examples of text in many languages, using various
11846 scripts.
11847
11848 *** The command C-h L (describe-language-support) displays
11849 information about the support for a particular language.
11850 You specify the language as an argument.
11851
11852 *** The mode line now contains a letter or character that identifies
11853 the coding system used in the visited file. It normally follows the
11854 first dash.
11855
11856 A dash indicates the default state of affairs: no code conversion
11857 (except CRLF => newline if appropriate). `=' means no conversion
11858 whatsoever. The ISO 8859 coding systems are represented by digits
11859 1 through 9. Other coding systems are represented by letters:
11860
11861 A alternativnyj (Russian)
11862 B big5 (Chinese)
11863 C cn-gb-2312 (Chinese)
11864 C iso-2022-cn (Chinese)
11865 D in-is13194-devanagari (Indian languages)
11866 E euc-japan (Japanese)
11867 I iso-2022-cjk or iso-2022-ss2 (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
11868 J junet (iso-2022-7) or old-jis (iso-2022-jp-1978-irv) (Japanese)
11869 K euc-korea (Korean)
11870 R koi8 (Russian)
11871 Q tibetan
11872 S shift_jis (Japanese)
11873 T lao
11874 T tis620 (Thai)
11875 V viscii or vscii (Vietnamese)
11876 i iso-2022-lock (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
11877 k iso-2022-kr (Korean)
11878 v viqr (Vietnamese)
11879 z hz (Chinese)
11880
11881 When you are using a character-only terminal (not a window system),
11882 two additional characters appear in between the dash and the file
11883 coding system. These two characters describe the coding system for
11884 keyboard input, and the coding system for terminal output.
11885
11886 *** The new variable rmail-file-coding-system specifies the code
11887 conversion to use for RMAIL files. The default value is nil.
11888
11889 When you read mail with Rmail, each message is decoded automatically
11890 into Emacs' internal format. This has nothing to do with
11891 rmail-file-coding-system. That variable controls reading and writing
11892 Rmail files themselves.
11893
11894 *** The new variable sendmail-coding-system specifies the code
11895 conversion for outgoing mail. The default value is nil.
11896
11897 Actually, there are three different ways of specifying the coding system
11898 for sending mail:
11899
11900 - If you use C-x RET f in the mail buffer, that takes priority.
11901 - Otherwise, if you set sendmail-coding-system non-nil, that specifies it.
11902 - Otherwise, the default coding system for new files is used,
11903 if that is non-nil. That comes from your language environment.
11904 - Otherwise, Latin-1 is used.
11905
11906 *** The command C-h t (help-with-tutorial) accepts a prefix argument
11907 to specify the language for the tutorial file. Currently, English,
11908 Japanese, Korean and Thai are supported. We welcome additional
11909 translations.
11910
11911 ** An easy new way to visit a file with no code or format conversion
11912 of any kind: Use M-x find-file-literally. There is also a command
11913 insert-file-literally which inserts a file into the current buffer
11914 without any conversion.
11915
11916 ** C-q's handling of octal character codes is changed.
11917 You can now specify any number of octal digits.
11918 RET terminates the digits and is discarded;
11919 any other non-digit terminates the digits and is then used as input.
11920
11921 ** There are new commands for looking up Info documentation for
11922 functions, variables and file names used in your programs.
11923
11924 Type M-x info-lookup-symbol to look up a symbol in the buffer at point.
11925 Type M-x info-lookup-file to look up a file in the buffer at point.
11926
11927 Precisely which Info files are used to look it up depends on the major
11928 mode. For example, in C mode, the GNU libc manual is used.
11929
11930 ** M-TAB in most programming language modes now runs the command
11931 complete-symbol. This command performs completion on the symbol name
11932 in the buffer before point.
11933
11934 With a numeric argument, it performs completion based on the set of
11935 symbols documented in the Info files for the programming language that
11936 you are using.
11937
11938 With no argument, it does completion based on the current tags tables,
11939 just like the old binding of M-TAB (complete-tag).
11940
11941 ** File locking works with NFS now.
11942
11943 The lock file for FILENAME is now a symbolic link named .#FILENAME,
11944 in the same directory as FILENAME.
11945
11946 This means that collision detection between two different machines now
11947 works reasonably well; it also means that no file server or directory
11948 can become a bottleneck.
11949
11950 The new method does have drawbacks. It means that collision detection
11951 does not operate when you edit a file in a directory where you cannot
11952 create new files. Collision detection also doesn't operate when the
11953 file server does not support symbolic links. But these conditions are
11954 rare, and the ability to have collision detection while using NFS is
11955 so useful that the change is worth while.
11956
11957 When Emacs or a system crashes, this may leave behind lock files which
11958 are stale. So you may occasionally get warnings about spurious
11959 collisions. When you determine that the collision is spurious, just
11960 tell Emacs to go ahead anyway.
11961
11962 ** If you wish to use Show Paren mode to display matching parentheses,
11963 it is no longer sufficient to load paren.el. Instead you must call
11964 show-paren-mode.
11965
11966 ** If you wish to use Delete Selection mode to replace a highlighted
11967 selection when you insert new text, it is no longer sufficient to load
11968 delsel.el. Instead you must call the function delete-selection-mode.
11969
11970 ** If you wish to use Partial Completion mode to complete partial words
11971 within symbols or filenames, it is no longer sufficient to load
11972 complete.el. Instead you must call the function partial-completion-mode.
11973
11974 ** If you wish to use uniquify to rename buffers for you,
11975 it is no longer sufficient to load uniquify.el. You must also
11976 set uniquify-buffer-name-style to one of the non-nil legitimate values.
11977
11978 ** Changes in View mode.
11979
11980 *** Several new commands are available in View mode.
11981 Do H in view mode for a list of commands.
11982
11983 *** There are two new commands for entering View mode:
11984 view-file-other-frame and view-buffer-other-frame.
11985
11986 *** Exiting View mode does a better job of restoring windows to their
11987 previous state.
11988
11989 *** New customization variable view-scroll-auto-exit. If non-nil,
11990 scrolling past end of buffer makes view mode exit.
11991
11992 *** New customization variable view-exits-all-viewing-windows. If
11993 non-nil, view-mode will at exit restore all windows viewing buffer,
11994 not just the selected window.
11995
11996 *** New customization variable view-read-only. If non-nil, visiting a
11997 read-only file automatically enters View mode, and toggle-read-only
11998 turns View mode on or off.
11999
12000 *** New customization variable view-remove-frame-by-deleting controls
12001 how to remove a not needed frame at view mode exit. If non-nil,
12002 delete the frame, if nil make an icon of it.
12003
12004 ** C-x v l, the command to print a file's version control log,
12005 now positions point at the entry for the file's current branch version.
12006
12007 ** C-x v =, the command to compare a file with the last checked-in version,
12008 has a new feature. If the file is currently not locked, so that it is
12009 presumably identical to the last checked-in version, the command now asks
12010 which version to compare with.
12011
12012 ** When using hideshow.el, incremental search can temporarily show hidden
12013 blocks if a match is inside the block.
12014
12015 The block is hidden again if the search is continued and the next match
12016 is outside the block. By customizing the variable
12017 isearch-hide-immediately you can choose to hide all the temporarily
12018 shown blocks only when exiting from incremental search.
12019
12020 By customizing the variable hs-isearch-open you can choose what kind
12021 of blocks to temporarily show during isearch: comment blocks, code
12022 blocks, all of them or none.
12023
12024 ** The new command C-x 4 0 (kill-buffer-and-window) kills the
12025 current buffer and deletes the selected window. It asks for
12026 confirmation first.
12027
12028 ** C-x C-w, which saves the buffer into a specified file name,
12029 now changes the major mode according to that file name.
12030 However, the mode will not be changed if
12031 (1) a local variables list or the `-*-' line specifies a major mode, or
12032 (2) the current major mode is a "special" mode,
12033 not suitable for ordinary files, or
12034 (3) the new file name does not particularly specify any mode.
12035
12036 This applies to M-x set-visited-file-name as well.
12037
12038 However, if you set change-major-mode-with-file-name to nil, then
12039 these commands do not change the major mode.
12040
12041 ** M-x occur changes.
12042
12043 *** If the argument to M-x occur contains upper case letters,
12044 it performs a case-sensitive search.
12045
12046 *** In the *Occur* buffer made by M-x occur,
12047 if you type g or M-x revert-buffer, this repeats the search
12048 using the same regular expression and the same buffer as before.
12049
12050 ** In Transient Mark mode, the region in any one buffer is highlighted
12051 in just one window at a time. At first, it is highlighted in the
12052 window where you set the mark. The buffer's highlighting remains in
12053 that window unless you select to another window which shows the same
12054 buffer--then the highlighting moves to that window.
12055
12056 ** The feature to suggest key bindings when you use M-x now operates
12057 after the command finishes. The message suggesting key bindings
12058 appears temporarily in the echo area. The previous echo area contents
12059 come back after a few seconds, in case they contain useful information.
12060
12061 ** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
12062 selected buffers, so that the default for C-x b is now based on the
12063 buffers recently selected in the selected frame.
12064
12065 ** Outline mode changes.
12066
12067 *** Outline mode now uses overlays (this is the former noutline.el).
12068
12069 *** Incremental searches skip over invisible text in Outline mode.
12070
12071 ** When a minibuffer window is active but not the selected window, if
12072 you try to use the minibuffer, you used to get a nested minibuffer.
12073 Now, this not only gives an error, it also cancels the minibuffer that
12074 was already active.
12075
12076 The motive for this change is so that beginning users do not
12077 unknowingly move away from minibuffers, leaving them active, and then
12078 get confused by it.
12079
12080 If you want to be able to have recursive minibuffers, you must
12081 set enable-recursive-minibuffers to non-nil.
12082
12083 ** Changes in dynamic abbrevs.
12084
12085 *** Expanding dynamic abbrevs with M-/ is now smarter about case
12086 conversion. If the expansion has mixed case not counting the first
12087 character, and the abbreviation matches the beginning of the expansion
12088 including case, then the expansion is copied verbatim.
12089
12090 The expansion is also copied verbatim if the abbreviation itself has
12091 mixed case. And using SPC M-/ to copy an additional word always
12092 copies it verbatim except when the previous copied word is all caps.
12093
12094 *** The values of `dabbrev-case-replace' and `dabbrev-case-fold-search'
12095 are no longer Lisp expressions. They have simply three possible
12096 values.
12097
12098 `dabbrev-case-replace' has these three values: nil (don't preserve
12099 case), t (do), or `case-replace' (do like M-x query-replace).
12100 `dabbrev-case-fold-search' has these three values: nil (don't ignore
12101 case), t (do), or `case-fold-search' (do like search).
12102
12103 ** Minibuffer history lists are truncated automatically now to a
12104 certain length. The variable history-length specifies how long they
12105 can be. The default value is 30.
12106
12107 ** Changes in Mail mode.
12108
12109 *** The key C-x m no longer runs the `mail' command directly.
12110 Instead, it runs the command `compose-mail', which invokes the mail
12111 composition mechanism you have selected with the variable
12112 `mail-user-agent'. The default choice of user agent is
12113 `sendmail-user-agent', which gives behavior compatible with the old
12114 behavior.
12115
12116 C-x 4 m now runs compose-mail-other-window, and C-x 5 m runs
12117 compose-mail-other-frame.
12118
12119 *** While composing a reply to a mail message, from Rmail, you can use
12120 the command C-c C-r to cite just the region from the message you are
12121 replying to. This copies the text which is the selected region in the
12122 buffer that shows the original message.
12123
12124 *** The command C-c C-i inserts a file at the end of the message,
12125 with separator lines around the contents.
12126
12127 *** The command M-x expand-mail-aliases expands all mail aliases
12128 in suitable mail headers. Emacs automatically extracts mail alias
12129 definitions from your mail alias file (e.g., ~/.mailrc). You do not
12130 need to expand mail aliases yourself before sending mail.
12131
12132 *** New features in the mail-complete command.
12133
12134 **** The mail-complete command now inserts the user's full name,
12135 for local users or if that is known. The variable mail-complete-style
12136 controls the style to use, and whether to do this at all.
12137 Its values are like those of mail-from-style.
12138
12139 **** The variable mail-passwd-command lets you specify a shell command
12140 to run to fetch a set of password-entries that add to the ones in
12141 /etc/passwd.
12142
12143 **** The variable mail-passwd-file now specifies a list of files to read
12144 to get the list of user ids. By default, one file is used:
12145 /etc/passwd.
12146
12147 ** You can "quote" a file name to inhibit special significance of
12148 special syntax, by adding `/:' to the beginning. Thus, if you have a
12149 directory named `/foo:', you can prevent it from being treated as a
12150 reference to a remote host named `foo' by writing it as `/:/foo:'.
12151
12152 Emacs uses this new construct automatically when necessary, such as
12153 when you start it with a working directory whose name might otherwise
12154 be taken to be magic.
12155
12156 ** There is a new command M-x grep-find which uses find to select
12157 files to search through, and grep to scan them. The output is
12158 available in a Compile mode buffer, as with M-x grep.
12159
12160 M-x grep now uses the -e option if the grep program supports that.
12161 (-e prevents problems if the search pattern starts with a dash.)
12162
12163 ** In Dired, the & command now flags for deletion the files whose names
12164 suggest they are probably not needed in the long run.
12165
12166 In Dired, * is now a prefix key for mark-related commands.
12167
12168 new key dired.el binding old key
12169 ------- ---------------- -------
12170 * c dired-change-marks c
12171 * m dired-mark m
12172 * * dired-mark-executables * (binding deleted)
12173 * / dired-mark-directories / (binding deleted)
12174 * @ dired-mark-symlinks @ (binding deleted)
12175 * u dired-unmark u
12176 * DEL dired-unmark-backward DEL
12177 * ? dired-unmark-all-files C-M-?
12178 * ! dired-unmark-all-marks
12179 * % dired-mark-files-regexp % m
12180 * C-n dired-next-marked-file M-}
12181 * C-p dired-prev-marked-file M-{
12182
12183 ** Rmail changes.
12184
12185 *** When Rmail cannot convert your incoming mail into Babyl format, it
12186 saves the new mail in the file RMAILOSE.n, where n is an integer
12187 chosen to make a unique name. This way, Rmail will not keep crashing
12188 each time you run it.
12189
12190 *** In Rmail, the variable rmail-summary-line-count-flag now controls
12191 whether to include the line count in the summary. Non-nil means yes.
12192
12193 *** In Rmail summary buffers, d and C-d (the commands to delete
12194 messages) now take repeat counts as arguments. A negative argument
12195 means to move in the opposite direction.
12196
12197 *** In Rmail, the t command now takes an optional argument which lets
12198 you specify whether to show the message headers in full or pruned.
12199
12200 *** In Rmail, the new command w (rmail-output-body-to-file) writes
12201 just the body of the current message into a file, without the headers.
12202 It takes the file name from the message subject, by default, but you
12203 can edit that file name in the minibuffer before it is actually used
12204 for output.
12205
12206 ** Gnus changes.
12207
12208 *** nntp.el has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
12209
12210 *** Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
12211 Gnus.
12212
12213 *** Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like
12214 `and', `or', `not', and parent redirection.
12215
12216 *** Article washing status can be displayed in the
12217 article mode line.
12218
12219 *** gnus.el has been split into many smaller files.
12220
12221 *** Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID.
12222
12223 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
12224
12225 *** New variables for specifying what score and adapt files
12226 are to be considered home score and adapt files. See
12227 `gnus-home-score-file' and `gnus-home-adapt-files'.
12228
12229 *** Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics.
12230
12231 *** Article editing has been revamped and is now usable.
12232
12233 *** Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions.
12234 See `gnus-signature-separator' and `gnus-signature-limit'.
12235
12236 *** Summary pick mode has been made to look more nn-like.
12237 Line numbers are displayed and the `.' command can be
12238 used to pick articles.
12239
12240 *** Commands for moving the .newsrc.eld from one server to
12241 another have been added.
12242
12243 `M-x gnus-change-server'
12244
12245 *** A way to specify that "uninteresting" fields be suppressed when
12246 generating lines in buffers.
12247
12248 *** Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with
12249 `C-M-_'.
12250
12251 *** Scoring can be done on words using the new score type `w'.
12252
12253 *** Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis:
12254
12255 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
12256
12257 *** Scores can be decayed.
12258
12259 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
12260
12261 *** Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The
12262 Date is normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first.
12263
12264 *** A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
12265 the native server.
12266
12267 `M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups'
12268
12269 *** A new command for reading collections of documents
12270 (nndoc with nnvirtual on top) has been added -- `C-M-d'.
12271
12272 *** Process mark sets can be pushed and popped.
12273
12274 *** A new mail-to-news backend makes it possible to post
12275 even when the NNTP server doesn't allow posting.
12276
12277 *** A new backend for reading searches from Web search engines
12278 (DejaNews, Alta Vista, InReference) has been added.
12279
12280 Use the `G w' command in the group buffer to create such
12281 a group.
12282
12283 *** Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard
12284 sorting functions, and each topic can be sorted independently.
12285
12286 See the commands under the `T S' submap.
12287
12288 *** Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently.
12289
12290 See the commands under the `G P' submap.
12291
12292 *** Cached articles can be pulled into the groups.
12293
12294 Use the `Y c' command.
12295
12296 *** Score files are now applied in a more reliable order.
12297
12298 *** Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated.
12299
12300 `M-x nnmail-split-history'
12301
12302 *** More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk
12303 from incoming mail before saving the mail.
12304
12305 See `nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook'.
12306
12307 *** The nnml mail backend now understands compressed article files.
12308
12309 *** To enable Gnus to read/post multi-lingual articles, you must execute
12310 the following code, for instance, in your .emacs.
12311
12312 (add-hook 'gnus-startup-hook 'gnus-mule-initialize)
12313
12314 Then, when you start Gnus, it will decode non-ASCII text automatically
12315 and show appropriate characters. (Note: if you are using gnus-mime
12316 from the SEMI package, formerly known as TM, you should NOT add this
12317 hook to gnus-startup-hook; gnus-mime has its own method of handling
12318 this issue.)
12319
12320 Since it is impossible to distinguish all coding systems
12321 automatically, you may need to specify a choice of coding system for a
12322 particular news group. This can be done by:
12323
12324 (gnus-mule-add-group NEWSGROUP 'CODING-SYSTEM)
12325
12326 Here NEWSGROUP should be a string which names a newsgroup or a tree
12327 of newsgroups. If NEWSGROUP is "XXX.YYY", all news groups under
12328 "XXX.YYY" (including "XXX.YYY.ZZZ") will use the specified coding
12329 system. CODING-SYSTEM specifies which coding system to use (for both
12330 for reading and posting).
12331
12332 CODING-SYSTEM can also be a cons cell of the form
12333 (READ-CODING-SYSTEM . POST-CODING-SYSTEM)
12334 Then READ-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you read messages from the
12335 newsgroups, while POST-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you post messages
12336 there.
12337
12338 Emacs knows the right coding systems for certain newsgroups by
12339 default. Here are some of these default settings:
12340
12341 (gnus-mule-add-group "fj" 'iso-2022-7)
12342 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text" 'hz-gb-2312)
12343 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.hk" 'hz-gb-2312)
12344 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text.big5" 'cn-big5)
12345 (gnus-mule-add-group "soc.culture.vietnamese" '(nil . viqr))
12346
12347 When you reply by mail to an article, these settings are ignored;
12348 the mail is encoded according to sendmail-coding-system, as usual.
12349
12350 ** CC mode changes.
12351
12352 *** If you edit primarily one style of C (or C++, Objective-C, Java)
12353 code, you may want to make the CC Mode style variables have global
12354 values so that you can set them directly in your .emacs file. To do
12355 this, set c-style-variables-are-local-p to nil in your .emacs file.
12356 Note that this only takes effect if you do it *before* cc-mode.el is
12357 loaded.
12358
12359 If you typically edit more than one style of C (or C++, Objective-C,
12360 Java) code in a single Emacs session, you may want to make the CC Mode
12361 style variables have buffer local values. By default, all buffers
12362 share the same style variable settings; to make them buffer local, set
12363 c-style-variables-are-local-p to t in your .emacs file. Note that you
12364 must do this *before* CC Mode is loaded.
12365
12366 *** The new variable c-indentation-style holds the C style name
12367 of the current buffer.
12368
12369 *** The variable c-block-comments-indent-p has been deleted, because
12370 it is no longer necessary. C mode now handles all the supported styles
12371 of block comments, with no need to say which one you will use.
12372
12373 *** There is a new indentation style "python", which specifies the C
12374 style that the Python developers like.
12375
12376 *** There is a new c-cleanup-list option: brace-elseif-brace.
12377 This says to put ...} else if (...) {... on one line,
12378 just as brace-else-brace says to put ...} else {... on one line.
12379
12380 ** VC Changes [new]
12381
12382 *** In vc-retrieve-snapshot (C-x v r), if you don't specify a snapshot
12383 name, it retrieves the *latest* versions of all files in the current
12384 directory and its subdirectories (aside from files already locked).
12385
12386 This feature is useful if your RCS directory is a link to a common
12387 master directory, and you want to pick up changes made by other
12388 developers.
12389
12390 You can do the same thing for an individual file by typing C-u C-x C-q
12391 RET in a buffer visiting that file.
12392
12393 *** VC can now handle files under CVS that are being "watched" by
12394 other developers. Such files are made read-only by CVS. To get a
12395 writable copy, type C-x C-q in a buffer visiting such a file. VC then
12396 calls "cvs edit", which notifies the other developers of it.
12397
12398 *** vc-version-diff (C-u C-x v =) now suggests reasonable defaults for
12399 version numbers, based on the current state of the file.
12400
12401 ** Calendar changes.
12402
12403 *** A new function, list-holidays, allows you list holidays or
12404 subclasses of holidays for ranges of years. Related menu items allow
12405 you do this for the year of the selected date, or the
12406 following/previous years.
12407
12408 *** There is now support for the Baha'i calendar system. Use `pb' in
12409 the *Calendar* buffer to display the current Baha'i date. The Baha'i
12410 calendar, or "Badi calendar" is a system of 19 months with 19 days
12411 each, and 4 intercalary days (5 during a Gregorian leap year). The
12412 calendar begins May 23, 1844, with each of the months named after a
12413 supposed attribute of God.
12414
12415 ** ps-print changes
12416
12417 There are some new user variables and subgroups for customizing the page
12418 layout.
12419
12420 *** Headers & Footers (subgroup)
12421
12422 Some printer systems print a header page and force the first page to
12423 be printed on the back of the header page when using duplex. If your
12424 printer system has this behavior, set variable
12425 `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' to t.
12426
12427 If variable `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' is non-nil, it prints a
12428 blank page as the very first printed page. So, it behaves as if the
12429 very first character of buffer (or region) were a form feed ^L (\014).
12430
12431 The variable `ps-spool-config' specifies who is responsible for
12432 setting duplex mode and page size. Valid values are:
12433
12434 lpr-switches duplex and page size are configured by `ps-lpr-switches'.
12435 Don't forget to set `ps-lpr-switches' to select duplex
12436 printing for your printer.
12437
12438 setpagedevice duplex and page size are configured by ps-print using the
12439 setpagedevice PostScript operator.
12440
12441 nil duplex and page size are configured by ps-print *not* using
12442 the setpagedevice PostScript operator.
12443
12444 The variable `ps-spool-tumble' specifies how the page images on
12445 opposite sides of a sheet are oriented with respect to each other. If
12446 `ps-spool-tumble' is nil, ps-print produces output suitable for
12447 bindings on the left or right. If `ps-spool-tumble' is non-nil,
12448 ps-print produces output suitable for bindings at the top or bottom.
12449 This variable takes effect only if `ps-spool-duplex' is non-nil.
12450 The default value is nil.
12451
12452 The variable `ps-header-frame-alist' specifies a header frame
12453 properties alist. Valid frame properties are:
12454
12455 fore-color Specify the foreground frame color.
12456 Value should be a float number between 0.0 (black
12457 color) and 1.0 (white color), or a string which is a
12458 color name, or a list of 3 float numbers which
12459 correspond to the Red Green Blue color scale, each
12460 float number between 0.0 (dark color) and 1.0 (bright
12461 color). The default is 0 ("black").
12462
12463 back-color Specify the background frame color (similar to fore-color).
12464 The default is 0.9 ("gray90").
12465
12466 shadow-color Specify the shadow color (similar to fore-color).
12467 The default is 0 ("black").
12468
12469 border-color Specify the border color (similar to fore-color).
12470 The default is 0 ("black").
12471
12472 border-width Specify the border width.
12473 The default is 0.4.
12474
12475 Any other property is ignored.
12476
12477 Don't change this alist directly; instead use Custom, or the
12478 `ps-value', `ps-get', `ps-put' and `ps-del' functions (see there for
12479 documentation).
12480
12481 Ps-print can also print footers. The footer variables are:
12482 `ps-print-footer', `ps-footer-offset', `ps-print-footer-frame',
12483 `ps-footer-font-family', `ps-footer-font-size', `ps-footer-line-pad',
12484 `ps-footer-lines', `ps-left-footer', `ps-right-footer' and
12485 `ps-footer-frame-alist'. These variables are similar to those
12486 controlling headers.
12487
12488 *** Color management (subgroup)
12489
12490 If `ps-print-color-p' is non-nil, the buffer's text will be printed in
12491 color.
12492
12493 *** Face Management (subgroup)
12494
12495 If you need to print without worrying about face background colors,
12496 set the variable `ps-use-face-background' which specifies if face
12497 background should be used. Valid values are:
12498
12499 t always use face background color.
12500 nil never use face background color.
12501 (face...) list of faces whose background color will be used.
12502
12503 *** N-up printing (subgroup)
12504
12505 The variable `ps-n-up-printing' specifies the number of pages per
12506 sheet of paper.
12507
12508 The variable `ps-n-up-margin' specifies the margin in points (pt)
12509 between the sheet border and the n-up printing.
12510
12511 If variable `ps-n-up-border-p' is non-nil, a border is drawn around
12512 each page.
12513
12514 The variable `ps-n-up-filling' specifies how the page matrix is filled
12515 on each sheet of paper. Following are the valid values for
12516 `ps-n-up-filling' with a filling example using a 3x4 page matrix:
12517
12518 `left-top' 1 2 3 4 `left-bottom' 9 10 11 12
12519 5 6 7 8 5 6 7 8
12520 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
12521
12522 `right-top' 4 3 2 1 `right-bottom' 12 11 10 9
12523 8 7 6 5 8 7 6 5
12524 12 11 10 9 4 3 2 1
12525
12526 `top-left' 1 4 7 10 `bottom-left' 3 6 9 12
12527 2 5 8 11 2 5 8 11
12528 3 6 9 12 1 4 7 10
12529
12530 `top-right' 10 7 4 1 `bottom-right' 12 9 6 3
12531 11 8 5 2 11 8 5 2
12532 12 9 6 3 10 7 4 1
12533
12534 Any other value is treated as `left-top'.
12535
12536 *** Zebra stripes (subgroup)
12537
12538 The variable `ps-zebra-color' controls the zebra stripes grayscale or
12539 RGB color.
12540
12541 The variable `ps-zebra-stripe-follow' specifies how zebra stripes
12542 continue on next page. Visually, valid values are (the character `+'
12543 to the right of each column indicates that a line is printed):
12544
12545 `nil' `follow' `full' `full-follow'
12546 Current Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
12547 1 XXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXX + 1 XXXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12548 2 XXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXX + 2 XXXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12549 3 XXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXX + 3 XXXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12550 4 + 4 + 4 + 4 +
12551 5 + 5 + 5 + 5 +
12552 6 + 6 + 6 + 6 +
12553 7 XXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXX + 7 XXXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12554 8 XXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXX + 8 XXXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12555 9 XXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXX + 9 XXXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12556 10 + 10 +
12557 11 + 11 +
12558 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
12559 Next Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
12560 12 XXXXX + 12 + 10 XXXXXX + 10 +
12561 13 XXXXX + 13 XXXXXXXX + 11 XXXXXX + 11 +
12562 14 XXXXX + 14 XXXXXXXX + 12 XXXXXX + 12 +
12563 15 + 15 XXXXXXXX + 13 + 13 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12564 16 + 16 + 14 + 14 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12565 17 + 17 + 15 + 15 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12566 18 XXXXX + 18 + 16 XXXXXX + 16 +
12567 19 XXXXX + 19 XXXXXXXX + 17 XXXXXX + 17 +
12568 20 XXXXX + 20 XXXXXXXX + 18 XXXXXX + 18 +
12569 21 + 21 XXXXXXXX +
12570 22 + 22 +
12571 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
12572
12573 Any other value is treated as `nil'.
12574
12575
12576 *** Printer management (subgroup)
12577
12578 The variable `ps-printer-name-option' determines the option used by
12579 some utilities to indicate the printer name; it's used only when
12580 `ps-printer-name' is a non-empty string. If you're using the lpr
12581 utility to print, for example, `ps-printer-name-option' should be set
12582 to "-P".
12583
12584 The variable `ps-manual-feed' indicates if the printer requires manual
12585 paper feeding. If it's nil, automatic feeding takes place. If it's
12586 non-nil, manual feeding takes place.
12587
12588 The variable `ps-end-with-control-d' specifies whether C-d (\x04)
12589 should be inserted at end of the generated PostScript. Non-nil means
12590 do so.
12591
12592 *** Page settings (subgroup)
12593
12594 If variable `ps-warn-paper-type' is nil, it's *not* treated as an
12595 error if the PostScript printer doesn't have a paper with the size
12596 indicated by `ps-paper-type'; the default paper size will be used
12597 instead. If `ps-warn-paper-type' is non-nil, an error is signaled if
12598 the PostScript printer doesn't support a paper with the size indicated
12599 by `ps-paper-type'. This is used when `ps-spool-config' is set to
12600 `setpagedevice'.
12601
12602 The variable `ps-print-upside-down' determines the orientation for
12603 printing pages: nil means `normal' printing, non-nil means
12604 `upside-down' printing (that is, the page is rotated by 180 degrees).
12605
12606 The variable `ps-selected-pages' specifies which pages to print. If
12607 it's nil, all pages are printed. If it's a list, list elements may be
12608 integers specifying a single page to print, or cons cells (FROM . TO)
12609 specifying to print from page FROM to TO. Invalid list elements, that
12610 is integers smaller than one, or elements whose FROM is greater than
12611 its TO, are ignored.
12612
12613 The variable `ps-even-or-odd-pages' specifies how to print even/odd
12614 pages. Valid values are:
12615
12616 nil print all pages.
12617
12618 `even-page' print only even pages.
12619
12620 `odd-page' print only odd pages.
12621
12622 `even-sheet' print only even sheets.
12623 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
12624 `even-page', but for values greater than 1, it'll
12625 print only the even sheet of paper.
12626
12627 `odd-sheet' print only odd sheets.
12628 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
12629 `odd-page'; but for values greater than 1, it'll print
12630 only the odd sheet of paper.
12631
12632 Any other value is treated as nil.
12633
12634 If you set `ps-selected-pages' (see there for documentation), pages
12635 are filtered by `ps-selected-pages', and then by
12636 `ps-even-or-odd-pages'. For example, if we have:
12637
12638 (setq ps-selected-pages '(1 4 (6 . 10) (12 . 16) 20))
12639
12640 and we combine this with `ps-even-or-odd-pages' and
12641 `ps-n-up-printing', we get:
12642
12643 `ps-n-up-printing' = 1:
12644 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
12645 nil 1, 4, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 20
12646 even-page 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
12647 odd-page 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
12648 even-sheet 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
12649 odd-sheet 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
12650
12651 `ps-n-up-printing' = 2:
12652 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
12653 nil 1/4, 6/7, 8/9, 10/12, 13/14, 15/16, 20
12654 even-page 4/6, 8/10, 12/14, 16/20
12655 odd-page 1/7, 9/13, 15
12656 even-sheet 6/7, 10/12, 15/16
12657 odd-sheet 1/4, 8/9, 13/14, 20
12658
12659 *** Miscellany (subgroup)
12660
12661 The variable `ps-error-handler-message' specifies where error handler
12662 messages should be sent.
12663
12664 It is also possible to add a user-defined PostScript prologue code in
12665 front of all generated prologue code by setting the variable
12666 `ps-user-defined-prologue'.
12667
12668 The variable `ps-line-number-font' specifies the font for line numbers.
12669
12670 The variable `ps-line-number-font-size' specifies the font size in
12671 points for line numbers.
12672
12673 The variable `ps-line-number-color' specifies the color for line
12674 numbers. See `ps-zebra-color' for documentation.
12675
12676 The variable `ps-line-number-step' specifies the interval in which
12677 line numbers are printed. For example, if `ps-line-number-step' is set
12678 to 2, the printing will look like:
12679
12680 1 one line
12681 one line
12682 3 one line
12683 one line
12684 5 one line
12685 one line
12686 ...
12687
12688 Valid values are:
12689
12690 integer an integer specifying the interval in which line numbers are
12691 printed. If it's smaller than or equal to zero, 1
12692 is used.
12693
12694 `zebra' specifies that only the line number of the first line in a
12695 zebra stripe is to be printed.
12696
12697 Any other value is treated as `zebra'.
12698
12699 The variable `ps-line-number-start' specifies the starting point in
12700 the interval given by `ps-line-number-step'. For example, if
12701 `ps-line-number-step' is set to 3, and `ps-line-number-start' is set to
12702 3, the output will look like:
12703
12704 one line
12705 one line
12706 3 one line
12707 one line
12708 one line
12709 6 one line
12710 one line
12711 one line
12712 9 one line
12713 one line
12714 ...
12715
12716 The variable `ps-postscript-code-directory' specifies the directory
12717 where the PostScript prologue file used by ps-print is found.
12718
12719 The variable `ps-line-spacing' determines the line spacing in points,
12720 for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
12721 `ps-font-size').
12722
12723 The variable `ps-paragraph-spacing' determines the paragraph spacing,
12724 in points, for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
12725 `ps-font-size').
12726
12727 The variable `ps-paragraph-regexp' specifies the paragraph delimiter.
12728
12729 The variable `ps-begin-cut-regexp' and `ps-end-cut-regexp' specify the
12730 start and end of a region to cut out when printing.
12731
12732 ** hideshow changes.
12733
12734 *** now supports hiding of blocks of single line comments (like // for
12735 C++, ; for lisp).
12736
12737 *** Support for java-mode added.
12738
12739 *** When doing `hs-hide-all' it is now possible to also hide the comments
12740 in the file if `hs-hide-comments-when-hiding-all' is set.
12741
12742 *** The new function `hs-hide-initial-comment' hides the comments at
12743 the beginning of the files. Finally those huge RCS logs don't stay in your
12744 way! This is run by default when entering the `hs-minor-mode'.
12745
12746 *** Now uses overlays instead of `selective-display', so is more
12747 robust and a lot faster.
12748
12749 *** A block beginning can span multiple lines.
12750
12751 *** The new variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' if t, directs hideshow
12752 to show only the beginning of a block when it is hidden. See the
12753 documentation for more details.
12754
12755 ** Changes in Enriched mode.
12756
12757 *** When you visit a file in enriched-mode, Emacs will make sure it is
12758 filled to the current fill-column. This behavior is now independent
12759 of the size of the window. When you save the file, the fill-column in
12760 use is stored as well, so that the whole buffer need not be refilled
12761 the next time unless the fill-column is different.
12762
12763 *** use-hard-newlines is now a minor mode. When it is enabled, Emacs
12764 distinguishes between hard and soft newlines, and treats hard newlines
12765 as paragraph boundaries. Otherwise all newlines inserted are marked
12766 as soft, and paragraph boundaries are determined solely from the text.
12767
12768 ** Font Lock mode
12769
12770 *** Custom support
12771
12772 The variables font-lock-face-attributes, font-lock-display-type and
12773 font-lock-background-mode are now obsolete; the recommended way to specify the
12774 faces to use for Font Lock mode is with M-x customize-group on the new custom
12775 group font-lock-highlighting-faces. If you set font-lock-face-attributes in
12776 your ~/.emacs file, Font Lock mode will respect its value. However, you should
12777 consider converting from setting that variable to using M-x customize.
12778
12779 You can still use X resources to specify Font Lock face appearances.
12780
12781 *** Maximum decoration
12782
12783 Fontification now uses the maximum level of decoration supported by
12784 default. Previously, fontification used a mode-specific default level
12785 of decoration, which is typically the minimum level of decoration
12786 supported. You can set font-lock-maximum-decoration to nil
12787 to get the old behavior.
12788
12789 *** New support
12790
12791 Support is now provided for Java, Objective-C, AWK and SIMULA modes.
12792
12793 Note that Font Lock mode can be turned on without knowing exactly what modes
12794 support Font Lock mode, via the command global-font-lock-mode.
12795
12796 *** Configurable support
12797
12798 Support for C, C++, Objective-C and Java can be more easily configured for
12799 additional types and classes via the new variables c-font-lock-extra-types,
12800 c++-font-lock-extra-types, objc-font-lock-extra-types and, you guessed it,
12801 java-font-lock-extra-types. These value of each of these variables should be a
12802 list of regexps matching the extra type names. For example, the default value
12803 of c-font-lock-extra-types is ("\\sw+_t") which means fontification follows the
12804 convention that C type names end in _t. This results in slower fontification.
12805
12806 Of course, you can change the variables that specify fontification in whatever
12807 way you wish, typically by adding regexps. However, these new variables make
12808 it easier to make specific and common changes for the fontification of types.
12809
12810 *** Adding highlighting patterns to existing support
12811
12812 You can use the new function font-lock-add-keywords to add your own
12813 highlighting patterns, such as for project-local or user-specific constructs,
12814 for any mode.
12815
12816 For example, to highlight `FIXME:' words in C comments, put:
12817
12818 (font-lock-add-keywords 'c-mode '(("\\<FIXME:" 0 font-lock-warning-face t)))
12819
12820 in your ~/.emacs.
12821
12822 *** New faces
12823
12824 Font Lock now defines two new faces, font-lock-builtin-face and
12825 font-lock-warning-face. These are intended to highlight builtin keywords,
12826 distinct from a language's normal keywords, and objects that should be brought
12827 to user attention, respectively. Various modes now use these new faces.
12828
12829 *** Changes to fast-lock support mode
12830
12831 The fast-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now process
12832 cache files silently. You can use the new variable fast-lock-verbose, in the
12833 same way as font-lock-verbose, to control this feature.
12834
12835 *** Changes to lazy-lock support mode
12836
12837 The lazy-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now fontify
12838 according to the true syntactic context relative to other lines. You can use
12839 the new variable lazy-lock-defer-contextually to control this feature. If
12840 non-nil, changes to the buffer will cause subsequent lines in the buffer to be
12841 refontified after lazy-lock-defer-time seconds of idle time. If nil, then only
12842 the modified lines will be refontified; this is the same as the previous Lazy
12843 Lock mode behavior and the behavior of Font Lock mode.
12844
12845 This feature is useful in modes where strings or comments can span lines.
12846 For example, if a string or comment terminating character is deleted, then if
12847 this feature is enabled subsequent lines in the buffer will be correctly
12848 refontified to reflect their new syntactic context. Previously, only the line
12849 containing the deleted character would be refontified and you would have to use
12850 the command M-o M-o (font-lock-fontify-block) to refontify some lines.
12851
12852 As a consequence of this new feature, two other variables have changed:
12853
12854 Variable `lazy-lock-defer-driven' is renamed `lazy-lock-defer-on-scrolling'.
12855 Variable `lazy-lock-defer-time' can now only be a time, i.e., a number.
12856 Buffer modes for which on-the-fly deferral applies can be specified via the
12857 new variable `lazy-lock-defer-on-the-fly'.
12858
12859 If you set these variables in your ~/.emacs, then you may have to change those
12860 settings.
12861
12862 ** Ada mode changes.
12863
12864 *** There is now better support for using find-file.el with Ada mode.
12865 If you switch between spec and body, the cursor stays in the same
12866 procedure (modulo overloading). If a spec has no body file yet, but
12867 you try to switch to its body file, Ada mode now generates procedure
12868 stubs.
12869
12870 *** There are two new commands:
12871 - `ada-make-local' : invokes gnatmake on the current buffer
12872 - `ada-check-syntax' : check syntax of current buffer.
12873
12874 The user options `ada-compiler-make', `ada-make-options',
12875 `ada-language-version', `ada-compiler-syntax-check', and
12876 `ada-compile-options' are used within these commands.
12877
12878 *** Ada mode can now work with Outline minor mode. The outline level
12879 is calculated from the indenting, not from syntactic constructs.
12880 Outlining does not work if your code is not correctly indented.
12881
12882 *** The new function `ada-gnat-style' converts the buffer to the style of
12883 formatting used in GNAT. It places two blanks after a comment start,
12884 places one blank between a word end and an opening '(', and puts one
12885 space between a comma and the beginning of a word.
12886
12887 ** Scheme mode changes.
12888
12889 *** Scheme mode indentation now uses many of the facilities of Lisp
12890 mode; therefore, the variables to customize it are the variables used
12891 for Lisp mode which have names starting with `lisp-'. The variables
12892 with names starting with `scheme-' which used to do this no longer
12893 have any effect.
12894
12895 If you want to use different indentation for Scheme and Lisp, this is
12896 still possible, but now you must do it by adding a hook to
12897 scheme-mode-hook, which could work by setting the `lisp-' indentation
12898 variables as buffer-local variables.
12899
12900 *** DSSSL mode is a variant of Scheme mode, for editing DSSSL scripts.
12901 Use M-x dsssl-mode.
12902
12903 ** Changes to the emacsclient program
12904
12905 *** If a socket can't be found, and environment variables LOGNAME or
12906 USER are set, emacsclient now looks for a socket based on the UID
12907 associated with the name. That is an emacsclient running as root
12908 can connect to an Emacs server started by a non-root user.
12909
12910 *** The emacsclient program now accepts an option --no-wait which tells
12911 it to return immediately without waiting for you to "finish" the
12912 buffer in Emacs.
12913
12914 *** The new option --alternate-editor allows to specify an editor to
12915 use if Emacs is not running. The environment variable
12916 ALTERNATE_EDITOR can be used for the same effect; the command line
12917 option takes precedence.
12918
12919 ** M-x eldoc-mode enables a minor mode in which the echo area
12920 constantly shows the parameter list for function being called at point
12921 (in Emacs Lisp and Lisp Interaction modes only).
12922
12923 ** C-x n d now runs the new command narrow-to-defun,
12924 which narrows the accessible parts of the buffer to just
12925 the current defun.
12926
12927 ** Emacs now handles the `--' argument in the standard way; all
12928 following arguments are treated as ordinary file names.
12929
12930 ** On MSDOS and Windows, the bookmark file is now called _emacs.bmk,
12931 and the saved desktop file is now called _emacs.desktop (truncated if
12932 necessary).
12933
12934 ** When you kill a buffer that visits a file,
12935 if there are any registers that save positions in the file,
12936 these register values no longer become completely useless.
12937 If you try to go to such a register with C-x j, then you are
12938 asked whether to visit the file again. If you say yes,
12939 it visits the file and then goes to the same position.
12940
12941 ** When you visit a file that changes frequently outside Emacs--for
12942 example, a log of output from a process that continues to run--it may
12943 be useful for Emacs to revert the file without querying you whenever
12944 you visit the file afresh with C-x C-f.
12945
12946 You can request this behavior for certain files by setting the
12947 variable revert-without-query to a list of regular expressions. If a
12948 file's name matches any of these regular expressions, find-file and
12949 revert-buffer revert the buffer without asking for permission--but
12950 only if you have not edited the buffer text yourself.
12951
12952 ** set-default-font has been renamed to set-frame-font
12953 since it applies only to the current frame.
12954
12955 ** In TeX mode, you can use the variable tex-main-file to specify the
12956 file for tex-file to run TeX on. (By default, tex-main-file is nil,
12957 and tex-file runs TeX on the current visited file.)
12958
12959 This is useful when you are editing a document that consists of
12960 multiple files. In each of the included files, you can set up a local
12961 variable list which specifies the top-level file of your document for
12962 tex-main-file. Then tex-file will run TeX on the whole document
12963 instead of just the file you are editing.
12964
12965 ** RefTeX mode
12966
12967 RefTeX mode is a new minor mode with special support for \label, \ref
12968 and \cite macros in LaTeX documents. RefTeX distinguishes labels of
12969 different environments (equation, figure, ...) and has full support for
12970 multifile documents. To use it, select a buffer with a LaTeX document and
12971 turn the mode on with M-x reftex-mode. Here are the main user commands:
12972
12973 C-c ( reftex-label
12974 Creates a label semi-automatically. RefTeX is context sensitive and
12975 knows which kind of label is needed.
12976
12977 C-c ) reftex-reference
12978 Offers in a menu all labels in the document, along with context of the
12979 label definition. The selected label is referenced as \ref{LABEL}.
12980
12981 C-c [ reftex-citation
12982 Prompts for a regular expression and displays a list of matching BibTeX
12983 database entries. The selected entry is cited with a \cite{KEY} macro.
12984
12985 C-c & reftex-view-crossref
12986 Views the cross reference of a \ref or \cite command near point.
12987
12988 C-c = reftex-toc
12989 Shows a table of contents of the (multifile) document. From there you
12990 can quickly jump to every section.
12991
12992 Under X, RefTeX installs a "Ref" menu in the menu bar, with additional
12993 commands. Press `?' to get help when a prompt mentions this feature.
12994 Full documentation and customization examples are in the file
12995 reftex.el. You can use the finder to view the file documentation:
12996 C-h p --> tex --> reftex.el
12997
12998 ** Changes in BibTeX mode.
12999
13000 *** Info documentation is now available.
13001
13002 *** Don't allow parentheses in string constants anymore. This confused
13003 both the BibTeX program and Emacs BibTeX mode.
13004
13005 *** Renamed variable bibtex-mode-user-optional-fields to
13006 bibtex-user-optional-fields.
13007
13008 *** Removed variable bibtex-include-OPTannote
13009 (use bibtex-user-optional-fields instead).
13010
13011 *** New interactive functions to copy and kill fields and complete
13012 entries to the BibTeX kill ring, from where they can be yanked back by
13013 appropriate functions.
13014
13015 *** New interactive functions for repositioning and marking of
13016 entries. They are bound by default to C-M-l and C-M-h.
13017
13018 *** New hook bibtex-clean-entry-hook. It is called after entry has
13019 been cleaned.
13020
13021 *** New variable bibtex-field-delimiters, which replaces variables
13022 bibtex-field-{left|right}-delimiter.
13023
13024 *** New variable bibtex-entry-delimiters to determine how entries
13025 shall be delimited.
13026
13027 *** Allow preinitialization of fields. See documentation of
13028 bibtex-user-optional-fields, bibtex-entry-field-alist, and
13029 bibtex-include-OPTkey for details.
13030
13031 *** Book and InBook entries require either an author or an editor
13032 field. This is now supported by bibtex.el. Alternative fields are
13033 prefixed with `ALT'.
13034
13035 *** New variable bibtex-entry-format, which replaces variable
13036 bibtex-clean-entry-zap-empty-opts and allows specification of many
13037 formatting options performed on cleaning an entry (see variable
13038 documentation).
13039
13040 *** Even more control on how automatic keys are generated. See
13041 documentation of bibtex-generate-autokey for details. Transcriptions
13042 for foreign languages other than German are now handled, too.
13043
13044 *** New boolean user option bibtex-comma-after-last-field to decide if
13045 comma should be inserted at end of last field.
13046
13047 *** New boolean user option bibtex-align-at-equal-sign to determine if
13048 alignment should be made at left side of field contents or at equal
13049 signs. New user options to control entry layout (e.g. indentation).
13050
13051 *** New function bibtex-fill-entry to realign entries.
13052
13053 *** New function bibtex-reformat to reformat region or buffer.
13054
13055 *** New function bibtex-convert-alien to convert a BibTeX database
13056 from alien sources.
13057
13058 *** New function bibtex-complete-key (similar to bibtex-complete-string)
13059 to complete prefix to a key defined in buffer. Mainly useful in
13060 crossref entries.
13061
13062 *** New function bibtex-count-entries to count entries in buffer or
13063 region.
13064
13065 *** Added support for imenu.
13066
13067 *** The function `bibtex-validate' now checks current region instead
13068 of buffer if mark is active. Now it shows all errors of buffer in a
13069 `compilation mode' buffer. You can use the normal commands (e.g.
13070 `next-error') for compilation modes to jump to errors.
13071
13072 *** New variable `bibtex-string-file-path' to determine where the files
13073 from `bibtex-string-files' are searched.
13074
13075 ** Iso Accents mode now supports Latin-3 as an alternative.
13076
13077 ** The command next-error now opens blocks hidden by hideshow.
13078
13079 ** The function using-unix-filesystems has been replaced by the
13080 functions add-untranslated-filesystem and remove-untranslated-filesystem.
13081 Each of these functions takes the name of a drive letter or directory
13082 as an argument.
13083
13084 When a filesystem is added as untranslated, all files on it are read
13085 and written in binary mode (no cr/lf translation is performed).
13086
13087 ** browse-url changes
13088
13089 *** New methods for: Grail (browse-url-generic), MMM (browse-url-mmm),
13090 Lynx in a separate xterm (browse-url-lynx-xterm) or in an Emacs window
13091 (browse-url-lynx-emacs), remote W3 (browse-url-w3-gnudoit), generic
13092 non-remote-controlled browsers (browse-url-generic) and associated
13093 customization variables.
13094
13095 *** New commands `browse-url-of-region' and `browse-url'.
13096
13097 *** URLs marked up with <URL:...> (RFC1738) work if broken across
13098 lines. Browsing methods can be associated with URL regexps
13099 (e.g. mailto: URLs) via `browse-url-browser-function'.
13100
13101 ** Changes in Ediff
13102
13103 *** Clicking Mouse-2 on a brief command description in Ediff control panel
13104 pops up the Info file for this command.
13105
13106 *** There is now a variable, ediff-autostore-merges, which controls whether
13107 the result of a merge is saved in a file. By default, this is done only when
13108 merge is done from a session group (eg, when merging files in two different
13109 directories).
13110
13111 *** Since Emacs 19.31 (this hasn't been announced before), Ediff can compare
13112 and merge groups of files residing in different directories, or revisions of
13113 files in the same directory.
13114
13115 *** Since Emacs 19.31, Ediff can apply multi-file patches interactively.
13116 The patches must be in the context format or GNU unified format. (The bug
13117 related to the GNU format has now been fixed.)
13118
13119 ** Changes in Viper
13120
13121 *** The startup file is now .viper instead of .vip
13122 *** All variable/function names have been changed to start with viper-
13123 instead of vip-.
13124 *** C-\ now simulates the meta-key in all Viper states.
13125 *** C-z in Insert state now escapes to Vi for the duration of the next
13126 Viper command. In Vi and Insert states, C-z behaves as before.
13127 *** C-c \ escapes to Vi for one command if Viper is in Insert or Emacs states.
13128 *** _ is no longer the meta-key in Vi state.
13129 *** The variable viper-insert-state-cursor-color can be used to change cursor
13130 color when Viper is in insert state.
13131 *** If search lands the cursor near the top or the bottom of the window,
13132 Viper pulls the window up or down to expose more context. The variable
13133 viper-adjust-window-after-search controls this behavior.
13134
13135 ** Etags changes.
13136
13137 *** In C, C++, Objective C and Java, Etags tags global variables by
13138 default. The resulting tags files are inflated by 30% on average.
13139 Use --no-globals to turn this feature off. Etags can also tag
13140 variables which are members of structure-like constructs, but it does
13141 not by default. Use --members to turn this feature on.
13142
13143 *** C++ member functions are now recognized as tags.
13144
13145 *** Java is tagged like C++. In addition, "extends" and "implements"
13146 constructs are tagged. Files are recognised by the extension .java.
13147
13148 *** Etags can now handle programs written in Postscript. Files are
13149 recognised by the extensions .ps and .pdb (Postscript with C syntax).
13150 In Postscript, tags are lines that start with a slash.
13151
13152 *** Etags now handles Objective C and Objective C++ code. The usual C and
13153 C++ tags are recognized in these languages; in addition, etags
13154 recognizes special Objective C syntax for classes, class categories,
13155 methods and protocols.
13156
13157 *** Etags also handles Cobol. Files are recognised by the extension
13158 .cobol. The tagged lines are those containing a word that begins in
13159 column 8 and ends in a full stop, i.e. anything that could be a
13160 paragraph name.
13161
13162 *** Regexps in Etags now support intervals, as in ed or grep. The syntax of
13163 an interval is \{M,N\}, and it means to match the preceding expression
13164 at least M times and as many as N times.
13165
13166 ** The format for specifying a custom format for time-stamp to insert
13167 in files has changed slightly.
13168
13169 With the new enhancements to the functionality of format-time-string,
13170 time-stamp-format will change to be eventually compatible with it.
13171 This conversion is being done in two steps to maintain compatibility
13172 with old time-stamp-format values.
13173
13174 In the new scheme, alternate case is signified by the number-sign
13175 (`#') modifier, rather than changing the case of the format character.
13176 This feature is as yet incompletely implemented for compatibility
13177 reasons.
13178
13179 In the old time-stamp-format, all numeric fields defaulted to their
13180 natural width. (With format-time-string, each format has a
13181 fixed-width default.) In this version, you can specify the colon
13182 (`:') modifier to a numeric conversion to mean "give me the historical
13183 time-stamp-format width default." Do not use colon if you are
13184 specifying an explicit width, as in "%02d".
13185
13186 Numbers are no longer truncated to the requested width, except in the
13187 case of "%02y", which continues to give a two-digit year. Digit
13188 truncation probably wasn't being used for anything else anyway.
13189
13190 The new formats will work with old versions of Emacs. New formats are
13191 being recommended now to allow time-stamp-format to change in the
13192 future to be compatible with format-time-string. The new forms being
13193 recommended now will continue to work then.
13194
13195 See the documentation string for the variable time-stamp-format for
13196 details.
13197
13198 ** There are some additional major modes:
13199
13200 dcl-mode, for editing VMS DCL files.
13201 m4-mode, for editing files of m4 input.
13202 meta-mode, for editing MetaFont and MetaPost source files.
13203
13204 ** In Shell mode, the command shell-copy-environment-variable lets you
13205 copy the value of a specified environment variable from the subshell
13206 into Emacs.
13207
13208 ** New Lisp packages include:
13209
13210 *** battery.el displays battery status for laptops.
13211
13212 *** M-x bruce (named after Lenny Bruce) is a program that might
13213 be used for adding some indecent words to your email.
13214
13215 *** M-x crisp-mode enables an emulation for the CRiSP editor.
13216
13217 *** M-x dirtrack arranges for better tracking of directory changes
13218 in shell buffers.
13219
13220 *** The new library elint.el provides for linting of Emacs Lisp code.
13221 See the documentation for `elint-initialize', `elint-current-buffer'
13222 and `elint-defun'.
13223
13224 *** M-x expand-add-abbrevs defines a special kind of abbrev which is
13225 meant for programming constructs. These abbrevs expand like ordinary
13226 ones, when you type SPC, but only at the end of a line and not within
13227 strings or comments.
13228
13229 These abbrevs can act as templates: you can define places within an
13230 abbrev for insertion of additional text. Once you expand the abbrev,
13231 you can then use C-x a p and C-x a n to move back and forth to these
13232 insertion points. Thus you can conveniently insert additional text
13233 at these points.
13234
13235 *** filecache.el remembers the location of files so that you
13236 can visit them by short forms of their names.
13237
13238 *** find-func.el lets you find the definition of the user-loaded
13239 Emacs Lisp function at point.
13240
13241 *** M-x handwrite converts text to a "handwritten" picture.
13242
13243 *** M-x iswitchb-buffer is a command for switching to a buffer, much like
13244 switch-buffer, but it reads the argument in a more helpful way.
13245
13246 *** M-x landmark implements a neural network for landmark learning.
13247
13248 *** M-x locate provides a convenient interface to the `locate' program.
13249
13250 *** M4 mode is a new mode for editing files of m4 input.
13251
13252 *** mantemp.el creates C++ manual template instantiations
13253 from the GCC error messages which indicate which instantiations are needed.
13254
13255 *** mouse-copy.el provides a one-click copy and move feature.
13256 You can drag a region with M-mouse-1, and it is automatically
13257 inserted at point. M-Shift-mouse-1 deletes the text from its
13258 original place after inserting the copy.
13259
13260 *** mouse-drag.el lets you do scrolling by dragging Mouse-2
13261 on the buffer.
13262
13263 You click the mouse and move; that distance either translates into the
13264 velocity to scroll (with mouse-drag-throw) or the distance to scroll
13265 (with mouse-drag-drag). Horizontal scrolling is enabled when needed.
13266
13267 Enable mouse-drag with:
13268 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-throw)
13269 -or-
13270 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-drag)
13271
13272 *** mspools.el is useful for determining which mail folders have
13273 mail waiting to be read in them. It works with procmail.
13274
13275 *** Octave mode is a major mode for editing files of input for Octave.
13276 It comes with a facility for communicating with an Octave subprocess.
13277
13278 *** ogonek
13279
13280 The ogonek package provides functions for changing the coding of
13281 Polish diacritic characters in buffers. Codings known from various
13282 platforms are supported such as ISO8859-2, Mazovia, IBM Latin2, and
13283 TeX. For example, you can change the coding from Mazovia to
13284 ISO8859-2. Another example is a change of coding from ISO8859-2 to
13285 prefix notation (in which `/a' stands for the aogonek character, for
13286 instance) and vice versa.
13287
13288 To use this package load it using
13289 M-x load-library [enter] ogonek
13290 Then, you may get an explanation by calling one of
13291 M-x ogonek-jak -- in Polish
13292 M-x ogonek-how -- in English
13293 The info specifies the commands and variables provided as well as the
13294 ways of customization in `.emacs'.
13295
13296 *** Interface to ph.
13297
13298 Emacs provides a client interface to CCSO Nameservers (ph/qi)
13299
13300 The CCSO nameserver is used in many universities to provide directory
13301 services about people. ph.el provides a convenient Emacs interface to
13302 these servers.
13303
13304 *** uce.el is useful for replying to unsolicited commercial email.
13305
13306 *** vcursor.el implements a "virtual cursor" feature.
13307 You can move the virtual cursor with special commands
13308 while the real cursor does not move.
13309
13310 *** webjump.el is a "hot list" package which you can set up
13311 for visiting your favorite web sites.
13312
13313 *** M-x winner-mode is a minor mode which saves window configurations,
13314 so you can move back to other configurations that you have recently used.
13315
13316 ** movemail change
13317
13318 Movemail no longer needs to be installed setuid root in order for POP
13319 mail retrieval to function properly. This is because it no longer
13320 supports the RPOP (reserved-port POP) protocol; instead, it uses the
13321 user's POP password to authenticate to the mail server.
13322
13323 This change was made earlier, but not reported in NEWS before.
13324 \f
13325 * Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows.
13326
13327 ** Changes in handling MS-DOS/MS-Windows text files.
13328
13329 Emacs handles three different conventions for representing
13330 end-of-line: CRLF for MSDOS, LF for Unix and GNU, and CR (used on the
13331 Macintosh). Emacs determines which convention is used in a specific
13332 file based on the contents of that file (except for certain special
13333 file names), and when it saves the file, it uses the same convention.
13334
13335 To save the file and change the end-of-line convention, you can use
13336 C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system) to specify a different
13337 coding system for the buffer. Then, when you save the file, the newly
13338 specified coding system will take effect. For example, to save with
13339 LF, specify undecided-unix (or some other ...-unix coding system); to
13340 save with CRLF, specify undecided-dos.
13341 \f
13342 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 20.1
13343
13344 ** Byte-compiled files made with Emacs 20 will, in general, work in
13345 Emacs 19 as well, as long as the source code runs in Emacs 19. And
13346 vice versa: byte-compiled files made with Emacs 19 should also run in
13347 Emacs 20, as long as the program itself works in Emacs 20.
13348
13349 ** Windows-specific functions and variables have been renamed
13350 to start with w32- instead of win32-.
13351
13352 In hacker language, calling something a "win" is a form of praise. We
13353 don't want to praise a non-free Microsoft system, so we don't call it
13354 "win".
13355
13356 ** Basic Lisp changes
13357
13358 *** A symbol whose name starts with a colon now automatically
13359 evaluates to itself. Therefore such a symbol can be used as a constant.
13360
13361 *** The defined purpose of `defconst' has been changed. It should now
13362 be used only for values that should not be changed whether by a program
13363 or by the user.
13364
13365 The actual behavior of defconst has not been changed.
13366
13367 *** There are new macros `when' and `unless'
13368
13369 (when CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION (progn BODY...))
13370 (unless CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION nil BODY...)
13371
13372 *** Emacs now defines functions caar, cadr, cdar and cddr with their
13373 usual Lisp meanings. For example, caar returns the car of the car of
13374 its argument.
13375
13376 *** equal, when comparing strings, now ignores their text properties.
13377
13378 *** The new function `functionp' tests whether an object is a function.
13379
13380 *** arrayp now returns t for char-tables and bool-vectors.
13381
13382 *** Certain primitives which use characters (as integers) now get an
13383 error if the integer is not a valid character code. These primitives
13384 include insert-char, char-to-string, and the %c construct in the
13385 `format' function.
13386
13387 *** The `require' function now insists on adding a suffix, either .el
13388 or .elc, to the file name. Thus, (require 'foo) will not use a file
13389 whose name is just foo. It insists on foo.el or foo.elc.
13390
13391 *** The `autoload' function, when the file name does not contain
13392 either a directory name or the suffix .el or .elc, insists on
13393 adding one of these suffixes.
13394
13395 *** string-to-number now takes an optional second argument BASE
13396 which specifies the base to use when converting an integer.
13397 If BASE is omitted, base 10 is used.
13398
13399 We have not implemented other radices for floating point numbers,
13400 because that would be much more work and does not seem useful.
13401
13402 *** substring now handles vectors as well as strings.
13403
13404 *** The Common Lisp function eql is no longer defined normally.
13405 You must load the `cl' library to define it.
13406
13407 *** The new macro `with-current-buffer' lets you evaluate an expression
13408 conveniently with a different current buffer. It looks like this:
13409
13410 (with-current-buffer BUFFER BODY-FORMS...)
13411
13412 BUFFER is the expression that says which buffer to use.
13413 BODY-FORMS say what to do in that buffer.
13414
13415 *** The new primitive `save-current-buffer' saves and restores the
13416 choice of current buffer, like `save-excursion', but without saving or
13417 restoring the value of point or the mark. `with-current-buffer'
13418 works using `save-current-buffer'.
13419
13420 *** The new macro `with-temp-file' lets you do some work in a new buffer and
13421 write the output to a specified file. Like `progn', it returns the value
13422 of the last form.
13423
13424 *** The new macro `with-temp-buffer' lets you do some work in a new buffer,
13425 which is discarded after use. Like `progn', it returns the value of the
13426 last form. If you wish to return the buffer contents, use (buffer-string)
13427 as the last form.
13428
13429 *** The new function split-string takes a string, splits it at certain
13430 characters, and returns a list of the substrings in between the
13431 matches.
13432
13433 For example, (split-string "foo bar lose" " +") returns ("foo" "bar" "lose").
13434
13435 *** The new macro with-output-to-string executes some Lisp expressions
13436 with standard-output set up so that all output feeds into a string.
13437 Then it returns that string.
13438
13439 For example, if the current buffer name is `foo',
13440
13441 (with-output-to-string
13442 (princ "The buffer is ")
13443 (princ (buffer-name)))
13444
13445 returns "The buffer is foo".
13446
13447 ** Non-ASCII characters are now supported, if enable-multibyte-characters
13448 is non-nil.
13449
13450 These characters have character codes above 256. When inserted in the
13451 buffer or stored in a string, they are represented as multibyte
13452 characters that occupy several buffer positions each.
13453
13454 *** When enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, a single character in
13455 a buffer or string can be two or more bytes (as many as four).
13456
13457 Buffers and strings are still made up of unibyte elements;
13458 character positions and string indices are always measured in bytes.
13459 Therefore, moving forward one character can increase the buffer
13460 position by 2, 3 or 4. The function forward-char moves by whole
13461 characters, and therefore is no longer equivalent to
13462 (lambda (n) (goto-char (+ (point) n))).
13463
13464 ASCII characters (codes 0 through 127) are still single bytes, always.
13465 Sequences of byte values 128 through 255 are used to represent
13466 non-ASCII characters. These sequences are called "multibyte
13467 characters".
13468
13469 The first byte of a multibyte character is always in the range 128
13470 through 159 (octal 0200 through 0237). These values are called
13471 "leading codes". The second and subsequent bytes are always in the
13472 range 160 through 255 (octal 0240 through 0377). The first byte, the
13473 leading code, determines how many bytes long the sequence is.
13474
13475 *** The function forward-char moves over characters, and therefore
13476 (forward-char 1) may increase point by more than 1 if it moves over a
13477 multibyte character. Likewise, delete-char always deletes a
13478 character, which may be more than one buffer position.
13479
13480 This means that some Lisp programs, which assume that a character is
13481 always one buffer position, need to be changed.
13482
13483 However, all ASCII characters are always one buffer position.
13484
13485 *** The regexp [\200-\377] no longer matches all non-ASCII characters,
13486 because when enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, these characters
13487 have codes that are not in the range octal 200 to octal 377. However,
13488 the regexp [^\000-\177] does match all non-ASCII characters,
13489 guaranteed.
13490
13491 *** The function char-boundary-p returns non-nil if position POS is
13492 between two characters in the buffer (not in the middle of a
13493 character).
13494
13495 When the value is non-nil, it says what kind of character follows POS:
13496
13497 0 if POS is at an ASCII character or at the end of range,
13498 1 if POS is before a 2-byte length multi-byte form,
13499 2 if POS is at a head of 3-byte length multi-byte form,
13500 3 if POS is at a head of 4-byte length multi-byte form,
13501 4 if POS is at a head of multi-byte form of a composite character.
13502
13503 *** The function char-bytes returns how many bytes the character CHAR uses.
13504
13505 *** Strings can contain multibyte characters. The function
13506 `length' returns the string length counting bytes, which may be
13507 more than the number of characters.
13508
13509 You can include a multibyte character in a string constant by writing
13510 it literally. You can also represent it with a hex escape,
13511 \xNNNNNNN..., using as many digits as necessary. Any character which
13512 is not a valid hex digit terminates this construct. If you want to
13513 follow it with a character that is a hex digit, write backslash and
13514 newline in between; that will terminate the hex escape.
13515
13516 *** The function concat-chars takes arguments which are characters
13517 and returns a string containing those characters.
13518
13519 *** The function sref access a multibyte character in a string.
13520 (sref STRING INDX) returns the character in STRING at INDEX. INDEX
13521 counts from zero. If INDEX is at a position in the middle of a
13522 character, sref signals an error.
13523
13524 *** The function chars-in-string returns the number of characters
13525 in a string. This is less than the length of the string, if the
13526 string contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
13527
13528 *** The function chars-in-region returns the number of characters
13529 in a region from BEG to END. This is less than (- END BEG) if the
13530 region contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
13531
13532 *** The function string-to-list converts a string to a list of
13533 the characters in it. string-to-vector converts a string
13534 to a vector of the characters in it.
13535
13536 *** The function store-substring alters part of the contents
13537 of a string. You call it as follows:
13538
13539 (store-substring STRING IDX OBJ)
13540
13541 This says to alter STRING, by storing OBJ starting at index IDX in
13542 STRING. OBJ may be either a character or a (smaller) string.
13543 This function really does alter the contents of STRING.
13544 Since it is impossible to change the length of an existing string,
13545 it is an error if OBJ doesn't fit within STRING's actual length.
13546
13547 *** char-width returns the width (in columns) of the character CHAR,
13548 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
13549
13550 *** string-width returns the width (in columns) of the text in STRING,
13551 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
13552
13553 *** truncate-string-to-width shortens a string, if necessary,
13554 to fit within a certain number of columns. (Of course, it does
13555 not alter the string that you give it; it returns a new string
13556 which contains all or just part of the existing string.)
13557
13558 (truncate-string-to-width STR END-COLUMN &optional START-COLUMN PADDING)
13559
13560 This returns the part of STR up to column END-COLUMN.
13561
13562 The optional argument START-COLUMN specifies the starting column.
13563 If this is non-nil, then the first START-COLUMN columns of the string
13564 are not included in the resulting value.
13565
13566 The optional argument PADDING, if non-nil, is a padding character to be added
13567 at the beginning and end the resulting string, to extend it to exactly
13568 WIDTH columns. If PADDING is nil, that means do not pad; then, if STRING
13569 is narrower than WIDTH, the value is equal to STRING.
13570
13571 If PADDING and START-COLUMN are both non-nil, and if there is no clean
13572 place in STRING that corresponds to START-COLUMN (because one
13573 character extends across that column), then the padding character
13574 PADDING is added one or more times at the beginning of the result
13575 string, so that its columns line up as if it really did start at
13576 column START-COLUMN.
13577
13578 *** When the functions in the list after-change-functions are called,
13579 the third argument is the number of bytes in the pre-change text, not
13580 necessarily the number of characters. It is, in effect, the
13581 difference in buffer position between the beginning and the end of the
13582 changed text, before the change.
13583
13584 *** The characters Emacs uses are classified in various character
13585 sets, each of which has a name which is a symbol. In general there is
13586 one character set for each script, not for each language.
13587
13588 **** The function charsetp tests whether an object is a character set name.
13589
13590 **** The variable charset-list holds a list of character set names.
13591
13592 **** char-charset, given a character code, returns the name of the character
13593 set that the character belongs to. (The value is a symbol.)
13594
13595 **** split-char, given a character code, returns a list containing the
13596 name of the character set, followed by one or two byte-values
13597 which identify the character within that character set.
13598
13599 **** make-char, given a character set name and one or two subsequent
13600 byte-values, constructs a character code. This is roughly the
13601 opposite of split-char.
13602
13603 **** find-charset-region returns a list of the character sets
13604 of all the characters between BEG and END.
13605
13606 **** find-charset-string returns a list of the character sets
13607 of all the characters in a string.
13608
13609 *** Here are the Lisp facilities for working with coding systems
13610 and specifying coding systems.
13611
13612 **** The function coding-system-list returns a list of all coding
13613 system names (symbols). With optional argument t, it returns a list
13614 of all distinct base coding systems, not including variants.
13615 (Variant coding systems are those like latin-1-dos, latin-1-unix
13616 and latin-1-mac which specify the end-of-line conversion as well
13617 as what to do about code conversion.)
13618
13619 **** coding-system-p tests a symbol to see if it is a coding system
13620 name. It returns t if so, nil if not.
13621
13622 **** file-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
13623 for certain file names. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
13624 except that the PATTERN is matched against the file name.
13625
13626 Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
13627 which file names the element applies to. PATTERN should be a regexp
13628 to match against a file name.
13629
13630 VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
13631 a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
13632 decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
13633 to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
13634 systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
13635 specifies the coding system for encoding.
13636
13637 If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
13638 or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
13639
13640 **** The variable network-coding-system-alist specifies
13641 the coding system to use for network sockets.
13642
13643 Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
13644 which network sockets the element applies to. PATTERN should be
13645 either a port number or a regular expression matching some network
13646 service names.
13647
13648 VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
13649 a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
13650 decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
13651 to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
13652 systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
13653 specifies the coding system for encoding.
13654
13655 If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
13656 or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
13657
13658 **** process-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
13659 for certain subprocess. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
13660 except that the PATTERN is matched against the program name used to
13661 start the subprocess.
13662
13663 **** The variable default-process-coding-system specifies the coding
13664 systems to use for subprocess (and net connection) input and output,
13665 when nothing else specifies what to do. The value is a cons cell
13666 (OUTPUT-CODING . INPUT-CODING). OUTPUT-CODING applies to output
13667 to the subprocess, and INPUT-CODING applies to input from it.
13668
13669 **** The variable coding-system-for-write, if non-nil, specifies the
13670 coding system to use for writing a file, or for output to a synchronous
13671 subprocess.
13672
13673 It also applies to any asynchronous subprocess or network connection,
13674 but in a different way: the value of coding-system-for-write when you
13675 start the subprocess or connection affects that subprocess or
13676 connection permanently or until overridden.
13677
13678 The variable coding-system-for-write takes precedence over
13679 file-coding-system-alist, process-coding-system-alist and
13680 network-coding-system-alist, and all other methods of specifying a
13681 coding system for output. But most of the time this variable is nil.
13682 It exists so that Lisp programs can bind it to a specific coding
13683 system for one operation at a time.
13684
13685 **** coding-system-for-read applies similarly to input from
13686 files, subprocesses or network connections.
13687
13688 **** The function process-coding-system tells you what
13689 coding systems(s) an existing subprocess is using.
13690 The value is a cons cell,
13691 (DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM . ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM)
13692 where DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for decoding output from
13693 the subprocess, and ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for encoding
13694 input to the subprocess.
13695
13696 **** The function set-process-coding-system can be used to
13697 change the coding systems in use for an existing subprocess.
13698
13699 ** Emacs has a new facility to help users manage the many
13700 customization options. To make a Lisp program work with this facility,
13701 you need to use the new macros defgroup and defcustom.
13702
13703 You use defcustom instead of defvar, for defining a user option
13704 variable. The difference is that you specify two additional pieces of
13705 information (usually): the "type" which says what values are
13706 legitimate, and the "group" which specifies the hierarchy for
13707 customization.
13708
13709 Thus, instead of writing
13710
13711 (defvar foo-blurgoze nil
13712 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely.")
13713
13714 you would now write this:
13715
13716 (defcustom foo-blurgoze nil
13717 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely."
13718 :type 'boolean
13719 :group foo)
13720
13721 The type `boolean' means that this variable has only
13722 two meaningful states: nil and non-nil. Other type values
13723 describe other possibilities; see the manual for Custom
13724 for a description of them.
13725
13726 The "group" argument is used to specify a group which the option
13727 should belong to. You define a new group like this:
13728
13729 (defgroup ispell nil
13730 "Spell checking using Ispell."
13731 :group 'processes)
13732
13733 The "group" argument in defgroup specifies the parent group. The root
13734 group is called `emacs'; it should not contain any variables itself,
13735 but only other groups. The immediate subgroups of `emacs' correspond
13736 to the keywords used by C-h p. Under these subgroups come
13737 second-level subgroups that belong to individual packages.
13738
13739 Each Emacs package should have its own set of groups. A simple
13740 package should have just one group; a more complex package should
13741 have a hierarchy of its own groups. The sole or root group of a
13742 package should be a subgroup of one or more of the "keyword"
13743 first-level subgroups.
13744
13745 ** New `widget' library for inserting UI components in buffers.
13746
13747 This library, used by the new custom library, is documented in a
13748 separate manual that accompanies Emacs.
13749
13750 ** easy-mmode
13751
13752 The easy-mmode package provides macros and functions that make
13753 developing minor modes easier. Roughly, the programmer has to code
13754 only the functionality of the minor mode. All the rest--toggles,
13755 predicate, and documentation--can be done in one call to the macro
13756 `easy-mmode-define-minor-mode' (see the documentation). See also
13757 `easy-mmode-define-keymap'.
13758
13759 ** Text property changes
13760
13761 *** The `intangible' property now works on overlays as well as on a
13762 text property.
13763
13764 *** The new functions next-char-property-change and
13765 previous-char-property-change scan through the buffer looking for a
13766 place where either a text property or an overlay might change. The
13767 functions take two arguments, POSITION and LIMIT. POSITION is the
13768 starting position for the scan. LIMIT says where to stop the scan.
13769
13770 If no property change is found before LIMIT, the value is LIMIT. If
13771 LIMIT is nil, scan goes to the beginning or end of the accessible part
13772 of the buffer. If no property change is found, the value is the
13773 position of the beginning or end of the buffer.
13774
13775 *** In the `local-map' text property or overlay property, the property
13776 value can now be a symbol whose function definition is a keymap. This
13777 is an alternative to using the keymap itself.
13778
13779 ** Changes in invisibility features
13780
13781 *** Isearch can now temporarily show parts of the buffer which are
13782 hidden by an overlay with a invisible property, when the search match
13783 is inside that portion of the buffer. To enable this the overlay
13784 should have a isearch-open-invisible property which is a function that
13785 would be called having the overlay as an argument, the function should
13786 make the overlay visible.
13787
13788 During incremental search the overlays are shown by modifying the
13789 invisible and intangible properties, if beside this more actions are
13790 needed the overlay should have a isearch-open-invisible-temporary
13791 which is a function. The function is called with 2 arguments: one is
13792 the overlay and the second is nil when it should show the overlay and
13793 t when it should hide it.
13794
13795 *** add-to-invisibility-spec, remove-from-invisibility-spec
13796
13797 Modes that use overlays to hide portions of a buffer should set the
13798 invisible property of the overlay to the mode's name (or another symbol)
13799 and modify the `buffer-invisibility-spec' to include that symbol.
13800 Use `add-to-invisibility-spec' and `remove-from-invisibility-spec' to
13801 manipulate the `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
13802 Here is an example of how to do this:
13803
13804 ;; If we want to display an ellipsis:
13805 (add-to-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
13806 ;; If you don't want ellipsis:
13807 (add-to-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
13808
13809 ...
13810 (overlay-put (make-overlay beginning end) 'invisible 'my-symbol)
13811
13812 ...
13813 ;; When done with the overlays:
13814 (remove-from-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
13815 ;; Or respectively:
13816 (remove-from-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
13817
13818 ** Changes in syntax parsing.
13819
13820 *** The syntax-directed buffer-scan functions (such as
13821 `parse-partial-sexp', `forward-word' and similar functions) can now
13822 obey syntax information specified by text properties, if the variable
13823 `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil.
13824
13825 If the value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is nil, the behavior
13826 is as before: the syntax-table of the current buffer is always
13827 used to determine the syntax of the character at the position.
13828
13829 When `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil, the syntax of a
13830 character in the buffer is calculated thus:
13831
13832 a) if the `syntax-table' text-property of that character
13833 is a cons, this cons becomes the syntax-type;
13834
13835 Valid values of `syntax-table' text-property are: nil, a valid
13836 syntax-table, and a valid syntax-table element, i.e.,
13837 a cons cell of the form (SYNTAX-CODE . MATCHING-CHAR).
13838
13839 b) if the character's `syntax-table' text-property
13840 is a syntax table, this syntax table is used
13841 (instead of the syntax-table of the current buffer) to
13842 determine the syntax type of the character.
13843
13844 c) otherwise the syntax-type is determined by the syntax-table
13845 of the current buffer.
13846
13847 *** The meaning of \s in regular expressions is also affected by the
13848 value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties'. The details are the same as
13849 for the syntax-directed buffer-scan functions.
13850
13851 *** There are two new syntax-codes, `!' and `|' (numeric values 14
13852 and 15). A character with a code `!' starts a comment which is ended
13853 only by another character with the same code (unless quoted). A
13854 character with a code `|' starts a string which is ended only by
13855 another character with the same code (unless quoted).
13856
13857 These codes are mainly meant for use as values of the `syntax-table'
13858 text property.
13859
13860 *** The function `parse-partial-sexp' has new semantics for the sixth
13861 arg COMMENTSTOP. If it is `syntax-table', parse stops after the start
13862 of a comment or a string, or after end of a comment or a string.
13863
13864 *** The state-list which the return value from `parse-partial-sexp'
13865 (and can also be used as an argument) now has an optional ninth
13866 element: the character address of the start of last comment or string;
13867 nil if none. The fourth and eighth elements have special values if the
13868 string/comment is started by a "!" or "|" syntax-code.
13869
13870 *** Since new features of `parse-partial-sexp' allow a complete
13871 syntactic parsing, `font-lock' no longer supports
13872 `font-lock-comment-start-regexp'.
13873
13874 ** Changes in face features
13875
13876 *** The face functions are now unconditionally defined in Emacs, even
13877 if it does not support displaying on a device that supports faces.
13878
13879 *** The function face-documentation returns the documentation string
13880 of a face (or nil if it doesn't have one).
13881
13882 *** The function face-bold-p returns t if a face should be bold.
13883 set-face-bold-p sets that flag.
13884
13885 *** The function face-italic-p returns t if a face should be italic.
13886 set-face-italic-p sets that flag.
13887
13888 *** You can now specify foreground and background colors for text
13889 by adding elements of the form (foreground-color . COLOR-NAME)
13890 and (background-color . COLOR-NAME) to the list of faces in
13891 the `face' property (either the character's text property or an
13892 overlay property).
13893
13894 This means that you no longer need to create named faces to use
13895 arbitrary colors in a Lisp package.
13896
13897 ** Changes in file-handling functions
13898
13899 *** File-access primitive functions no longer discard an extra redundant
13900 directory name from the beginning of the file name. In other words,
13901 they no longer do anything special with // or /~. That conversion
13902 is now done only in substitute-in-file-name.
13903
13904 This makes it possible for a Lisp program to open a file whose name
13905 begins with ~.
13906
13907 *** If copy-file is unable to set the date of the output file,
13908 it now signals an error with the condition file-date-error.
13909
13910 *** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
13911 the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a list of integers.
13912
13913 *** insert-file-contents can now read from a special file,
13914 as long as the arguments VISIT and REPLACE are nil.
13915
13916 *** The RAWFILE arg to find-file-noselect, if non-nil, now suppresses
13917 character code conversion as well as other things.
13918
13919 Meanwhile, this feature does work with remote file names
13920 (formerly it did not).
13921
13922 *** Lisp packages which create temporary files should use the TMPDIR
13923 environment variable to decide which directory to put them in.
13924
13925 *** interpreter-mode-alist elements now specify regexps
13926 instead of constant strings.
13927
13928 *** expand-file-name no longer treats `//' or `/~' specially. It used
13929 to delete all the text of a file name up through the first slash of
13930 any `//' or `/~' sequence. Now it passes them straight through.
13931
13932 substitute-in-file-name continues to treat those sequences specially,
13933 in the same way as before.
13934
13935 *** The variable `format-alist' is more general now.
13936 The FROM-FN and TO-FN in a format definition can now be strings
13937 which specify shell commands to use as filters to perform conversion.
13938
13939 *** The new function access-file tries to open a file, and signals an
13940 error if that fails. If the open succeeds, access-file does nothing
13941 else, and returns nil.
13942
13943 *** The function insert-directory now signals an error if the specified
13944 directory cannot be listed.
13945
13946 ** Changes in minibuffer input
13947
13948 *** The functions read-buffer, read-variable, read-command, read-string
13949 read-file-name, read-from-minibuffer and completing-read now take an
13950 additional argument which specifies the default value. If this
13951 argument is non-nil, it should be a string; that string is used in two
13952 ways:
13953
13954 It is returned if the user enters empty input.
13955 It is available through the history command M-n.
13956
13957 *** The functions read-string, read-from-minibuffer,
13958 read-no-blanks-input and completing-read now take an additional
13959 argument INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. If this is non-nil, then the
13960 minibuffer inherits the current input method and the setting of
13961 enable-multibyte-characters from the previously current buffer.
13962
13963 In an interactive spec, you can use M instead of s to read an
13964 argument in this way.
13965
13966 *** All minibuffer input functions discard text properties
13967 from the text you enter in the minibuffer, unless the variable
13968 minibuffer-allow-text-properties is non-nil.
13969
13970 ** Echo area features
13971
13972 *** Clearing the echo area now runs the normal hook
13973 echo-area-clear-hook. Note that the echo area can be used while the
13974 minibuffer is active; in that case, the minibuffer is still active
13975 after the echo area is cleared.
13976
13977 *** The function current-message returns the message currently displayed
13978 in the echo area, or nil if there is none.
13979
13980 ** Keyboard input features
13981
13982 *** tty-erase-char is a new variable that reports which character was
13983 set up as the terminal's erase character when time Emacs was started.
13984
13985 *** num-nonmacro-input-events is the total number of input events
13986 received so far from the terminal. It does not count those generated
13987 by keyboard macros.
13988
13989 ** Frame-related changes
13990
13991 *** make-frame runs the normal hook before-make-frame-hook just before
13992 creating a frame, and just after creating a frame it runs the abnormal
13993 hook after-make-frame-functions with the new frame as arg.
13994
13995 *** The new hook window-configuration-change-hook is now run every time
13996 the window configuration has changed. The frame whose configuration
13997 has changed is the selected frame when the hook is run.
13998
13999 *** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
14000 selected buffers, in its buffer-list frame parameter, so that the
14001 value of other-buffer is now based on the buffers recently displayed
14002 in the selected frame.
14003
14004 *** The value of the frame parameter vertical-scroll-bars
14005 is now `left', `right' or nil. A non-nil value specifies
14006 which side of the window to put the scroll bars on.
14007
14008 ** X Windows features
14009
14010 *** You can examine X resources for other applications by binding
14011 x-resource-class around a call to x-get-resource. The usual value of
14012 x-resource-class is "Emacs", which is the correct value for Emacs.
14013
14014 *** In menus, checkboxes and radio buttons now actually work.
14015 The menu displays the current status of the box or button.
14016
14017 *** The function x-list-fonts now takes an optional fourth argument
14018 MAXIMUM which sets a limit on how many matching fonts to return.
14019 A smaller value of MAXIMUM makes the function faster.
14020
14021 If the only question is whether *any* font matches the pattern,
14022 it is good to supply 1 for this argument.
14023
14024 ** Subprocess features
14025
14026 *** A reminder: it is no longer necessary for subprocess filter
14027 functions and sentinels to do save-match-data, because Emacs does this
14028 automatically.
14029
14030 *** The new function shell-command-to-string executes a shell command
14031 and returns the output from the command as a string.
14032
14033 *** The new function process-contact returns t for a child process,
14034 and (HOSTNAME SERVICE) for a net connection.
14035
14036 ** An error in running pre-command-hook or post-command-hook
14037 does clear the variable to nil. The documentation was wrong before.
14038
14039 ** In define-key-after, if AFTER is t, the new binding now always goes
14040 at the end of the keymap. If the keymap is a menu, this means it
14041 goes after the other menu items.
14042
14043 ** If you have a program that makes several changes in the same area
14044 of the buffer, you can use the macro combine-after-change-calls
14045 around that Lisp code to make it faster when after-change hooks
14046 are in use.
14047
14048 The macro arranges to call the after-change functions just once for a
14049 series of several changes--if that seems safe.
14050
14051 Don't alter the variables after-change-functions and
14052 after-change-function within the body of a combine-after-change-calls
14053 form.
14054
14055 ** If you define an abbrev (with define-abbrev) whose EXPANSION
14056 is not a string, then the abbrev does not expand in the usual sense,
14057 but its hook is still run.
14058
14059 ** Normally, the Lisp debugger is not used (even if you have enabled it)
14060 for errors that are handled by condition-case.
14061
14062 If you set debug-on-signal to a non-nil value, then the debugger is called
14063 regardless of whether there is a handler for the condition. This is
14064 useful for debugging problems that happen inside of a condition-case.
14065
14066 This mode of operation seems to be unreliable in other ways. Errors that
14067 are normal and ought to be handled, perhaps in timers or process
14068 filters, will instead invoke the debugger. So don't say you weren't
14069 warned.
14070
14071 ** The new variable ring-bell-function lets you specify your own
14072 way for Emacs to "ring the bell".
14073
14074 ** If run-at-time's TIME argument is t, the action is repeated at
14075 integral multiples of REPEAT from the epoch; this is useful for
14076 functions like display-time.
14077
14078 ** You can use the function locate-library to find the precise file
14079 name of a Lisp library. This isn't new, but wasn't documented before.
14080
14081 ** Commands for entering view mode have new optional arguments that
14082 can be used from Lisp. Low-level entrance to and exit from view mode
14083 is done by functions view-mode-enter and view-mode-exit.
14084
14085 ** batch-byte-compile-file now makes Emacs return a nonzero status code
14086 if there is an error in compilation.
14087
14088 ** pop-to-buffer, switch-to-buffer-other-window and
14089 switch-to-buffer-other-frame now accept an additional optional
14090 argument NORECORD, much like switch-to-buffer. If it is non-nil,
14091 they don't put the buffer at the front of the buffer list.
14092
14093 ** If your .emacs file leaves the *scratch* buffer non-empty,
14094 Emacs does not display the startup message, so as to avoid changing
14095 the *scratch* buffer.
14096
14097 ** The new function regexp-opt returns an efficient regexp to match a string.
14098 The arguments are STRINGS and (optionally) PAREN. This function can be used
14099 where regexp matching or searching is intensively used and speed is important,
14100 e.g., in Font Lock mode.
14101
14102 ** The variable buffer-display-count is local to each buffer,
14103 and is incremented each time the buffer is displayed in a window.
14104 It starts at 0 when the buffer is created.
14105
14106 ** The new function compose-mail starts composing a mail message
14107 using the user's chosen mail composition agent (specified with the
14108 variable mail-user-agent). It has variants compose-mail-other-window
14109 and compose-mail-other-frame.
14110
14111 ** The `user-full-name' function now takes an optional parameter which
14112 can either be a number (the UID) or a string (the login name). The
14113 full name of the specified user will be returned.
14114
14115 ** Lisp packages that load files of customizations, or any other sort
14116 of user profile, should obey the variable init-file-user in deciding
14117 where to find it. They should load the profile of the user name found
14118 in that variable. If init-file-user is nil, meaning that the -q
14119 option was used, then Lisp packages should not load the customization
14120 files at all.
14121
14122 ** format-time-string now allows you to specify the field width
14123 and type of padding. This works as in printf: you write the field
14124 width as digits in the middle of a %-construct. If you start
14125 the field width with 0, it means to pad with zeros.
14126
14127 For example, %S normally specifies the number of seconds since the
14128 minute; %03S means to pad this with zeros to 3 positions, %_3S to pad
14129 with spaces to 3 positions. Plain %3S pads with zeros, because that
14130 is how %S normally pads to two positions.
14131
14132 ** thing-at-point now supports a new kind of "thing": url.
14133
14134 ** imenu.el changes.
14135
14136 You can now specify a function to be run when selecting an
14137 item from menu created by imenu.
14138
14139 An example of using this feature: if we define imenu items for the
14140 #include directives in a C file, we can open the included file when we
14141 select one of those items.
14142 \f
14143 * For older news, see the file ONEWS
14144
14145 ----------------------------------------------------------------------
14146 Copyright information:
14147
14148 Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
14149
14150 Permission is granted to anyone to make or distribute verbatim copies
14151 of this document as received, in any medium, provided that the
14152 copyright notice and this permission notice are preserved,
14153 thus giving the recipient permission to redistribute in turn.
14154
14155 Permission is granted to distribute modified versions
14156 of this document, or of portions of it,
14157 under the above conditions, provided also that they
14158 carry prominent notices stating who last changed them.
14159 \f
14160 Local variables:
14161 mode: outline
14162 paragraph-separate: "[ \f]*$"
14163 end:
14164
14165 arch-tag: 1aca9dfa-2ac4-4d14-bebf-0007cee12793